As filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on December 29, 2017

Securities Act File No. 333-            

Investment Company Act File No. 811-22499

 

 

 

United States

Securities and Exchange Commission

Washington, D.C. 20549

 

 

FORM N-2

Registration Statement

under

   the Securities Act of 1933   
   Pre-Effective Amendment No.       
   Post-Effective Amendment No.       

and/or

Registration Statement

under

   the Investment Company Act of 1940   
   Amendment No. 7   

 

 

THE CUSHING ® RENAISSANCE FUND

(Exact Name of Registrant as Specified in Charter)

 

 

8117 Preston Road, Suite 440

Dallas, Texas 75225

(Address of Principal Executive Offices)

(214) 692-6334

(Registrant’s Telephone Number, Including Area Code)

Jerry V. Swank

Cushing ® Asset Management, LP

8117 Preston Road, Suite 440

Dallas, Texas 75225

(Name and Address of Agent for Service)

 

 

Copies to:

Kevin T. Hardy, Esq.

Skadden, Arps, Slate, Meagher & Flom LLP

155 North Wacker Drive

Chicago, Illinois 60606

 

 

Approximate date of proposed public offering: As soon as practicable after the effective date of this registration statement.

If any securities being registered on this form will be offered on a delayed or continuous basis in reliance on Rule 415 under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, other than securities offered in connection with a dividend reinvestment plan, check the following box  ☒

It is proposed that this filing will become effective (check appropriate box):

 

  When declared effective pursuant to section 8(c).

If appropriate, check the following box:

 

  This [post-effective] amendment designates a new effective date for a previously filed [post-effective amendment] [registration statement].

 

  This form is filed to register additional securities for an offering pursuant to Rule 462(b) under the Securities Act and the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement for the same offering is             .

 

 

CALCULATION OF REGISTRATION FEE UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933

 

 

Title of Securities Being Registered   Amount Being
Registered(1)
 

Proposed Maximum 
Offering Price

Per Share(2)

 

Proposed Maximum 
Aggregate

Offering Price(3)

  Amount of
Registration Fee

Common Shares, $0.001 par value

               

Subscription Rights for Common Shares

               

Total

          $1,000,000   $124.50

 

 

 

(1) There are being registered hereunder a presently indeterminate number of common shares and/or subscription rights to purchase common shares to be offered on an immediate, continuous or delayed basis.
(2) The proposed maximum offering price per share will be determined, from time to time, by the Registrant in connection with the sale by the Registrant of the securities registered under this registration statement.
(3) Estimated solely for the purpose of calculating the registration fee pursuant to Rule 457(o) under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended.

The Registrant hereby amends this Registration Statement on such date or dates as may be necessary to delay its effective date until the Registrant shall file a further amendment which specifically states that this Registration Statement shall thereafter become effective in accordance with Section 8(a) of the Securities Act of 1933 or until this Registration Statement shall become effective on such date as the Securities and Exchange Commission, acting pursuant to Section 8(a), may determine.

 

 

 


The information in this Preliminary Prospectus is not complete and may be changed. We may not sell these securities until the Registration Statement filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission is effective. This Preliminary Prospectus is not an offer to sell these securities and is not soliciting an offer to buy these securities in any state where the offer or sale is not permitted.

 

Subject To Completion Preliminary Prospectus dated December 29, 2017

 

LOGO

$        

The Cushing ® Renaissance Fund

Common Shares

Subscription Rights for Common Shares

 

 

Investment Objective . The Cushing ® Renaissance Fund (the “Fund”) is a non-diversified, closed-end management investment company. The Fund’s investment objective is to seek high total return with an emphasis on current income.

Investment Strategy. The Fund seeks to achieve its investment objective by investing, under normal conditions, at least 80% of its Managed Assets (as defined in this Prospectus) in a portfolio of (i) companies across the energy supply chain spectrum, including upstream, midstream and downstream energy companies (i.e. companies engaged in exploration and production, gathering, transporting and processing and marketing and distribution, respectively), as well as oil and gas services companies (collectively, “Energy Companies”), (ii) energy-intensive chemical, metal and industrial and manufacturing companies and engineering and construction companies that the Investment Adviser expects to benefit from growing energy production and lower feedstock costs relative to global costs (collectively, “Industrial Companies”) and, (iii) transportation and logistics companies providing solutions to the U.S. manufacturing industry (collectively, “Logistics Companies” and, together with Energy Companies and Industrial Companies, “Renaissance Companies”). The Fund will invest no more than 25% of its Managed Assets in securities of energy master limited partnerships (“MLPs”) that are “qualified publicly traded partnerships” under the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the “Code”), and no more than 30% of its Managed Assets in debt securities, preferred stock and convertible securities.

Investment Adviser . The Fund is managed by Cushing ® Asset Management, LP (the “Investment Adviser”).

Offering. The Fund may offer, from time to time, up to $         aggregate initial offering price of common shares of beneficial interest, par value $0.001 per share (“Common Shares”), and/or subscription rights to purchase Common Shares (“Rights” and together with the Common Shares,” “Securities”) in one or more offerings in amounts, at prices and on terms set forth in one or more supplements to this Prospectus (each a “Prospectus Supplement”). You should read this Prospectus and any related Prospectus Supplement carefully before you decide to invest in the Securities.

The Fund may offer Securities (1) directly to one or more purchasers, (2) through agents that the Fund may designate from time to time or (3) to or through underwriters or dealers. The Prospectus Supplement relating to a particular offering of Securities will identify any agents or underwriters involved in the sale of Securities, and will set forth any applicable purchase price, fee, commission or discount arrangement between the Fund and agents or underwriters or among underwriters or the basis upon which such amount may be calculated. The Fund may not sell Securities through agents, underwriters or dealers without delivery of this Prospectus and a Prospectus Supplement. See “Plan of Distribution.”

( continued on inside front cover )

 

 

Investing in the Fund’s Securities involves a high degree of risk. See “ Risks ” on page 36 of this Prospectus.

Neither the Securities and Exchange Commission nor any state securities commission has approved or disapproved of these securities or determined that this prospectus is truthful or complete. Any representation to the contrary is a criminal offense.

 

 

Prospectus dated            , 2018


(continued from front cover)

NYSE Listing. The Fund’s currently outstanding Common Shares are, and the Common Shares offered by this Prospectus, will be, subject to notice of issuance, listed on the New York Stock Exchange (the “NYSE”) under the symbol “SZC.” As of December 20, 2017, the last reported sale price for the Fund’s Common Shares on the NYSE was $19.69 per Common Share, and the net asset value of the Fund’s Common Shares was $20.34 per Common Share, representing a discount to net asset value of 3.20%. In connection with any offering of Rights, the Fund will provide information in the Prospectus Supplement for the expected trading market, if any, for Rights.

Leverage. The Fund generally seeks to increase total return by utilizing leverage. The Fund may utilize leverage through the issuance of commercial paper or notes and other forms of borrowing (“Indebtedness”) or the issuance of preferred shares, in each case to the maximum extent permitted by the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended (the “1940 Act”). Under current market conditions, the Fund currently intends to utilize leverage principally through Indebtedness. The amount of Indebtedness outstanding is expected to vary over time, but will not exceed 33 1 / 3 % of the Fund’s Managed Assets ( i.e. , 50% of its net assets attributable to the Fund’s Common Shares), including the proceeds of such leverage. The costs associated with the issuance and use of leverage will be borne by the holders of the Common Shares. Leverage is a speculative technique and investors should note that there are special risks and costs associated with leverage. There can be no assurance that a leveraging strategy will be successful during any period in which it is employed. As of November 30, 2017, the Fund had outstanding Indebtedness of approximately $23 million, which represents 16% of the Fund’s Managed Assets (or approximately 20% of its net assets attributable to the Fund’s Common Shares). See “Use of Leverage.”

You should read this Prospectus, which contains important information about the Fund that you should know before deciding whether to invest, and retain it for future reference. A Statement of Additional Information, dated             , 2018 (“SAI”), containing additional information about the Fund, has been filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission (the “SEC”) and is incorporated by reference in its entirety into this Prospectus. You may request a free copy of the Statement of Additional Information, the table of contents of which is on page 74 of this Prospectus, and the Fund’s annual and semi-annual reports by calling toll-free (888) 777-2346, or you may obtain a copy of such reports, the SAI and other information regarding the Fund from the SEC’s website ( http://www.sec.gov ). Free copies of the Fund’s annual and semi-annual reports are also be available from the Fund’s website at www.cushingcef.com . Information on, or accessible through, the Fund’s website is not a part of, and is not incorporated into, this Prospectus.

The Fund’s securities do not represent a deposit or obligation of, and are not guaranteed or endorsed by, any bank or other insured depository institution and are not federally insured by the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation, the Federal Reserve Board or any other government agency.

 

ii


TABLE OF CONTENTS

 

Prospectus Summary

     1  

Summary of Fund Expenses

     22  

Financial Highlights

     23  

Senior Securities

     25  

The Fund

     26  

Use of Proceeds

     26  

Market and Net Asset Value Information

     26  

Investment Objective and Policies

     27  

The Fund’s Investments

     29  

Use of Leverage

     33  

Risks

     36  

Management of the Fund

     53  

Net Asset Value

     56  

Distributions

     57  

Dividend Reinvestment Plan

     58  

Description of Shares

     59  

Anti-Takeover Provisions in the Agreement and Declaration of Trust

     62  

Certain Provisions of Delaware Law, the Agreement and Declaration of Trust and Bylaws

     64  

Closed-End Fund Structure

     65  

Repurchase of Common Shares

     65  

U.S. Federal Income Tax Considerations

     66  

Plan of Distribution

     69  

Other Service Providers

     71  

Legal Matters

     71  

Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

     71  

Additional Information

     71  

Privacy Policy

     73  

Table of Contents of the Statement of Additional Information

     74  

You should rely only on the information contained or incorporated by reference in this prospectus. The Fund has not authorized any other person to provide you with different information. If anyone provides you with different or inconsistent information, you should not rely on it. The Fund is not making an offer to sell these securities in any jurisdiction where the offer or sale is not permitted. The information contained in this prospectus and any related prospectus supplement is accurate only as of the date of this prospectus and any related prospectus supplement, regardless of the time of delivery of this prospectus and any related prospectus supplement or of any sale of Securities of the Fund. The Fund’s business, financial condition and prospects may have changed since that date.

 

iii


CAUTIONARY NOTICE REGARDING FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS

This Prospectus, including documents incorporated by reference, contain “forward-looking statements.” Forward-looking statements can be identified by the words “may,” “will,” “intend,” “expect,” “estimate,” “continue,” “plan,” “anticipate,” and similar terms and the negative of such terms. By their nature, all forward-looking statements involve risks and uncertainties, and actual results could differ materially from those contemplated by the forward-looking statements. Many factors that could materially affect the Fund’s actual results are the performance of the portfolio of securities held by the Fund, the conditions in the U.S. and international financial, petroleum and other markets, the price at which the Fund’s Common Shares will trade in the public markets and other factors discussed in this Prospectus and to be discussed in the Fund’s periodic filings with the SEC.

Although the Fund believes that the expectations expressed in such forward-looking statements are reasonable, actual results could differ materially from those expressed or implied in such forward-looking statements. The Fund’s future financial condition and results of operations, as well as any forward-looking statements, are subject to change and are subject to inherent risks and uncertainties, such as those disclosed in the “Risks” section of this Prospectus. You are cautioned not to place undue reliance on these forward-looking statements. All forward-looking statements contained or incorporated by reference in this Prospectus are made as of the date of this Prospectus. Except for the Fund’s ongoing obligations under the federal securities laws, the Fund does not intend, and the Fund undertakes no obligation, to update any forward-looking statement. The forward-looking statements contained in this Prospectus are excluded from the safe harbor protection provided by section 27A of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended.

Currently known risk factors that could cause actual results to differ materially from the Fund’s expectations include, but are not limited to, the factors described in the “Risks” section of this Prospectus. The Fund urges you to review carefully this section for a more detailed discussion of the risks of an investment in the Fund’s securities.

 

iv


PROSPECTUS SUMMARY

This is only a summary of information contained elsewhere in this prospectus (the “Prospectus”). This summary does not contain all of the information that you should consider before investing in the Fund’s securities. In particular, you should carefully read the more detailed information contained in this Prospectus and the statement of additional information, dated             , 2018 (the “SAI”), especially the information set forth under the heading “Risks.”

 

The Fund     The Cushing ®  Renaissance Fund is a non-diversified, closed-end management investment company registered under the 1940 Act that commenced investment operations on September 25, 2012. The Fund’s Investment Adviser is Cushing ® Asset Management, LP.
The Offering   

The Fund may offer, from time to time, up to $         aggregate initial offering price of common shares of beneficial interest, par value $0.001 per share (“Common Shares”), and/or subscription rights to purchase Common Shares (“Rights” and together with the “Common Shares,” “Securities”) in one or more offerings in amounts, at prices and on terms set forth in one or more supplements to this Prospectus (each a “Prospectus Supplement”). You should read this Prospectus and any related Prospectus Supplement carefully before you decide to invest in the Securities.

 

The Fund may offer Securities (1) directly to one or more purchasers, (2) through agents that the Fund may designate from time to time or (3) to or through underwriters or dealers. The Prospectus Supplement relating to a particular offering of Securities will identify any agents or underwriters involved in the sale of Securities, and will set forth any applicable purchase price, fee, commission or discount arrangement between the Fund and agents or underwriters or among underwriters or the basis upon which such amount may be calculated. The Fund may not sell Securities through agents, underwriters or dealers without delivery of this Prospectus and a Prospectus Supplement. See “Plan of Distribution.”

Use of Proceeds    Unless otherwise specified in a Prospectus Supplement, the Fund intends to invest the net proceeds of an offering of Securities in accordance with its investment objective and policies as stated in this Prospectus. It is currently anticipated that the Fund will be able to invest substantially all of the net proceeds of an offering of Securities in accordance with its investment objective and policies within three months after the completion of such offering. Prior to the time the proceeds of each offering are fully invested, such proceeds may temporarily be invested in cash, cash equivalents, or in debt securities that are rated AA or higher. Income received by the Fund from such temporary investments would likely be less than returns sought pursuant to the Fund’s investment objective and policies. A delay in the anticipated use of proceeds could lower returns and reduce the Fund’s distribution to holders of Common Shares (“Common Shareholders”).
Investment Objective    The Fund’s investment objective is to seek a high total return with an emphasis on current income. There can be no assurance that the Fund’s investment objective will be achieved.
Principal Investment Policies    The Fund seeks to achieve its investment objective by investing, under normal market conditions, at least 80% of its Managed Assets in a portfolio of Renaissance Companies, which are (i) Energy Companies, which are companies across the energy supply chain spectrum, including upstream, midstream and downstream energy companies (i.e. companies engaged in exploration and production, gathering, transporting and processing and marketing and distribution, respectively), as well as oil and gas services companies, (ii) Industrial Companies,

 



 

1


  

which are energy-intensive chemical, metal and industrial and manufacturing companies and engineering and construction companies that the Investment Adviser expects to benefit from growing energy production and lower feedstock costs relative to global costs and, (iii) Logistics Companies, which are transportation and logistics companies providing solutions to the U.S. manufacturing industry.

 

The Fund will invest no more than 25% of its Managed Assets in securities of energy MLPs that are “qualified publicly traded partnerships” under the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the “Code”).

 

The Fund generally seeks to invest in no more than 10% of its Managed Assets in any one issue and no more than 20% of Managed Assets in any one issuer, in each case, determined at the time of investment. For purposes of this limit with respect to an investment in an MLP, an “issuer” includes both an issuer and its controlling general partner, managing member or sponsor, and an “issue” is a class of an issuer’s securities or a derivative security that tracks that class of securities.

 

The Fund may invest up to 25% of its Managed Assets in unregistered or otherwise restricted securities, including securities issued by private companies.

 

The Fund may invest up to 30% of its Managed Assets in debt securities, preferred stock and convertible securities, provided that such securities are (a) rated, at the time of investment, at least (i) B3 by Moody’s Investors Service, Inc. (“Moody’s”), (ii) B- by Standard & Poor’s (“S&P”) or Fitch Ratings (“Fitch”), or (iii) of a comparable rating by another Nationally Recognized Statistical Rating Organization (“NRSRO”) or (b) with respect to up to 10% of its Managed Assets, lower rated or unrated at the time of investment.

 

The Fund may invest in non-U.S. securities, including, among other things, non-U.S. securities represented by American Depositary Receipts or “ADRs.”

 

The Fund may invest in issuers of any market capitalization size.

 

The Fund may seek to hedge risks to the portfolio as deemed prudent by the Investment Adviser.

 

The Fund will not invest directly in commodities.

 

The Fund’s investment objective and percentage parameters are not fundamental policies of the Fund and may be changed without shareholder approval.

Investment Process and Risk Management   

The Investment Adviser’s investment process involves fundamental and quantitative analysis. The Investment Adviser selects a core group of investments utilizing a proprietary quantitative ranking system and seeks to build a strategically developed core portfolio designed to take advantage of changing dynamics in the energy and industrial and manufacturing sectors. The Fund is actively managed, incorporating dynamic quantitative analysis with the Investment Adviser’s proprietary research process. The Investment Adviser utilizes its financial and industry experience to identify the absolute and relative value investments that, in the Investment Adviser’s view, present the best opportunities. The results of the Investment Adviser’s analysis and comprehensive investment process will influence the weightings of positions held by the Fund.

 

Fundamental Analysis . The Investment Adviser utilizes dedicated industry analysts to cover the Fund’s potential investment sectors. Analysts prepare detailed

 



 

2


  

financial models of potential portfolio companies with full financial projections that incorporate current and future capital projects. This bottom-up modeling process is designed to help accurately predict earnings.

 

Qualitative Analysis . The bottom-up fundamental analysis is then coupled with a top-down theme overlay, which includes potential views on commodity prices. Discussions and debate by the investment team of research analysts and portfolio managers regarding the qualitative characteristics of current and potential portfolio holdings are also utilized. These qualitative characteristics include, but are not limited to, asset-related strengths and weaknesses, market sentiment and strength of management.

 

Portfolio Construction and M anagement . Once an investment thesis is formed at the company specific level, the portfolio management team determines the appropriate level of exposure based on current views of commodities prices and overall macroeconomic environment. In constructing and maintaining the portfolio, the Investment Adviser monitors such factors as company valuations relative to relevant benchmarks, general economic conditions and trends, and regulatory policy regarding energy and manufacturing.

 

The Investment Adviser constructs a core portfolio that it believes will have the highest level of total return performance over the next six (6) to twenty-four (24) months. The Investment Adviser’s buy discipline incorporates liquidity and pricing tolerances for each investment. The Investment Adviser’s sell discipline develops from a combination of price appreciation based on initial price targets from the core portfolio, relative valuation metrics and macro issues which may impact the original thesis.

 

Risk M anagement . An overlay to the investment process is the Investment Adviser’s risk management function, which is designed to provide independent oversight to the portfolio management process. The Investment Adviser maintains a dedicated risk management team that monitors managed portfolios for macroeconomic risks, such as geopolitical concerns, credit spreads, currency and commodity price exposure, as well as investment specific risks, such as value at risk (VaR), liquidity concerns, sub-sector concentration and position exposure.

 

Investment

Characteristics

  

The Investment Adviser believes that the following characteristics of Renaissance Companies makes them attractive investments:

 

•       Renaissance Companies are positioned to directly benefit from the current dislocation of domestic energy prices as compared to commodity prices in other parts of the world.

 

•       Renaissance Companies are positioned to directly benefit from the increased domestic development and transportation of energy.

 

•       Energy Companies are positioned to benefit from the continued build-out of U.S. energy infrastructure.

 

•       Industrial Companies whose primary feedstock is energy should benefit from lower domestic energy costs as compared to global costs.

 

•       Energy Companies provide the potential for current income through monthly or quarterly distributions.

 

An investment in Renaissance Companies also involves risks, some of which are described below under “Risks.”

 



 

3


Leverage   

The Fund may seek to increase total return by utilizing leverage. The Fund may utilize leverage through the issuance of commercial paper or notes and other forms of borrowing (“Indebtedness”) or the issuance of preferred shares. The Fund may utilize leverage through Indebtedness or preferred shares to the maximum extent permitted by the 1940 Act. Under current market conditions, the Fund intends to utilize leverage principally through Indebtedness. The amount of Indebtedness outstanding is expected to vary over time, but will not exceed 33 1/3% of the Fund’s Managed Assets (i.e., 50% of its net assets attributable to the Fund’s Common Shares), including the proceeds of such leverage.

 

The costs associated with the issuance and use of leverage will be borne by the holders of the Common Shares. Leverage is a speculative technique, and investors should note that there are special risks and costs associated with leverage. There can be no assurance that a leveraging strategy will be successful during any period in which it is employed.

 

The Fund will only utilize leverage when it expects to be able to invest the proceeds at a higher rate of return than its cost of borrowing. The use of leverage for investment purposes creates opportunities for greater total return, but at the same time increases risk. When leverage is employed, the net asset value, market price of the Common Shares and the yield to holders of Common Shares may be more volatile. Any investment income or gains earned with respect to the amounts borrowed in excess of the interest due on the borrowing will augment the Fund’s income. Conversely, if the investment performance with respect to the amounts borrowed fails to cover the interest on such borrowings, the value of the Fund’s Common Shares may decrease more quickly than would otherwise be the case and distributions on the Common Shares would be reduced or eliminated. Interest payments and fees incurred in connection with such borrowings will reduce the amount of net income available for distribution to Common Shareholders.

 

The Fund currently utilizes Indebtedness pursuant to a borrowing arrangement with Scotiabank TM . The interest rate charged on such Indebtedness is 1-month London Interbank Offered Rate (“LIBOR”) plus 1.00%. As of November 30, 2017, the principal balance outstanding was approximately $23 million, which represented 16% of the Fund’s Managed Assets (or approximately 20% of its net assets attributable to the Fund’s Common Shares).

 

The costs associated with the issuance and use of leverage are borne by the holders of the Common Shares. Because the investment management fee paid to the Investment Adviser is calculated on the basis of the Fund’s Managed Assets, which include the proceeds of leverage, the dollar amount of the management fee paid by the Fund to the Investment Adviser will be higher (and the Investment Adviser will be benefited to that extent) when leverage is utilized. The Investment Adviser will utilize leverage only if it believes such action would result in a net benefit to the Fund’s shareholders after taking into account the higher fees and expenses associated with leverage (including higher management fees). There can be no assurance that a leveraging strategy will be successful during any period in which it is employed. See “Use of Leverage.”

 

Other Investment Practices    Strategic Transactions . The Fund may, but is not required to, use investment strategies (referred to herein as “Strategic Transactions”) for hedging, risk management or portfolio management purposes or to earn income. These strategies may be executed through the use of derivative contracts. In the course of pursuing these investment strategies, the Fund may purchase and sell exchange-listed and

 



 

4


  

over-the-counter put and call options on securities, equity and fixed-income indices and other instruments, purchase and sell futures contracts and options thereon, and enter into various transactions such as swaps, caps, floors or collars. In addition, derivative transactions may also include new techniques, instruments or strategies that are permitted as regulatory changes occur. For a more complete discussion of the Fund’s investment practices involving transactions in derivatives and certain other investment techniques, see “The Fund’s Investments—Strategic Transactions” in this Prospectus and “Strategic Transactions” in the SAI.

 

Covered Call Options . The Fund may, from time to time, seek to enhance total return by writing call options on a portion of the securities held in the Fund’s portfolio (commonly referred to as “covered” call options). As the writer of a covered call option, the Fund receives a premium but forgoes, during the option’s life, the opportunity to profit from increases in the market value of the security covering the call option above the sum of the premium and the strike price of the call, but retains the risk of loss should the price of the underlying security decline. As the Fund writes covered calls over more of its portfolio, its ability to benefit from capital appreciation becomes more limited. See “Strategic Transactions—Options” in the SAI for additional information regarding option transactions.

 

Short Sales, Arbitrage And Other Strategies. The Fund may use short sales, arbitrage and other strategies to try to generate additional return. As part of such strategies, the Fund may engage in paired long-short trades to arbitrage pricing disparities in securities issued by Renaissance Companies, write (or sell) covered call options on securities held in its portfolio, write (or sell) uncovered call options on the securities of Renaissance Companies, purchase call options or enter into swap contracts to increase its exposure to Renaissance Companies, or sell securities short. With a long position, the Fund purchases a stock outright, but with a short position, it would sell a security that it does not own and must borrow to meet its settlement obligations. The Fund will realize a profit or incur a loss from a short position depending on whether the value of the underlying stock decreases or increases, respectively, between the time the stock is sold and when the Fund replaces the borrowed security. To increase its exposure to certain issuers, the Fund may purchase call options or use swap agreements. The Fund expects to use these strategies on a limited basis. See “Risks—Short Sales Risk” and “Risks—Strategic Transactions Risk.”

 

Lending of Portfolio Securities. The Fund may lend its portfolio securities to broker-dealers and banks. Any such loan must be continuously secured by collateral in cash or cash equivalents maintained on a current basis in an amount at least equal to 102% of the value of the securities loaned. The Fund would continue to receive the equivalent of the interest or distributions paid by the issuer on the securities loaned and would also receive an additional return that may be in the form of a fixed fee or a percentage of the collateral. The Fund may pay reasonable fees for services in arranging these loans.

 

Temporary Defensive Strategies. When market conditions dictate a more defensive investment strategy, the Fund may, on a temporary basis, hold cash or invest a portion or all of its assets in money-market instruments including obligations of the U.S. government, its agencies or instrumentalities, other high-quality debt securities, including prime commercial paper, repurchase agreements and bank obligations, such as bankers’ acceptances and certificates of deposit. Under normal market conditions, the potential for capital appreciation on these securities will tend to be lower than the potential for capital appreciation on other securities that may be owned by the Fund. In taking such a defensive position, the Fund would temporarily not be pursuing its principal investment strategies and may not achieve its investment objective.

 



 

5


Investment Adviser    

The Fund’s investments are managed by its Investment Adviser, Cushing ® Asset Management, LP, whose principal business address is 8117 Preston Road, Suite 440, Dallas, Texas 75225. The Investment Adviser serves as investment adviser to registered and unregistered funds, which invest primarily in securities of MLPs and other Energy Companies. The Investment Adviser continues to seek to expand its platform of energy-related investment products, leveraging extensive industry contacts and significant research depth to drive both passive and actively managed investment opportunities for individual and institutional investors. The Investment Adviser seeks to identify and exploit investment niches that it believes are generally less understood and less followed by the broader investor community.

 

The Investment Adviser considers itself one of the principal professional institutional investors in the energy sector based on the following:

 

•       An investment team with extensive experience in analysis, portfolio management, risk management, and private securities transactions.

 

•       A focus on bottom-up, fundamental analysis performed by its experienced investment team is core to the Investment Adviser’s investment process.

 

•       The investment team’s wide range of professional backgrounds, market knowledge, industry relationships, and experience in the analysis, financing, and structuring of energy income investments give the Investment Adviser insight into, and the ability to identify and capitalize on, investment opportunities.

 

Its central location in Dallas, Texas and proximity to major players and assets in the energy sector.

Distributions   

The Fund intends to pay substantially all of its net investment income to Common Shareholders through monthly distributions. In addition, the Fund intends to distribute any net long-term capital gains to Common Shareholders at least annually. The Fund expects that distributions paid on the Common Shares will consist primarily of (i) investment company taxable income, which includes, among other things, ordinary income, net short-term capital gain and income from certain hedging and interest rate transactions, and (ii) net capital gain (which is the excess of net long-term capital gain over net short-term capital loss). A portion of the Fund’s distributions may also be characterized as return of capital. The Fund may invest up to 25% of its Managed Assets in MLPs that are “qualified publicly traded partnerships” under the Code, and a portion of the cash distributions received by the Fund from the MLPs in which it invests may be characterized as return of capital. If, for any calendar year, the Fund’s total distributions exceed both current earnings and profits and accumulated earnings and profits, the excess will generally be treated as a return of capital for U.S. federal income tax purposes up to the amount of a shareholder’s tax basis in the Common Shares, reducing that basis accordingly. The Fund cannot assure you as to what percentage, if any, of the distributions paid on the Common Shares will consist of net capital gain, which is taxed at reduced rates for non-corporate shareholders, or return of capital. For the fiscal year ended November 30, 2017, the Fund’s distributions were comprised of 25.97% ordinary income and 74.03% return of capital.

 

To permit the Fund to maintain a more stable distribution rate, the Fund may distribute less or more than the income it earns on its investments in a particular period. Any undistributed income would be available to supplement future distributions and, until distributed, would add to the Fund’s net asset value. Correspondingly, such amounts, once distributed, will be deducted from the Fund’s net asset value. See “Distributions.”

 



 

6


Dividend Reinvestment Plan     Shareholders will automatically have all distributions reinvested in Common Shares issued by the Fund or Common Shares of the Fund purchased on the open market in accordance with the Fund’s dividend reinvestment plan unless an election is made to receive cash. Common Shareholders who receive distributions in the form of additional Common Shares will be subject to the same U.S. federal income tax consequences as Common Shareholders who elect to receive their distributions in cash. See “Dividend Reinvestment Plan.”
Listing and Symbol    The Fund’s currently outstanding Common Shares are, and the Common Shares offered by this Prospectus, will be, subject to notice of issuance, listed on the New York Stock Exchange (the “NYSE”) under the symbol “SZC.” As of December 20, 2017, the last reported sale price for the Fund’s Common Shares on the NYSE was $19.69 per Common Share, and the net asset value of the Fund’s Common Shares was $20.34 per Common Share, representing a discount to net asset value of 3.20%. In connection with any offering of Rights, the Fund will provide information in the Prospectus Supplement for the expected trading market, if any, for Rights.
Special Risk Considerations    The following is a summary of the principal risks associated with an investment in Common Shares of the Fund. Investors should also refer to “Risks” in this prospectus for a more detailed explanation of these and other risks associated with investing in the Fund.
   Investment And Market Risk . An investment in the Fund’s Common Shares is subject to investment risk, including the possible loss of an investor’s entire investment. The Fund’s Common Shares at any point in time may be worth less than at the time of original investment, even after taking into account the reinvestment of the Fund’s distributions. The Fund is primarily a long-term investment vehicle and should not be used for short-term trading. An investment in the Fund’s Common Shares is not intended to constitute a complete investment program and should not be viewed as such.
   Common Stock Risk. The Fund will have exposure to common stocks. Although common stocks have historically generated higher average total returns than fixed-income securities over the long-term, common stocks also have experienced significantly more volatility in those returns and may significantly under-perform relative to fixed income securities during certain periods. An adverse event, such as an unfavorable earnings report, may depress the value of a particular common stock held by the Fund. Also, the price of common stocks is sensitive to general movements in the stock market and a drop in the stock market may depress the price of common stocks to which the Fund has exposure. Common stock prices fluctuate for several reasons, including changes in investors’ perceptions of the financial condition of an issuer or the general condition of the relevant stock market, or when political or economic events affecting the issuers occur. In addition, common stock prices may be particularly sensitive to rising interest rates, as the cost of capital rises and borrowing costs increase.
   Concentration Risk . The Fund’s investments will be concentrated in issuers in the energy sector. Because the Fund will be concentrated in the energy sector, it may be subject to more risks than if it were more broadly diversified over numerous industries and sectors of the economy. General changes in market sentiment towards Energy Companies may adversely affect the Fund, and the performance of

 



 

7


  

Energy Companies may lag behind the broader market as a whole. Also, the Fund’s concentration in the energy sector may subject the Fund to a variety risks associated with that sector. See “Risks—Energy Sector Risks.”

 

In addition, issuers outside the energy sector in which the Fund intends to invest will typically consist of industrial and manufacturing companies that the Investment Adviser expects to benefit from to benefit from lower energy and feedstock costs. As a result, these companies may also be more sensitive to certain risks associated with the energy sector.

 

Energy Sector Risks . Under normal circumstances, the Fund concentrates its investments in the energy sector. Energy Companies are subject to certain risks, including, but not limited to, the following:

 

Commodity Price Risk . Energy Companies may be affected by fluctuations in the prices of commodities, including, for example, natural gas, natural gas liquids and crude oil, in the short- and long-term. Natural resources commodity prices have been very volatile in the past and such volatility is expected to continue. Fluctuations in commodity prices can result from changes in general economic conditions or political circumstances (especially of key energy-consuming countries); market conditions; weather patterns; domestic production levels; volume of imports; energy conservation; domestic and foreign governmental regulation; international politics; policies of the Organization of Petroleum Exporting Countries (“OPEC”); taxation; tariffs; and the availability and costs of local, intrastate and interstate transportation methods. Companies engaged in crude oil and natural gas exploration, development or production, natural gas gathering and processing and crude oil refining and transportation may be directly affected by their respective natural resources commodity prices. The volatility of, and interrelationships between, commodity prices can also indirectly affect certain companies due to the potential impact on the volume of commodities transported, processed, stored or distributed. Some companies that own the underlying commodities may be unable to effectively mitigate or manage direct margin exposure to commodity price levels. The energy sector as a whole may also be impacted by the perception that the performance of energy sector companies is directly linked to commodity prices. See “Risks—Energy Sector Risks — Commodity Price Risk.”

 

Cyclicality Risk . The operating results of companies in the broader energy sector are cyclical, with fluctuations in commodity prices and demand for commodities driven by a variety of factors. The highly cyclical nature of the energy sector may adversely affect the earnings or operating cash flows of certain Energy Companies in which the Fund will invest.

 

Supply Risk . A significant decrease in the production of natural gas, crude oil or other energy commodities, due to the decline of production from existing resources, import supply disruption, depressed commodity prices or otherwise, would reduce the revenue, operating income and operating cash flows of certain Energy Companies and, therefore, their ability to make distributions or pay distributions. See “Risks—Energy Sector Risks — Supply Risk.”

 

Demand Risk . A sustained decline in demand for natural gas, natural gas liquids, crude oil and refined petroleum products could adversely affect an Energy Company’s revenues and cash flows. See “Risks—Energy Sector Risks — Demand Risk.”

 



 

8


  

Competition Risk . The energy sector is highly competitive. To the extent that the Energy Companies in which the Fund will invest are unable to compete effectively, their operating results, financial position, growth potential and cash flows may be adversely affected, which could in turn adversely affect the results of the Fund. See “Risks—Energy Sector Risks — Competition Risk.”

 

Weather Risk . Extreme weather conditions could result in substantial damage to the facilities of certain Energy Companies located in the affected areas and significant volatility in the supply of natural resources, commodity prices and the earnings of Energy Companies, and could therefore adversely affect their securities.

 

Interest Rate Risk . The prices of debt securities of the Energy Companies the Fund expects to hold in its portfolio are, and the prices of equity securities held in its portfolio may be, susceptible in the short-term to a decline when interest rates rise. Rising interest rates could limit the capital appreciation of securities of certain Energy Companies as a result of the increased availability of alternative investments with yields comparable to those of Energy Companies. Rising interest rates could adversely impact the financial performance of Energy Companies by increasing their cost of capital. This may reduce their ability to execute acquisitions or expansion projects in a cost effective manner.

 

Regulatory Risk . The profitability of Energy Companies could be adversely affected by changes in the regulatory environment. Energy Companies are subject to significant foreign, federal, state and local regulation in virtually every aspect of their operations, including with respect to how facilities are constructed, maintained and operated, environmental and safety controls, and the prices they may charge for the products and services they provide. Energy Companies may be adversely affected by future regulatory requirements. While the nature of such regulations cannot be predicted at this time, they may impose additional costs or limit certain operations by Energy Companies operating in various sectors. See “Risks—Energy Sector Risks — Regulatory Risk.”

 

Environmental Risk . There is an inherent risk that Energy Companies may incur environmental costs and liabilities due to the nature of their businesses and the substances they handle. For example, an accidental release from wells or gathering pipelines could subject them to substantial liabilities for environmental cleanup and restoration costs, claims made by neighboring landowners and other third parties for personal injury and property damage, and fines or penalties for related violations of environmental laws or regulations. Moreover, the possibility exists that stricter laws, regulations or enforcement policies could significantly increase the compliance costs of Energy Companies, and the cost of any remediation that may become necessary. Energy Companies may not be able to recover these costs from insurance. In addition, regulation can change over time in both scope and intensity, may have adverse effects on Energy Companies and may be implemented in unforeseen manners on an “emergency” basis in response to catastrophes or other events. See “Risks—Energy Sector Risks — Environmental Risk.”

 

Affiliated Party Risk . Certain Energy Companies are dependent on their parents or sponsors for a majority of their revenues. Any failure by an Energy Company’s parents or sponsors to satisfy their payments or obligations would impact the Energy Company’s revenues and cash flows and ability to make distributions. Moreover, the terms of an Energy Company’s transactions with its parent or sponsor are typically not arrived at on an arm’s-length basis, and may not be as favorable to the Energy Company as a transaction with a non-affiliate.

 



 

9


  

Catastrophe Risk . The operations of Energy Companies are subject to many hazards inherent in the exploration for, and development, production, gathering, transportation, processing, storage, refining, distribution, mining or marketing of natural gas, natural gas liquids, crude oil, refined petroleum products or other hydrocarbons. See “Risks—Energy Sector Risks — Catastrophe Risk.”

 

Risks Relating to Expansions and Acquisitions . Some Energy Companies employ a variety of means to increase cash flow, including increasing utilization of existing facilities, expanding operations through new construction or development activities, expanding operations through acquisitions, or securing additional long-term contracts. Thus, some Energy Companies may be subject to construction risk, development risk, acquisition risk or other risks arising from their specific business strategies. Energy Companies that attempt to grow through acquisitions may not be able to effectively integrate acquired operations with their existing operations. See “Risks—Energy Sector Risks — Risks Relating to Expansions and Acquisitions.”

 

Technology Risk . Some Energy Companies are focused on developing new technologies and are strongly influenced by technological changes. Technology development efforts by Energy Companies may not result in viable methods or products. Energy Companies may bear high research and development costs, which can limit their ability to maintain operations during periods of organizational growth or instability. Some Energy Companies may be in the early stages of operations and may have limited operating histories and smaller market capitalizations on average than companies in other sectors. As a result of these and other factors, the value of investments in such Energy Companies may be considerably more volatile than that in more established segments of the economy.

 

Sub-Sector Specific Risks . Energy Companies are also subject to risks that are specific to the particular sub-sector of the energy sector in which they operate. See Risks –Sub-Sector Specific Risks.”

 

•       Gathering and processing companies are subject to natural declines in the production of oil and natural gas fields, which utilize their gathering and processing facilities as a way to market their production, prolonged declines in the price of natural gas or crude oil, which curtails drilling activity and therefore production, and declines in the prices of natural gas liquids and refined petroleum products, which cause lower processing margins. In addition, some gathering and processing contracts subject the gathering or processing company to direct commodities price risk.

 

•       Exploration, development and production companies are particularly vulnerable to declines in the demand for and prices of crude oil and natural gas. Reductions in prices for crude oil and natural gas can cause a given reservoir to become uneconomic for continued production earlier than it would if prices were higher, resulting in the plugging and abandonment of, and cessation of production from, that reservoir. In addition, lower commodity prices not only reduce revenues but also can result in substantial downward adjustments in reserve estimates.

 

•       In addition to the risk described above applicable to gathering and processing companies and exploration and production companies, companies involved in the transportation, gathering, processing,

 



 

10


  

exploration, development or production of crude oil or refined petroleum products may be adversely affected by increased regulations, increased operating costs and reductions in the supply of and/or demand for crude oil and refined petroleum. Increased regulation may result in a decline in production and/or increased cost associated with offshore oil exploration in the United States and around the world, which may adversely affect certain Energy Companies and the oil industry in general.

   Small-Cap and Mid-Cap Company Risk. Certain of the companies in which the Fund may invest may have small or medium-sized market capitalizations (“small-cap” and “mid-cap” companies, respectively). Investing in the securities of small-cap or mid-cap companies presents some particular investment risks. These companies may have limited product lines and markets, as well as shorter operating histories, less experienced management and more limited financial resources than larger companies, and may be more vulnerable to adverse general market or economic developments. Stocks of these companies s may be less liquid than those of larger companies, and may experience greater price fluctuations than larger companies. In addition, small-cap or mid-cap company securities may not be widely followed by investors, which may result in reduced demand.
   Risks Associated with an Investment in IPOs . The Fund may invest in initial public offerings (“IPOs”). Securities purchased in IPOs are often subject to the general risks associated with investments in companies with small market capitalizations, and typically to a heightened degree. Securities issued in IPOs have no trading history, and information about the companies may be available for very limited periods. In addition, the prices of securities sold in an IPO may be highly volatile, thus the Fund cannot predict whether investments in IPOs will be successful. As the Fund grows in size, the positive effect of IPO investments on the Fund may decrease. See “Risks—Risks Associated with an Investment in IPOs.”
   Risks Associated with an Investment in PIPE Transactions . PIPE investors purchase securities directly from a publicly traded company in a private placement transaction, typically at a discount to the market price of the company’s common stock. Because the sale of the securities is not registered under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the “Securities Act”), the securities are “restricted” and cannot be immediately resold by the investors into the public markets. Accordingly, the company typically agrees as part of the PIPE deal to register the restricted securities with the SEC. PIPE securities may be deemed illiquid.
   Privately Held Company Risk . Investing in privately held companies involves risk. For example, privately held companies are not subject to SEC reporting requirements, are not required to maintain their accounting records in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and are not required to maintain effective internal controls over financial reporting. As a result, the Investment Adviser may not have timely or accurate information about the business, financial condition and results of operations of the privately held companies in which the Fund invests. In addition, the securities of privately held companies are generally illiquid, and entail the risks described under “Risks—Liquidity Risk.”
   MLP Risks . An investment in MLP units involves some risks that differ from an investment in the common stock of a corporation. As compared to common stockholders of a corporation, holders of MLP units have more limited control and limited rights to vote on matters affecting the partnership. In addition, there are certain tax risks associated with an investment in MLP units and conflicts of interest may exist between common unit holders and the general partner, including those arising from incentive distribution payments.

 



 

11


  

A portion of the benefit the Fund derives from its investment in equity securities of MLPs is a result of MLPs generally being treated as partnerships for U.S. federal income tax purposes. A change in current tax law, or a change in the business of a given MLP, could result in an MLP being treated as a corporation for U.S. federal income tax purposes, which would result in such MLP being required to pay U.S. federal income tax on its taxable income, which would have the effect of reducing the amount of cash available for distribution by the MLP and causing any such distributions received by the Fund to be taxed as distribution income to the extent of the MLP’s current or accumulated earnings and profits.

 

To the extent that the Fund invests in the equity securities of an MLP that is treated as a partnership under the Code, the Fund will be a partner in such MLP. Accordingly, the Fund will be required to include in its taxable income the Fund’s allocable share of the income, gains, losses, deductions and credits recognized by each such MLP, regardless of whether the MLP distributes cash to the Fund. Historically, MLPs have been able to offset a significant portion of their income with tax deductions. The portion, if any, of a distribution received by the Fund from an MLP that is offset by the MLP’s tax deductions, losses or credits is essentially treated as a return of capital. However, those distributions will reduce the Fund’s adjusted tax basis in the equity securities of the MLP, which will result in an increase in the amount of gain (or decrease in the amount of loss) that will be recognized by the Fund for tax purposes upon the sale of any such equity securities or upon subsequent distributions in respect of such equity securities.

 

In addition, changes in tax laws or regulations, or future interpretations of such laws or regulations, could adversely affect the Fund or the MLP investments in which the Fund invests. See “Risks—MLP Risks.”

   Liquidity Risk . The investments made by the Fund may be illiquid and consequently the Fund may not be able to sell such investments at prices that reflect the Investment Adviser’s assessment of their value, the value at which the Fund is carrying the securities on its books or the amount paid for such investments by the Fund. Furthermore, the nature of the Fund’s investments may require a long holding period prior to profitability. See “Risks—Liquidity Risk.”
   Non-U.S. Securities Risk . Investing in non-U.S. securities involves certain risks not involved in domestic investments, including, but not limited to: fluctuations in foreign exchange rates; future foreign economic, financial, political and social developments; different legal systems; the possible imposition of exchange controls or other foreign governmental laws or restrictions, including expropriation; lower trading volume; much greater price volatility and illiquidity of certain non-U.S. securities markets; different trading and settlement practices; less governmental supervision; changes in currency exchange rates; high and volatile rates of inflation; fluctuating interest rates; less publicly available information; and different accounting, auditing and financial recordkeeping standards and requirements. Investing in securities of issuers based in underdeveloped emerging markets entails all of the risks of investing in securities of non-U.S. issuers to a heightened degree. Currencies of certain countries may be volatile and therefore may affect the value of securities denominated in such currencies, which means that the Fund’s net asset value could decline as a result of changes in the exchange rates between foreign currencies and the U.S. dollar. See “Risks—Non-U.S. Securities Risk.”
   Debt Securities Risk . Debt securities are subject to many of the risks described elsewhere in this section. In addition, they are subject to credit risk, prepayment risk and, depending on their quality, other special risks.

 



 

12


  

Below investment grade and unrated debt securities generally pay a premium above the yields of U.S. government securities or debt securities of investment grade issuers because they are subject to greater risks than these securities. These risks, which reflect their speculative character, include the following: greater yield and price volatility; greater credit risk and risk of default; potentially greater sensitivity to general economic or industry conditions; potential lack of attractive resale opportunities (illiquidity); and additional expenses to seek recovery from issuers who default. Debt securities rated below investment grade are commonly known as “junk bonds” and are regarded as predominantly speculative with respect to the issuer’s capacity to pay interest and repay principal in accordance with the terms of the obligations, and involve major risk exposure to adverse conditions.

 

Certain debt instruments, particularly below investment grade securities, may contain call or redemption provisions which would allow the issuer of the debt instrument to prepay principal prior to the debt instrument’s stated maturity. This is also sometimes known as prepayment risk. See “Risks—Debt Securities Risk.”

   Preferred Stock Risk . Preferred stocks combine some of the characteristics of both common stocks and debt securities. Preferred stocks typically have a yield advantage over common stocks as well as comparably-rated fixed income investments. Preferred stocks are typically subordinated to bonds and other debt instruments in a company’s capital structure, in terms of priority to corporate income, and therefore will be subject to greater credit risk than those debt instruments. Unlike interest payments on debt securities, preferred stock distributions are payable only if declared by the issuer’s board of directors. Preferred stocks also may be subject to optional or mandatory redemption provisions. See “Risks—Preferred Stock Risk.”
   Convertible Instrument Risk . The Fund may invest in convertible instruments. A convertible instrument is a bond, debenture, note, preferred stock or other security that may be converted into or exchanged for a prescribed amount of Common Shares of the same or a different issuer within a particular period of time at a specified price or formula. Convertible debt instruments have characteristics of both fixed income and equity investments. Convertible instruments are subject both to the stock market risk associated with equity securities and to the credit and interest rate risks associated with fixed-income securities. As the market price of the equity security underlying a convertible instrument falls, the convertible instrument tends to trade on the basis of its yield and other fixed-income characteristics. As the market price of such equity security rises, the convertible security tends to trade on the basis of its equity conversion features. See “Risks—Convertible Instruments Risk.”
   Interest Rate Risk . The costs associated with any leverage used by the Fund are likely to increase when interest rates rise. Accordingly, the market price of the Fund’s Common Shares may decline when interest rates rise.
   Interest Rate Hedging Risk . The Fund may from time to time hedge against interest rate risk resulting from the Fund’s portfolio holdings and any financial leverage it may incur. Interest rate transactions the Fund may use for hedging purposes will expose the Fund to certain risks that differ from the risks associated with its portfolio holdings. There are economic costs of hedging reflected in the price of interest rate swaps, caps and similar techniques, the cost of which can be significant. In addition, the Fund’s success in using hedging instruments is subject to the Investment Adviser’s ability to correctly predict changes in the relationships of such hedging instruments to the Fund’s leverage risk, and there can be no assurance that the Investment Adviser’s judgment in this respect will be accurate. See “Risks—Interest Rate Hedging Risk.”

 



 

13


   Leverage  Risk.  The Fund may use leverage through the issuance of Indebtedness or the issuance of preferred shares. The use of leverage magnifies both the favorable and unfavorable effects of price movements in the investments made by the Fund. Insofar as the Fund employs leverage in its investment operations, the Fund will be subject to increased risk of loss. In addition, the Fund pays (and the holders of Common Shares bear) all costs and expenses relating to the issuance and ongoing maintenance of leverage, including higher advisory fees. Similarly, any decline in the net asset value of the Fund’s investments will be borne entirely by the holders of Common Shares. Therefore, if the market value of the Fund’s portfolio declines, the leverage will result in a greater decrease in net asset value to the holders of Common Shares than if the Fund were not leveraged. This greater net asset value decrease will also tend to cause a greater decline in the market price for the Common Shares. See “Risks—Leverage Risk.”
   Covered Call Option Risk. As the writer of a covered call option, the Fund forgoes, during the option’s life, the opportunity to profit from increases in the market value of the security covering the call option above the sum of the premium and the strike price of the call, but retains the risk of loss should the price of the underlying security decline. As the Fund writes covered calls over more of its portfolio, its ability to benefit from capital appreciation becomes more limited. There are significant differences between the securities and options markets that could result in an imperfect correlation between these markets, causing a given transaction not to achieve its objectives. A decision as to whether, when and how to use options involves the exercise of skill and judgment, and even a well-conceived transaction may be unsuccessful to some degree because of market behavior or unexpected events. See “Strategic Transactions — Options” in the SAI for additional information regarding risks associated with option transactions.
   Arbitrage Risk . A part of the Investment Adviser’s investment operations may involve spread positions between two or more securities, or derivatives positions including commodities hedging positions, or a combination of the foregoing. The Investment Adviser’s trading operations also may involve arbitraging between two securities or commodities, between the security, commodity and related options or derivatives markets, between spot and futures or forward markets, and/or any combination of the above. To the extent the price relationships between such positions remain constant, no gain or loss on the positions will occur. These offsetting positions entail substantial risk that the price differential could change unfavorably, causing a loss to the position.
   Securities Lending Risk. The Fund may lend its portfolio securities (up to a maximum of one-third of its Managed Assets) to banks or dealers which meet the creditworthiness standards established by the Board of Trustees of the Fund (the “Board” or the “Board of Trustees”). Securities lending is subject to the risk that loaned securities may not be available to the Fund on a timely basis and the Fund may, therefore, lose the opportunity to sell the securities at a desirable price. Any loss in the market price of securities loaned by the Fund that occurs during the term of the loan would be borne by the Fund and would adversely affect the Fund’s performance. There may also be delays in recovery, or no recovery, of securities loaned or even a loss of rights in the collateral should the borrower of the securities fail financially while the loan is outstanding. These risks may be greater for non-U.S. securities.
   Non-Diversification Risk . The Fund is a non-diversified, closed-end management investment company under the 1940 Act. Accordingly, the Fund may invest a greater portion of its assets in a more limited number of issuers than a diversified

 



 

14


   fund. An investment in the Fund may present greater risk to an investor than an investment in a diversified portfolio because changes in the financial condition or market assessment of a single issuer may cause greater fluctuations in the value of the Fund’s shares.
  

Valuation Risk. Market prices may not be readily available for certain of the Fund’s investments, and the value of such investments will ordinarily be determined based on fair valuations determined by the Board of Trustees or its designee pursuant to procedures adopted by the Board of Trustees. Restrictions on resale or the absence of a liquid secondary market may adversely affect the Fund’s ability to determine its net asset value. The sale price of securities that are not readily marketable may be lower or higher than the Fund’s most recent determination of their fair value.

 

When determining the fair value of an asset, the Investment Adviser seeks to determine the price that the Fund might reasonably expect to receive from the current sale of that asset in an arm’s length transaction. Fair value pricing, however, involves judgments that are inherently subjective and inexact, since fair valuation procedures are used only when it is not possible to be sure what value should be attributed to a particular asset or when an event will affect the market price of an asset and to what extent. As a result, there can be no assurance that fair value pricing will reflect actual market value and it is possible that the fair value determined for a security will be materially different from the value that actually could be or is realized upon the sale of that asset.

   Portfolio Turnover Risk . Portfolio turnover rate is not considered a limiting factor in the Investment Adviser’s execution of investment decisions. The Fund anticipates that its annual portfolio turnover rate may vary greatly from year to year.. A higher portfolio turnover rate results in correspondingly greater brokerage commissions and other transactional expenses that are borne by the Fund. High portfolio turnover may result in an increased realization of net short-term capital gains or capital losses by the Fund.
   Strategic Transactions Risk . The Fund may, but is not required to, use investment strategies (referred to herein as “Strategic Transactions”) for hedging, risk management or portfolio management purposes or to earn income. The Fund’s use of Strategic Transactions may involve the purchase and sale of derivative instruments. The Fund may purchase and sell exchange-listed and over-the-counter put and call options on securities, indices and other instruments, enter into forward contracts, purchase and sell futures contracts and options thereon, enter into swap, cap, floor or collar transactions, purchase structured investment products and enter into transactions that combine multiple derivative instruments. Strategic Transactions often have risks similar to the securities underlying the Strategic Transactions. However, the use of Strategic Transactions also involves risks that are different from, and possibly greater than, the risks associated with other portfolio investments. Strategic Transactions may involve the use of highly specialized instruments that require investment techniques and risk analyses different from those associated with other portfolio investments. The use of derivative instruments has risks, including the imperfect correlation between the value of the derivative instruments and the underlying assets, the possible default of the counterparty to the transaction or illiquidity of the derivative investments. Furthermore, the ability to successfully use these techniques depends on the Investment Adviser’s ability to predict pertinent market movements, which cannot be assured. Thus, the use of Strategic Transactions may result in losses greater than if they had not been used, may require the Fund to sell or purchase portfolio securities at inopportune times or for prices other than current market values, may limit the amount of appreciation the Fund can realize on an investment or may

 



 

15


   cause the Fund to hold a security that it might otherwise sell. In addition, amounts paid by the Fund as premiums and cash, or other assets held in margin accounts with respect to Strategic Transactions are not otherwise available to the Fund for investment purposes. It is possible that government regulation of various types of derivative instruments, including regulations enacted pursuant to the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act (the “Dodd-Frank Act”), which was signed into law in July 2010, may impact the availability, liquidity and cost of derivative instruments. There can be no assurance that such regulation will not have a material adverse effect on the Fund or will not impair the ability of the Fund to implement certain Strategic Transactions or to achieve its investment objective. Although the Investment Adviser seeks to use Strategic Transactions to further the Fund’s investment objective, no assurance can be given that the use of Strategic Transactions will achieve this result. A more complete discussion of Strategic Transactions and their risks is included in the SAI under the heading “Strategic Transactions.”
   Short Sales Risk . Short selling involves selling securities which may or may not be owned and borrowing the same securities for delivery to the purchaser, with an obligation to replace the borrowed securities at a later date. Short selling allows the short seller to profit from declines in market prices to the extent such declines exceed the transaction costs and the costs of borrowing the securities. A naked short sale creates the risk of an unlimited loss because the price of the underlying security could theoretically increase without limit, thus increasing the cost of buying those securities to cover the short position. There can be no assurance that the securities necessary to cover a short position will be available for purchase. Purchasing securities to close out the short position can itself cause the price of the securities to rise, further exacerbating the loss. See “Risks—Short Sales Risk.”
   Inflation Risk. Inflation risk is the risk that the value of assets or income from investment will be worth less in the future as inflation decreases the value of money. As inflation increases, the real value of the Fund’s Common Shares and distributions can decline.
   Deflation Risk. Deflation risk is the risk that prices throughout the economy decline over time, which may have an adverse effect on the market valuation of companies, their assets and their revenues. In addition, deflation may have an adverse effect on the creditworthiness of issuers and may make issuer default more likely, which may result in a decline in the value of the Fund’s portfolio.
   Other Investment Companies Risk. The Fund may invest in securities of other investment companies, including other closed-end or open-end investment companies (including ETFs). The market value of their shares may differ from the net asset value of the particular fund. To the extent the Fund invests a portion of its assets in investment company securities, those assets will be subject to the risks of the purchased investment company’s portfolio securities. In addition, if the Fund invests in such investment companies or investment funds, the Fund’s shareholders will bear not only their proportionate share of the expenses of the Fund (including operating expenses and the fees of the Investment Adviser), but also will indirectly bear similar expenses of the underlying investment company. In addition, the securities of other investment companies may also be leveraged and will therefore be subject to the same leverage risks described herein. As described in the section entitled “Risks—Leverage Risk,” the net asset value and market value of leveraged shares will be more volatile and the yield to stockholders will tend to fluctuate more than the yield generated by unleveraged shares. Other investment companies may have investment policies that differ from those of the Fund. In addition, to the extent the Fund invests in other investment companies, the Fund will be dependent upon the investment and research abilities of persons other than the Investment Adviser.

 



 

16


   ETN and ETF Risk. An exchange-traded note (“ETN”) or exchange-traded fund (“ETF”) that is based on a specific index may not be able to replicate and maintain exactly the composition and relative weighting of securities in the index. An ETN or ETF also incurs certain expenses not incurred by its applicable index. The market value of an ETN or ETF share may differ from its net asset value; the share may trade at a premium or discount to its net asset value, which may be due to, among other things, differences in the supply and demand in the market for the share and the supply and demand in the market for the underlying assets of the ETN or ETF. See “Risks—ETN and ETF Risk.”
   Investment Management Risk. The Fund’s portfolio is subject to investment management risk because it will be actively managed. The Investment Adviser will apply investment techniques and risk analyses in making investment decisions for the Fund, but there can be no guarantee that they will produce the desired results. See “Risks—Investment Management Risk.”
   Dependence on Key Personnel of the Investment Adviser. The Fund is dependent upon the Investment Adviser’s key personnel for its future success and upon their access to certain individuals and investments in the energy sector. In particular, the Fund will depend on the diligence, skill and network of business contacts of the personnel of the Investment Adviser and its portfolio managers, who will evaluate, negotiate, structure, close and monitor the Fund’s investments. The portfolio managers do not have a long-term employment contract with the Investment Adviser, although they do have equity interests and other financial incentives to remain with the firm. See “Risks—Dependence on Key Personnel of the Investment Adviser.”
   Conflicts of Interest with the Investment Adviser. Conflicts of interest may arise because the Investment Adviser and its affiliates generally will be carrying on substantial investment activities for other clients, including, but not limited to, other client accounts and funds managed or advised by the Investment Adviser in which the Fund will have no interest. The Investment Adviser or its affiliates may have financial incentives to favor certain of such accounts over the Fund. Any of their proprietary accounts and other customer accounts may compete with the Fund for specific trades. Notwithstanding these potential conflicts of interest, the Fund’s Board of Trustees and officers have a fiduciary obligation to act in the Fund’s best interest. See “Risks—Conflicts of Interest with the Investment Adviser.”
  

Market Discount from Net Asset Value. Shares of closed-end investment companies frequently trade at a discount from their net asset value, which is a risk separate and distinct from the risk that the Fund’s net asset value could decrease as a result of its investment activities.

 

Although the value of the Fund’s net assets is generally considered by market participants in determining whether to purchase or sell Common Shares, whether investors will realize gains or losses upon the sale of Common Shares will depend entirely upon whether the market price of Common Shares at the time of sale is above or below the investor’s purchase price for Common Shares. Because the market price of Common Shares will be determined by factors such as net asset value, distribution levels (which are dependent, in part, on expenses), supply of and demand for Common Shares, stability of distributions, trading volume of Common Shares, general market and economic conditions and other factors beyond the control of the Fund, the Fund cannot predict whether Common Shares will trade at, below or above net asset value or at, below or above the initial public offering

 



 

17


   price. This risk may be greater for investors expecting to sell their Common Shares soon after the completion of the public offering, as the net asset value of the Common Shares will be reduced immediately following the offering as a result of the payment of certain offering costs. Common Shares of the Fund are designed primarily for long-term investors; investors in Common Shares should not view the Fund as a vehicle for trading purposes.
  

Recent Economic Events Risk . Global and domestic financial markets have experienced periods of unprecedented turmoil. The debt and equity capital markets in the United States were negatively impacted by significant write-offs in the financial services sector relating to subprime mortgages and the re-pricing of credit risk in the broader market, among other things. These events, along with the deterioration of the housing market and the failure of major financial institutions, led to worsening general economic conditions, contributed to severe market volatility and caused severe liquidity strains in the capital markets.

 

Recently markets have witnessed more stabilized economic activity as expectations for an economic recovery increased. However, risks to a robust resumption of growth persist. Demand for energy commodities and prices of oil and other energy commodities have experienced significant volatility during recent years. Slower global growth may lower demand for oil and other energy commodities and increased exports by Iran with the end of sanctions may increase supply, exacerbating oversupply of such commodities and further reducing commodity prices. Many companies in which the Fund may invest have been and may continue to be adversely impacted by volatility of, prices of energy commodities. Continued volatility of such prices could further erode such companies’ growth prospects and negatively impact such companies’ ability to sustain attractive distribution levels. Growth of the Energy sector is dependent on several factors, including the strength of the financial sector, the general economy and the commodity markets.

  

Legislation and Regulatory Risks . At any time after the date hereof, legislation may be enacted that could negatively affect the issuers in which the Fund invests. Changing approaches to regulation may also have a negative impact issuers in which the Fund invests. In addition, legislation or regulation may change the way in which the Fund is regulated. There can be no assurance that future legislation, regulation or deregulation will not have a material adverse effect on the Fund or will not impair the ability of the Fund to achieve its investment objective.

 

The Dodd-Frank Act, which was signed into law in July 2010, has resulted in significant revisions to the U.S. financial regulatory framework. The Dodd-Frank Act covers a broad range of topics, including, among many others: a reorganization of federal financial regulators; the creation of a process designed to ensure financial system stability and the resolution of potentially insolvent financial firms; the enactment of new rules for derivatives trading; the creation of a consumer financial protection watchdog; the registration and regulation of managers of private funds; the regulation of rating agencies; and the enactment of new federal requirements for residential mortgage loans. The regulation of various types of derivative instruments pursuant to the Dodd-Frank Act may adversely affect the Fund or its counterparties.

 

The change in presidential administration could significantly impact the regulation of United States financial markets. Areas subject to potential change, amendment or repeal include the Dodd-Frank Act, including the Volcker Rule, the authority of the Federal Reserve and Financial Stability Oversight Council, and renewed proposals to separate banks’ commercial and investment banking activities. The Financial CHOICE Act, which was passed by the U.S. House of Representatives in June 2017, would, if enacted, roll back parts of the Dodd-Frank Act. Other

 



 

18


  

potential changes that could be pursued by the new presidential administration could include the United States’ withdrawal from, or attempt to renegotiate, various trade agreements or the taking of other actions that would change current trade policies of the United States. It is not possible to predict which, if any, of these actions will be taken or, if taken, their effect on the economy, securities markets or the financial stability of the United States. The Fund may be affected by governmental action in ways that are not foreseeable, and there is a possibility that such actions could have a significant adverse effect on the Fund and its ability to achieve its investment objective.

 

[The Tax Cuts and Jobs Act of 2017 was signed into law on December 22, 2017. The long term impacts of this legislation on issuers in which the Fund may invest, the energy sector generally and the economy and securities market of the United States is not yet certain.]

   Geopolitical and Market Disruption Risk. The aftermath of the war in Iraq, instability in Afghanistan, Pakistan, Egypt, Libya, Syria, Russia, Ukraine and the Middle East, possible terrorist attacks in the United States and around the world, growing social and political discord in the United States, the European debt crisis, the response of the international community—through economic sanctions and otherwise—to Russia’s recent annexation of the Crimea region of Ukraine and posture vis-a-vis Ukraine, continued tensions between North Korea and the United States and the international community generally, new and continued political unrest in various countries, such as Venezuela and Spain, the United Kingdom’s pending withdrawal from the European Union and the resulting profound and uncertain impacts on the economic and political future of the United Kingdom, the European Union and global financial markets, further downgrade of U.S. Government securities, the change in the U.S. president and the new administration and other similar events, may have long-term effects on the U.S. and worldwide financial markets and may cause further economic uncertainties in the United States and worldwide. The Fund does not know and cannot predict how long the securities markets may be affected by these events and the effects of these and similar events in the future on the U.S. economy and securities markets. The Fund may be adversely affected by abrogation of international agreements and national laws which have created the market instruments in which the Fund may invest, failure of the designated national and international authorities to enforce compliance with the same laws and agreements, failure of local, national and international organization to carry out their duties prescribed to them under the relevant agreements, revisions of these laws and agreements which dilute their effectiveness or conflicting interpretation of provisions of the same laws and agreements. The Fund may be adversely affected by uncertainties such as terrorism, international political developments, and changes in government policies, taxation, restrictions on foreign investment and currency repatriation, currency fluctuations and other developments in the laws and regulations of the countries in which it is invested.
   Not a Complete Investment Program . The Fund is intended for investors seeking a high level of total return with an emphasis on current income. The Fund is not meant to provide a vehicle for those who wish to exploit short-term swings in the stock market and is intended for long-term investors. An investment in shares of the Fund should not be considered a complete investment program. Each shareholder should take into account the Fund’s investment objective as well as the shareholder’s other investments when considering an investment in the Fund.
   Risks Associate with Offerings of Additional Common Shares . The voting power of current Common Shareholders will be diluted to the extent that current Common

 



 

19


   Shareholders do not purchase Common Shares in any future offerings of Common Shares or do not purchase sufficient Common Shares to maintain their percentage interest. If the Fund is unable to invest the proceeds of such offering as intended, the Fund’s per Common Share distribution may decrease and the Fund may not participate in market advances to the same extent as if such proceeds were fully invested as planned. If the Fund sells Common Shares at a price below NAV pursuant to the consent of Common Shareholders, shareholders will experience a dilution of the aggregate NAV per Common Share because the sale price will be less than the Fund’s then-current NAV per Common Share. Similarly, were the expenses of the offering to exceed the amount by which the sale price exceeded the Fund’s then current NAV per Common Share, shareholders would experience a dilution of the aggregate NAV per Common Share. This dilution will be experienced by all shareholders, irrespective of whether they purchase Common Shares in any such offering. See “Description of Shares—Common Shares—Issuance of Additional Common Shares.”
   Additional Risks of Rights. There are additional risks associated with an offering of Rights. Shareholders who do not exercise their Rights may, at the completion of such an offering, own a smaller proportional interest in the Fund than if they exercised their Rights. As a result of such an offering, a shareholder may experience dilution in net asset value per share if the subscription price per share is below the net asset value per share on the expiration date. If the subscription price per share is below the net asset value per share of the Fund’s Common Shares on the expiration date, a shareholder will experience an immediate dilution of the aggregate net asset value of such shareholder’s Common Shares if the shareholder does not participate in such an offering and the shareholder will experience a reduction in the net asset value per share of such shareholder’s Common Shares whether or not the shareholder participates in such an offering. Such a reduction in net asset value per share may have the effect of reducing market price of the Common Share. The Fund cannot state precisely the extent of this dilution (if any) if the shareholder does not exercise such shareholder’s Rights because the Fund does not know what the net asset value per share will be when the offer expires or what proportion of the Rights will be exercised. If the subscription price is substantially less than the then current net asset value per Common Share at the expiration of a rights offering, such dilution could be substantial. Any such dilution or accretion will depend upon whether (i) such shareholders participate in the Rights offering and (ii) the Fund’s net asset value per Common Share is above or below the subscription price on the expiration date of the Rights offering. In addition to the economic dilution described above, if a Common Shareholder does not exercise all of their rights, the Common Shareholder will incur voting dilution as a result of this rights offering. This voting dilution will occur because the Common Shareholder will own a smaller proportionate interest in the Fund after the rights offering than prior to the rights offering. There is a risk that changes in market conditions may result in the underlying Common Shares purchasable upon exercise of the subscription rights being less attractive to investors at the conclusion of the subscription period. This may reduce or eliminate the value of the subscription rights. If investors exercise only a portion of the rights, the number of Common Shares issued may be reduced, and the Common Shares may trade at less favorable prices than larger offerings for similar securities. Subscription rights issued by the Fund may be transferable or non-transferable rights. In a non-transferable rights offering, Common Shareholders who do not wish to exercise their rights will be unable to sell their rights. In a transferrable rights offering, the Fund will use its best efforts to ensure an adequate trading market for the rights; however, investors may find that there is no market to sell rights they do not wish to exercise.

 



 

20


Anti-Takeover Provisions in the Fund’s Agreement and Declaration of Trust and Bylaws    The Fund’s Agreement and Declaration of Trust and Bylaws include provisions that could have the effect of limiting the ability of other entities or persons to acquire control of the Fund or to change the composition of its Board of Trustees. For example, the Fund’s Agreement and Declaration of Trust limits the ability of persons to beneficially own (within the meaning of Section 382 of the Code) more than 4.99% of the outstanding Common Shares of the Fund. This restriction is intended to reduce the risk of the Fund undergoing an “ownership change” within the meaning of Section 382 of the Code, which would limit the Fund’s ability to use a capital loss carryforward and certain unrealized losses (if such tax attributes exist). In general, an ownership change occurs if 5% shareholders (and certain persons or groups treated as 5% shareholders) of the Fund increase their ownership percentage in the Fund by more than 50 percentage points in the aggregate within any three-year period ending on certain defined testing dates. If an ownership change were to occur, Section 382 would impose an annual limitation on the amount of post-ownership change gains that the Fund may offset with pre-ownership change losses, and might impose restrictions on the Fund’s ability to use certain unrealized losses existing at the time of the ownership change. Such a limitation arising under Section 382 could reduce the benefit of the Fund’s then existing capital loss carryforward or unrealized losses, if any. These ownership restrictions could have the effect of depriving shareholders of an opportunity to sell their shares at a premium over prevailing market prices by discouraging a third party from seeking to obtain control over the Fund. Such attempts could have the effect of increasing the expenses of the Fund and disrupting the normal operation of the Fund. In addition, these ownership restrictions may reduce market demand for the Fund’s Common Shares, which could have the effect of increasing the likelihood that the Fund’s Common Shares trade at a discount to net asset value and increasing the amount of any such discount. See “Anti-Takeover Provisions in the Agreement and Declaration of Trust” and “Certain Provisions of Delaware Law, the Agreement and Declaration of Trust and Bylaws.”

Other Service

Providers

  

Under a transfer agency and service agreement among U.S. Bancorp Fund Services, LLC and the Fund, U.S. Bancorp Fund Services, LLC serves as the Fund’s transfer agent, registrar and distribution disbursing agent.

 

U.S. Bancorp Fund Services, LLC (the “Administrator”) provides the Fund with administrative services. The Administrator also performs fund accounting.

 

U.S. Bank National Association serves as the custodian of the Fund’s securities and other assets.

 



 

21


SUMMARY OF FUND EXPENSES

The following table contains information about the costs and expenses that Common Shareholders will bear directly or indirectly. The table is based on the capital structure of the Fund as of November 30, 2017 (except as noted below). The purpose of the table and the example below is to help you understand the fees and expenses that you, as a holder of Common Shares, would bear directly or indirectly.

 

Shareholder transaction expenses       

Sales load (as a percentage of estimated offering price)

     —   % (1)  

Offering expenses borne by the Fund (as a percentage of estimated offering price)

     —   % (1)  

Dividend reinvestment Plan fees

     None  

 

Annual Expenses    Percentage of Net Assets
Attributable to Common  Shares (2)

Management fees (3)

   1.53%

Interest payments on borrowed funds (4)

   0.48%

Other expenses (5)

   0.48%

Total annual expenses (6)

   2.49%

 

(1) If Common Shares to which this Prospectus relates are sold to or through underwriters, the Prospectus Supplement will set forth any applicable sales load and the estimated offering expenses borne by the Fund.
(2) Based upon net assets attributable to common shares as of November 30, 2017.
(3) The Fund pays the Investment Adviser an annual fee, payable monthly, in an amount equal to 1.25% of the Fund’s average weekly Managed Assets. The fee shown above is based upon outstanding leverage of 16% of the Fund’s Managed Assets. If leverage of more than 16% of the Fund’s Managed Assets is used, the management fees shown would be higher.
(4) Based upon the Fund’s outstanding borrowings as of November 30, 2017 of $23 million and the interest rate as of November 30, 2017, of 2.37%.
(5) “Other expenses” are estimated based upon those incurred during the fiscal period ended November 30, 2017. Other expenses do not include expense related to realized or unrealized investment gains or losses.

EXAMPLE

As required by relevant SEC regulations, the following example illustrates the expenses that you would pay on a $1,000 investment in Common Shares, assuming (1) “Total annual expenses” of 2.49% of net assets attributable to Common Shares and (4) a 5% annual return*:

 

     1 Year      3 Years      5 Years      10 Years  

Total expenses incurred

   $ 25      $ 78      $ 133      $ 283  

The example should not be considered a representation of future expenses or returns. Actual expenses may be greater or less than those shown. Moreover, the Fund’s actual rate of return may be greater or less than the hypothetical 5% return shown in the example. The example assumes that all distributions and distributions are reinvested at net asset value.

 

22


F INANCIAL HIGHLIGHTS

The financial highlights table is intended to help you understand the Fund’s financial performance. The information in this table for the past five years is derived from the Fund’s financial statements audited by Ernst & Young LLP, independent registered public accounting firm for the Fund, whose report on such financial statements, together with the financial statements of the Fund, are included in the Fund’s annual report to shareholders for the fiscal year ended             ,         , and are incorporated by reference into the SAI.

The Cushing ® Renaissance Fund

Financial Highlights

 

    Fiscal
Year Ended
November 30,
2017
    Fiscal
Year Ended
November 30,
2016
    Fiscal
Year Ended
November 30,
2015
    Fiscal
Year Ended
November 30,
2014
    Fiscal
Year Ended
November 30,
2013
    Period From
September 25,
2012 (1)
through
November 30, 2012
 

Per Common Share Data (2)

           

Net Asset Value, beginning of period

  $     $ 19.58     $ 25.78     $ 27.46     $ 23.76     $  

Public offering price

                                  25.00  

Underwriting discounts and offering costs on issuance of common shares

                                  (1.17

Income from Investment Operations:

           

Net investment income (loss)

          (0.01     0.58       0.53       0.72       0.01  

Net realized and unrealized gain (loss) on investments

          1.49       (5.14     (0.57     4.46       (0.08
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total increase (decrease) from investment operations

          1.48       (4.56     (0.04     5.18       (0.07
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Less Distributions to Common Stockholders:

           

Net investment income

          (0.54     (0.51     (0.38     (0.35      

Net realized gain

                      (0.41     (1.13      

Return of capital

          (1.10     (1.13     (0.85            
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total distributions to common stockholders

          (1.64     (1.64     (1.64     (1.48      
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net Asset Value, end of period

        $ 19.42     $ 19.58     $ 25.78     $ 27.46     $ 23.76  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Per common share fair value, end of period

        $ 17.49     $ 15.75     $ 23.51     $ 24.30     $ 23.41  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Investment Return Based on Fair Value (4)

          24.19     (27.15 )%      2.85     10.47     (6.36 )% (3)  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

23


The Cushing ® Renaissance Fund

Financial Highlights — (Continued)

 

 

    Fiscal
Year Ended
November 30,
2017
    Fiscal
Year Ended
November 30,
2016
    Fiscal
Year Ended
November 30,
2015
    Fiscal
Year Ended
November 30,
2014
    Fiscal
Year Ended
November 30,
2013
    Period From
September 25,
2012 (1)
through
November 30, 2012
 

Supplemental Data and Ratios

           

Net assets applicable to common stockholders, end of period (000’s)

  $     $ 117,569     $ 118,568     $ 156,094     $ 166,240     $ 143,850  

Ratio of expenses to average net assets after waiver (5)(6)

          1.99     1.95     1.95     1.75     2.06

Ratio of net investment income to average net assets before waiver (5)

          3.43     2.53     1.81     1.13     (0.05 )% 

Ratio of net investment income to average net assets after waiver (5)

          3.43     2.53     1.81     1.37     0.21

Portfolio turnover rate

          226.71     101.17     26.08     87.61     9.23 % (7)  

 

(1)   Commencement of operations.

 

(2)   Information presented relates to a share of common stock outstanding for the entire period

 

(3)   Not annualized. Total investment return is calculated assuming a purchase of common stock at the initial public offering price and a sale at the closing price on the last day of the period reported. The calculation also assumes reinvestment of dividends at actual prices pursuant to the Fund’s dividend reinvestment plan. Total investment return does not reflect brokerage commissions.

 

(4)   Not annualized for periods less than one full year. The calculation also assumes reinvestment of dividends at actual prices pursuant to the Fund’s dividend reinvestment plan. Total investment return does not reflect brokerage commissions.

 

(5)   Annualized for periods less than one full year.

 

(6)   The ratio of expenses to average net assets before waiver was 2.45%, 1.99%, 1.95%, 1.96%, 1.99% and 2.32% for the period ended May 31, 2017, the fiscal years ended November  30, 2016, 2015, 2014 and 2013, and the fiscal period from September  25, 2012 through November  30, 2012, respectively.

 

(7)   Not annualized.

 


 

24


SENIOR SE CURITIES

The following table sets forth information about the Fund’s outstanding senior securities as of the end of each fiscal year since its inception. The information in this table for the past five years is derived from the Fund’s financial statements audited by Ernst & Young LLP, independent registered public accounting firm for the Fund, whose report on such financial statements, together with the financial statements of the Fund, are included in the Fund’s annual report to shareholders for the fiscal year ended             ,         , and are incorporated by reference into the SAI.

 

Fiscal Period Ended    Title of Security   

Total Principal

Amount Outstanding

    

Asset Coverage Per

$1,000 of Principal Amount

 

November 30, 2017

   Borrowings    $      $  

November 30, 2016

   Borrowings    $ 10,456,007      $ 12,244  

November 30, 2015

   Borrowings    $ 7,321,000      $ 17,196  

November 30, 2014

   Borrowings    $ 24,171,751      $ 7,458  

November 30, 2013

   Borrowings    $ 24,659,062      $ 7,742  

November 30, 2012

   Borrowings    $ 0        N/A  

 

25


T HE FUND

The Cushing ® Renaissance Fund (the “Fund”) was formed as a Delaware statutory trust on November 17, 2010 and is a non-diversified, closed-end management investment company registered under the Investment Company Act of 1940 Act (the “1940 Act”). The Fund commenced investment operations on September 25, 2012. The Fund’s principal office is located at 8117 Preston Road, Suite 440, Dallas, Texas 75225.

The “Cushing” name originates from a city in Oklahoma of the same name that was a center for the exploration, production and storage of crude oil during the early 20th century. Cushing, Oklahoma, with its large amount of energy infrastructure assets, is currently a major storage and trading clearing hub for crude oil and refined products in the United States.

US E OF PROCEEDS

Unless otherwise specified in a Prospectus Supplement, the Fund intends to invest the net proceeds of an offering of Securities in accordance with its investment objective and policies as stated in this Prospectus. It is currently anticipated that the Fund will be able to invest substantially all of the net proceeds of an offering of Securities in accordance with its investment objective and policies within three months after the completion of such offering. Prior to the time the proceeds of each offering are fully invested, such proceeds may temporarily be invested in cash, cash equivalents, or in debt securities that are rated AA or higher. Income received by the Fund from such temporary investments would likely be less than returns sought pursuant to the Fund’s investment objective and policies. A delay in the anticipated use of proceeds could lower returns and reduce the Fund’s distribution to Common Shareholders.

MARKET AND NET ASSET VALUE INFORMATION

The Fund’s currently outstanding Common Shares are, and the Common Shares offered by this Prospectus, will be, subject to notice of issuance, listed on the New York Stock Exchange (the “NYSE”). The Fund’s Common Shares commenced trading on the NYSE on September 25, 2012. In connection with any offering of Rights, the Fund will provide information in the Prospectus Supplement for the expected trading market, if any, for Rights.

The Common Shares have traded both at a premium and at a discount in relation to the Fund’s net asset value per share. Although the Common Shares recently have traded at a premium to net asset value, there can be no assurance that this will continue after the offering nor that the Common Shares will not trade at a discount in the future. Shares of closed-end investment companies frequently trade at a discount to net asset value. The Fund’s net asset value will be reduced immediately following an offering of the Common Shares due to the costs of such offering, which will be borne entirely by the Fund. The sale of Common Shares by the Fund (or the perception that such sales may occur) may have an adverse effect on prices of Common Shares in the secondary market. An increase in the number of Common Shares available may put downward pressure on the market price for Common Shares. See “Risks—Market Discount From Net Asset Value.”

The following table sets forth, for each of the periods indicated, the high and low closing market prices for the Common Shares on the NYSE, the net asset value per Common Share and the premium or discount to net asset value per Common Share at which the Common Shares were trading.

 

     Market Price      Corresponding Net
Asset Value Per
Common Share
     Corresponding
Premium/(Discount)
as a Percentage of

Net Asset Value
 

Fiscal Quarter Ended

   High      Low      High      Low      High     Low  

November 30, 2017

   $ 19.14      $ 17.28      $ 19.96      $ 18.89        (4.11 )%      (8.52 )% 

August 31, 2017

   $ 17.92      $ 16.54      $ 19.17      $ 17.86        (6.52 )%      (7.39 )% 

May 31, 2017

   $ 18.68      $ 17.43      $ 19.84      $ 19.22        (5.85 )%      (9.31 )% 

February 28, 2017

   $ 19.07      $ 17.05      $ 20.62      $ 19.73        (7.52 )%      (13.58 )% 

November 30, 2016

   $ 17.55      $ 15.88      $ 19.23      $ 17.85        (8.74 )%      (11.01 )% 

August 31, 2016

   $ 16.65      $ 14.77      $ 18.51      $ 16.93        (10.05 )%      (12.76 )% 

May 31, 2016

   $ 15.61      $ 12.70      $ 18.20      $ 15.45        (14.23 )%      (17.80 )% 

February 28, 2016

   $ 16.00      $ 11.24      $ 19.69      $ 13.74        (18.74 )%      (18.20 )% 

November 30, 2015

   $ 16.95      $ 14.44      $ 20.29      $ 17.80        (16.46 )%      (18.88 )% 

 

26


As of December 20, 2017, the last reported sale price for the Fund’s Common Shares on the NYSE was $20.34 per Common Share, and the net asset value of the Fund’s Common Shares was $19.69 per Common Share, representing a discount to net asset value of 3.20%. The Fund cannot predict whether its Common Shares will trade in the future at a premium to or discount from net asset value, or the level of any premium or discount. Shares of closed-end investment companies frequently trade at a discount from net asset value. As of November 30, 2017, 5,853,857 Common Shares of the Fund were outstanding.

INVE STMENT OBJECTIVE AND POLICIES

Investment Objective

The Fund’s investment objective is to seek a high total return with an emphasis on current income. There can be no assurance that the Fund’s investment objective will be achieved.

Principal Investment Policies

The Fund seeks to achieve its investment objective by investing, under normal market conditions, at least 80% of its Managed Assets (as defined in this Prospectus) in a portfolio of Renaissance Companies, which are (i) Energy Companies, which are companies across the energy supply chain spectrum, including upstream, midstream and downstream energy companies (i.e. companies engaged in exploration and production, gathering, transporting and processing and marketing and distribution, respectively), as well as oil and gas services companies, (ii) Industrial Companies, which are energy-intensive chemical, metal and industrial and manufacturing companies and engineering and construction companies that the Investment Adviser expects to benefit from growing energy production and lower feedstock costs relative to global costs and, (iii) Logistics Companies, which are transportation and logistics companies providing solutions to the U.S. manufacturing industry.

The Fund will invest no more than 25% of its Managed Assets in securities of energy MLPs that are “qualified publicly traded partnerships” under the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the “Code”).

The Fund generally seeks to invest no more than 10% of Managed Assets in any one issue and no more than 20% of Managed Assets in any one issuer, in each case, determined at the time of investment.

The Fund may invest up to 25% of its Managed Assets in unregistered or otherwise restricted securities, including securities issued by private companies.

The Fund may invest up to 30% of its Managed Assets in debt securities, preferred stock and convertible securities of energy supply chain companies and other issuers, provided that such securities are (a) rated, at the time of investment, at least (i) B3 by Moody’s Investors Service, Inc. (“Moody’s”), (ii) B- by Standard & Poor’s (“S&P”) or Fitch Ratings (“Fitch”), or (iii) of a comparable rating by another Nationally Recognized Statistical Rating Organization (“NRSRO”) or (b) with respect to up to 10% of its Managed Assets in debt securities, preferred shares and convertible securities that have lower ratings or are unrated at the time of investment.

The Fund may invest in non-U.S. securities, including, among other things, non-U.S. securities represented by American Depositary Receipts or “ADRs.”

The Fund may invest in issuers of any market capitalization size.

The Fund may seek to hedge risks to the portfolio as deemed prudent by the Investment Adviser.

The Fund will not invest directly in commodities.

The Fund’s investment objective and percentage parameters are not fundamental policies of the Fund and may be changed without shareholder approval.

 

27


Investment Process and Risk Management

The Investment Adviser’s investment process involves fundamental and quantitative analysis. The Investment Adviser selects a core group of investments utilizing a proprietary quantitative ranking system and seeks to build a strategically developed core portfolio designed to take advantage of changing dynamics in the energy and industrial and manufacturing sectors. The Fund will be actively managed and the quantitative analysis will be dynamic in conjunction with the Investment Adviser’s proprietary research process. The Investment Adviser utilizes its financial and industry experience to identify the absolute and relative value investments that, in the Investment Adviser’s view, present the best opportunities. The results of the Investment Adviser’s analysis and comprehensive investment process will influence the weightings of positions held by the Fund.

Fundamental Analysis. The Investment Adviser utilizes dedicated industry analysts to cover the Fund’s potential investment sectors. Analysts prepare detailed financial models of potential portfolio companies with full financial projections that incorporate current and future capital projects. This bottom-up modeling process is designed to help accurately predict earnings.

Qualitative Analysis . The bottom-up fundamental analysis is then coupled with a top-down theme overlay, which includes potential views on commodity prices. Discussions and debate by the investment team of research analysts and portfolio managers regarding the qualitative characteristics of current and potential portfolio holdings are also utilized. These qualitative characteristics include, but are not limited to, asset-related strengths and weaknesses, market sentiment and strength of management.

Portfolio Construction and Management . Once an investment thesis is formed at the company specific level, the portfolio management team determines the appropriate level of exposure based on current views of commodities prices and overall macroeconomic environment. In constructing and maintaining the portfolio, the Investment Adviser monitors such factors as company valuations relative to relevant benchmarks, general economic conditions and trends, and regulatory policy regarding energy and manufacturing.

The Investment Adviser constructs a core portfolio that it believes will have the highest level of total return performance over the next six (6) to twenty-four (24) months. The Investment Adviser’s buy discipline incorporates liquidity and pricing tolerances for each investment. The Investment Adviser’s sell discipline develops from a combination of price appreciation based on initial price targets from the core portfolio, relative valuation metrics and macro issues which may impact the original thesis.

Risk Management . An overlay to the investment process is the Investment Adviser’s risk management function, which is designed to provide independent oversight to the portfolio management process. The Investment Adviser maintains a dedicated risk manager who monitors managed portfolios for macroeconomic risks, such as geopolitical concerns, credit spreads, currency and commodity price exposure, as well as investment specific risks, such as value at risk (VaR), liquidity concerns, sub-sector concentration and position exposure.

Investment Characteristics

The Investment Adviser believes that the following characteristics of Renaissance Companies makes them attractive investments:

 

    Renaissance Companies are positioned to directly benefit from the current dislocation of domestic energy prices as compared to commodity prices in other parts of the world.

 

    Renaissance Companies are positioned to directly benefit from the increased domestic development and transportation of energy.

 

    Energy Companies are positioned to benefit from the continued build-out of U.S. energy infrastructure.

 

    Industrial Companies whose primary feedstock is energy should benefit from lower domestic energy costs as compared to global costs.

 

    Energy Companies provide the potential for current income through monthly or quarterly distributions.

 

28


An investment in Renaissance Companies also involves risks, some of which are described below under “Risks.”

THE FUND’S INVESTMENTS

Energy Companies

The Fund will invest in a portfolio of equity and debt securities of energy supply chain and energy services companies, including companies that operate assets used in gathering, transporting, processing, storing, refining, distributing, mining, or marketing natural gas, natural gas liquids, crude oil or refined petroleum products. The energy supply chain companies in which the Fund will invest will primarily include:

 

    Upstream Energy Companies , which are businesses engaged in energy exploration and production, including, among others, crude oil, natural gas and natural gas liquids (“NGLs”);

 

    Midstream Energy Companies , which are businesses engaged in the gathering, transportation, processing, fractionation, refining and storage of crude oil, natural gas and natural gas liquids or refined petroleum products; and

 

    Downstream Energy Companies , which are businesses engaged in the marketing and distribution of refined energy products, such as petroleum, liquefied petroleum gas (“LPG”), fuel oils, lubricants, plastics and other chemicals, fertilizer and natural gas to retail customers and industrial end-users.

The Fund may invest in equity securities of oil and gas services sector companies. Companies are considered to be in the oil and gas services sector if they derive a majority of their revenues from oil and gas services, which include oil and gas equipment, oil and gas services or oil and gas drilling. The Fund may also invest in extractive logistics companies engaged in the delivery and sale of petroleum products, such as diesel fuel and lubricating oil, antifreeze, methanol and other chemicals to customers engaged in drilling, exploration and production and mining activities.

Industrial Companies

The Fund will invest in equity and debt securities of companies that the Investment Adviser expects to benefit from lower energy and feedstock costs, including energy-intensive chemical, metal and industrial manufacturing companies and engineering and construction (“E&C”) companies.

Master Limited Partnerships

The Fund may invest up to 25% of the value of its Managed Assets in MLPs that are “qualified publicly traded partnerships” under the Code. MLPs are formed as limited partnerships or limited liability companies and taxed as partnerships for federal income tax purposes. The securities issued by many MLPs are listed and traded on a U.S. exchange. An MLP typically issues general partner and limited partner interests or managing member and member interests. The general partner or managing member manages and often controls, has an ownership stake in, and may receive incentive distribution payments from, the MLP. If publicly traded, to be treated as a partnership for U.S. federal income tax purposes, an MLP must derive at least 90% of its gross income for each taxable year from qualifying sources as described in Section 7704 of the Code. These qualifying sources include natural resources-based activities such as the exploration, development, mining, production, processing, refining, transportation, storage and certain marketing of mineral or natural resources.

The general partner or managing member may be structured as a private or publicly-traded corporation or other entity. The general partner or managing member typically controls the operations and management of the entity and has an up to 2% general partner or managing member interest in the entity plus, in many cases, ownership of some percentage of the outstanding limited partner or member interests. The limited partners or members, through their ownership of limited partner or member interests, provide capital to the entity, are intended to have no role in the operation and management of the entity and receive cash distributions.

Due to their structure as partnerships for U.S. federal income tax purposes and the expected character of their income, MLPs generally do not pay federal income taxes. Thus, unlike investors in corporate securities, direct MLP investors are generally not subject to double taxation ( i.e. , corporate level tax and tax on corporate distributions). Currently, most MLPs operate in the energy and midstream, natural resources, shipping or real estate sectors.

 

29


Equity securities issued by MLPs typically consist of common and subordinated units (which represent the limited partner or member interests) and a general partner or managing member interest. For more information on MLP securities, see “Investment Strategies and Risks — Master Limited Partnership Interests” in the SAI.

For purposes of the Fund’s policy with respect to investments in any single issue or issuer, an MLP “issuer” includes both an MLP issuer and its controlling general partner, managing member or sponsor and an MLP “issue” is a class of an issuer’s securities or a derivative security that tracks that class of securities.

Restricted Securities

The Fund may invest up to 25% of its Managed Assets in unregistered or otherwise restricted securities, including securities issued by private companies. “Restricted securities” are securities that are unregistered, held by control persons of the issuer or are subject to contractual restrictions on resale. The Fund will typically acquire restricted securities in directly negotiated transactions. The Fund’s investments in restricted securities may include privately issued securities of both public and private issuers.

Debt Securities

The Fund may invest up to 30% of its Managed Assets in debt securities, preferred stock and convertible securities, provided that such securities are (a) rated, at the time of investment, at least (i) B3 by Moody’s, (ii) B- by S&P or Fitch, or (iii) of a comparable rating by another NRSRO or (b) with respect to up to 10% of its Managed Assets, lower rated or are unrated at the time of investment. Debt securities rated below investment grade (such as those rated Ba or lower by Moody’s and BB or lower by S&P) are commonly known as “junk bonds” and are regarded as predominantly speculative with respect to the issuer’s capacity to pay interest and repay principal in accordance with the terms of the obligations, and involve major risk exposure to adverse conditions. The credit quality policies noted above apply only at the time a security is purchased, and the Fund is not required to dispose of a security in the event that a rating agency downgrades its assessment of the credit characteristics of a particular issue. In determining whether to retain or sell such a security, the Investment Adviser may consider such factors as the Investment Adviser’s assessment of the credit quality of the issuer of such security, the price at which such security could be sold and the rating, if any, assigned to such security by other rating agencies. Rating agencies are private services that provide ratings of the credit quality of debt obligations. Ratings assigned by a rating agency are not absolute standards of credit quality and do not evaluate market risks or the liquidity of securities. Rating agencies may fail to make timely changes in credit ratings; and an issuer’s current financial condition may be better or worse than a rating indicates. To the extent that the issuer of a security pays a rating agency for the analysis of its security, an inherent conflict of interest may exist that could affect the reliability of the rating. See “Appendix A: Description of Securities Ratings” in the SAI.

Preferred stock generally has a preference as to distributions and upon liquidation over an issuer’s common stock but ranks junior to other income securities in an issuer’s capital structure. Preferred stock generally pays distributions in cash (or additional shares of preferred stock) at a defined rate but, unlike interest payments on other income securities, preferred stock distributions are payable only if declared by the issuer’s board of directors. distributions on preferred stock may be cumulative, meaning that, in the event the issuer fails to make one or more distribution payments on the preferred stock, no distributions may be paid on the issuer’s common stock until all unpaid preferred stock distributions have been paid. Preferred stock also may provide that, in the event the issuer fails to make a specified number of distribution payments, the holders of the preferred stock will have the right to elect a specified number of directors to the issuer’s board. Preferred stock also may be subject to optional or mandatory redemption provisions.

A convertible security is a bond, debenture, note, preferred stock or other security that may be converted into or exchanged for a prescribed amount of common stock or other equity security of the same or a different issuer within a particular period of time at a specified price or formula. A convertible security entitles the holder to receive interest paid or accrued on debt or the distribution paid on preferred stock until the convertible security matures or is redeemed, converted or exchanged. Before conversion, convertible securities have characteristics similar to nonconvertible income securities in that they ordinarily provide a stable stream of income with generally higher

 

30


yields than those of common stocks of the same or similar issuers, but lower yields than comparable nonconvertible securities. The value of a convertible security is influenced by changes in interest rates, with investment value declining as interest rates increase and increasing as interest rates decline. The credit standing of the issuer and other factors also may have an effect on the convertible security’s investment value. Convertible securities rank senior to common stock in a corporation’s capital structure but are usually subordinated to comparable nonconvertible securities. Convertible securities may be subject to redemption at the option of the issuer at a price established in the convertible security’s governing instrument.

Non-U.S. Securities

The Fund may invest in non-U.S. securities, including, among other things, non-U.S. securities represented by American Depositary Receipts or “ADRs.” ADRs are certificates evidencing ownership of shares of a non-U.S. issuer that are issued by depositary banks and generally trade on an established market in the United States or elsewhere.

Strategic Transactions

The Fund may, but is not required to, use investment strategies (referred to herein as “Strategic Transactions”) for hedging, risk management or portfolio management purposes or to earn income. Strategic Transactions may involve the purchase and sale of derivative instruments. The Fund may purchase and sell exchange-listed and over-the-counter put and call options on securities, indices and other instruments, enter into forward contracts, purchase and sell futures contracts and options thereon, enter into swap, cap, floor or collar transactions, purchase structured investment products and enter into transactions that combine multiple derivative instruments. The Fund’s use of Strategic Transactions may also include newly developed or permitted instruments, strategies and techniques, consistent with the Fund’s investment objectives and applicable regulatory requirements.

Strategic Transactions often have risks similar to the securities underlying the Strategic Transactions. However, the use of Strategic Transactions also involves risks that are different from, and possibly greater than, the risks associated with other portfolio investments. Strategic Transactions may involve the use of highly specialized instruments that require investment techniques and risk analyses different from those associated with other portfolio investments. The Fund complies with applicable regulatory requirements when implementing Strategic Transactions, including the segregation of cash and/or liquid securities on the books of the Fund’s custodian, as mandated by SEC rules or SEC staff positions. Although the Investment Adviser seeks to use Strategic Transactions to further the Fund’s investment objective, no assurance can be given that the use of Strategic Transactions will achieve this result.

Examples of how the Fund may use Strategic Transactions include, but are not limited to:

 

    Using derivative investments to hedge certain risks such as overall market, interest rate and commodity price risks. The Fund may engage in various interest rate and currency hedging transactions, including buying or selling options or futures, entering into other transactions including forward contracts, swaps or options on futures and other derivatives transactions.

 

    Using Strategic Transactions to manage its effective interest rate exposure, including the effective yield paid on any leverage used by the Fund, protect against possible adverse changes in the market value of the securities held in or to be purchased for its portfolio, or otherwise protect the value of its portfolio.

 

    Engaging in Strategic Transactions to hedge the currency risk to which it may be exposed by, for example, buying or selling options or futures or entering into other foreign currency transactions, including forward foreign currency contracts, currency swaps or options on currency and currency futures and other derivatives transactions.

 

    Selling short Treasury securities to hedge its interest rate exposure. When shorting Treasury securities, the loss is limited to the principal amount that is contractually required to be repaid at maturity and the interest expense that must be paid at the specified times. See “Risks—Short Sales Risk.”

 

    Engaging in paired long-short trades to arbitrage pricing disparities in securities issued by Renaissance Companies, write (or sell) covered call options on securities held in its portfolio, write (or sell) uncovered call options on the securities of Renaissance Companies, purchase call options or enter into swap contracts to increase its exposure to Renaissance Companies, or sell securities short.

 

31


Hedging transactions can be expensive and have risks, including the imperfect correlation between the value of such instruments and the underlying assets, the possible default of the other party to the transaction or illiquidity of the derivative instruments. Furthermore, the ability to successfully use hedging transactions depends on the Investment Adviser’s ability to predict pertinent market movements, which cannot be assured. A more complete discussion of Strategic Transactions and their risks is included in the SAI under the heading “Strategic Transactions.”

Other Investment Companies

The Fund may invest in securities of other closed-end or open-end investment companies (including ETFs) that invest primarily in companies in which the Fund may invest directly to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act. The Fund may invest in other investment companies during periods when it has large amounts of uninvested cash, such as the period shortly after the Fund receives the proceeds of the offering of its Securities, during periods when there is a shortage of attractive Renaissance Company securities available in the market, or when the Investment Adviser believes share prices of other investment companies offer attractive values. The Fund may invest in investment companies that are advised by the Investment Adviser or its affiliates to the extent permitted by applicable law and/or pursuant to exemptive relief from the SEC. As a stockholder in an investment company, the Fund will bear its ratable share of that investment company’s expenses, and would remain subject to payment of the Fund’s management fees and other expenses with respect to assets so invested. Common Shareholders would therefore be subject to duplicative expenses to the extent the Fund invests in other investment companies. The Investment Adviser will take expenses into account when evaluating the investment merits of an investment in an investment company relative to other available investments. To the extent that the Fund invests in investment companies that invest primarily in Renaissance Companies, such investments will be counted for purposes of the Fund’s policy of investing at least 80% of its Managed Assets in Renaissance Companies.

Exchange-Traded Notes

The Fund may invest in ETNs, which are typically unsecured, unsubordinated debt securities that trade on a securities exchange and are designed to replicate the returns of market benchmarks minus applicable fees. To the extent that the Fund invests in ETNs that are designed to replicate indices comprised primarily of securities issued by Renaissance Companies, such investments will be counted for purposes of the Fund’s policy of investing at least 80% of its Managed Assets in Renaissance Company investments.

New Securities and Other Investment Techniques

New types of securities and other investment and hedging practices are developed from time to time. The Investment Adviser expects, consistent with the Fund’s investment objective and policies, to invest in such new types of securities and to engage in such new types of investment practices if the Investment Adviser believes that these investments and investment techniques may assist the Fund in achieving its investment objective. In addition, the Investment Adviser may use investment techniques and instruments that are not specifically described herein.

Covered Call Options

The Fund may, from time to time, seek to enhance total return by writing call options on a portion of the securities held in the Fund’s portfolio (commonly referred to as “covered” call options). As the writer of a covered call option, the Fund receives a premium but forgoes, during the option’s life, the opportunity to profit from increases in the market value of the security covering the call option above the sum of the premium and the strike price of the call, but retains the risk of loss should the price of the underlying security decline. As the Fund writes covered calls over more of its portfolio, its ability to benefit from capital appreciation becomes more limited. See “Strategic Transactions — Options” in the SAI for additional information regarding option transactions.

Short Sales, Arbitrage and Other Strategies

The Fund may use short sales, arbitrage and other strategies to try to generate additional return. As part of such strategies, the Fund may engage in paired long-short trades to arbitrage pricing disparities in securities issued by

 

32


Renaissance Companies, write (or sell) uncovered call options on the securities of Renaissance Companies, purchase call options or enter into swap contracts to increase its exposure to Renaissance Companies, or sell securities short. With a long position, the Fund purchases a stock outright, but with a short position, it would sell a security that it does not own and must borrow to meet its settlement obligations. The Fund will realize a profit or incur a loss from a short position depending on whether the value of the underlying stock decreases or increases, respectively, between the time the stock is sold and when the Fund replaces the borrowed security. To increase its exposure to certain issuers, the Fund may purchase call options or use swap agreements. The Fund expects to use these strategies on a limited basis. See “Risks—Short Sales Risk” and “Risks—Strategic Transactions Risk.”

Lending of Portfolio Securities

The Fund may lend its portfolio securities to broker-dealers and banks. Any such loan must be continuously secured by collateral in cash or cash equivalents maintained on a current basis in an amount at least equal to 102% of the value of the securities loaned. The Fund would continue to receive the equivalent of the interest or distributions paid by the issuer on the securities loaned and would also receive an additional return that may be in the form of a fixed fee or a percentage of the collateral. The Fund may pay reasonable fees for services in arranging these loans. The Fund would have the right to call the loan and obtain the securities loaned at any time on notice of not more than five (5) business days. The Fund would not have the right to vote the securities during the existence of the loan but would call the loan to permit voting of the securities, if, in the Investment Adviser’s judgment, a material event requiring a shareholder vote would otherwise occur before the loans were repaid. In the event of bankruptcy or other default of the borrower, the Fund could experience both delays in liquidating the loan collateral or recovering the loaned securities and losses, including (a) possible decline in the value of the collateral or in the value of the securities loaned during the period while the Fund seeks to enforce its rights to the collateral or loaned securities, (b) possible subnormal levels of income and lack of access to income during this period, and (c) expenses of enforcing its rights.

Temporary Defensive Investments

When market conditions dictate a more defensive investment strategy, the Fund may, on a temporary basis, hold cash or invest a portion or all of its assets in money-market instruments, including obligations of the U.S. government, its agencies or instrumentalities, other high-quality debt securities, including prime commercial paper, repurchase agreements and bank obligations, such as bankers’ acceptances and certificates of deposit. Under normal market conditions, the potential for capital appreciation on these securities will tend to be lower than the potential for capital appreciation on other securities that may be owned by the Fund. In taking such a defensive position, the Fund would temporarily not be pursuing its principal investment strategies and may not achieve its investment objective.

Portfolio Turnover

Portfolio turnover rate is not considered a limiting factor in the Investment Adviser’s execution of investment decisions. The Fund anticipates that its annual portfolio turnover rate may vary greatly from year to year. For the fiscal years ended November 30, 2017 and November 30, 2016, the Fund’s portfolio turnover rate was approximately 96% and 227%, respectively. A higher portfolio turnover rate results in correspondingly greater brokerage commissions and other transactional expenses that are borne by the Fund.

Investment Restrictions

The Fund has adopted certain other investment limitations designed to limit investment risk. These limitations are, unless otherwise indicated, fundamental and may not be changed without the approval of the holders of a majority of the outstanding voting securities of the Fund, as defined in the 1940 Act. See “Investment Restrictions” in the SAI for a complete list of the fundamental investment policies of the Fund. The Fund’s investment objective and percentage parameters are not fundamental policies of the Fund and may be changed without shareholder approval.

USE OF L EVERAGE

The Fund generally seeks to increase total return by utilizing leverage. The Fund may utilize leverage through the Indebtedness, including through the issuance of commercial paper or notes and other forms of borrowing, or the

 

33


issuance of preferred shares. The Fund may utilize leverage through Indebtedness or preferred shares to the maximum extent permitted by the 1940 Act. Under current market conditions, the Fund currently intends to utilize leverage principally through Indebtedness. The amount of Indebtedness outstanding is expected to vary over time, but will not exceed 331/3% of the Fund’s Managed Assets (i.e., 50% of its net assets attributable to the Fund’s Common Shares), including the proceeds of such leverage.

The costs associated with the issuance and use of leverage will be borne by the holders of the Common Shares. Leverage is a speculative technique and investors should note that there are special risks and costs associated with leverage. There can be no assurance that a leveraging strategy will be successful during any period in which it is employed. The use of leverage creates risks and involves special considerations. See “Risks—Leverage Risk.” To the extent that the Fund uses leverage, it expects to utilize hedging techniques such as swaps and caps on a portion of its leverage to mitigate potential interest rate risk. See “Risks—Interest Rate Hedging Risk.”

Indebtedness

Delaware trust law and the Fund’s governing documents authorize the Fund, without prior approval of its Common Shareholders, to borrow money. In this regard, the Fund may issue notes or other evidence of Indebtedness (including bank borrowings or commercial paper) and may secure any such borrowings by mortgaging, pledging or otherwise subjecting as security its assets. In connection with any borrowing, the Fund may be required to maintain minimum average balances with the lender or to pay a commitment or other fee to maintain a line of credit. Any such requirements will increase the cost of borrowing over the stated interest rate. The rights of the Fund’s lenders to receive interest on and repayment of principal of borrowings will be senior to those of the Fund’s Common Shareholders, and the terms of any such borrowings may contain provisions which limit certain of the Fund’s activities, including the payment of distributions to the Fund’s Common Shareholders in certain circumstances. A borrowing will likely be ranked senior or equal to all of the Fund’s other existing and future borrowings.

Certain types of borrowings may result in the Fund being subject to covenants in credit agreements relating to asset coverage and portfolio composition requirements. The Fund may be subject to certain restrictions on investments imposed by guidelines of one or more rating agencies, which may issue ratings for Indebtedness issued by the Fund. These guidelines may impose asset coverage or portfolio composition requirements that are more stringent than those imposed by the 1940 Act. It is not anticipated that these covenants or guidelines will impede the Investment Adviser from managing the Fund’s portfolio in accordance with the Fund’s investment objective and policies.

The Fund may secure any borrowings by mortgaging, pledging or otherwise subjecting as security its assets. Except as set forth below, under the requirements of the 1940 Act the Fund, immediately after any issuance of Indebtedness, must have “asset coverage” of at least 300% (33 1 / 3 % of its Managed Assets, or 50% of its net assets attributable to the Fund’s Common Shares). With respect to Indebtedness, asset coverage means the ratio which the value of the Fund’s total assets, less all liabilities and indebtedness not represented by senior securities (as defined in the 1940 Act), bears to the aggregate amount of such borrowing represented by senior securities issued by the Fund.

Under the 1940 Act, the Fund may not declare any distribution or other distribution on any class of its shares, or purchase any such shares, unless its aggregate Indebtedness has, at the time of the declaration of any such distribution or distribution, or at the time of any such purchase, an asset coverage of at least 300% after declaring the amount of such distribution, distribution or purchase price, as the case may be. Furthermore, the 1940 Act (in certain circumstances) grants the Fund’s lenders certain voting rights in the event of default in the payment of interest on or repayment of principal. Such restrictions do not apply with respect to evidence of Indebtedness in consideration of a loan, extension or renewal thereof that is privately arranged and not intended for public distribution.

With the use of borrowings, there is a risk that the interest rates paid by the Fund on the amount it borrows will be higher than the return on the Fund’s investments.

The Fund may also borrow money as a temporary measure for extraordinary or emergency purposes, including the payment of distributions and the settlement of securities transactions that otherwise might require untimely dispositions of its securities. Temporary borrowings not exceeding 5% of the Fund’s total assets are not subject to the “asset coverage” limitation under the 1940 Act.

 

34


The Fund currently utilizes Indebtedness pursuant to a borrowing arrangement with Scotiabank TM (the “Loan Agreements”), which permits the Fund to borrow up to $50 million. The interest rate charged on such Indebtedness is 1-month LIBOR plus 1.00%. The Fund’s Indebtedness under the Loan Agreements is collateralized by portfolio assets which are maintained by the Fund in a separate account with the Fund’s custodian for the benefit of the lender, which collateral exceeds the amount borrowed. In the event of a default by the Fund under the Loan Agreements, the lender has the right to sell such collateral assets to satisfy the Fund’s obligation to the lender. The Loan Agreements include usual and customary covenants. These covenants impose on the Fund asset coverage requirements, collateral requirements, investment strategy requirements, and certain financial obligations. As of November 30, 2017, the principal balance outstanding was approximately $23 million, which represented 16% of the Fund’s Managed Assets (or approximately 20% of its net assets attributable to the Fund’s Common Shares).

Preferred Shares

The Fund’s Declaration of Trust provides that the Fund’s Board of Trustees may authorize and issue preferred shares with rights as determined by the Board of Trustees, by action of the Board of Trustees without prior approval of the holders of the Common Shares. Common Shareholders have no preemptive right to purchase any preferred shares that might be issued. Any such preferred share offering would be subject to the limits imposed by the 1940 Act. Under the 1940 Act, the Fund is not permitted to issue preferred shares unless immediately after such issuance the value of its total assets is at least 200% of the liquidation value of the outstanding preferred shares ( i.e. , the liquidation value may not exceed 50% of the Fund’s total assets). In addition, the Fund is not permitted to declare any cash distribution or other distribution on its Common Shares unless, at the time of such declaration, the value of its total assets is at least 200% of such liquidation value. If the Fund issues preferred shares, it intends, to the extent possible, to purchase or redeem them from time to time to the extent necessary in order to maintain asset coverage on such preferred shares of at least 200%. In addition, as a condition to obtaining ratings on the preferred shares, the terms of any preferred shares issued are expected to include asset coverage maintenance provisions which will require the redemption of the preferred shares in the event of non-compliance by the Fund and may also prohibit distributions and other distributions on the Fund’s Common Shares in such circumstances. In order to meet redemption requirements to maintain asset coverage or otherwise, the Fund may have to liquidate portfolio securities. Such liquidations and redemptions would cause the Fund to incur related transaction costs and could result in capital losses to the Fund. If the Fund has preferred shares outstanding, two of its Trustees will be elected by the holders of preferred shares, voting as a separate class. The Fund’s remaining Trustees will be elected by holders of its Common Shares and preferred shares voting together as a single class. In the event the Fund fails to pay distributions on its preferred shares for two years, holders of preferred shares would be entitled to elect a majority of the Fund’s Trustees.

Effects of Leverage

As of November 30, 2017, the Fund had outstanding Indebtedness of approximately $23 million, which represented 16% of the Fund’s Managed Assets (or approximately 20% of its net assets attributable to the Fund’s Common Shares). The interest rate charged on such Indebtedness as of November 30, 2017 was 2.37%. Assuming that the Fund’s leverage costs remain as described above, then the incremental income generated by the Fund’s portfolio (net of estimated expenses including expenses related to the leverage) must exceed approximately 0.47% to cover such interest specifically related to the borrowing. These numbers are merely estimates used for illustration. Actual interest rates may vary frequently and in the future may be significantly higher or lower than the rate estimated above.

The following table is designed to assist the investor in understanding the effects of leverage by illustrating the effect on the return to a holder of the Fund’s Common Shares of leverage in the amount of approximately 33 1 / 3 % of the Fund’s Managed Assets ( i.e. , 50% of its net assets attributable to the Fund’s Common Shares), assuming hypothetical annual returns of the Fund’s portfolio of minus 10% to plus 10%. As the table shows, leverage generally increases the return to holders of Common Shares when portfolio return is positive and greater than the cost of leverage and decreases the return when the portfolio return is negative or less than the cost of leverage. The figures appearing in the table are hypothetical and actual returns may be greater or less than those appearing in the table.

 

Assumed portfolio total return (net of expenses)

     (10.00)%        (5.00)%        0.00%        5.00%        10.00%  

Common Share total return

     (16.19)%        (8.69)%        (1.19)%        6.31%        13.81%  

 

35


Common Share total return is composed of two elements: distributions on Common Shares paid by the Fund (the amount of which is largely determined by the Fund’s net investment income after paying distributions or interest on its outstanding leverage) and gains or losses on the value of the securities the Fund owns. As required by SEC rules, the table above assumes that the Fund is more likely to suffer capital losses than to enjoy capital appreciation. For example, to assume a total return of 0%, the Fund must assume that the distributions it receives on its investments are entirely offset by losses in the value of those securities.

During the time in which the Fund is utilizing leverage, the amount of the fees paid to the Investment Adviser for investment advisory services will be higher than if the Fund did not utilize such leverage because the fees paid will be calculated based on the Fund’s Managed Assets, which may create a conflict of interest between the Investment Adviser and the Common Shareholders. Because the Fund’s leverage costs will be borne by the Fund at a specified rate, only the Fund’s Common Shareholders will bear the cost associated with such leverage.

R ISKS

Investment and Market Risk

An investment in the Fund’s Common Shares is subject to investment risk, including the possible loss of an investor’s entire investment. The Fund’s Common Shares at any point in time may be worth less than at the time of original investment, even after taking into account the reinvestment of the Fund’s distributions. The Fund is primarily a long-term investment vehicle and should not be used for short-term trading. An investment in the Fund’s Common Shares is not intended to constitute a complete investment program and should not be viewed as such.

Common Stock Risk

The Fund will have exposure to common stocks. Although common stocks have historically generated higher average total returns than fixed-income securities over the long-term, common stocks also have experienced significantly more volatility in those returns and may significantly under-perform relative to fixed income securities during certain periods. An adverse event, such as an unfavorable earnings report, may depress the value of a particular common stock held by the Fund. Also, the price of common stocks is sensitive to general movements in the stock market and a drop in the stock market may depress the price of common stocks to which the Fund has exposure. Common stock prices fluctuate for several reasons, including changes in investors’ perceptions of the financial condition of an issuer or the general condition of the relevant stock market, or when political or economic events affecting the issuers occur. In addition, common stock prices may be particularly sensitive to rising interest rates, as the cost of capital rises and borrowing costs increase.

Concentration Risk

The Fund’s investments will be concentrated in issuers in the energy sector. Because the Fund will be concentrated in the energy sector, it may be subject to more risks than if it were more broadly diversified over numerous industries and sectors of the economy. General changes in market sentiment towards Energy Companies may adversely affect the Fund, and the performance of Energy Companies may lag behind the broader market as a whole. Also, the Fund’s concentration in the energy sector may subject the Fund to a variety risks associated with that sector.

In addition, issuers outside the energy sector in which the Fund intends to invest will typically consist of industrial and manufacturing companies that the Investment Adviser expects to benefit from lower energy and feedstock costs. As a result, these companies may also be more sensitive to certain risks associated with the energy sector. See “—Energy Sector Risks.”

 

36


Energy Sector Risks

Under normal circumstances, the Fund concentrates its investments in the energy sector. Energy Companies are subject to certain risks, including, but not limited to, the following:

Commodity Price Risk. Energy Companies may be affected by fluctuations in the prices of commodities, including, for example, natural gas, natural gas liquids and crude oil, in the short- and long-term. Natural resources commodity prices have been very volatile in the past and such volatility is expected to continue. Fluctuations in commodity prices can result from changes in general economic conditions or political circumstances (especially of key energy-consuming countries); market conditions; weather patterns; domestic production levels; volume of imports; energy conservation; domestic and foreign governmental regulation; international politics; policies of the Organization of Petroleum Exporting Countries (“OPEC”); taxation; tariffs; and the availability and costs of local, intrastate and interstate transportation methods. Companies engaged in crude oil and natural gas exploration, development or production, natural gas gathering and processing and crude oil refining and transportation may be directly affected by their respective natural resources commodity prices. The volatility of, and interrelationships between, commodity prices can also indirectly affect certain companies due to the potential impact on the volume of commodities transported, processed, stored or distributed. Some companies that own the underlying commodities may be unable to effectively mitigate or manage direct margin exposure to commodity price levels. The energy sector as a whole may also be impacted by the perception that the performance of energy sector companies is directly linked to commodity prices. The prices of companies’ securities can be adversely affected by market perceptions that their performance and distributions or distributions are directly tied to commodity prices. High commodity prices may drive further energy conservation efforts and a slowing economy may adversely impact energy consumption which may adversely affect the performance of Energy Companies.

Prices of oil and other energy commodities have experienced significant volatility during recent years. Companies engaged in crude oil and natural gas exploration, development or production, natural gas gathering and processing, crude oil refining and transportation and coal mining or sales may be directly affected by their respective natural resources commodity prices. The volatility of commodity prices may also indirectly affect certain companies engaged in the transportation, processing, storage or distribution of such commodities. Some companies that own the underlying commodities may be unable to effectively mitigate or manage direct margin exposure to commodity price levels. The energy sector as a whole may also be impacted by the perception that the performance of energy sector companies is directly linked to commodity prices. As a result, many companies in which the Fund may invest have been and may continue to be adversely impacted by volatility of prices of energy commodities. Demand for energy commodities has recently declined. Reductions in production of oil and other energy commodities may lag decreases in demand or declines in commodity prices, resulting in global oversupply in such commodities. Slower global growth may lower demand for oil and other energy commodities and increased exports by Iran with the end of sanctions may increase supply, exacerbating oversupply of such commodities and further reducing commodity prices. Continued volatility of commodity prices could further erode such companies’ growth prospects and negatively impact such companies’ ability to sustain attractive distribution levels.

Cyclicality Risk. The operating results of companies in the broader energy sector are cyclical, with fluctuations in commodity prices and demand for commodities driven by a variety of factors. The highly cyclical nature of the energy sector may adversely affect the earnings or operating cash flows of certain Energy Companies in which the Fund will invest.

Supply Risk. A significant decrease in the production of natural gas, crude oil, or other energy commodities would reduce the revenue, operating income and operating cash flows of certain Energy Companies and, therefore, their ability to make distributions or pay distributions. The volume of production of energy commodities and the volume of energy commodities available for transportation, storage, processing or distribution could be affected by a variety of factors, including depletion of resources; depressed commodity prices; catastrophic events; labor relations; increased environmental or other governmental regulation; equipment malfunctions and maintenance difficulties; import volumes; international politics; policies of OPEC; and increased competition from alternative energy sources.

Demand Risk. A sustained decline in demand for natural gas, natural gas liquids, crude oil and refined petroleum products could adversely affect an Energy Company’s revenues and cash flows. Factors that could lead to a sustained decrease in market demand include a recession or other adverse economic conditions, an increase in the market price of the underlying commodity that is not, or is not expected to be, merely a short-term increase, higher taxes or other regulatory actions that increase costs, or a shift in consumer demand for such products. Demand may also be adversely affected by consumer sentiment with respect to global warming and by state or federal legislation intended to promote the use of alternative energy sources.

 

37


Competition Risk. The energy sector is highly competitive. The Energy Companies in which the Fund will invest will face substantial competition from other companies, many of which will have greater financial, technological, human and other resources, in acquiring natural resources assets, obtaining and retaining customers and contracts and hiring and retaining qualified personnel. Larger companies may be able to pay more for assets and may have a greater ability to continue their operations during periods of low commodity prices. To the extent that the Energy Companies in which the Fund will invest are unable to compete effectively, their operating results, financial position, growth potential and cash flows may be adversely affected, which could in turn adversely affect the results of the Fund.

Weather Risk. Extreme weather conditions could result in substantial damage to the facilities of certain Energy Companies located in the affected areas and significant volatility in the supply of natural resources, commodity prices and the earnings of Energy Companies, and could therefore adversely affect their securities.

Interest Rate Risk. The prices of debt securities of the Energy Companies the Fund expects to hold in its portfolio are, and the prices of the equity securities held in its portfolio may be, susceptible in the short-term to a decline when interest rates rise. Rising interest rates could limit the capital appreciation of securities of certain Energy Companies as a result of the increased availability of alternative investments with yields comparable to those of Energy Companies. Rising interest rates could adversely impact the financial performance of Energy Companies by increasing their cost of capital. This may reduce their ability to execute acquisitions or expansion projects in a cost effective manner.

Regulatory Risk. The profitability of Energy Companies could be adversely affected by changes in the regulatory environment. Energy Companies are subject to significant foreign, federal, state and local regulation in virtually every aspect of their operations, including with respect to how facilities are constructed, maintained and operated, environmental and safety controls, and the prices they may charge for the products and services they provide. Such regulation can change over time in both scope and intensity. For example, a particular by-product may be declared hazardous by a regulatory agency and unexpectedly increase production costs. Various governmental authorities have the power to enforce compliance with these regulations and the permits issued under them, and violators are subject to administrative, civil and criminal penalties, including civil fines, injunctions or both. Stricter laws, regulations or enforcement policies could be enacted in the future which would likely increase compliance costs and may adversely affect the financial performance of Energy Companies. Energy Companies may be adversely affected by future regulatory requirements. While the nature of such regulations cannot be predicted at this time, they may impose additional costs or limit certain operations by Energy Companies operating in various sectors.

Environmental Risk . There is an inherent risk that Energy Companies may incur environmental costs and liabilities due to the nature of their businesses and the substances they handle. For example, an accidental release from wells or gathering pipelines could subject them to substantial liabilities for environmental cleanup and restoration costs, claims made by neighboring landowners and other third parties for personal injury and property damage, and fines or penalties for related violations of environmental laws or regulations. Moreover, the possibility exists that stricter laws, regulations or enforcement policies could significantly increase the compliance costs of Energy Companies, and the cost of any remediation that may become necessary. Energy Companies may not be able to recover these costs from insurance.

Specifically, the operations of wells, gathering systems, pipelines, refineries and other facilities are subject to stringent and complex federal, state and local environmental laws and regulations. These include, for example:

 

    the federal Clean Air Act and comparable state laws and regulations that impose obligations related to air emissions;

 

    the federal Clean Water Act and comparable state laws and regulations that impose obligations related to discharges of pollutants into regulated bodies of water;

 

    the federal Resource Conservation and Recovery Act (“RCRA”) and comparable state laws and regulations that impose requirements for the handling and disposal of waste from facilities; and

 

    the federal Comprehensive Environmental Response, Compensation and Liability Act of 1980 (“CERCLA”), also known as “Superfund,” and comparable state laws and regulations that regulate the cleanup of hazardous substances that may have been released at properties currently or previously owned or operated by Energy Companies or at locations to which they have sent waste for disposal.

 

38


Failure to comply with these laws and regulations may trigger a variety of administrative, civil and criminal enforcement measures, including the assessment of monetary penalties, the imposition of remedial requirements, and the issuance of orders enjoining future operations. Certain environmental statutes, including RCRA, CERCLA, the federal Oil Pollution Act and analogous state laws and regulations, impose strict, joint and several liability for costs required to clean up and restore sites where hazardous substances have been disposed or otherwise released. Moreover, it is not uncommon for neighboring landowners and other third parties to file claims for personal injury and property damage allegedly caused by the release of hazardous substances or other waste products into the environment.

Voluntary initiatives and mandatory controls have been adopted or are being discussed both in the United States and worldwide to reduce emissions of “greenhouse gases” such as carbon dioxide, a by-product of burning fossil fuels, and methane, the major constituent of natural gas. These measures and future measures could result in increased costs to certain companies in which the Fund may invest to operate and maintain facilities and administer and manage a greenhouse gas emissions program and may reduce demand for fuels that generate greenhouse gases and that are managed or produced by companies in which the Fund may invest.

In the wake of a Supreme Court decision holding that the Environmental Protection Agency (“EPA”) has some legal authority to deal with climate change under the federal Clean Air Act of 1990, as amended (the “Clean Air Act”), the EPA and the Department of Transportation jointly wrote regulations to cut gasoline use and control greenhouse gas emissions from cars and trucks. These measures, and other programs addressing greenhouse gas emissions, could reduce demand for energy or raise prices, which may adversely affect the total return of certain of the Fund’s investments.

The types of regulations described above can change over time in both scope and intensity, may have adverse effects on Energy Companies and may be implemented in unforeseen manners on an “emergency” basis in response to catastrophes or other events.

Catastrophe Risk. The operations of Energy Companies are subject to many hazards inherent in the exploration for, and development, production, gathering, transportation, processing, storage, refining, distribution, mining or marketing of natural gas, natural gas liquids, crude oil, refined petroleum products or other hydrocarbons, including: damage to production equipment, pipelines, storage tanks or related equipment and surrounding properties caused by hurricanes, tornadoes, floods, fires and other natural disasters or by acts of terrorism; inadvertent damage from construction or other equipment; leaks of natural gas, natural gas liquids, crude oil, refined petroleum products or other hydrocarbons; and fires and explosions. Since the September 11th terrorist attacks, the U.S. government has issued warnings that energy assets, specifically U.S. pipeline infrastructure, may be targeted in future terrorist attacks. These dangers give rise to risks of substantial losses as a result of loss or destruction of commodity reserves; damage to or destruction of property, facilities and equipment; pollution and environmental damage; and personal injury or loss of life. Any occurrence of such catastrophic events could bring about a limitation, suspension or discontinuation of the operations of Energy Companies. Energy Companies may not be fully insured against all risks inherent in their business operations and therefore accidents and catastrophic events could adversely affect such companies’ operations, financial conditions and ability to pay distributions to shareholders.

Risks Relating to Expansions and Acquisitions. Energy Companies employ a variety of means to increase cash flow, including increasing utilization of existing facilities, expanding operations through new construction or development activities, expanding operations through acquisitions, or securing additional long-term contracts. Thus, some Energy Companies may be subject to construction risk, development risk, acquisition risk or other risks arising from their specific business strategies. Energy Companies that attempt to grow through acquisitions may not be able to effectively integrate acquired operations with their existing operations. In addition, acquisition or expansion projects may not perform as anticipated. A significant slowdown in merger and acquisition activity in the energy sector could reduce the growth rate of cash flows received by the Fund from Energy Companies that grow through acquisitions.

Technology Risk . Some Energy Companies are focused on developing new technologies and are strongly influenced by technological changes. Technology development efforts by Energy Companies may not result in viable methods or products. Energy Companies may bear high research and development costs, which can limit their ability to

 

39


maintain operations during periods of organizational growth or instability. Some Energy Companies may be in the early stages of operations and may have limited operating histories and smaller market capitalizations on average than companies in other sectors. As a result of these and other factors, the value of investments in such Energy Companies may be considerably more volatile than that in more established segments of the economy.

Sub-Sector Specific Risk. Energy Companies are also subject to risks that are specific to the particular sub-sector of the energy sector in which they operate.

 

    Gathering and processing . Gathering and processing companies are subject to natural declines in the production of oil and natural gas fields, which utilize their gathering and processing facilities as a way to market their production, prolonged declines in the price of natural gas or crude oil, which curtails drilling activity and therefore production, and declines in the prices of natural gas liquids and refined petroleum products, which cause lower processing margins. In addition, some gathering and processing contracts subject the gathering or processing company to direct commodities price risk.

 

    Exploration and production . Exploration, development and production companies are particularly vulnerable to declines in the demand for and prices of crude oil and natural gas. Reductions in prices for crude oil and natural gas can cause a given reservoir to become uneconomic for continued production earlier than it would if prices were higher, resulting in the plugging and abandonment of, and cessation of production from, that reservoir. In addition, lower commodity prices not only reduce revenues but also can result in substantial downward adjustments in reserve estimates. The accuracy of any reserve estimate is a function of the quality of available data, the accuracy of assumptions regarding future commodity prices and future exploration and development costs and engineering and geological interpretations and judgments. Different reserve engineers may make different estimates of reserve quantities and related revenue based on the same data. Actual oil and gas prices, development expenditures and operating expenses will vary from those assumed in reserve estimates, and these variances may be significant. Any significant variance from the assumptions used could result in the actual quantity of reserves and future net cash flow being materially different from those estimated in reserve reports. In addition, results of drilling, testing and production and changes in prices after the date of reserve estimates may result in downward revisions to such estimates. Substantial downward adjustments in reserve estimates could have a material adverse effect on a given exploration and production company’s financial position and results of operations. In addition, due to natural declines in reserves and production, exploration and production companies must economically find or acquire and develop additional reserves in order to maintain and grow their revenues and distributions.

 

    Oil . In addition to the risk described above applicable to gathering and processing companies and exploration and production companies, companies involved in the transportation, gathering, processing, exploration, development or production of crude oil or refined petroleum products may be adversely affected by increased regulations, increased operating costs and reductions in the supply of and/or demand for crude oil and refined petroleum products as a result of the 2010 Deepwater Horizon oil spill and the reaction thereto. Increased regulation may result in a decline in production and/or increased cost associated with offshore oil exploration in the United States and around the world, which may adversely affect certain Energy Companies and the oil industry in general. Continued financial deterioration of BP plc as a result of the 2010 Deepwater Horizon oil spill may have wide-ranging and unforeseen impacts on the oil industry and the broader energy sector.

Small-Cap and Mid-Cap Company Risk

Certain of the companies in which the Fund may invest may have small or medium-sized market capitalizations (“small-cap” and “mid-cap” companies, respectively). Investing in the securities of small-cap or mid-cap companies presents some particular investment risks. These companies may have limited product lines and markets, as well as shorter operating histories, less experienced management and more limited financial resources than larger companies, and may be more vulnerable to adverse general market or economic developments. Stocks of these companies may be less liquid than those of larger companies, and may experience greater price fluctuations than larger companies. In addition, small-cap or mid-cap company securities may not be widely followed by investors, which may result in reduced demand.

 

40


Risks Associated with an Investment in IPOs

The Fund may invest in initial public offerings (“IPOs”). Securities purchased in IPOs are often subject to the general risks associated with investments in companies with small market capitalizations, and typically to a heightened degree. Securities issued in IPOs have no trading history, and information about the companies may be available for very limited periods. In addition, the prices of securities sold in an IPO may be highly volatile. At any particular time or from time to time, the Fund may not be able to invest in IPOs, or to invest to the extent desired, because, for example, only a small portion (if any) of the securities being offered in an IPO may be available to the Fund. In addition, under certain market conditions, a relatively small number of companies may issue securities in IPOs. The investment performance of the Fund during periods when it is unable to invest significantly or at all in IPOs may be lower than during periods when it is able to do so. IPO securities may be volatile, and the Fund cannot predict whether investments in IPOs will be successful.

Risks Associated with an Investment in PIPE Transactions

The Fund may invest in private investment in public equity (“PIPE”) transactions. PIPE investors purchase securities directly from a publicly traded company in a private placement transaction, typically at a discount to the market price of the company’s common stock. Because the sale of the securities is not registered under the Securities Act, the securities are “restricted” and cannot be immediately resold by the investors into the public markets. Accordingly, the company typically agrees as part of the PIPE deal to register the restricted securities with the SEC. PIPE securities may be deemed illiquid.

Privately Held Company Risk

Investing in privately held companies involves risk. For example, privately held companies are not subject to SEC reporting requirements, are not required to maintain their accounting records in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and are not required to maintain effective internal controls over financial reporting. As a result, the Investment Adviser may not have timely or accurate information about the business, financial condition and results of operations of the privately held companies in which the Fund invests. In addition, the securities of privately held companies are generally illiquid, and entail the risks described under “— Liquidity Risk” below.

MLP Risks

An investment in MLP units involves some risks that differ from an investment in the common stock of a corporation. As compared to common stockholders of a corporation, holders of MLP units have more limited control and limited rights to vote on matters affecting the partnership. In addition, there are certain tax risks associated with an investment in MLP units and conflicts of interest may exist between common unit holders and the general partner, including those arising from incentive distribution payments.

A portion of the benefit the Fund derives from its investment in equity securities of MLPs is a result of MLPs generally being treated as partnerships for U.S. federal income tax purposes. Partnerships do not pay U.S. federal income tax at the partnership level. Rather, each partner of a partnership, in computing its U.S. federal income tax liability, will include its allocable share of the partnership’s income, gains, losses, deductions and expenses. A change in current tax law, or a change in the business of a given MLP, could result in an MLP being treated as a corporation for U.S. federal income tax purposes, which would result in such MLP being required to pay U.S. federal income tax on its taxable income. The classification of an MLP as a corporation for U.S. federal income tax purposes would have the effect of reducing the amount of cash available for distribution by the MLP and causing any such distributions received by the Fund to be taxed as distribution income to the extent of the MLP’s current or accumulated earnings and profits. Thus, if any of the MLPs owned by the Fund were treated as corporations for U.S. federal income tax purposes, the after-tax return to the Fund with respect to its investment in such MLPs would be materially reduced, which could cause a decline in the value of the Common Shares. Recently, a number of MLPs have reduced, suspended or eliminated their distributions.

To the extent that the Fund invests in the equity securities of an MLP treated as a partnership under the Code, the Fund will be a partner in such MLP. Accordingly, the Fund will be required to include in its taxable income the Fund’s allocable share of the income, gains, losses, deductions and credits recognized by each such MLP, regardless of whether the MLP distributes cash to the Fund. Historically, MLPs have been able to offset a significant portion of

 

41


their income with tax deductions. The Fund will incur a current tax liability on its allocable share of an MLP’s income and gains that is not offset by the MLP’s tax deductions, losses and credits. The portion, if any, of a distribution received by the Fund from an MLP that is offset by the MLP’s tax deductions, losses or credits is essentially treated as a return of capital. However, those distributions will reduce the Fund’s adjusted tax basis in the equity securities of the MLP, which will result in an increase in the amount of gain (or decrease in the amount of loss) that will be recognized by the Fund for tax purposes upon the sale of any such equity securities, and may increase the amount of income or gain that will be recognized by the Fund upon subsequent distributions in respect of such equity securities. The percentage of an MLP’s income and gains that is offset by tax deductions, losses and credits will fluctuate over time for various reasons. A significant slowdown in acquisition activity or capital spending by MLPs held in the Fund’s portfolio could result in a reduction of accelerated depreciation generated by new acquisitions, which may result in a decrease in the portion of the MLP’s distributions that is offset by tax deductions.

Because of the Fund’s investments in equity securities of MLPs, the Fund’s earnings and profits may be calculated using accounting methods that are different from those used for calculating taxable income. Because of these differences, the Fund may make distributions out of its current or accumulated earnings and profits, which will be treated as distributions, in years in which the Fund’s distributions exceed its taxable income. See “U.S. Federal Income Tax Considerations.”

In addition, changes in tax laws or regulations, or future interpretations of such laws or regulations, could adversely affect the Fund or the MLP investments in which the Fund invests.

Adverse developments in the energy sector may result in MLPs seeking to restructure debt or file for bankruptcy. Limited partners in such MLPs, such as the Fund, may owe taxes on debt that is forgiven in a bankruptcy or an out-of-court restructuring, as cancellation of debt income, which creates a tax liability for investors without an associated cash distribution. While an MLP facing a debt restructuring may seek to implement structures that would limit the tax liability associated with the debt restructuring, there can be no assurance that such structures could be successfully implemented or would not have other adverse impacts on the Fund as an investor in the MLP.

Liquidity Risk

The investments made by the Fund may be illiquid and consequently the Fund may not be able to sell such investments at prices that reflect the Investment Adviser’s assessment of their value, the amount paid for such investments by the Fund or at prices approximating the value at which the Fund is carrying the securities on its books. Furthermore, the nature of the Fund’s investments may require a long holding period prior to profitability.

Although the equity securities of the companies in which the Fund invests generally trade on major stock exchanges, certain securities may trade less frequently, particularly those with smaller capitalizations. Securities with limited trading volumes may display volatile or erratic price movements. Investment of the Fund’s capital in securities that are less actively traded or over time experience decreased trading volume may restrict the Fund’s ability to take advantage of other market opportunities.

The Fund also expects to invest in unregistered or otherwise restricted securities. Unregistered securities are securities that cannot be sold publicly in the United States without registration under the Securities Act, unless an exemption from such registration is available. Restricted securities may be more difficult to value and the Fund may have difficulty disposing of such assets either in a timely manner or for a reasonable price. In order to dispose of an unregistered security, the Fund, where it has contractual rights to do so, may have to cause such security to be registered. A considerable period may elapse between the time the decision is made to sell the security and the time the security is registered so that the Fund could sell it. Contractual restrictions on the resale of securities vary in length and scope and are generally the result of a negotiation between the issuer and acquiror of the securities. The Fund would, in either case, bear the risks of any downward price fluctuation during that period. The difficulties and delays associated with selling restricted securities could result in the Fund’s inability to realize a favorable price upon disposition of such securities, and at times might make disposition of such securities impossible.

 

42


Non-U.S. Securities Risk

Investing in non-U.S. securities involves certain risks not involved in domestic investments, including, but not limited to: fluctuations in foreign exchange rates; future foreign economic, financial, political and social developments; different legal systems; the possible imposition of exchange controls or other foreign governmental laws or restrictions, including expropriation; lower trading volume; much greater price volatility and illiquidity of certain non-U.S. securities markets; different trading and settlement practices; less governmental supervision; changes in currency exchange rates; high and volatile rates of inflation; fluctuating interest rates; less publicly available information; and different accounting, auditing and financial recordkeeping standards and requirements.

Certain countries in which the Fund may invest, especially emerging market countries, historically have experienced, and may continue to experience, high rates of inflation, high interest rates, exchange rate fluctuations, large amounts of external debt, balance of payments and trade difficulties and extreme poverty and unemployment. Many of these countries are also characterized by political uncertainty and instability. The cost of servicing external debt will generally be adversely affected by rising international interest rates because many external debt obligations bear interest at rates that are adjusted based upon international interest rates. In addition, with respect to certain foreign countries, there is a risk of: the possibility of expropriation or nationalization of assets; confiscatory taxation; difficulty in obtaining or enforcing a court judgment; restrictions on currency repatriation; economic, political or social instability; and diplomatic developments that could affect investments in those countries.

Because the Fund may invest in securities denominated or quoted in currencies other than the U.S. dollar, changes in foreign currency exchange rates may affect the value of securities in the Fund and the unrealized appreciation or depreciation of investments. Currencies of certain countries may be volatile and therefore may affect the value of securities denominated in such currencies, which means that the Fund’s net asset value or current income could decline as a result of changes in the exchange rates between foreign currencies and the U.S. dollar. Certain investments in non-U.S. securities also may be subject to foreign withholding taxes. Distribution income from non-U.S. corporations may not be eligible for the reduced U.S. income tax rate currently available for qualified distribution income. These risks often are heightened for investments in smaller, emerging capital markets. In addition, individual foreign economies may differ favorably or unfavorably from the U.S. economy in such respects as: growth of gross domestic product; rates of inflation; capital reinvestment; resources; self-sufficiency; and balance of payments position.

Investing in securities of issuers based in underdeveloped emerging markets entails all of the risks of investing in securities of non-U.S. issuers to a heightened degree. “Emerging market countries” generally include every nation in the world except developed countries, that is the United States, Canada, Japan, Australia, New Zealand and most countries located in Western Europe. These heightened risks include: greater risks of expropriation, confiscatory taxation, nationalization, and less social, political and economic stability; the smaller size of the market for such securities and a lower volume of trading, resulting in lack of liquidity and an increase in price volatility; and certain national policies that may restrict the Fund’s investment opportunities including restrictions on investing in issuers or industries deemed sensitive to relevant national interests. As a result of these potential risks, the Investment Adviser may determine that, notwithstanding otherwise favorable investment criteria, it may not be practicable or appropriate to invest in a particular country.

Debt securities risk

Debt securities are subject to many of the risks described elsewhere in this section. In addition, they are subject to credit risk, prepayment risk and, depending on their quality, other special risks.

Credit Risk. An issuer of a debt security may be unable to make interest payments and repay principal. The Fund could lose money if the issuer of a debt obligation is, or is perceived to be, unable or unwilling to make timely principal and/or interest payments, or to otherwise honor its obligations. The downgrade of a security may further decrease its value.

Below Investment Grade and Unrated Debt Securities Risk. Below investment grade and unrated debt securities generally pay a premium above the yields of U.S. government securities or debt securities of investment grade issuers because they are subject to greater risks than those securities. These risks, which reflect their speculative character, include the following: greater yield and price volatility; greater credit risk and risk of default; potentially

 

43


greater sensitivity to general economic or industry conditions; potential lack of attractive resale opportunities (illiquidity); and additional expenses to seek recovery from issuers who default. Debt securities rated below investment grade are commonly known as “junk bonds” and are regarded as predominantly speculative with respect to the issuer’s capacity to pay interest and repay principal in accordance with the terms of the obligations, and involve major risk exposure to adverse conditions.

The prices of these below investment grade and unrated debt securities are more sensitive to negative developments, such as a decline in the issuer’s revenues, downturns in profitability in the natural resources industry or a general economic downturn, than are the prices of higher-grade securities. Below investment grade and unrated debt securities tend to be less liquid than investment grade securities and the market for below investment grade and unrated debt securities could contract further under adverse market or economic conditions. In such a scenario, it may be more difficult for the Fund to sell these securities in a timely manner or for as high a price as could be realized if such securities were more widely traded. The market value of below investment grade and unrated debt securities may be more volatile than the market value of investment grade securities and generally tends to reflect the market’s perception of the creditworthiness of the issuer and short-term market developments to a greater extent than investment grade securities, which primarily reflect fluctuations in general levels of interest rates. In the event of a default by a below investment grade or unrated debt security held in the Fund’s portfolio in the payment of principal or interest, the Fund may incur additional expense to the extent the Fund is required to seek recovery of such principal or interest. For a description of the ratings categories of certain rating agencies, see “Appendix A: Description of Securities Ratings” in the SAI.

Reinvestment Risk. Certain debt instruments, particularly below investment grade securities, may contain call or redemption provisions which would allow the issuer of the debt instrument to prepay principal prior to the debt instrument’s stated maturity. This is also sometimes known as prepayment risk. Prepayment risk is greater during a falling interest rate environment as issuers can reduce their cost of capital by refinancing higher yielding debt instruments with lower yielding debt instruments. An issuer may also elect to refinance its debt instruments with lower yielding debt instruments if the credit standing of the issuer improves. To the extent debt securities in the Fund’s portfolio are called or redeemed, the Fund may be forced to reinvest in lower yielding securities.

Preferred Stock Risk

Preferred stocks combine some of the characteristics of both common stocks and debt securities. Preferred stocks generally pay a fixed rate of return and are sold on the basis of current yield, like debt securities. However, because they are equity securities, preferred stock provides equity ownership of a company, and the income is paid in the form of distributions. Preferred stocks typically have a yield advantage over common stocks as well as comparably-rated fixed income investments. Preferred stocks are typically subordinated to bonds and other debt instruments in a company’s capital structure, in terms of priority to corporate income, and therefore will be subject to greater credit risk than those debt instruments. Unlike interest payments on debt securities, preferred stock distributions are payable only if declared by the issuer’s board of directors. Preferred stocks also may be subject to optional or mandatory redemption provisions. Certain of the preferred stocks in which the Fund may invest may be convertible preferred stocks, which have risks similar to convertible securities as described below in “— Convertible Instruments Risk.”

Convertible Instruments Risk

The Fund may invest in convertible instruments. A convertible instrument is a bond, debenture, note, preferred stock or other security that may be converted into or exchanged for a prescribed amount of Common Shares of the same or a different issuer within a particular period of time at a specified price or formula. Convertible debt instruments have characteristics of both fixed income and equity investments. Convertible instruments are subject both to the stock market risk associated with equity securities and to the credit and interest rate risks associated with fixed-income securities. As the market price of the equity security underlying a convertible instrument falls, the convertible instrument tends to trade on the basis of its yield and other fixed-income characteristics. As the market price of such equity security rises, the convertible security tends to trade on the basis of its equity conversion features. The Fund may invest in convertible instruments that have varying conversion values. Convertible instruments are typically issued at prices that represent a premium to their conversion value. Accordingly, the value of a convertible instrument increases (or decreases) as the price of the underlying equity security increases (or decreases). If a convertible instrument held by the Fund is called for redemption, the Fund will be required to permit the issuer to redeem the instrument, or convert it into the underlying stock, and will hold the stock to the extent the Investment Adviser determines that such equity investment is consistent with the investment objective of the Fund.

 

44


Interest Rate Risk

The costs associated with any leverage used by the Fund are likely to increase when interest rates rise. Accordingly, the market price of the Fund’s Common Shares may decline when interest rates rise.

Interest Rate Hedging Risk

The Fund may from time to time hedge against interest rate risk resulting from the Fund’s portfolio holdings and any financial leverage it may incur. Interest rate transactions the Fund may use for hedging purposes will expose the Fund to certain risks that differ from the risks associated with its portfolio holdings. There are economic costs of hedging reflected in the price of interest rate swaps, caps and similar techniques, the cost of which can be significant. In addition, the Fund’s success in using hedging instruments is subject to the Investment Adviser’s ability to correctly predict changes in the relationships of such hedging instruments to the Fund’s leverage risk, and there can be no assurance that the Investment Adviser’s judgment in this respect will be accurate. Depending on the state of interest rates in general, the Fund’s use of interest rate hedging instruments could enhance or decrease investment company taxable income available to the holders of its Common Shares. To the extent there is a decline in interest rates, the value of interest rate swaps or caps could decline, and result in a decline in the net asset value of the Fund’s Common Shares. In addition, if the counterparty to an interest rate swap or cap defaults, the Fund would not be able to use the anticipated net receipts under the interest rate swap or cap to offset its cost of financial leverage.

Leverage Risk

The Fund may use leverage through the issuance of Indebtedness or the issuance of preferred shares. The use of leverage magnifies both the favorable and unfavorable effects of price movements in the investments made by the Fund. Insofar as the Fund employs leverage in its investment operations, the Fund will be subject to increased risk of loss. In addition, the Fund will pay (and the holders of Common Shares will bear) all costs and expenses relating to the issuance and ongoing maintenance of leverage, including higher advisory fees. Similarly, any decline in the net asset value of the Fund’s investments will be borne entirely by the holders of Common Shares. Therefore, if the market value of the Fund’s portfolio declines, the leverage will result in a greater decrease in net asset value to the holders of Common Shares than if the Fund were not leveraged. This greater net asset value decrease will also tend to cause a greater decline in the market price for the Common Shares.

Leverage creates a greater risk of loss, as well as potential for more gain, for the Fund’s Common Shares than if leverage is not used. Preferred shares or debt issued by the Fund would have complete priority upon distribution of assets over Common Shares. Depending on the type of leverage involved, the Fund’s use of financial leverage may require the approval of its Board of Trustees. The Fund expects to invest the net proceeds derived from any leveraging according to the investment objective and policies described in this Prospectus. So long as the Fund’s portfolio is invested in securities that provide a higher rate of return than the distribution rate or interest rate of the leverage instrument or other borrowing arrangements, after taking its related expenses into consideration, the leverage will cause the Fund’s Common Shareholders to receive a higher rate of income than if it were not leveraged. There is no assurance that the Fund will continue to utilize leverage or, if leverage is utilized, that it will be successful in enhancing the level of the Fund’s total return. The net asset value of the Fund’s Common Shares will be reduced by the fees and issuance costs of any leverage.

Leverage creates risk for holders of the Fund’s Common Shares, including the likelihood of greater volatility of net asset value and market price of the shares. Risk of fluctuations in distribution rates or interest rates on leverage instruments or other borrowing arrangements may affect the return to the holders of the Fund’s Common Shares. To the extent the return on securities purchased with funds received from the use of leverage exceeds the cost of leverage (including increased expenses to the Fund), the Fund’s returns will be greater than if leverage had not been used. Conversely, if the return derived from such securities is less than the cost of leverage (including increased expenses to the Fund), the Fund’s returns will be less than if leverage had not been used, and therefore, the amount available for distribution to the Fund’s Common Shareholders will be reduced. In the latter case, the Investment Adviser in its best judgment nevertheless may determine to maintain the Fund’s leveraged position if it expects that the benefits to the Fund’s Common Shareholders of so doing will outweigh the current reduced return. Under

 

45


normal market conditions, the Fund anticipates that it will be able to invest the proceeds from leverage at a higher rate than the costs of leverage (including increased expenses to the Fund), which would enhance returns to the Fund’s Common Shareholders. The fees paid to the Investment Adviser will be calculated on the basis of the Fund’s Managed Assets, which include proceeds from leverage instruments and other borrowings. During periods in which the Fund uses financial leverage, the investment management fee payable to the Investment Adviser will be higher than if the Fund did not use a leveraged capital structure. Consequently, the Fund and the Investment Adviser may have differing interests in determining whether to leverage the Fund’s assets. The Board of Trustees will monitor the Fund’s use of leverage and this potential conflict.

Covered Call Option Risk

As the writer of a covered call option, the Fund forgoes, during the option’s life, the opportunity to profit from increases in the market value of the security covering the call option above the sum of the premium and the strike price of the call, but retains the risk of loss should the price of the underlying security decline. As the Fund writes covered calls over more of its portfolio, its ability to benefit from capital appreciation becomes more limited. There are significant differences between the securities and options markets that could result in an imperfect correlation between these markets, causing a given transaction not to achieve its objectives. A decision as to whether, when and how to use options involves the exercise of skill and judgment, and even a well-conceived transaction may be unsuccessful to some degree because of market behavior or unexpected events. See “Strategic Transactions — Options” in the SAI for additional information regarding risks associated with option transactions.

Arbitrage Risk

A part of the Investment Adviser’s investment operations may involve spread positions between two or more securities, or derivatives positions including commodities hedging positions, or a combination of the foregoing. The Investment Adviser’s trading operations also may involve arbitraging between two securities or commodities, between the security, commodity and related options or derivatives markets, between spot and futures or forward markets, and/or any combination of the above. To the extent the price relationships between such positions remain constant, no gain or loss on the positions will occur. These offsetting positions entail substantial risk that the price differential could change unfavorably, causing a loss to the position.

Securities Lending Risk

The Fund may lend its portfolio securities (up to a maximum of one-third of its Managed Assets) to banks or dealers which meet the creditworthiness standards established by the Board of Trustees of the Fund. Securities lending is subject to the risk that loaned securities may not be available to the Fund on a timely basis and the Fund may, therefore, lose the opportunity to sell the securities at a desirable price. Any loss in the market price of securities loaned by the Fund that occurs during the term of the loan would be borne by the Fund and would adversely affect the Fund’s performance. In addition, there may be delays in recovery, or no recovery, of securities loaned or even a loss of rights in the collateral should the borrower of the securities fail financially while the loan is outstanding. These risks may be greater for non-U.S. securities.

Non-Diversification Risk

The Fund is a non-diversified, closed-end management investment company under the 1940 Act. Accordingly, the Fund may invest a greater portion of its assets in a more limited number of issuers than a diversified fund. An investment in the Fund may present greater risk to an investor than an investment in a diversified portfolio because changes in the financial condition or market assessment of a single issuer may cause greater fluctuations in the value of the Fund’s shares.

Valuation Risk

Market prices may not be readily available for certain of the Fund’s investments, and the value of such investments will ordinarily be determined based on fair valuations determined by the Board of Trustees or its designee pursuant to procedures adopted by the Board of Trustees. Restrictions on resale or the absence of a liquid secondary market may adversely affect the Fund’s ability to determine its net asset value. The sale price of securities that are not readily marketable may be lower or higher than the Fund’s most recent determination of their fair value.

 

46


In addition, the value of these securities typically requires more reliance on the judgment of the Investment Adviser than that required for securities for which there is an active trading market. Due to the difficulty in valuing these securities and the absence of an active trading market for these investments, the Fund may not be able to realize these securities’ true value or may have to delay their sale in order to do so.

When determining the fair value of an asset, the Investment Adviser seeks to determine the price that the Fund might reasonably expect to receive from the current sale of that asset in an arm’s length transaction. Fair value pricing, however, involves judgments that are inherently subjective and inexact, since fair valuation procedures are used only when it is not possible to be sure what value should be attributed to a particular asset or when an event will affect the market price of an asset and to what extent. As a result, there can be no assurance that fair value pricing will reflect actual market value, and it is possible that the fair value determined for a security will be materially different from the value that actually could be or is realized upon the sale of that asset.

Portfolio Turnover Risk

Portfolio turnover rate is not considered a limiting factor in the Investment Adviser’s execution of investment decisions. The Fund anticipates that its annual portfolio turnover rate may vary greatly from year to year. A higher portfolio turnover rate results in correspondingly greater brokerage commissions and other transactional expenses that are borne by the Fund. High portfolio turnover may result in an increased realization of net short-term capital gains or capital losses by the Fund.

Strategic Transactions Risk

The Fund’s use of Strategic Transactions may involve the purchase and sale of derivative instruments. The Fund may purchase and sell exchange-listed and over-the-counter put and call options on securities, indices and other instruments, enter into forward contracts, purchase and sell futures contracts and options thereon, enter into swap, cap, floor or collar transactions, purchase structured investment products and enter into transactions that combine multiple derivative instruments. Strategic Transactions often have risks similar to the securities underlying the Strategic Transactions. However, the use of Strategic Transactions also involves risks that are different from, and possibly greater than, the risks associated with other portfolio investments. Strategic Transactions may involve the use of highly specialized instruments that require investment techniques and risk analyses different from those associated with other portfolio investments. The use of derivative instruments has risks, including the imperfect correlation between the value of the derivative instruments and the underlying assets, the possible default of the counterparty to the transaction or illiquidity of the derivative investments. Furthermore, the ability to successfully use these techniques depends on the Investment Adviser’s ability to predict pertinent market movements, which cannot be assured. Thus, the use of Strategic Transactions may result in losses greater than if they had not been used, may require the Fund to sell or purchase portfolio securities at inopportune times or for prices other than current market values, may limit the amount of appreciation the Fund can realize on an investment or may cause the Fund to hold a security that it might otherwise sell. In addition, amounts paid by the Fund as premiums and cash, or other assets held in margin accounts with respect to Strategic Transactions, are not otherwise available to the Fund for investment purposes. It is possible that government regulation of various types of derivative instruments, including regulations enacted pursuant to the Dodd-Frank Act, which was signed into law in July 2010, may impact the availability, liquidity and cost of derivative instruments. There can be no assurance that such regulation will not have a material adverse effect on the Fund or will not impair the ability of the Fund to implement certain Strategic Transactions or to achieve its investment objective. Although the Investment Adviser seeks to use Strategic Transactions to further the Fund’s investment objective, no assurance can be given that the use of Strategic Transactions will achieve this result. A more complete discussion of Strategic Transactions and their risks is included in the SAI under the heading “Strategic Transactions.”

Counterparty Risk

The Fund will be subject to credit risk with respect to the counterparties to the derivative contracts entered into by the Fund. If a counterparty becomes bankrupt or otherwise fails to perform its obligations under a derivative contract due to financial difficulties, the Fund may experience significant delays in obtaining any recovery under the derivative contract in bankruptcy or other reorganization proceedings. The Fund may obtain only a limited recovery, or may obtain no recovery, in such circumstances.

 

47


Short Sales Risk

Short selling involves selling securities which may or may not be owned and borrowing the same securities for delivery to the purchaser, with an obligation to replace the borrowed securities at a later date. Short selling allows the short seller to profit from declines in market prices to the extent such declines exceed the transaction costs and the costs of borrowing the securities. A naked short sale creates the risk of an unlimited loss because the price of the underlying security could theoretically increase without limit, thus increasing the cost of buying those securities to cover the short position. There can be no assurance that the securities necessary to cover a short position will be available for purchase. Purchasing securities to close out the short position can itself cause the price of the securities to rise, further exacerbating the loss.

The Fund’s obligation to replace the borrowed security will be secured by collateral deposited with the broker-dealer, usually cash, U.S. government securities or other liquid securities similar to those borrowed. The Fund also will be required to segregate similar collateral to the extent, if any, necessary so that the value of both collateral amounts in the aggregate is at all times equal to at least 100% of the current market value of the security sold short. Depending on arrangements made with the broker-dealer from which the Fund borrowed the security regarding repaying amounts received by the Fund on such security, the Fund may not receive any payments (including interest) on the Fund’s collateral deposited with such broker-dealer.

Inflation Risk

Inflation risk is the risk that the value of assets or income from investment will be worth less in the future as inflation decreases the value of money. As inflation increases, the real value of the Fund’s Common Shares and distributions can decline.

Deflation Risk

Deflation risk is the risk that prices throughout the economy decline over time, which may have an adverse effect on the market valuation of companies, their assets and their revenues. In addition, deflation may have an adverse effect on the creditworthiness of issuers and may make issuer default more likely, which may result in a decline in the value of the Fund’s portfolio.

Other Investment Companies Risk

The Fund may invest in securities of other investment companies, including other closed-end or open-end investment companies (including ETFs). The market value of their shares may differ from the net asset value of the particular fund. To the extent the Fund invests a portion of its assets in investment company securities, those assets will be subject to the risks of the purchased investment company’s portfolio securities. In addition, if the Fund invests in such investment companies or investment funds, the Fund’s shareholders will bear not only their proportionate share of the expenses of the Fund (including operating expenses and the fees of the investment adviser), but also will indirectly bear similar expenses of the underlying investment company. In addition, the securities of other investment companies may also be leveraged and will therefore be subject to the same leverage risks described herein. As described in the section entitled “—Leverage Risk,” the net asset value and market value of leveraged shares will be more volatile and the yield to stockholders will tend to fluctuate more than the yield generated by unleveraged shares. Other investment companies may have investment policies that differ from those of the Fund. In addition, to the extent the Fund invests in other investment companies, the Fund will be dependent upon the investment and research abilities of persons other than the Investment Adviser.

ETN and ETF Risk

An ETN or ETF that is based on a specific index may not be able to replicate and maintain exactly the composition and relative weighting of securities in the index. An ETN or ETF also incurs certain expenses not incurred by its applicable index. The market value of an ETN or ETF share may differ from its net asset value; the share may trade at a premium or discount to its net asset value, which may be due to, among other things, differences in the supply and demand in the market for the share and the supply and demand in the market for the underlying assets of the ETN or ETF. In addition, certain securities that are part of the index tracked by an ETN or ETF may, at times, be unavailable, which may impede the ETN’s or ETF’s ability to track its index. An ETF that uses leverage can, at

 

48


times, be relatively illiquid, which can affect whether its share price approximates net asset value. As a result of using leverage, an ETF is subject to the risk of failure in the futures and options markets it uses to obtain leverage and the risk that a counterparty will default on its obligations, which can result in a loss to the Fund. If the Fund invests in ETFs, the Fund’s shareholders will bear not only their proportionate share of the expenses of the Fund, but also will indirectly bear similar expenses of the underlying ETF. Although an ETN is a debt security, it is unlike a typical bond, in that there are no periodic interest payments and principal is not protected.

Investment Management Risk

The Fund’s portfolio is subject to investment management risk because it will be actively managed. The Investment Adviser will apply investment techniques and risk analyses in making investment decisions for the Fund, but there can be no guarantee that they will produce the desired results.

The decisions with respect to the management of the Fund are made exclusively by the Investment Adviser, subject to the oversight of the Board of Trustees. Investors have no right or power to take part in the management of the Fund. The Investment Adviser also is responsible for all of the trading and investment decisions of the Fund. In the event of the withdrawal or bankruptcy of the Investment Adviser, generally the affairs of the Fund will be wound-up and its assets will be liquidated.

Dependence on Key Personnel of the Investment Adviser

The Fund is dependent upon the Investment Adviser’s key personnel for its future success and upon their access to certain individuals and investments in the energy sector. In particular, the Fund will depend on the diligence, skill and network of business contacts of the personnel of the Investment Adviser and its portfolio managers, who will evaluate, negotiate, structure, close and monitor the Fund’s investments. The portfolio managers have phantom equity interests and other financial incentives to remain with the firm. The Fund will also depend on the senior management of the Investment Adviser, including particularly Jerry V. Swank. The departure of Mr. Swank or another of the Investment Adviser’s senior management could have a material adverse effect on the Fund’s ability to achieve its investment objective. In addition, the Fund can offer no assurance that the Investment Adviser will remain its investment adviser, or that the Fund will continue to have access to the Investment Adviser’s industry contacts and deal flow.

Conflicts of Interest with the Investment Adviser

Conflicts of interest may arise because the Investment Adviser and its affiliates generally will be carrying on substantial investment activities for other clients, including, but not limited to, other client accounts and funds managed or advised by the Investment Adviser, in which the Fund will have no interest. The Investment Adviser or its affiliates may have financial incentives to favor certain of such accounts over the Fund. Any of their proprietary accounts and other customer accounts may compete with the Fund for specific trades. The Investment Adviser or its affiliates may buy or sell securities for the Fund which differ from securities bought or sold for other accounts and customers, even though their investment objectives and policies may be similar to the Fund’s. Situations may occur when the Fund could be disadvantaged because of the investment activities conducted by the Investment Adviser and its affiliates for their other accounts. Such situations may be based on, among other things, legal or internal restrictions on the combined size of positions that may be taken for the Fund and the other accounts, limiting the size of the Fund’s position, or the difficulty of liquidating an investment for the Fund and the other accounts where the market cannot absorb the sale of the combined position. Notwithstanding these potential conflicts of interest, the Fund’s Board of Trustees and officers have a fiduciary obligation to act in the Fund’s best interest.

The Fund’s investment opportunities may be limited by affiliations of the Investment Adviser or its affiliates with Renaissance Companies. In addition, to the extent that the Investment Adviser sources and structures private investments in Renaissance Companies, certain employees of the Investment Adviser may become aware of actions planned by Renaissance Companies, such as acquisitions that may not be announced to the public. It is possible that the Fund could be precluded from investing in a company about which the Investment Adviser has material non-public information; however, it is the Investment Adviser’s intention to ensure that any material non-public information available to certain of the Investment Adviser’s employees not be shared with those employees responsible for the purchase and sale of publicly traded securities.

 

49


The Investment Adviser manages several other client accounts and funds. Some of these other client accounts and funds have investment objectives that are similar to or overlap with the Fund. Furthermore, the Investment Adviser may at some time in the future manage additional client accounts and investment funds with the same investment objective as the Fund.

The Investment Adviser and its affiliates generally will be carrying on substantial investment activities for other clients’ accounts and funds in which the Fund will have no interest. Investment decisions for the Fund are made independently from those of such other clients; however, from time to time, the same investment decision may be made for more than one fund or account. When two or more clients advised by the Investment Adviser or its affiliates seek to purchase or sell the same publicly traded securities, the securities actually purchased or sold will be allocated among the clients on a good faith equitable basis by the Investment Adviser in its discretion in accordance with the clients’ various investment objectives and procedures adopted by the Investment Adviser and approved by the Fund’s Board of Trustees. In some cases, this system may adversely affect the price or size of the position the Fund may obtain.

The Fund’s investment opportunities may be limited by investment opportunities that the Investment Adviser is evaluating for other clients’ accounts and funds. To the extent a potential investment is appropriate for the Fund and one or more of the Investment Adviser’s other client accounts or funds, the Investment Adviser will need to fairly allocate that investment to the Fund or another client account or fund, or both, depending on its allocation procedures and applicable law related to combined or joint transactions. There may occur an attractive limited investment opportunity suitable for the Fund in which the Fund cannot invest under the particular allocation method being used for that investment.

Under the 1940 Act, the Fund and such other client accounts or funds managed or advised by the Investment Adviser may be precluded from co-investing in certain private placements of securities. Except as permitted by law or positions of the staff of the SEC, the Investment Adviser will not co-invest its other clients’ assets in private transactions in which the Fund invests. To the extent the Fund is precluded from co-investing, the Investment Adviser will allocate private investment opportunities among its clients, including but not limited to the Fund and its other client accounts and funds, based on allocation policies that take into account several suitability factors, including the size of the investment opportunity, the amount each client has available for investment and the client’s investment objectives. These allocation policies may result in the allocation of investment opportunities to another client account or fund managed or advised by the Investment Adviser rather than to the Fund.

The management fee payable to the Investment Adviser is based on the value of the Fund’s Managed Assets, as periodically determined. A portion of the Fund’s Managed Assets may be illiquid securities acquired in private transactions for which market quotations will not be readily available. Although the Fund will adopt valuation procedures designed to determine valuations of illiquid securities in a manner that reflects their fair value, there typically is a range of possible prices that may be established for each individual security. See “Net Asset Value.”

Skadden, Arps, Slate, Meagher & Flom LLP, counsel to the Fund in this offering, also represents the Investment Adviser. Such counsel does not purport to represent the separate interests of the investors and has assumed no obligation to do so. Accordingly, the investors have not had the benefit of independent counsel in the structuring of the Fund or determination of the relative interests, rights and obligations of the Investment Adviser and the investors.

Market Discount from Net Asset Value

Shares of closed-end investment companies frequently trade at a discount from their net asset value, which is a risk separate and distinct from the risk that the Fund’s net asset value could decrease as a result of its investment activities. Although the value of the Fund’s net assets is generally considered by market participants in determining whether to purchase or sell Common Shares, whether investors will realize gains or losses upon the sale of Common Shares will depend entirely upon whether the market price of Common Shares at the time of sale is above or below the investor’s purchase price for Common Shares. Because the market price of Common Shares will be determined by factors such as net asset value, distribution and distribution levels (which are dependent, in part, on expenses), supply of and demand for Common Shares, stability of distributions or distributions, trading volume of Common Shares, general market and economic conditions and other factors beyond the control of the Fund, the Fund cannot predict whether Common Shares will trade at, below or above net asset value or at, below or above the initial public offering price. This risk may be greater for investors expecting to sell their Common Shares soon after the

 

50


completion of the public offering, as the net asset value of the Common Shares will be reduced immediately following the offering as a result of the payment of certain offering costs. Common Shares of the Fund are designed primarily for long-term investors; investors in Common Shares should not view the Fund as a vehicle for trading purposes.

Recent Economic Events Risk

Global and domestic financial markets have experienced periods of unprecedented turmoil. The debt and equity capital markets in the United States were negatively impacted by significant write-offs in the financial services sector relating to subprime mortgages and the re-pricing of credit risk in the broader market, among other things. These events, along with the deterioration of the housing market and the failure of major financial institutions, led to worsening general economic conditions, contributed to severe market volatility and caused severe liquidity strains in the capital markets.

Recently markets have witnessed more stabilized economic activity as expectations for an economic recovery increased. However, risks to a robust resumption of growth persist. Demand for energy commodities and prices of oil and other energy commodities have experienced significant volatility during recent years. Slower global growth may lower demand for oil and other energy commodities and increased exports by Iran with the end of sanctions may increase supply, exacerbating oversupply of such commodities and further reducing commodity prices. Many companies in which the Fund may invest have been and may continue to be adversely impacted by volatility of, prices of energy commodities. Continued volatility of such prices could further erode such companies’ growth prospects and negatively impact such companies’ ability to sustain attractive distribution levels. Growth of the Energy sector is dependent on several factors, including the strength of the financial sector, the general economy and the commodity markets.

Legislation and Regulatory Risks

At any time after the date hereof, legislation may be enacted that could negatively affect the issuers in which the Fund invests. Changing approaches to regulation may also have a negative impact issuers in which the Fund invests. In addition, legislation or regulation may change the way in which the Fund is regulated. There can be no assurance that future legislation, regulation or deregulation will not have a material adverse effect on the Fund or will not impair the ability of the Fund to achieve its investment objective.

The Dodd-Frank Act, which was signed into law in July 2010, has resulted in significant revisions to the U.S. financial regulatory framework. The Dodd-Frank Act covers a broad range of topics, including, among many others: a reorganization of federal financial regulators; the creation of a process designed to ensure financial system stability and the resolution of potentially insolvent financial firms; the enactment of new rules for derivatives trading; the creation of a consumer financial protection watchdog; the registration and regulation of managers of private funds; the regulation of rating agencies; and the enactment of new federal requirements for residential mortgage loans. The regulation of various types of derivative instruments pursuant to the Dodd-Frank Act may adversely affect the Fund or its counterparties.

The change in presidential administration could significantly impact the regulation of United States financial markets. Areas subject to potential change, amendment or repeal include the Dodd-Frank Act, including the Volcker Rule, the authority of the Federal Reserve and Financial Stability Oversight Council, and renewed proposals to separate banks’ commercial and investment banking activities. The Financial CHOICE Act, which was passed by the U.S. House of Representatives in June 2017, would, if enacted, roll back parts of the Dodd-Frank Act. Other potential changes that could be pursued by the new presidential administration could include the United States’ withdrawal from, or attempt to renegotiate, various trade agreements or the taking of other actions that would change current trade policies of the United States. It is not possible to predict which, if any, of these actions will be taken or, if taken, their effect on the economy, securities markets or the financial stability of the United States. The Fund may be affected by governmental action in ways that are not foreseeable, and there is a possibility that such actions could have a significant adverse effect on the Fund and its ability to achieve its investment objective.

[The Tax Cuts and Jobs Act of 2017 was signed into law on December 22, 2017. The long term impacts of this legislation on issuers in which the Fund may invest, the energy sector generally and the economy and securities market of the United States is not yet certain.]

 

51


Geopolitical and Market Disruption Risk

The aftermath of the war in Iraq, instability in Afghanistan, Pakistan, Egypt, Libya, Syria, Russia, Ukraine and the Middle East, possible terrorist attacks in the United States and around the world, growing social and political discord in the United States, the European debt crisis, the response of the international community—through economic sanctions and otherwise—to Russia’s recent annexation of the Crimea region of Ukraine and posture vis-a-vis Ukraine, continued tensions between North Korea and the United States and the international community generally, new and continued political unrest in various countries, such as Venezuela, the United Kingdom’s pending withdrawal from the European Union and the resulting profound and uncertain impacts on the economic and political future of the United Kingdom, the European Union and global financial markets, further downgrade of U.S. Government securities, the change in the U.S. president and the new administration and other similar events, may have long-term effects on the U.S. and worldwide financial markets and may cause further economic uncertainties in the United States and worldwide. The Fund does not know and cannot predict how long the securities markets may be affected by these events and the effects of these and similar events in the future on the U.S. economy and securities markets. The Fund may be adversely affected by abrogation of international agreements and national laws which have created the market instruments in which the Fund may invest, failure of the designated national and international authorities to enforce compliance with the same laws and agreements, failure of local, national and international organization to carry out their duties prescribed to them under the relevant agreements, revisions of these laws and agreements which dilute their effectiveness or conflicting interpretation of provisions of the same laws and agreements. The Fund may be adversely affected by uncertainties such as terrorism, international political developments, and changes in government policies, taxation, restrictions on foreign investment and currency repatriation, currency fluctuations and other developments in the laws and regulations of the countries in which it is invested.

Not a Complete Investment Program

The Fund is intended for investors seeking a high level of total return with an emphasis on current income. The Fund is not meant to provide a vehicle for those who wish to exploit short-term swings in the stock market and is intended for long-term investors. An investment in shares of the Fund should not be considered a complete investment program. Each shareholder should take into account the Fund’s investment objective as well as the shareholder’s other investments when considering an investment in the Fund.

Risks Associated with Offerings of Additional Common Shares

The voting power of current Common Shareholders will be diluted to the extent that current Common Shareholders do not purchase Common Shares in any future offerings of Common Shares or do not purchase sufficient Common Shares to maintain their percentage interest. If the Fund is unable to invest the proceeds of such offering as intended, the Fund’s per Common Share distribution may decrease and the Fund may not participate in market advances to the same extent as if such proceeds were fully invested as planned. If the Fund sells Common Shares at a price below NAV pursuant to the consent of Common Shareholders, shareholders will experience a dilution of the aggregate NAV per Common Share because the sale price will be less than the Fund’s then-current NAV per Common Share. Similarly, were the expenses of the offering to exceed the amount by which the sale price exceeded the Fund’s then current NAV per Common Share, shareholders would experience a dilution of the aggregate NAV per Common Share. This dilution will be experienced by all shareholders, irrespective of whether they purchase Common Shares in any such offering. See “Description of Shares—Common Shares—Issuance of Additional Common Shares.”

Additional Risks of Rights

There are additional risks associated with an offering of Rights. Shareholders who do not exercise their Rights may, at the completion of such an offering, own a smaller proportional interest in the Fund than if they exercised their Rights. As a result of such an offering, a shareholder may experience dilution in net asset value per share if the subscription price per share is below the net asset value per share on the expiration date. If the subscription price per share is below the net asset value per share of the Fund’s Common Shares on the expiration date, a shareholder will experience an immediate dilution of the aggregate net asset value of such shareholder’s Common Shares if the shareholder does not participate in such an offering and the shareholder will experience a reduction in the net asset value per share of such shareholder’s Common Shares whether or not the shareholder participates in such an offering. Such a reduction in net asset value per share may have the effect of reducing market price of the Common

 

52


Share. The Fund cannot state precisely the extent of this dilution (if any) if the shareholder does not exercise such shareholder’s Rights because the Fund does not know what the net asset value per share will be when the offer expires or what proportion of the Rights will be exercised. If the subscription price is substantially less than the then current net asset value per Common Share at the expiration of a rights offering, such dilution could be substantial. Any such dilution or accretion will depend upon whether (i) such shareholders participate in the Rights offering and (ii) the Fund’s net asset value per Common Share is above or below the subscription price on the expiration date of the Rights offering. In addition to the economic dilution described above, if a Common Shareholder does not exercise all of their rights, the Common Shareholder will incur voting dilution as a result of this rights offering. This voting dilution will occur because the Common Shareholder will own a smaller proportionate interest in the Fund after the rights offering than prior to the rights offering. There is a risk that changes in market conditions may result in the underlying Common Shares purchasable upon exercise of the subscription rights being less attractive to investors at the conclusion of the subscription period. This may reduce or eliminate the value of the subscription rights. If investors exercise only a portion of the rights, the number of Common Shares issued may be reduced, and the Common Shares may trade at less favorable prices than larger offerings for similar securities. Subscription rights issued by the Fund may be transferable or non-transferable rights. In a non-transferable rights offering, Common Shareholders who do not wish to exercise their rights will be unable to sell their rights. In a transferrable rights offering, the Fund will use its best efforts to ensure an adequate trading market for the rights; however, investors may find that there is no market to sell rights they do not wish to exercise.

Anti-Takeover Provisions Risk

The Fund’s Agreement and Declaration of Trust and Bylaws include provisions that could have the effect of limiting the ability of other entities or persons to acquire control of the Fund or to change the composition of its Board of Trustees. For example, the Fund’s Agreement and Declaration of Trust limits the ability of persons to beneficially own (within the meaning of Section 382 of the Code) more than 4.99% of the outstanding Common Shares of the Fund. This restriction is intended to reduce the risk of the Fund undergoing an “ownership change” within the meaning of Section 382 of the Code, which would limit the Fund’s ability to use a capital loss carryforward and certain unrealized losses (if such tax attributes exist). In general, an ownership change occurs if 5% shareholders (and certain persons or groups treated as 5% shareholders) of the Fund increase their ownership percentage in the Fund by more than 50 percentage points in the aggregate within any three-year period ending on certain defined testing dates. If an ownership change were to occur, Section 382 would impose an annual limitation on the amount of post-ownership change gains that the Fund may offset with pre-ownership change losses, and might impose restrictions on the Fund’s ability to use certain unrealized losses existing at the time of the ownership change. Such a limitation arising under Section 382 could reduce the benefit of the Fund’s then existing capital loss carryforward or unrealized losses, if any. These ownership restrictions could have the effect of depriving shareholders of an opportunity to sell their shares at a premium over prevailing market prices by discouraging a third party from seeking to obtain control over the Fund. Such attempts could have the effect of increasing the expenses of the Fund and disrupting the normal operation of the Fund. In addition, these ownership restrictions may reduce market demand for the Fund’s Common Shares, which could have the effect of increasing the likelihood that the Fund’s Common Shares trade at a discount to net asset value and increasing the amount of any such discount. See “Anti-Takeover Provisions in the Agreement and Declaration of Trust” and “Certain Provisions of Delaware Law, the Agreement and Declaration of Trust and Bylaws.”

MANAGEMENT OF THE FUND

Trustees and Officers

The Board of Trustees of the Fund provides broad oversight over the operations and affairs of the Fund and protects the interests of shareholders. The Board of Trustees has overall responsibility to manage and control the business affairs of the Fund, including the complete and exclusive authority to establish policies regarding the management, conduct and operation of the Fund’s business. The Fund’s officers, who are all officers or employees of the Investment Adviser or its affiliates, are responsible for the day-to-day management and administration of the Fund’s operations. The names and ages of the Trustees and officers of the Fund, the year each was first elected or appointed to office, their principal business occupations during the last five years, the number of funds overseen by each Trustee and other directorships or trusteeships during the last five years are set forth under “Management of the Fund” in the SAI.

 

53


Investment Adviser

Subject to the overall supervision of the Board of Trustees, the Fund is managed by Cushing ® Asset Management, LP., the Investment Adviser. The Investment Adviser is an SEC-registered investment adviser headquartered in Dallas, Texas. The Investment Adviser serves as investment adviser to separately managed accounts, registered and unregistered funds, which invest primarily in securities of MLPs and other natural resource companies. The Investment Adviser continues to seek to expand its platform of energy-related investment products, leveraging extensive industry contacts and significant research depth to drive both passive and actively managed investment opportunities for individual and institutional investors. The Investment Adviser seeks to identify and exploit investment niches that it believes are generally less understood and less followed by the broader investor community. The Investment Adviser’s principal business address is 8117 Preston Road, Suite 440, Dallas, Texas 75225. The Investment Adviser is indirectly controlled by Jerry V. Swank.

The Investment Adviser considers itself one of the principal professional institutional investors in the energy sector based on the following:

 

    An investment team with extensive experience in analysis, portfolio management, risk management, and private securities transactions.

 

    A focus on bottom-up, fundamental analysis performed by its experienced investment team is core to the Investment Adviser’s investment process.

 

    The investment team’s wide range of professional backgrounds, market knowledge, industry relationships, and experience in the analysis, financing, and structuring of energy income investments give the Investment Adviser insight into, and the ability to identify and capitalize on, investment opportunities.

 

    Its central location in Dallas, Texas and proximity to major players and assets in the energy sector.

The Investment Adviser acts as the investment adviser to the Fund pursuant to an investment management agreement (the “Investment Management Agreement”). Pursuant to the Investment Management Agreement, the Fund has agreed to pay the Investment Adviser a fee, payable at the end of each calendar month, at an annual rate equal to 1.25% of the average weekly value of the Fund’s Managed Assets during such month (the “Management Fee”) for the services and facilities provided by the Investment Adviser to the Fund. “Managed Assets” means the total assets of the Fund, minus all accrued expenses incurred in the normal course of operations other than liabilities or obligations attributable to investment leverage, including, without limitation, investment leverage obtained through (i) indebtedness of any type (including, without limitation, borrowing through a credit facility or the issuance of debt securities), (ii) the issuance of shares of preferred stock or other similar preference securities and/or (iii) the reinvestment of collateral received for securities loaned in accordance with the Fund’s investment objective and policies.

Because the Management Fee is based upon a percentage of the Fund’s Managed Assets, the Management Fee will be higher if the Fund employs leverage. Therefore, the Investment Adviser will have a financial incentive to use leverage, which may create a conflict of interest between the Investment Adviser and the Fund’s Common Shareholders.

Pursuant to the Investment Management Agreement, the Investment Adviser is responsible for managing the portfolio of the Fund in accordance with its stated investment objective and policies, making investment decisions for the Fund, placing orders to purchase and sell securities on behalf of the Fund and managing the other business and affairs of the Fund, all subject to the supervision and direction of the Fund’s Board of Trustees. In addition, the Investment Adviser furnishes offices, necessary facilities and equipment on behalf of the Fund; provides personnel, including certain officers required for the Fund’s administrative management; and pays the compensation of all officers and Trustees of the Fund who are its affiliates.

In addition to the Management Fee, the Fund pays all other costs and expenses of its operations, including the compensation of its Trustees (other than those affiliated with the Investment Adviser); the fees and expenses of the Fund’s administrator, the custodian and transfer and distribution disbursing agent; legal fees; leverage expenses (if any); rating agency fees (if any); listing fees and expenses; fees of independent auditors; expenses of repurchasing shares; expenses of preparing, printing and distributing shareholder reports, notices, proxy statements and reports to governmental agencies; and taxes, if any.

 

54


A discussion regarding the basis for the approval of the Investment Management Agreement by the Board of Trustees is available in the Fund’s semi-annual report to shareholders for the period ended May 31, 2017.

Portfolio Management

Jerry V. Swank, Founder, Managing Partner and Co-Chief Investment Officer of the Investment Adviser, Saket Kumar, Portfolio Manager of the Investment Adviser, and Matthew Lemme, Portfolio Manager of the Investment Adviser, are primarily responsible for the day-to-day management of the Fund’s portfolio.

Jerry V. Swank . Mr. Swank formed Swank Capital, LLC in 2000 to provide proprietary energy research to a select group of institutional investors, emphasizing in-depth independent research. Prior to forming Swank Capital, LLC, Mr. Swank spent five years with John S. Herold, Inc. and oil and gas research and consulting company that is now part of IHS Markit. He joined John S. Herold in 1995 and served as Managing Director heading up its sales and new product development team until May 1998, when he assumed the position of President. During this period, Mr. Swank developed an in-depth knowledge of the worldwide energy industry, sector profitability, global growth prospects and supply/demand dynamics. Prior to joining Herold, Mr. Swank spent 14 years with Credit Suisse First Boston Corporation in Institutional Equity and Fixed Income Sales in its Dallas office from 1980 to 1995. From 1985 to 1995 he was a Credit Suisse First Boston Corporation Director and Southwestern Regional Sales Manager. Prior to Credit Suisse First Boston Corporation, Mr. Swank worked from 1976 to 1980 on the buy side as an analyst and portfolio manager with Mercantile Texas Corp. Mr. Swank received a B.A. from the University of Missouri (Economics) and an M.B.A. from the University of North Texas. Mr. Swank has previously served on the Board of Directors of John S. Herold, Inc., Matador Petroleum Corporation and Advantage Acceptance, Inc. Mr. Swank is also Chairman of the Board, CEO, President, and a Portfolio Manager of The Cushing ® MLP Total Return Fund, The Cushing ® Energy & Income Fund, and Cushing ® MLP Infrastructure Fund, a series of the Cushing Mutual Funds Trust.

Matthew A. Lemme . Mr. Lemme joined the Investment Adviser in November 2012. Previously, Mr. Lemme worked at Highland Capital Management for over five years, most recently as a Managing Director. Prior to joining Highland Capital Management, he was an Associate Research Analyst at UBS Securities in New York, NY. Mr. Lemme’s primary focus was providing equity research coverage of companies and master limited partnerships in the natural gas and coal industries. His coverage spanned pipelines, utilities, exploration & production, and midstream companies. Prior to UBS, Mr. Lemme was a consultant at Deloitte Consulting, where he provided mergers & acquisitions and strategic advisory services to electric utilities and independent power producers. Prior to Deloitte, Mr. Lemme was an investment banking analyst at CCF Charterhouse, a French investment bank now owned by HSBC. He received an MBA from the McCombs School of Business, University of Texas at Austin and a Bachelor of Science in Management from Villanova University. Mr. Lemme has earned the right to use the Chartered Financial Analyst designation.

Saket Kumar . Mr. Kumar has experience as an engineer, in investment research and investment banking and is a specialist in the materials, energy and basic industrials sectors. Mr. Kumar worked at Citadel Investment Group from October 2011 through October 2012 as a research analyst. He originally joined the Investment Adviser in 2008 as a Senior Research Analyst for the Investment Adviser. Prior to the Investment Adviser, he was an investment banker at Bear Stearns where he focused on corporate finance and mergers and acquisitions in the global industrial group. Prior to that, he spent three years in the marine transportation industry as an engineer on board cargo vessels specializing in dry bulk and crude oil shipping. Mr. Kumar received an M.B.A. in finance and accounting from Southern Methodist University and a B.S. in marine engineering from Marine Engineering and Research Institute in India.

The SAI provides additional information about the portfolio managers’ compensation, other accounts managed by the portfolio managers and the portfolio managers’ ownership of securities of the Fund.

 

55


NET ASSET VALUE

The Fund will determine the net asset value of its Common Shares as of the close of regular session trading on the New York Stock Exchange (normally 4:00 p.m. eastern time) on each day on which there is a regular trading session on the NYSE. The Fund calculates net asset value per Common Share by subtracting liabilities (including accrued expenses or distributions) from the total assets of the Fund (the value of the securities plus cash or other assets, including interest accrued but not yet received) and dividing the result by the total number of outstanding Common Shares of the Fund.

The Fund will use the following valuation methods to determine either current market value for investments for which market quotations are available, or if not available, the fair value, as determined in good faith pursuant to such policies and procedures as may be approved by the Board of Trustees from time to time. The valuation of the portfolio securities of the Fund currently includes the following processes:

 

    The market value of each security listed or traded on any recognized securities exchange or automated quotation system will be the last reported sale price at the relevant valuation date on the composite tape or on the principal exchange on which such security is traded. If no sale is reported on that date, the last reported bid price is used. If the Investment Adviser determines that the price is not representative of the actual market price, the Investment Adviser’s valuation committee may determine the fair value of the security.

 

    Generally, the Fund’s loan and bond positions are not traded on exchanges and consequently are valued based on market prices received from third-party pricing services or broker-dealer sources.

 

    Distributions declared but not yet received, and rights in respect of securities which are quoted ex-distribution or ex-rights, will be recorded at the fair value of those distributions or rights, as determined by the Investment Adviser, which may (but need not) be the value so determined on the day such securities are first quoted ex-distribution or ex-rights.

 

    Listed options, or over-the-counter options for which representative brokers’ quotations are available, will be valued in the same manner as listed or over-the-counter securities. Premiums for the sale of such options written by the Fund will be included in the assets of the Fund, and the market value of such options will be included as a liability.

 

    The Fund’s non-marketable investments will generally be valued in such manner as the Investment Adviser determines in good faith to reflect their fair values under procedures established by, and under the general supervision and responsibility of, the Board of Trustees. The pricing of all assets that are fair valued in this manner will be subsequently reported to and ratified by the Board of Trustees.

When determining the fair value of an asset, the Investment Adviser seeks to determine the price that the Fund might reasonably expect to receive from the current sale of that asset in an arm’s length transaction. Fair value determinations will be based upon all available factors that the Investment Adviser deems relevant.

Trading in securities on many foreign securities exchanges and over-the-counter markets is normally completed before the close of business on each U.S. business day. In addition, securities trading in a particular country or countries may not take place on all U.S. business days or may take place on days which are not U.S. business days. If events occur between the time when a security’s price was last determined on a securities exchange or market and the time when the Fund’s net asset value is last calculated that the Investment Adviser deems materially affect the price of such security (for example, (i) movements in certain U.S. securities indices which demonstrate strong correlation to movements in certain foreign securities markets, (ii) a foreign securities market closes because of a natural disaster or some other reason, (iii) a halt in trading of the securities of an issuer on an exchange during the trading day or (iv) a significant event affecting an issuer occurs), such securities may be valued at their fair value as determined in good faith in accordance with procedures established by the Board of Trustees, an effect of which may be to foreclose opportunities available to market timers or short-term traders. For purposes of calculating net asset value per share, all assets and liabilities initially expressed in foreign currencies will be converted into U.S. dollars at the mean of the bid price and asked price of such currencies against the U.S. dollar, as quoted by a major bank.

 

56


The Fund determines the value of derivative instruments based on bid and ask prices, when available, or otherwise at fair value, in accordance with the Fund’s valuation policies and procedures. Any derivative transaction that the Fund enters into may, depending on the applicable market environment, have a positive or negative value for purposes of calculating net asset value. In addition, accrued payments to the Fund under such transactions will be assets of the Fund and accrued payments by the Fund will be liabilities of the Fund.

DISTRIBUTIONS

The Fund intends to pay substantially all of its net investment income to Common Shareholders through monthly distributions. In addition, the Fund intends to distribute any net long-term capital gains to Common Shareholders at least annually. The Fund expects that distributions paid on the Common Shares will consist primarily of (i) investment company taxable income, which includes, among other things, ordinary income, net short-term capital gain and income from certain hedging and interest rate transactions, and (ii) net capital gain (which is the excess of net long-term capital gain over net short-term capital loss). A portion of the Fund’s distributions may also be characterized as return of capital. The Fund may invest up to 25% of its Managed Assets in MLPs are “qualified publicly traded partnerships” under the Code and a portion of the cash distributions received by the Fund from the MLPs in which it invests may be characterized as return of capital. If, for any calendar year, the Fund’s total distributions exceed both current earnings and profits and accumulated earnings and profits, the excess will generally be treated as a return of capital for U.S. federal income tax purposes up to the amount of a shareholder’s tax basis in the Common Shares, reducing that basis accordingly, which will generally increase the Common Shareholder’s potential gain, or reduce the Common Shareholder’s potential loss, on any subsequent sale or other disposition of Common Shares. The Fund cannot assure you as to what percentage, if any, of the distributions paid on the Common Shares will consist of net capital gain, which is taxed at reduced rates for non-corporate shareholders, or return of capital. For the fiscal year ended November 30, 2017, the Fund’s distributions were comprised of 25.97% ordinary income and 74.03% return of capital.

Pursuant to the requirements of the 1940 Act, in the event the Fund makes distributions from sources other than income, a notice will accompany each distribution with respect to the estimated source of the distribution made. Such notices will describe the portion, if any, of the distribution which, in the Fund’s good faith judgment, constitutes long-term capital gain, short-term capital gain, investment income or a return of capital. The actual character of such distributions for U.S. federal income tax purposes, however, will only be determined finally by the Fund at the close of its fiscal year, based on the Fund’s full year performance and its actual net income and net capital gains for the year, which may result in a recharacterization of amounts distributed during such fiscal year from the characterization in the estimates.

Because of the nature of the Fund’s investments and changes in market conditions from time to time, the distributions paid by the Fund for any particular month may be more or less than the amount of net investment income from that monthly period. As a result, all or a portion of a distribution may be a return of capital, which is in effect a partial return of the amount a Common Shareholder invested in the Fund.

If the Fund’s total distributions in any year exceed the amount of its investment company taxable income and net capital gain for the year, any such excess would generally be characterized as a return of capital for U.S. federal income tax purposes. For example, because of the nature of the Fund’s investments, the Fund may distribute net short-term capital gains early in the calendar year, but incur net short-term capital losses later in the year, thereby offsetting the short-term net capital gains for which distributions have already been made by the Fund. In such a situation, the amount by which the Fund’s total distributions exceed investment company taxable income and net capital gain would generally be treated as a tax-free return of capital up to the amount of the Common Shareholder’s tax basis in their Common Shares, which would reduce such tax basis, with any amounts exceeding such basis treated as a gain from the sale of their Common Shares. Consequently, although a return of capital may not be taxable, it will generally increase the Common Shareholder’s potential gain, or reduce the Common Shareholder’s potential loss, on any subsequent sale or other disposition of Common Shares.

To permit the Fund to maintain a more stable distribution rate, the Fund may distribute less or more than the income it earns on its investments in a particular period. Any undistributed income would be available to supplement future distributions and, until distributed, would add to the Fund’s net asset value. Correspondingly, such amounts, once distributed, will be deducted from the Fund’s net asset value. The Fund expects that over time it will distribute all of its investment company taxable income.

 

57


The Fund reserves the right to change its distribution policy and the basis for establishing the rate of distributions at any time and may do so without prior notice to Common Shareholders.

Payment of future distributions is subject to approval by the Fund’s Board of Trustees, as well as meeting the covenants of any outstanding Indebtedness or preferred shares and the asset coverage requirements of the 1940 Act.

DIVIDEND REINVESTMENT PLAN

Unless the registered owner of Common Shares elects to receive cash by contacting the Plan Agent, all distributions declared for your Common Shares of the Fund will be automatically reinvested by U.S. Bancorp Fund Services, LLC (the “Plan Agent”), agent for shareholders in administering the Fund’s Dividend reinvestment Plan (the “Plan”), in additional Common Shares of the Fund. If a registered owner of Common Shares elects not to participate in the Plan, you will receive all distributions in cash paid by check mailed directly to you (or, if the shares are held in street or other nominee name, then to such nominee) by the Plan Agent, as distribution disbursing agent. You may elect not to participate in the Plan and to receive all distributions in cash by sending written instructions or by contacting the Plan Agent, as distribution disbursing agent, at the address set out below. Participation in the Plan is completely voluntary and may be terminated or resumed at any time without penalty by contacting the Plan Agent before the distribution record date; otherwise such termination or resumption will be effective with respect to any subsequently declared distribution. Some brokers may automatically elect to receive cash on your behalf and may reinvest that cash in additional Common Shares of the Fund for you.

Whenever the Fund declares a distribution payable in cash, non-participants in the Plan will receive cash and participants in the Plan will receive the equivalent in Common Shares. The Common Shares will be acquired by the Plan Agent for the participants’ accounts, depending upon the circumstances described below, either (i) through receipt of additional unissued but authorized Common Shares from the Fund (“newly-issued Common Shares”) or (ii) by purchase of outstanding Common Shares on the open market (“open-market purchases”) on the New York Stock Exchange or elsewhere.

If, on the payment date for any distribution, the market price per Common Share plus estimated brokerage commissions is greater than the net asset value per Common Share (such condition being referred to in this Prospectus as “market premium”), the Plan Agent will invest the distribution amount in newly-issued Common Shares, including fractions, on behalf of the participants. The number of newly-issued Common Shares to be credited to each participant’s account will be determined by dividing the dollar amount of the distribution by the net asset value per Common Share on the payment date; provided that, if the net asset value per Common Share is less than 95% of the market price per Common Share on the payment date, the dollar amount of the distribution will be divided by 95% of the market price per Common Share on the payment date.

If, on the payment date for any distribution, the net asset value per Common Share is greater than the market value per Common Share plus estimated brokerage commissions (such condition being referred to in this Prospectus as “market discount”), the Plan Agent will invest the distribution amount in Common Shares acquired on behalf of the participants in open-market purchases.

In the event of a market discount on the payment date for any distribution, the Plan Agent will have until the last business day before the next date on which the Common Shares trade on an “ex-distribution” basis or 120 days after the payment date for such distribution, whichever is sooner (the “last purchase date”), to invest the distribution amount in Common Shares acquired in open-market purchases. The period during which open-market purchases can be made will exist only from the payment date of each distribution through the date before the “ex-distribution” date of the following distribution. If, before the Plan Agent has completed its open-market purchases, the market price of a Common Share exceeds the net asset value per Common Share, the average per Common Share purchase price paid by the Plan Agent may exceed the net asset value of the Common Shares, resulting in the acquisition of fewer Common Shares than if the distribution had been paid in newly-issued Common Shares on the distribution payment date. Because of the foregoing difficulty with respect to open market purchases, if the Plan Agent is unable to invest the full distribution amount in open market purchases during the purchase period or if the market discount shifts to a market premium during the purchase period, the Plan Agent may cease making open-market purchases and may invest the uninvested portion of the distribution amount in newly-issued Common Shares at the net asset value per Common Share at the close of business on the last purchase date; provided that, if the net asset value per Common Share is less than 95% of the market price per Common Share on the payment date, the dollar amount of the distribution will be divided by 95% of the market price per Common Share on the payment date.

 

58


The Plan Agent maintains all shareholders’ accounts in the Plan and furnishes written confirmation of all transactions in the accounts, including information needed by shareholders for tax records. Common Shares in the account of each Plan participant will be held by the Plan Agent on behalf of the Plan participant, and each shareholder proxy will include those shares purchased or received pursuant to the Plan. The Plan Agent or its designee will forward all proxy solicitation materials to participants and vote proxies for shares held under the Plan in accordance with the instructions of the participants.

In the case of shareholders such as banks, brokers or nominees which hold shares for others who are the beneficial owners, the Plan Agent will administer the Plan on the basis of the number of Common Shares certified from time to time by the record shareholder’s name and held for the account of beneficial owners who participate in the Plan.

There will be no brokerage charges with respect to Common Shares issued directly by the Fund. However, each participant will pay a pro rata share of brokerage commissions incurred in connection with open-market purchases. The automatic reinvestment of distributions will not relieve participants of any federal, state or local income tax that may be payable (or required to be withheld) on such distributions. Accordingly, any taxable distribution received by a participant that is reinvested in additional Common Shares will be subject to federal (and possibly state and local) income tax even though such participant will not receive a corresponding amount of cash with which to pay such taxes. See “U.S. Federal Income Tax Considerations.”

The Fund reserves the right to amend or terminate the Plan. There is no direct service charge to participants in the Plan; however, the Fund reserves the right to amend the Plan to include a service charge payable by the participants.

For more information about the Plan you may contact the Plan Agent in writing at PO Box 708, Milwaukee, Wisconsin 53201-0701, or by calling the Plan Agent.

DESCRIPTION OF SHARES

The following is a brief description of the terms of the securities which may be issued by the Fund. This description does not purport to be complete and is qualified by reference to the Fund’s governing documents. The Fund is a statutory trust organized under the laws of Delaware pursuant to a Certificate of Trust dated November 17, 2010, as filed with the State of Delaware on November 17, 2010 and as amended through the date hereof.

Common Shares

The Fund is authorized to issue an unlimited number of Common Shares of beneficial interest, par value $0.001 per share. Each Common Share has one vote and, when issued and paid for in accordance with the terms of this offering, will be fully paid and non-assessable, except that the Board of Trustees will have the power to cause shareholders to pay expenses of the Fund by setting off charges due from shareholders from declared but unpaid distributions owed the shareholders and/or by reducing the number of Common Shares owned by each respective shareholder. The Fund currently is not aware of any expenses that will be paid pursuant to this provision, except to the extent fees payable under its Dividend reinvestment Plan are deemed to be paid pursuant to this provision.

The Fund intends to hold annual meetings of shareholders so long as the Common Shares are listed on a national securities exchange and such meetings are required as a condition to such listing. All Common Shares are equal as to distributions, assets and voting privileges and have no conversion, preemptive or other subscription rights. The Fund will send annual and semi-annual reports, including financial statements, to all holders of its shares.

Unlike open-end funds, closed-end funds like the Fund do not continuously offer shares and do not provide daily redemptions. Rather, if a shareholder determines to buy additional Common Shares or sell shares already held, the shareholder may do so by trading through a broker on the NYSE or otherwise. Shares of closed-end funds frequently trade on an exchange at prices lower than net asset value. Because the market value of the Common Shares may be influenced by such factors as distribution levels (which are in turn affected by expenses), distribution stability, net asset value, relative demand for and supply of such shares in the market, general market and economic conditions and other factors beyond the control of the Fund, the Fund cannot assure you that Common Shares will trade at a price equal to or higher than net asset value in the future. The Common Shares are designed primarily for long-term investors, and you should not purchase the Common Shares if you intend to sell them soon after purchase.

 

59


Issuance of Additional Common Shares. The provisions of the 1940 Act generally require that the public offering price (less underwriting commissions and discounts) of common shares sold by a closed-end investment company must equal or exceed the net asset value of such company’s common shares (calculated within 48 hours of the pricing of such offering), unless such sale is made with the consent of a majority of its common shareholders. The Fund may, from time to time, seek the consent of Common Shareholders to permit the issuance and sale by the Fund of Common Shares at a price below the Fund’s then-current net asset value, subject to certain conditions. If such consent is obtained, the Fund may, contemporaneous with and in no event more than one year following the receipt of such consent, sell Common Shares at price below net asset value in accordance with any conditions adopted in connection with the giving of such consent. Additional information regarding any consent of Common Shareholders obtained by the Fund and the applicable conditions imposed on the issuance and sale by the Fund of Common Shares at a price below net asset value will be disclosed in the Prospectus Supplement relating to any such offering of Common Shares at a price below net asset value. Until such consent of Common Shareholders, if any, is obtained, the Fund may not sell Common Shares at a price below net asset value. Because the Fund’s advisory fee is based upon average Managed Assets, the Investment Adviser’s interest in recommending the issuance and sale of Common Shares at a price below net asset value may conflict with the interests of the Fund and its Common Shareholders.

Subscription Rights to Purchase Common Shares

The Fund may issue subscription rights to holders of Common Shares to purchase Common Shares. Subscription rights may be issued independently or together with any other offered security and may or may not be transferable by the person purchasing or receiving the subscription rights. In connection with a subscription rights offering to holders of Common Shares, the Fund would distribute certificates evidencing the subscription rights and a Prospectus Supplement to our common or preferred shareholders as of the record date that we set for determining the shareholders eligible to receive subscription rights in such subscription rights offering. For complete terms of the subscription rights, please refer to the actual terms of such subscription rights which will be set forth in the subscription rights agreement relating to such subscription rights (the “Subscription Rights Agreement”).

The applicable Prospectus Supplement would describe the following terms of subscription rights in respect of which this Prospectus is being delivered:

 

    the period of time the offering would remain open (which will be open a minimum number of days such that all record holders would be eligible to participate in the offering and will not be open longer than 120 days);

 

    the exercise price for such subscription rights (or method of calculation thereof);

 

    the number of such subscription rights issued in respect of each Common Share;

 

    the extent to which such subscription rights are transferable and the market on which they may be traded if they are transferable;

 

    if applicable, a discussion of the material U.S. federal income tax considerations applicable to the issuance or exercise of such subscription rights;

 

    the date on which the right to exercise such subscription rights will commence, and the date on which such right will expire (subject to any extension);

 

    the extent to which such subscription rights include an over-subscription privilege with respect to unsubscribed securities and the terms of such over-subscription privilege;

 

    any termination right the Fund may have in connection with such subscription rights offering;

 

    the expected trading market, if any, for rights; and

 

60


    any other terms of such subscription rights, including exercise, settlement and other procedures and limitations relating to the transfer and exercise of such subscription rights.

Exercise of Subscription Rights. Each subscription right would entitle the holder of the subscription right to purchase for cash such number of shares at such exercise price as in each case is set forth in, or be determinable as set forth in the Prospectus Supplement relating to the subscription rights offered thereby. Subscription rights would be exercisable at any time up to the close of business on the expiration date for such subscription rights set forth in the Prospectus Supplement. After the close of business on the expiration date, all unexercised subscription rights would become void.

Upon expiration of the rights offering and the receipt of payment and the subscription rights certificate properly completed and duly executed at the corporate trust office of the subscription rights agent or any other office indicated in the Prospectus Supplement, the Fund would issue, as soon as practicable, the Common Shares purchased as a result of such exercise. To the extent permissible under applicable law, the Fund may determine to offer any unsubscribed offered securities directly to persons other than shareholders, to or through agents, underwriters or dealers or through a combination of such methods, as set forth in the applicable Prospectus Supplement

Preferred Shares

The Fund’s Agreement and Declaration of Trust provides that the Board of Trustees may authorize and issue preferred shares with rights as determined by the Board of Trustees, by action of the Board of Trustees without the approval of the holders of the Common Shares. Holders of Common Shares have no preemptive right to purchase any preferred shares that might be issued pursuant to such provision. Whenever preferred shares are outstanding, the holders of Common Shares will not be entitled to receive any distributions from the Fund unless all accrued distributions on preferred shares have been paid, unless asset coverage (as defined in the 1940 Act) with respect to preferred shares would be at least 200% after giving effect to the distributions and unless certain other requirements imposed by any rating agencies rating the preferred shares have been met. If the Board of Trustees determines to proceed with such an offering, the terms of the preferred shares may be the same as, or different from, the terms described below, subject to applicable law and the Agreement and Declaration of Trust. The Board of Trustees, without the approval of the holders of Common Shares, may authorize an offering of preferred shares or may determine not to authorize such an offering and may fix the terms of the preferred shares to be offered. As of the date of this Prospectus, the Fund has not issued any preferred shares.

Distributions . Holders of preferred shares will be entitled to receive cash distributions, when, as and if authorized by the Board of Trustees and declared by the Fund, out of funds legally available therefor. The Prospectus Supplement for any offering of preferred shares will describe the distributions payment provisions for those shares. Distributions so declared and payable shall be paid to the extent permitted under Delaware law and to the extent available and in preference to and priority over any distribution declared and payable on the Common Shares.

Limitations on Distributions . So long as the Fund has Indebtedness outstanding, holders of preferred shares will not be entitled to receive any distributions unless asset coverage (as defined in the 1940 Act) with respect to outstanding Indebtedness would be at least 300% after giving effect to such distributions.

Liquidation Preference . In the event of any voluntary or involuntary liquidation, dissolution or winding up of the Fund, the holders of preferred shares will be entitled to receive a preferential liquidating distribution, which is expected to equal the original purchase price per preferred share plus accrued and unpaid distributions, whether or not declared, before any distribution of assets is made to holders of Common Shares. After payment of the full amount of the liquidating distribution to which they are entitled, the holders of preferred shares will not be entitled to any further participation in any distribution of assets by the Fund.

Voting Rights . The 1940 Act requires that the holders of any preferred shares, voting separately as a single class, have the right to elect at least two trustees at all times. The remaining trustees will be elected by holders of Common Shares and preferred shares, voting together as a single class. In addition, subject to the prior rights, if any, of the holders of any other class of senior securities outstanding, the holders of any preferred shares have the right to elect a majority of the trustees of the Fund at any time two years of distributions on any preferred shares are unpaid. The 1940 Act also requires that, in addition to any approval by shareholders that might otherwise be required, the approval of the holders of a majority of any outstanding preferred shares, voting separately as a class, would be

 

61


required to (i) adopt any plan of reorganization that would adversely affect the preferred shares, and (ii) take any action requiring a vote of security holders under Section 13(a) of the 1940 Act, including, among other things, changes in the Fund’s sub-classification as a closed-end fund or changes in its fundamental investment restrictions. As a result of these voting rights, the Fund’s ability to take any such actions may be impeded to the extent that there are any preferred shares outstanding.

Debt Securities

The Board of Trustees (subject to applicable law and the Agreement and Declaration of Trust) may authorize an offering, without the approval of the holders of either Common Shares or preferred shares, of other classes of shares, or other classes or series of shares, as they determine to be necessary, desirable or appropriate, having such terms, rights, preferences, privileges, limitations and restrictions as the Board of Trustees deems appropriate. The Fund currently does not expect to issue any other classes of shares, or series of shares, except for the Common Shares.

Under Delaware law and the Fund’s Agreement and Declaration of Trust, the Board of Trustees may cause the Fund to borrow money, without prior approval of holders of common and preferred stock to the extent permitted by the Fund’s investment restrictions and the 1940 Act. The Fund may issue debt securities or other evidence of Indebtedness (including bank borrowings or commercial paper) and may secure any such notes or borrowings by mortgaging, pledging or otherwise subjecting as security Fund assets to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act or rating agency guidelines. Any borrowings will rank senior to the preferred shares and the Common Shares.

Under the 1940 Act, the Fund may only issue one class of senior securities representing Indebtedness.

Limitations . Under the requirements of the 1940 Act the Fund, immediately after any issuance of debt securities, must have “asset coverage” of at least 300% ( i.e. for every dollar of Indebtedness outstanding, the Fund is required to have at least three dollars of assets). The issuance of debt securities also may result in the Fund being subject to covenants that may be more stringent than the restrictions imposed by the 1940 Act.

Voting Rights . Debt securities are not expected to have any voting rights, except to the extent required by law or as otherwise provided in any documents governing the debt securities. The 1940 Act does, in certain circumstances, grant to the lenders certain voting rights in the event of default in the payment of interest on or repayment of principal.

Capitalization

The following information regarding the Fund’s authorized shares is as of November 30, 2017:

 

Title of Class

   Amount
Authorized
   Amount Held by Fund
for its own Account
   Amount Outstanding
Exclusive of Amounts
held by Fund
 

Common Shares of Beneficial Interest

   Unlimited    None      5,853,857  

ANTI-TAKEOVER PROVISIONS IN THE AGREEMENT AND DECLARATION OF TRUST

The Agreement and Declaration of Trust includes provisions that could have the effect of limiting the ability of other entities or persons to acquire control of the Fund or to change the composition of its Board of Trustees. This could have the effect of depriving shareholders of an opportunity to sell their shares at a premium over prevailing market prices by discouraging a third party from seeking to obtain control over the Fund. Such attempts could have the effect of increasing the expenses of the Fund and disrupting the normal operation of the Fund. In addition, these ownership restrictions may reduce market demand for the Fund’s Common Shares, which could have the effect of increasing the likelihood that the Fund’s Common Shares trade at a discount to net asset value and increasing the amount of any such discount.

The Board of Trustees is divided into two classes, with the terms of one class expiring at each annual meeting of shareholders. At each annual meeting, one class of Trustees is elected to a two-year term. This provision could delay for up to two years the replacement of a majority of the Board of Trustees. A Trustee may be removed from office (with or without cause) by the action of a majority of the remaining Trustees followed by a vote of the holders of at least 75% of the shares then entitled to vote for the election of the respective Trustee.

 

62


In addition, the Agreement and Declaration of Trust requires the favorable vote of a majority of the Fund’s Board of Trustees followed by the favorable vote of the holders of at least 75% of the outstanding shares of each affected class or series of the Fund, voting separately as a class or series, to approve, adopt or authorize certain transactions with 5% or greater holders of a class or series of shares and their associates, unless the transaction has been approved by at least 75% of the Trustees, in which case “a majority of the outstanding voting securities” (as defined in the 1940 Act) of the Fund will be required. For purposes of these provisions, a 5% or greater holder of a class or series of shares (a “Principal Shareholder”) refers to any person who, whether directly or indirectly and whether alone or together with its affiliates and associates, beneficially owns 5% or more of the outstanding shares of all outstanding classes or series of shares of beneficial interest of the Fund.

The 5% holder transactions subject to these special approval requirements are: the merger or consolidation of the Fund or any subsidiary of the Fund with or into any Principal Shareholder; the issuance of any securities of the Fund to any Principal Shareholder for cash, except pursuant to any automatic dividend reinvestment plan; the sale, lease or exchange of any assets of the Fund to any Principal Shareholder, except assets having an aggregate fair market value of less than $1,000,000, aggregating for the purpose of such computation all assets sold, leased or exchanged in any series of similar transactions within a twelve-month period; or the sale, lease or exchange to the Fund or any subsidiary of the Fund, in exchange for securities of the Fund, of any assets of any Principal Shareholder, except assets having an aggregate fair market value of less than $1,000,000, aggregating for purposes of such computation all assets sold, leased or exchanged in any series of similar transactions within a twelve-month period.

The Fund’s Agreement and Declaration of Trust limits the ability of persons to beneficially own (within the meaning of Section 382 of the Code) more than 4.99% of the outstanding Common Shares of the Fund and could have an anti-takeover effect on the Fund, which could decrease the Fund’s market price in certain circumstances or limit the ability of certain shareholders to influence the management of the Fund. This restriction is intended to reduce the risk of the Fund undergoing an “ownership change” within the meaning of Section 382 of the Code, which would limit the Fund’s ability to use a capital loss carryforward and certain unrealized losses (if such tax attributes exist). In general, an ownership change occurs if 5% shareholders (and certain persons or groups treated as 5% shareholders) of the Fund increase their ownership percentage in the Fund by more than 50 percentage points in the aggregate within any three-year period ending on certain defined testing dates. If an ownership change were to occur, Section 382 would impose an annual limitation on the amount of post-ownership change gains that the Fund may offset with pre-ownership change losses, and might impose restrictions on the Fund’s ability to use certain unrealized losses existing at the time of the ownership change. Such a limitation arising under Section 382 could reduce the benefit of the Fund’s then existing capital loss carryforward or unrealized losses, if any.

To convert the Fund to an open-end investment company, the Agreement and Declaration of Trust requires the favorable vote of a majority of the board of the Trustees followed by the favorable vote of the holders of at least 75% of the outstanding shares of each affected class or series of shares of the Fund, voting separately as a class or series, unless such amendment has been approved by 75% of the Trustees, in which case “a majority of the outstanding voting securities” (as defined in the 1940 Act) of the Fund will be required. The foregoing vote would satisfy a separate requirement in the 1940 Act that any conversion of the Fund to an open-end investment company be approved by the shareholders.

For the purposes of calculating “a majority of the outstanding voting securities” under the Agreement and Declaration of Trust, each class and series of the Fund will vote together as a single class, except to the extent required by the 1940 Act or the Agreement and Declaration of Trust, with respect to any class or series of shares. If a separate class vote is required, the applicable proportion of shares of the class or series, voting as a separate class or series, also will be required.

The Agreement and Declaration of Trust also provides that the Fund may be dissolved and terminated upon the approval of 75% of the Trustees by written notice to the shareholders.

The Board of Trustees has determined that provisions with respect to the Board of Trustees and the shareholder voting requirements described above, which voting requirements are greater than the minimum requirements under Delaware law or the 1940 Act, are in the best interest of shareholders generally. Reference should be made to the Agreement and Declaration of Trust, on file with the SEC for the full text of these provisions.

 

63


CERTAIN PROVISIONS OF DELAWARE LAW, THE AGREEMENT AND DECLARATION OF TRUST AND BYLAWS

Classified Board of Trustees

The Fund’s Board of Trustees is divided into two classes of trustees serving staggered two-year terms. Upon expiration of their current terms, Trustees of each class will be elected to serve for two-year terms and until their successors are duly elected and qualified or the Fund terminates, and each year one class of Trustees will be elected by the shareholders. A classified board may render a change in control of the Fund or removal of the Fund’s incumbent management more difficult. The Fund believes, however, that the longer time required to elect a majority of a classified Board of Trustees will help to ensure the continuity and stability of its management and policies.

Election of Trustees

The Fund’s Agreement and Declaration of Trust provides that the affirmative vote of the holders of a plurality of the outstanding shares entitled to vote in the election of Trustees will be required to elect a Trustee.

Number of Trustees; Vacancies; Removal

The Fund’s Agreement and Declaration of Trust provides that the number of Trustees will be set by the Board of Trustees. The Fund’s Agreement and Declaration of Trust provides that a majority of the Fund’s Trustees then in office may at any time increase or decrease the number of Trustees provided there will be at least one Trustee. As soon as any such Trustee has accepted his appointment in writing, the trust estate will vest in the new Trustee, together with the continuing Trustees, without any further act or conveyance, and he will be deemed a Trustee thereunder. The Trustees’ power of appointment is subject to Section 16(a) of the 1940 Act. Whenever a vacancy in the number of Trustees will occur, until such vacancy is filled as provided, the Trustees in office, regardless of their number, will have all the powers granted to the Trustees and will discharge all the duties imposed upon the Trustees by the Declaration of Trust.

Action by Shareholders

Shareholder action can be taken only at an annual or special meeting of shareholders or by written consent in lieu of a meeting.

Advance Notice Provisions for Shareholder Nominations and Shareholder Proposals

The Fund’s Bylaws provide that with respect to an annual meeting of shareholders, nominations of persons for election to the Board of Trustees and the proposal of business to be considered by shareholders may be made only (1) pursuant to the Fund’s notice of the meeting, (2) by the Board of Trustees or (3) by a shareholder of record both at the time of giving of notice and at the time of the annual meeting who is entitled to vote at the meeting and who has complied with the advance notice procedures of the Bylaws. With respect to special meetings of shareholders, only the business specified in the Fund’s notice of the meeting may be brought before the meeting. Nominations of persons for election to the Board of Trustees at a special meeting may be made only (1) pursuant to the Fund’s notice of the meeting, (2) by the Board of Trustees or (3) provided that the Board of Trustees has determined that Trustees will be elected at the meeting, by a shareholder of record both at the time of giving of notice and at the time of the annual meeting who is entitled to vote at the meeting and who has complied with the advance notice provisions of the Bylaws.

Calling of Special Meetings of Shareholders

The Fund’s Bylaws provide that special meetings of shareholders may be called at any time by the Chairman, the President or the Trustees. By following certain procedures, a special meeting of shareholders will also be called by the Secretary of the Fund upon the written request of the Common Shareholders entitled to cast not less than a majority of all the votes entitled to be cast at such meeting.

 

64


CLOSED-END FUND STRUCTURE

Closed-end funds differ from open-end management investment companies (commonly referred to as “mutual funds”). Closed-end funds generally list their shares for trading on a securities exchange and do not redeem their shares at the option of the shareholder. In contrast, mutual funds issue securities redeemable at net asset value at the option of the shareholder and typically engage in a continuous offering of their shares. Although mutual funds are subject to continuous asset in-flows and out-flows that can complicate portfolio management, closed-end funds generally can stay more fully invested in securities consistent with the closed-end fund’s investment objective and policies. Accordingly, closed-end funds have greater flexibility than open-end funds to make certain types of investments, including investments in illiquid securities.

Shares of closed-end funds listed for trading on a securities exchange frequently trade at discounts to their net asset value, but in some cases trade at a premium. The market price may be affected by net asset value, distribution levels (which are dependent, in part, on expenses), supply of and demand for the shares, stability of distributions, trading volume of the shares, general market and economic conditions and other factors beyond the control of the closed-end fund. The foregoing factors may result in the market price of the Fund’s Common Shares being greater than, less than or equal to net asset value. The Board of Trustees has reviewed the Fund’s structure in light of its investment objective and policies and has determined that the closed-end structure is in the best interests of the Fund’s shareholders. However, the Board of Trustees may periodically review the trading range and activity of the Fund’s shares with respect to their net asset value and may take certain actions to seek to reduce or eliminate any such discount. Such actions may include open market repurchases or tender offers for the Fund’s Common Shares at net asset value or the Fund’s possible conversion to an open-end mutual fund. There can be no assurance that the Board of Trustees will decide to undertake any of these actions or that, if undertaken, such actions would result in the Fund’s Common Shares trading at a price equal to or close to net asset value per share of its Common Shares.

To convert the Fund to an open-end investment company, the Agreement and Declaration of Trust requires the favorable vote of a majority of the board of the Trustees followed by the favorable vote of the holders of at least 75% of the outstanding shares of each affected class or series of shares of the Fund, voting separately as a class or series, unless such amendment has been approved by 75% of the Trustees, in which case “a majority of the outstanding voting securities” (as defined in the 1940 Act) of the Fund will be required. The foregoing vote would satisfy a separate requirement in the 1940 Act that any conversion of the Fund to an open-end investment company be approved by the shareholders. Following any such conversion, it is possible that certain of the Fund’s investment policies and strategies would have to be modified to assure sufficient portfolio liquidity. In the event of conversion, the Fund would be required to redeem any preferred shares then outstanding (requiring in turn that it liquidate a portion of its investment portfolio) and the Common Shares would cease to be listed on the New York Stock Exchange or other national securities exchanges or market systems. Shareholders of an open-end investment company may require the investment company to redeem their shares at any time (except in certain circumstances as authorized by or permitted under the 1940 Act) at their net asset value, less such redemption charge, if any, as might be in effect at the time of redemption. In order to avoid maintaining large cash positions or liquidating favorable investments to meet redemptions, open-end investment companies typically engage in a continuous offering of their shares. Open-end investment companies are thus subject to periodic asset in-flows and out-flows that can complicate portfolio management. The Fund’s Board of Trustees may at any time propose the Fund’s conversion to open-end status, depending upon its judgment regarding the advisability of such action in light of circumstances then prevailing. However, based on the determination of the Board of Trustees in connection with this initial offering of the Fund’s Common Shares that the closed-end structure is desirable in light of the Fund’s investment objective and policies, it is highly unlikely that the Board of Trustees would vote to convert the Fund to an open-end investment company.

REPURCHASE OF COMMON SHARES

In recognition of the possibility that the Fund’s Common Shares might trade at a discount to net asset value and that any such discount may not be in the interest of the Fund’s Common Shareholders, the Board of Trustees, in consultation with the Investment Adviser, from time to time may, but is not required to, review possible actions to reduce any such discount. The Board of Trustees also may, but is not required to, consider from time to time open market repurchases of and/or tender offers for the Fund’s Common Shares, as well as other potential actions, to seek to reduce any market discount from net asset value that may develop. After any consideration of potential actions to seek to reduce any significant market discount, the Board of Trustees may, subject to its applicable duties and

 

65


compliance with applicable U.S. state and federal laws, authorize the commencement of a share-repurchase program or tender offer. The size and timing of any such share repurchase program or tender offer will be determined by the Board of Trustees in light of the market discount of the Fund’s Common Shares, trading volume of the Fund’s Common Shares, information presented to the Board of Trustees regarding the potential impact of any such share repurchase program or tender offer, general market and economic conditions and applicable law. There can be no assurance that the Fund will in fact effect repurchases of or tender offers for any of its Common Shares. The Fund may, subject to its investment limitation with respect to borrowings, incur debt to finance such repurchases or a tender offer or for other valid purposes. Interest on any such borrowings would increase the Fund’s expenses and reduce its net income.

There can be no assurance that repurchases of the Fund’s Common Shares or tender offers, if any, will cause its Common Shares to trade at a price equal to or in excess of their net asset value. Nevertheless, the possibility that a portion of the Fund’s outstanding Common Shares may be the subject of repurchases or tender offers may reduce the spread between market price and net asset value that might otherwise exist. Sellers may be less inclined to accept a significant discount in the sale of their Common Shares if they have a reasonable expectation of being able to receive a price of net asset value for a portion of their Common Shares in conjunction with an announced repurchase program or tender offer for the Fund’s Common Shares.

Although the Board of Trustees believes that repurchases or tender offers generally would have a favorable effect on the market price of the Fund’s Common Shares, the acquisition of Common Shares by the Fund will decrease its total assets and therefore will have the effect of increasing its expense ratio and decreasing the asset coverage with respect to any preferred shares outstanding. Because of the nature of the Fund’s investment objective, policies and portfolio, particularly its investment in illiquid or otherwise restricted securities, it is possible that repurchases of Common Shares or tender offers could interfere with the Fund’s ability to manage its investments in order to seek its investment objective. Further, it is possible that the Fund could experience difficulty in borrowing money or be required to dispose of portfolio securities to consummate repurchases of or tender offers for Common Shares.

U.S. FEDERAL INCOME TAX CONSIDERATIONS

The following is a discussion of a summary of the U.S. federal income tax considerations generally applicable to the acquisition, ownership and disposition of Common Shares of the Fund. This discussion is based upon current provisions of the Code, the Treasury regulations promulgated thereunder and judicial and administrative authorities, all of which are subject to change or differing interpretations by the courts or the IRS, possibly with retroactive effect. This discussion does not address any other U.S. federal tax considerations (such as estate, gift, or net investment taxes) or any state, local or non-U.S. tax considerations. Except as otherwise stated herein, no ruling has been or will be sought from the IRS regarding any matter discussed herein. The Fund’s counsel has not rendered any legal opinion regarding any tax consequences relating to the Fund or an investment in the Fund. No assurance can be given that the IRS would not assert, or that a court would not sustain, a position different from any of the tax aspects set forth below. This discussion assumes that Common Shareholder’s hold their Common Shares as capital assets for U.S. federal income tax purposes (generally, assets held for investment). No attempt is made to present a detailed explanation of all U.S. federal, state, local and foreign tax concerns affecting the Fund and its Common Shareholders (including Common Shareholders subject to special provisions of the Code). The discussion set forth herein does not constitute tax advice. Investors are urged to consult their own tax advisors to determine the tax consequences to them of investing in the Fund.

The Fund has elected to be taxed as, and intends to continue to qualify each year for special tax treatment afforded to, a regulated investment company (“RIC”) under Subchapter M of the Code. In order to qualify as a RIC, the Fund must, among other things, satisfy certain income, asset diversification and distribution requirements. As long as it so qualifies, the Fund will not be subject to U.S. federal income tax to the extent that it distributes annually its investment company taxable income (which includes ordinary income and the excess of net short-term capital gain over net long-term capital loss) and its “net capital gain” ( i.e. , the excess of net long-term capital gain over net short-term capital loss). The Fund intends to distribute at least annually substantially all of such income and gain. If the Fund retains any investment company taxable income or net capital gain, it will be subject to U.S. federal income tax on the retained amount at regular corporate tax rates. In addition, if the Fund fails to qualify as a RIC for any taxable year and relief is not available, it will be subject to U.S. federal income tax on all of its income and gains at regular corporate tax rates.

 

66


Distributions paid to you by the Fund from its investment company taxable income are generally taxable to you as ordinary income to the extent of the Fund’s current and accumulated earnings and profits. Certain properly designated distributions may, however, qualify (provided that holding period and other requirements are met by both the Fund and the Common Shareholder) (i) for the distributions received deduction in the case of corporate Common Shareholders to the extent that the Fund’s income consists of distribution income from U.S. corporations or (ii) in the case of individual Common Shareholders, as qualified distribution income eligible to be taxed at a reduced maximum rate to the extent that the Fund receives qualified distribution income. Qualified distribution income is, in general, distribution income from taxable domestic corporations and certain foreign corporations. There can be no assurance as to what portion of the Fund’s distributions will qualify for the distributions received deduction or for treatment as qualified distribution income.

Distributions made to you from an excess of net long-term capital gain over net short-term capital loss (“capital gain distributions”), including capital gain distributions credited to you but retained by the Fund, are taxable to you as long-term capital gains if they have been properly reported by the Fund, regardless of the length of time you have owned Common Shares. For individuals, long-term capital gains are generally taxed at a reduced maximum rate.

If, for any calendar year, the Fund’s total distributions exceed both the current taxable year’s earnings and profits and accumulated earnings and profits from prior years, the excess will generally be treated as a tax-free return of capital up to the amount of a Common Shareholder’s tax basis in the Common Shares, reducing that basis accordingly. Such distributions exceeding the Common Shareholder’s basis will be treated as gain from the sale or exchange of the Common Shares. When you sell your Common Shares, the amount, if any, by which your sales price exceeds your basis in the Common Shares is gain subject to tax. Because a return of capital reduces your basis in the Common Shares, it will increase the amount of your gain or decrease the amount of your loss when you sell the Common Shares. Generally, after the end of each year, you will be provided with a written notice designating the amount of ordinary distribution income, capital gain distributions and other distributions (if relevant).

The sale or other disposition of Common Shares will generally result in capital gain or loss to you which will be long-term capital gain or loss if the Common Shares have been held for more than one year at the time of sale. Any loss upon the sale or exchange of Common Shares held for six months or less will be treated as long-term capital loss to the extent of any capital gain distributions received by you (including amounts credited to you as an undistributed capital gain distribution). Any loss realized on a sale or exchange of Common Shares will be disallowed if other substantially identical shares are acquired (whether through the automatic reinvestment of distributions or otherwise) within a 61-day period beginning 30 days before and ending 30 days after the date of disposition of Common Shares. In such case, the basis of the Common Shares acquired will be adjusted to reflect the disallowed loss. Present law taxes both long-term and short-term capital gain of corporations at the rates applicable to ordinary income. For non-corporate taxpayers, under current law short-term capital gain is taxed at the U.S. federal income tax rates applicable to ordinary income, while long-term capital gain generally is taxed at a reduced maximum U.S. federal income tax rate.

Dividends and other taxable distributions are taxable to Common Shareholders. If the Fund pays you a distribution in January that was declared in the previous October, November or December to Common Shareholders of record on a specified date in one of such months, then such distribution will be treated for tax purposes as being paid by the Fund and received by you on December 31 of the year in which the distribution was declared.

The Fund may be required to withhold, for U.S. federal backup withholding purposes, on all taxable distributions to any non-corporate holders of the Common Shares who (1) do not furnish the Fund with their correct taxpayer identification number (in the case of individuals, generally their social security number) or a certificate that such Common Shareholder is exempt from withholding, or (2) with respect to whom the IRS notifies the Fund that such Common Shareholder has failed to properly report certain interest and dividend income to the IRS and to respond to notices to that effect. Backup withholding is not an additional tax. Any amounts withheld from payments made to you may be refunded or credited against your U.S. federal income tax liability, if any, provided that the required information is timely furnished to the IRS. In addition, the Fund may be required to withhold on distributions to non-U.S. shareholders.

The foregoing is a general and abbreviated summary of the provisions of the Code and the Treasury regulations in effect as they directly govern the taxation of the Fund and its Common Shareholders. These provisions are subject to change by legislative, judicial or administrative action, and any such change may be

 

67


retroactive. A more complete discussion of the tax rules applicable to the Fund and its Common Sareholders can be found in the SAI that is incorporated by reference into this Prospectus. Investors are urged to consult their tax advisors regarding the U.S. federal, foreign, state and local tax consequences of investing in the Fund.

 

68


PLAN OF DISTRIBUTION

The Fund may sell up to $         in aggregate initial offering price of Common Shares or Rights from time to time under this Prospectus and any related Prospectus Supplement (1) directly to one or more purchases, including existing shareholders in a Rights offering; (2) through agents; (3) through underwriters; (4) through dealers; or (5) pursuant to the Plan. Each Prospectus Supplement relating to an offering of securities will state the terms of the offering, including:

 

    the names of any agents, underwriters or dealers;

 

    any sales loads or other items constituting underwriters’ compensation;

 

    any discounts, commissions, or fees allowed or paid to dealers or agents;

 

    the public offering or purchase price of the offered Securities and the net proceeds the Fund will receive from the sale; and

 

    any securities exchange on which the offered Securities may be listed.

In the case of a Rights offering, the applicable Prospectus Supplement will set forth the number of Common Shares issuable upon the exercise of each right and the other terms of such rights offering.

Direct Sales

The Fund may sell Securities directly to, and solicit offers from, institutional investors or others who may be deemed to be underwriters as defined in the Securities Act for any resales of the securities. In this case, no underwriters or agents would be involved. The Fund may use electronic media, including the Internet, to sell offered securities directly. The Fund will describe the terms of any of those sales in a Prospectus Supplement.

By Agents

The Fund may offer Securities through agents that the Fund may designate. The Fund will name any agent involved in the offer and sale and describe any commissions payable by the Fund in the Prospectus Supplement. Unless otherwise indicated in the Prospectus Supplement, the agents will be acting on a best efforts basis for the period of their appointment.

By Underwriters

The Fund may offer and sell Securities from time to time to one or more underwriters who would purchase the Securities as principal for resale to the public, either on a firm commitment or best efforts basis. If the Fund sells Securities to underwriters, the Fund will execute an underwriting agreement with them at the time of the sale and will name them in the Prospectus Supplement. In connection with these sales, the underwriters may be deemed to have received compensation from the Fund in the form of underwriting discounts and commissions. The underwriters also may receive commissions from purchasers of Securities for whom they may act as agent. Unless otherwise stated in the Prospectus Supplement, the underwriters will not be obligated to purchase the Securities unless the conditions set forth in the underwriting agreement are satisfied, and if the underwriters purchase any of the Securities, they will be required to purchase all of the offered Securities. The underwriters may sell the offered Securities to or through dealers, and those dealers may receive discounts, concessions or commissions from the underwriters as well as from the purchasers for whom they may act as agent. Any public offering price and any discounts or concessions allowed or reallowed or paid to dealers may be changed from time to time.

In connection with an offering of Common Shares, if a Prospectus Supplement so indicates, the Fund may grant the underwriters an option to purchase additional Common Shares at the public offering price, less the underwriting discounts and commissions, within 45 days from the date of the Prospectus Supplement, to cover any overallotments.

 

69


By Dealers

The Fund may offer and sell Securities from time to time to one or more dealers who would purchase the securities as principal. The dealers then may resell the offered Securities to the public at fixed or varying prices to be determined by those dealers at the time of resale. The Fund will set forth the names of the dealers and the terms of the transaction in the Prospectus Supplement.

General Information

Agents, underwriters, or dealers participating in an offering of Securities may be deemed to be underwriters, and any discounts and commission received by them and any profit realized by them on resale of the offered Securities for whom they act as agent, may be deemed to be underwriting discounts and commissions under the Securities Act.

The Fund may offer to sell securities either at a fixed price or at prices that may vary, at market prices prevailing at the time of sale, at prices related to prevailing market prices or at negotiated prices.

To facilitate an offering of Common Shares in an underwritten transaction and in accordance with industry practice, the underwriters may engage in transactions that stabilize, maintain, or otherwise affect the market price of the Common Shares or any other Security. Those transactions may include overallotment, entering stabilizing bids, effecting syndicate covering transactions, and reclaiming selling concessions allowed to an underwriter or a dealer.

 

    An overallotment in connection with an offering creates a short position in the common stock for the underwriter’s own account.

 

    An underwriter may place a stabilizing bid to purchase the Common Shares for the purpose of pegging, fixing, or maintaining the price of the Common Shares.

 

    Underwriters may engage in syndicate covering transactions to cover overallotments or to stabilize the price of the Common Shares by bidding for, and purchasing, the Common Shares or any other Securities in the open market in order to reduce a short position created in connection with the offering.

 

    The managing underwriter may impose a penalty bid on a syndicate member to reclaim a selling concession in connection with an offering when the Common Shares originally sold by the syndicate member is purchased in syndicate covering transactions or otherwise.

Any of these activities may stabilize or maintain the market price of the Securities above independent market levels. The underwriters are not required to engage in these activities, and may end any of these activities at any time.

In connection with any Rights offering, the Fund may also enter into a standby underwriting arrangement with one or more underwriters pursuant to which the underwriter(s) will purchase Common Shares remaining unsubscribed for after the Rights offering.

Any underwriters to whom the offered Securities are sold for offering and sale may make a market in the offered Securities, but the underwriters will not be obligated to do so and may discontinue any market-making at any time without notice. There can be no assurance that there will be a liquid trading market for the offered Securities.

Under agreements entered into with the Fund, underwriters and agents may be entitled to indemnification by the Fund and the Investment Adviser against certain civil liabilities, including liabilities under the Securities Act, or to contribution for payments the underwriters or agents may be required to make.

The underwriters, agents, and their affiliates may engage in financial or other business transactions with the Fund in the ordinary course of business.

Pursuant to a requirement of the Financial Industry Regulatory Authority, Inc., or FINRA, the maximum compensation to be received by any FINRA member or independent broker-dealer may not be greater than eight percent (8%) of the gross proceeds received by the Fund for the sale of any securities being registered pursuant to SEC Rule 415 under the Securities Act.

 

70


The aggregate offering price specified on the cover of this Prospectus relates to the offering of the Securities not yet issued as of the date of this Prospectus.

To the extent permitted under the 1940 Act and the rules and regulations promulgated thereunder, the underwriters may from time to time act as a broker or dealer and receive fees in connection with the execution of portfolio transactions on behalf of the Fund after the underwriters have ceased to be underwriters and, subject to certain restrictions, each may act as a broker while it is an underwriter.

A Prospectus and accompanying Prospectus Supplement in electronic form may be made available on the websites maintained by underwriters. The underwriters may agree to allocate a number of Securities for sale to their online brokerage account holders. Such allocations of Securities for internet distributions will be made on the same basis as other allocations. In addition, Securities may be sold by the underwriters to securities dealers who resell Securities to online brokerage account holders.

OTHER SERVICE PROVIDERS

U.S. Bancorp Fund Services, LLC, located at 615 East Michigan Street, Milwaukee, Wisconsin 53202, has entered into a transfer agent servicing agreement with the Fund. Under this agreement, U.S. Bancorp Fund Services, LLC serves as the Fund’s transfer agent, registrar and distribution disbursing agent.

U.S. Bank National Association, which is located at 1555 N. Riveright Dr., Suite 302, Milwaukee, Wisconsin 53212, acts as custodian of the Fund’s securities and other assets.

U.S. Bancorp Fund Services LLC, the Administrator, which is located at 615 East Michigan Street, Milwaukee, Wisconsin 53202, serves as the Fund’s administrator pursuant to a fund administration servicing agreement. Pursuant to this agreement, the Administrator provides the Fund with, among other things, compliance oversight, financial reporting oversight and tax reporting. The Administrator acts as the Fund’s fund accountant. The Administrator will assist in the calculation of the Fund’s net asset value. The Administrator will also maintain and keep current the accounts, books, records and other documents relating to the Fund’s financial and portfolio transactions.

LEGAL MATTERS

Certain legal matters will be passed on for the Fund by Skadden, Arps, Slate, Meagher & Flom LLP, Chicago, Illinois.

INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

Ernst & Young LLP, Dallas, Texas, is the independent registered public accounting firm of the Fund and is expected to render an opinion annually on the financial statements of the Fund.

ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

The Fund is subject to the informational requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 and the 1940 Act and in accordance with those requirements is required to file reports, proxy statements and other information with the Securities and Exchange Commission. Any such reports and other information, including the Fund and Investment Adviser’s code of ethics, can be inspected and copied at the Securities and Exchange Commission’s Public Reference Room, Washington, D.C. 20549-0102. Information on the operation of such public reference facilities may be obtained by calling the Securities and Exchange Commission at (202) 551-8090. Copies of such materials can be obtained from the Securities and Exchange Commission’s Public Reference Room, at prescribed rates, or by electronic request at publicinfo@sec.gov . The Securities and Exchange Commission maintains a website at www.sec.gov containing reports and information statements and other information regarding registrants, including the Fund, that file electronically with the Securities and Exchange Commission. Reports, proxy statements and other information concerning the Fund can also be inspected at the offices of the New York Stock Exchange, 20 Broad Street, New York, New York 10005. Copies of the Fund’s annual and semi-annual reports may be obtained, without charge, upon request mailed to The Cushing ® Renaissance Fund, c/o Cushing ® Asset Management, LP, 8117 Preston Road, Suite 440, Dallas, Texas 75225 or by calling toll free at (888) 777-2346 and also are made available

 

71


on the Fund’s website at www.cushingcef.com . You may also call this toll-free telephone number to request other information about the Fund or to make shareholder inquiries. Information on, or accessible through, the Fund’s website is not a part of, and is not incorporated into, this Prospectus.

Additional information regarding the Fund is contained in the registration statement on Form N-2, including the SAI and amendments, exhibits and schedules to the registration statement relating to such shares filed by the Fund with the Securities and Exchange Commission in Washington, D.C. This Prospectus does not contain all of the information set out in the registration statement, including the SAI and any amendments, exhibits and schedules to the registration statement. For further information with respect to the Fund and the Common Shares offered hereby, reference is made to the registration statement and the SAI. Statements contained in this Prospectus as to the contents of any contract or other document referred to are not necessarily complete and in each instance reference is made to the copy of such contract or other document filed as an exhibit to the registration statement, each such statement being qualified in all respects by such reference. A copy of the registration statement and the SAI may be inspected without charge at the Securities and Exchange Commission’s principal office in Washington, D.C., and copies of all or any part of the registration statement may be obtained from the Securities and Exchange Commission upon the payment of certain fees prescribed by the Securities and Exchange Commission.

You may request a free copy of the Statement of Additional Information, the table of contents of which is on page 74 of this Prospectus, by calling toll-free at (888) 777-2346, or you may obtain a copy (and other information regarding the Fund) from the SEC’s website (http://www.sec.gov). The SAI is incorporated by reference in its entirety into this Prospectus.

 

72


PRIVACY POLICY

In order to conduct its business, the Fund collects and maintains certain nonpublic personal information about its shareholders with respect to their transactions in shares of the Fund. This information includes:

 

    information the Fund receives from you on or in applications or other forms, correspondence, or conversations, including, but not limited to, your name, address, phone number, social security number, assets, income and date of birth; and

 

    information about your transactions with the Fund, its affiliates or others, including, but not limited to, your account number and balance, payment history, parties to transactions, cost basis information and other financial information.

The Fund does not disclose any nonpublic personal information about you, the Fund’s other shareholders or the Fund’s former shareholders to third parties unless necessary to process a transaction, service an account, or as otherwise permitted by law. To protect your personal information internally, the Fund restricts access to nonpublic personal information about the Fund’s shareholders to those employees who need to know that information to provide services to the Fund’s shareholders. The Fund also maintains certain other safeguards to protect your nonpublic personal information.

In the event that you hold shares of the Fund through a financial intermediary, including, but not limited to, a broker-dealer, bank or trust company, the privacy policy of your financial intermediary would govern how your non-public personal information would be shared with nonaffiliated third parties.

 

73


TABLE OF CONTENTS OF THE STATEMENT OF ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

The Fund

     S-1  

Investment Strategies and Risks

     S-1  

Strategic Transactions

     S-4  

Investment Restrictions

     S-14  

Management of the Fund

     S-15  

Portfolio Management

     S-21  

Investment Management Agreement

     S-22  

Portfolio Transactions and Brokerage

     S-23  

U.S. Federal Income Tax Considerations

     S-24  

Service Providers

     S-30  

General Information

     S-31  

Financial Statements

     S-32  

 

74


 

 

 

LOGO

$        

The Cushing ® Renaissance Fund

Common Shares

Subscription Rights for Common Shares

 

 

 


The information in this Statement of Additional Information is not complete and may be changed. The Fund may not sell these securities until the registration statement filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission is effective. This Statement of Additional Information is not an offer to sell these securities and is not soliciting an offer to buy these securities in any state where the offer or sale is not permitted.

 

Subject to Completion, dated December 29, 2017

 

LOGO

$        

The Cushing ® Renaissance Fund

Common Shares

Subscription Rights for Common Shares

Statement of Additional Information

 

 

The Cushing ® Renaissance Fund (the “Fund”) was formed as a Delaware statutory trust on November 17, 2010 and is a non-diversified, closed-end management investment company. The Fund’s investment objective is to seek high total return with an emphasis on current income. No assurance can be given that the Fund’s investment objective will be achieved.

This Statement of Additional Information (“SAI”) is not a prospectus, but should be read in conjunction with the prospectus for the Fund dated            , 2018 (the “Prospectus”). Investors should obtain and read the Prospectus prior to purchasing common shares. A copy of the Prospectus may be obtained, without charge, by calling the Fund at (877) 965-7386.

The Prospectus and this SAI omit certain of the information contained in the registration statement filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission (“SEC”). The registration statement may be obtained from the Securities and Exchange Commission upon payment of the fee prescribed, or inspected at the Securities and Exchange Commission’s office or via its website (www.sec.gov) at no charge. Capitalized terms used but not defined herein have the meanings ascribed to them in the Prospectus.

The Fund is managed by Cushing ® Asset Management, LP (the “Investment Adviser”).

 

 

This Statement of Additional Information is dated            , 2018.


TABLE OF CONTENTS

 

The Fund

     S-1  

Investment Strategies and Risks

     S-1  

Strategic Transactions

     S-4  

Investment Restrictions

     S-14  

Management of the Fund

     S-15  

Portfolio Management

     S-21  

Investment Management Agreement

     S-22  

Portfolio Transactions and Brokerage

     S-23  

U.S. Federal Income Tax Considerations

     S-24  

Service Providers

     S-30  

General Information

     S-31  

Financial Statements

     S-32  


THE FUND

The Fund was formed as a Delaware statutory trust on November 17, 2010 and is a non-diversified, closed-end management investment company registered under the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended (the “1940 Act”). The Fund commenced investment operations on September 25, 2012.

INVESTMENT STRATEGIES AND RISKS

The sections below describe, in greater detail than in the Prospectus, some of the different types of investments that may be made by the Fund and the investment practices in which the Fund may engage. The Fund may make the following investments, among others, some of which are part of its principal investment strategies and some of which are not. The principal risks of the Fund’s principal investment strategies are discussed in the Prospectus. The Fund may not buy all of the types of securities or use all of the investment techniques that are described.

Master Limited Partnership Interests

Master limited partnerships are formed as limited partnerships or limited liability companies and are treated as partnerships for U.S. federal income tax purposes. The equity securities issued by many MLPs are listed and traded on a U.S. exchange. An MLP typically issues general partner and limited partner interests. The general partner manages and often controls, has an ownership stake in, and is normally eligible to receive incentive distribution payments from, the MLP. To be treated as a partnership for U.S. federal income tax purposes, an MLP must derive at least 90% of its gross income for each taxable year from certain qualifying sources as described in the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the “Code”). These qualifying sources include natural resources-based activities such as the exploration, development, mining, production, processing, refining, transportation, storage and certain marketing of mineral or natural resources. The general partner may be structured as a private or publicly-traded corporation or other entity. The general partner typically controls the operations and management of the entity through an up to 2% general partner interest in the entity plus, in many cases, ownership of some percentage of the outstanding limited partner interests. The limited partners, through their ownership of limited partner interests, provide capital to the entity, are intended to have no role in the operation and management of the entity and receive cash distributions. Due to their structure as partnerships for U.S. federal income tax purposes and the expected character of their income, MLPs generally do not pay U.S. federal income taxes. Thus, unlike investors in corporate securities, direct MLP investors are generally not subject to double taxation ( i.e. , corporate level tax and tax on corporate dividends).

Certain MLPs are dependent on their parents or sponsors for a majority of their revenues. Any failure by an MLP’s parents or sponsors to satisfy their payments or obligations would impact the MLP’s revenues and cash flows and ability to make distributions. Moreover, the terms of an MLP’s transactions with its parent or sponsor are typically not arrived at on an arm’s-length basis, and may not be as favorable to the MLP as a transaction with a non-affiliate.

MLP Equity Securities

Equity securities issued by MLPs typically consist of common units, subordinated units and general partner interests.

Common Units . The common units of many MLPs are listed and traded on national securities exchanges, including the NYSE, the American Stock Exchange (the “AMEX”) and the NASDAQ Stock Market (the “NASDAQ”). Holders of MLP common units typically have very limited control and voting rights. Holders of such common units are typically entitled to receive the minimum quarterly distribution (the “MQD”), including arrearage rights, from the issuer. In the event of a liquidation, common unit holders are intended to have a preference to the remaining assets of the issuer over holders of subordinated units. The Fund may invest in different classes of common units that may have different voting, trading, and distribution rights.

Subordinated Units . Subordinated units, which, like common units, represent limited partner interests, are not typically listed on an exchange or publicly traded. Holders of such subordinated units are generally entitled to receive a distribution only after the MQD and any arrearages from prior quarters have been paid to holders of common units. Holders of subordinated units typically have the right to receive distributions before any incentive distributions are payable to the general partner. Subordinated units generally do not provide arrearage rights. Most MLP subordinated units are convertible into common units after the passage of a specified period of time or upon the achievement by the issuer of specified financial goals. The Fund may invest in different classes of subordinated units that may have different voting, trading, and distribution rights.

 

S-1


General Partner Interests . The general partner interest in MLPs is typically retained by the original sponsors of an MLP, such as its founders, corporate partners and entities that sell assets to the MLP. The holder of the general partner interest can be liable in certain circumstances for amounts greater than the amount of the holder’s investment. General partner interests often confer direct board participation rights in, and in many cases control over the operations of, the MLP. General partner or managing member interests receive cash distributions, typically in an amount of up to 2% of available cash, which is contractually defined in the partnership or limited liability company agreement. In addition, holders of general partner or managing member interests typically receive incentive distribution rights, which provide them with an increasing share of the entity’s aggregate cash distributions upon the payment of per common unit distributions that exceed specified threshold levels above the MQD. Due to the incentive distribution rights, GP MLPs have higher distribution growth prospects than their underlying MLPs, but quarterly incentive distribution payments would also decline at a greater rate than the decline rate in quarterly distributions to common and subordinated unit holders in the event of a reduction in the MLP’s quarterly distribution.

I-Shares

I-Shares represent an ownership interest issued by an MLP affiliate. The MLP affiliate uses the proceeds from the sale of I-Shares to purchase limited partnership interests in the MLP in the form of I-units. Thus, I-Shares represent an indirect limited partner interest in the MLP. I-units have features similar to MLP common units in terms of voting rights, liquidation preference and distribution. I-Shares differ from MLP common units primarily in that instead of receiving cash distributions, holders of I-Shares will receive distributions of additional I-Shares in an amount equal to the cash distributions received by common unit holders. I-Shares are traded on the NYSE.

Repurchase Agreements

The Fund may engage in repurchase agreements with broker-dealers, banks and other financial institutions to earn a return on temporarily available cash. A repurchase agreement is a short-term investment in which the purchaser ( i.e. , the Fund) acquires ownership of a security and the seller agrees to repurchase the obligation at a future time and set price, thereby determining the yield during the holding period. Repurchase agreements involve certain risks in the event of default by the other party. The Fund may enter into repurchase agreements with broker-dealers, banks and other financial institutions deemed to be creditworthy by the Investment Adviser under guidelines approved by the Board of Trustees. The Fund does not bear the risk of a decline in the value of the underlying security unless the seller defaults under its repurchase obligation. In the event of the bankruptcy or other default of a seller of a repurchase agreement, the Fund could experience both delays in liquidating the underlying securities and losses including: (a) possible decline in the value of the underlying security during the period while the Fund seeks to enforce its rights thereto; (b) possible lack of access to income on the underlying security during this period; and (c) expenses of enforcing its rights.

Repurchase agreements are fully collateralized by the underlying securities and are considered to be loans under the 1940 Act. The Fund pays for such securities only upon physical delivery or evidence of book entry transfer to the account of a custodian or bank acting as agent. The seller under a repurchase agreement will be required to maintain the value of the underlying securities marked-to-market daily at not less than the repurchase price. The underlying securities (normally securities of the U.S. government, its agencies or instrumentalities) may have maturity dates exceeding one year.

Reverse Repurchase Agreements

A reverse repurchase agreement involves the sale of a portfolio-eligible security by the Fund, coupled with its agreement to repurchase the instrument at a specified time and price. Under a reverse repurchase agreement, the Fund continues to receive any principal and interest payments on the underlying security during the term of the agreement. The Fund typically will segregate cash and/or liquid securities equal (on a daily mark-to-market basis) to its obligations under reverse repurchase agreements. However, reverse repurchase agreements involve the risk that the market value of securities retained by the Fund may decline below the repurchase price of the securities sold by the Fund which it is obligated to repurchase. To the extent that positions in reverse repurchase agreements are not covered through the segregation of cash and/or liquid securities at least equal to the amount of any purchase commitment, such transactions would be subject to the Fund’s limitations on borrowings.

 

S-2


Rights and Warrants

The Fund may invest in rights and warrants. Warrants are in effect longer-term call options. They give the holder the right to purchase a given number of shares of a particular company at specified prices within certain periods of time. Rights are similar to warrants except that they have a substantially shorter term. The purchaser of a warrant expects that the market price of the security will exceed the purchase price of the warrant plus the exercise price of the warrant, thus producing a profit. Of course, since the market price may never exceed the exercise price before the expiration date of the warrant, the purchaser of the warrant risks the loss of the entire purchase price of the warrant. Warrants generally trade in the open market and may be sold rather than exercised.

Warrants are sometimes sold in unit form with other securities of an issuer. Units of warrants and common stock may be employed in financing young, unseasoned companies. The purchase price of a warrant varies with the exercise price of the warrant, the current market value of the underlying security, the life of the warrant and various other investment factors. Rights and warrants may be considered more speculative and less liquid than certain other types of investments in that they do not entitle a holder to dividends or voting rights with respect to the underlying securities nor do they represent any rights in the assets of the issuing company and may lack a secondary market.

Depositary Receipts

The Fund may invest in both sponsored and unsponsored American Depositary Receipts (“ADRs”), European Depositary Receipts (“EDRs”), Global Depositary Receipts (“GDRs”) and other similar global instruments. ADRs typically are issued by an American bank or trust company and evidence ownership of underlying securities issued by a non-U.S. corporation. EDRs, which are sometimes referred to as Continental Depositary Receipts, are receipts issued in Europe, typically by non-U.S. banks and trust companies, that evidence ownership of either non-U.S. or domestic underlying securities. GDRs are depositary receipts structured like global debt issues to facilitate trading on an international basis. Unsponsored ADR, EDR and GDR programs are organized independently and without the cooperation of the issuer of the underlying securities. As a result, available information concerning the issuer may not be as current as for sponsored ADRs, EDRs and GDRs, and the prices of unsponsored ADRs, EDRs and GDRs may be more volatile than if such instruments were sponsored by the issuer. Investments in ADRs, EDRs and GDRs present additional investment considerations of non-U.S. securities.

When-Issued and Delayed Delivery Transactions

The Fund may purchase and sell portfolio securities on a when-issued and delayed delivery basis. No income accrues to the Fund on securities in connection with such purchase transactions prior to the date the Fund actually takes delivery of such securities. These transactions are subject to market fluctuation; the value of the securities at delivery may be more or less than their purchase price, and yields generally available on comparable securities when delivery occurs may be higher or lower than yields on the securities obtained pursuant to such transactions. Because the Fund relies on the buyer or seller, as the case may be, to consummate the transaction, failure by the other party to complete the transaction may result in the Fund missing the opportunity of obtaining a price or yield considered to be advantageous. When the Fund is the buyer in such a transaction, however, it will segregate cash and/or liquid securities having an aggregate value at least equal to the amount of such purchase commitments until payment is made. The Fund will make commitments to purchase securities on such basis only with the intention of actually acquiring these securities, but the Fund may sell such securities prior to the settlement date if such sale is considered to be advisable. To the extent the Fund engages in when-issued and delayed delivery transactions, it will do so for the purpose of acquiring securities for the Fund’s portfolio consistent with the Fund’s investment objectives and policies and not for the purpose of investment leverage.

Since the market value of both the securities or currency subject to the commitment and the securities or currency held as segregated assets may fluctuate, the use of commitments may magnify the impact of interest rate changes on the Fund’s net asset value. A commitment sale is covered if the Fund owns or has the right to acquire the underlying securities or currency subject to the commitment. A commitment sale is for cross-hedging purposes if it is not covered, but is designed to provide a hedge against a decline in value of a security or currency which the Fund owns or has the right to acquire. By entering into a commitment sale transaction, the Fund foregoes or reduces the potential for both gain and loss in the security which is being hedged by the commitment sale.

 

S-3


Short Sales Against the Box

The Fund may from time to time make short sales of securities it owns or has the right to acquire. A short sale is “against the box” to the extent that the Fund contemporaneously owns or has the right to obtain at no added cost securities identical to those sold short. In a short sale, the Fund does not immediately deliver the securities sold and does not receive the proceeds from the sale. The Fund is required to recognize gain from the short sale for federal income tax purposes at the time it enters into the short sale, even though it does not receive the sales proceeds until it delivers the securities. The Fund is said to have a short position in the securities sold until it delivers such securities at which time it receives the proceeds of the sale. The Fund may close out a short position by purchasing and delivering an equal amount of the securities sold short, rather than by delivering securities already held by the Fund, because the Fund may want to continue to receive interest and dividend payments on securities in its portfolio.

S TRATEGIC TRANSACTIONS

The Fund may, but is not required to, use various investment strategies as described below (“Strategic Transactions”). Strategic Transactions may be used for a variety of purposes including hedging, risk management, portfolio management or to earn income. Any or all of the investment techniques described herein may be used at any time and there is no particular strategy that dictates the use of one technique rather than another, as the use of any Strategic Transaction by the Fund is a function of numerous variables including market conditions. The Fund complies with applicable regulatory requirements when implementing Strategic Transactions, including the segregation of liquid assets when mandated by SEC rules or SEC staff positions. Although the Investment Adviser seeks to use Strategic Transactions to further the Fund’s investment objective, no assurance can be given that the use of Strategic Transactions will achieve this result.

General Risks of Derivatives

Strategic Transactions may involve the purchase and sale of derivative instruments. A derivative is a financial instrument the value of which depends upon (or derives from) the value of another asset, security, interest rate, or index. Derivatives may relate to a wide variety of underlying instruments, including equity and debt securities, indexes, interest rates, currencies and other assets. Certain derivative instruments which the Fund may use and the risks of those instruments are described in further detail below. The Fund may in the future also utilize derivatives techniques, instruments and strategies that may be newly developed or permitted as a result of regulatory changes, consistent with the Fund’s investment objective and policies. Such newly developed techniques, instruments and strategies may involve risks different than or in addition to those described herein. No assurance can be given that any derivatives strategy employed by the Fund will be successful.

The risks associated with the use of derivatives are different from, and possibly greater than, the risks associated with investing directly in the instruments underlying such derivatives. Derivatives are highly specialized instruments that require investment techniques and risk analyses different from other portfolio investments. The use of derivative instruments requires an understanding not only of the underlying instrument but also of the derivative itself. Certain risk factors generally applicable to derivative transactions are described below.

 

    Derivatives are subject to the risk that the market value of the derivative itself or the market value of underlying instruments will change in a way adverse to the Fund’s interests. The Fund bears the risk that the Investment Adviser may incorrectly forecast future market trends and other financial or economic factors or the value of the underlying security, index, interest rate or currency when establishing a derivatives position for the Fund.

 

    Derivatives may be subject to pricing or “basis” risk, which exists when a derivative becomes extraordinarily expensive (or inexpensive) relative to historical prices or corresponding instruments. Under such market conditions, it may not be economically feasible to initiate a transaction or liquidate a position at an advantageous time or price.

 

S-4


    Many derivatives are complex and often valued subjectively. Improper valuations can result in increased payment requirements to counterparties or a loss of value to the Fund.

 

    Using derivatives as a hedge against a portfolio investment presents the risk that the derivative will have imperfect correlation with the portfolio investment, which could result in the Fund incurring substantial losses. This correlation risk may be greater in the case of derivatives based on an index or other basket of securities, as the portfolio securities being hedged may not duplicate the components of the underlying index or the basket may not be of exactly the same type of obligation as those underlying the derivative. The use of derivatives for “cross hedging” purposes (using a derivative based on one instrument as a hedge on a different instrument) may also involve greater correlation risks.

 

    While using derivatives for hedging purposes can reduce the Fund’s risk of loss, it may also limit the Fund’s opportunity for gains or result in losses by offsetting or limiting the Fund’s ability to participate in favorable price movements in portfolio investments.

 

    Derivatives transactions for non-hedging purposes involve greater risks and may result in losses which would not be offset by increases in the value of portfolio securities or declines in the cost of securities to be acquired. In the event that the Fund enters into a derivatives transaction as an alternative to purchasing or selling the underlying instrument or in order to obtain desired exposure to an index or market, the Fund will be exposed to the same risks as are incurred in purchasing or selling the underlying instruments directly.

 

    The use of certain derivatives transactions involves the risk of loss resulting from the insolvency or bankruptcy of the other party to the contract (the “counterparty”) or the failure by the counterparty to make required payments or otherwise comply with the terms of the contract. In the event of default by a counterparty, the Fund may have contractual remedies pursuant to the agreements related to the transaction.

 

    Liquidity risk exists when a particular derivative is difficult to purchase or sell. If a derivative transaction is particularly large or if the relevant market is illiquid, the Fund may be unable to initiate a transaction or liquidate a position at an advantageous time or price.

 

    Certain derivatives transactions, including over-the-counter (“OTC”) options, swaps, forward contracts, certain options on foreign currencies and other OTC derivatives, are not entered into or traded on exchanges or in markets regulated by the CFTC or the SEC. Instead, such OTC derivatives are entered into directly by the counterparties and may be traded only through financial institutions acting as market makers. OTC derivatives transactions can only be entered into with a willing counterparty. Where no such counterparty is available, the Fund will be unable to enter into a desired transaction. There also may be greater risk that no liquid secondary market in the trading of OTC derivatives will exist, in which case the Fund may be required to hold such instruments until exercise, expiration or maturity. Many of the protections afforded to exchange participants will not be available to participants in OTC derivatives transactions. OTC derivatives transactions are not subject to the guarantee of an exchange or clearinghouse and as a result the Fund would bear greater risk of default by the counterparties to such transactions.

 

    The Fund may be required to make physical delivery of portfolio securities underlying a derivative in order to close out a derivatives position or to sell portfolio securities at a time or price at which it may be disadvantageous to do so in order to obtain cash to close out or to maintain a derivatives position.

 

    As a result of the structure of certain derivatives, adverse changes in the value of the underlying instrument can result in a losses substantially greater than the amount invested in the derivative itself. Certain derivatives have the potential for unlimited loss, regardless of the size of the initial investment.

 

    Certain derivatives, including certain OTC options and swap agreements, may be considered illiquid.

 

    Certain derivative transactions may give rise to a form of leverage. Leverage associated with derivative transactions may cause the Fund to sell portfolio securities when it may not be advantageous to do so to satisfy its obligations or to meet segregation requirements, pursuant to applicable SEC rules and regulations, or may cause the Fund to be more volatile than if the Fund had not been leveraged.

 

S-5


    Derivatives transactions conducted outside the United States may not be conducted in the same manner as those entered into on U.S. exchanges, and may be subject to different margin, exercise, settlement or expiration procedures. Many of the risks of OTC derivatives transactions are also applicable to derivatives transactions conducted outside the United States. Derivatives transactions conducted outside the United States are subject to the risk of governmental action affecting the trading in, or the prices of, foreign securities, currencies and other instruments The value of such positions could be adversely affected by foreign political and economic factors; lesser availability of data on which to make trading decisions; delays the Fund’s ability to act upon economic events occurring in foreign markets; and less liquidity than U.S. markets.

 

    Currency derivatives are subject to additional risks. Currency derivatives transactions may be negatively affected by government exchange controls, blockages, and manipulations. Currency exchange rates may be influenced by factors extrinsic to a country’s economy. There is no systematic reporting of last sale information with respect to foreign currencies. As a result, the available information on which trading in currency derivatives will be based may not be as complete as comparable data for other transactions. Events could occur in the foreign currency market which will not be reflected in currency derivatives until the following day, making it more difficult for the Fund to respond to such events in a timely manner.

 

    Legislation regarding regulation of the financial sector, including the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act (the “Dodd-Frank Act”), which was signed into law in July 2010, will change the way in which certain derivative instruments are regulated and/or traded. Such regulation may impact the availability, liquidity and cost of derivative instruments. While many provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act must be implemented through future rulemaking, and any regulatory or legislative activity may not necessarily have a direct, immediate effect upon the Fund, it is possible that, upon implementation of these measures or any future measures, they could potentially limit or completely restrict the ability of the Fund to use certain derivative instruments as a part of its investment strategy, increase the costs of using these instruments or make them less effective. Limits or restrictions applicable to the counterparties with which the Fund engages in derivatives transactions could also prevent the Fund from using these instruments or affect the pricing or other factors relating to these instruments, or may change the availability of certain investments. The Financial CHOICE Act, which was passed by the U.S. House of Representatives in June 2017, would, if enacted, roll back parts of the Dodd-Frank Act. There can be no assurance that such legislation or regulation will not have a material adverse effect on the Fund or will not impair the ability of the Fund to utilize certain derivatives transactions or achieve its investment objective.

 

    In connection with an ongoing review by the SEC and its staff of the regulation of investment companies’ use of derivatives, in August 2011 the SEC issued a concept release to seek public comment on a wide range of issues raised by the use of derivatives by investment companies. The SEC noted that it intends to consider the comments to help determine whether regulatory initiatives or guidance are needed to improve the current regulatory regime for investment companies and, if so, the nature of any such initiatives or guidance. While the nature of any such regulations is uncertain at this time, it is possible that such regulations could limit the implementation of the Fund’s use of derivatives, which could have an adverse impact on the Fund. The Investment Adviser cannot predict the effects of these regulations on the Fund’s portfolio. The Investment Adviser intends to monitor developments and seeks to manage the Fund’s portfolio in a manner consistent with achieving the Fund’s investment objective, but there can be no assurance that they will be successful in doing so.

 

    Recently, the U.S. Commodity Futures Trading Commission (“CFTC”) adopted amendments to its rules relating to the ability of an investment adviser to a registered investment company to claim an exclusion from the definition of the term “commodity pool operator” under the Commodity Exchange Act (“CEA”). If the Investment Adviser was unable to claim the exclusion with respect to the Fund, the Investment Adviser would become subject to registration and regulation as a commodity pool operator, which would subject the Investment Adviser and the Fund to additional registration and regulatory requirements and increased operating expenses. The Fund intends to limit its investments such that the Investment Adviser may continue to claim the exclusion with respect to the Fund, which may limit the Fund’s ability to use certain Strategic Transactions, including futures, options on futures and swaps.

 

S-6


Options

An option is a contract that gives the holder of the option the right, but not the obligation, to buy from (in the case of a call option) or sell to (in the case of a put option) the seller of the option (the “option writer”) the underlying security at a specified fixed price (the “exercise price”) prior to a specified date (the “expiration date”). The buyer of the option pays to the option writer the option premium, which represents the purchase price of the option.

Exchange-traded options are issued by a regulated intermediary such as the Options Clearing Corporation (“OCC”), which guarantees the performance of the obligations of the parties to such option. OTC options are purchased from or sold to counterparties through direct bilateral agreement between the counterparties. Certain options, such as options on individual securities, are settled through physical delivery of the underlying security, whereas other options, such as index options, are settled in cash in an amount based on the value of the underlying instrument multiplied by a specified multiplier.

Writing Options . The Fund may write call and put options. As the writer of a call option, the Fund receives the premium from the purchaser of the option and has the obligation, upon exercise of the option, to deliver the underlying security upon payment of the exercise price. If the option expires without being exercised the Fund is not required to deliver the underlying security but retains the premium received.

The Fund may write call options that are “covered.” A call option on a security is covered if (a) the Fund owns the security underlying the call or has an absolute and immediate right to acquire that security without additional cash consideration (or, if additional cash consideration is required, such amount is maintained by the Fund in segregated liquid assets) upon conversion or exchange of other securities held by the Fund; or (b) the Fund has purchased a call on the underlying security, the exercise price of which is (i) equal to or less than the exercise price of the call written, or (ii) greater than the exercise price of the call written, provided the difference is maintained by the Fund in segregated liquid assets.

Selling call options involves the risk that the Fund may be required to sell the underlying security at a disadvantageous price, below the market price of such security, at the time the option is exercised. As the writer of a covered call option, the Fund gives up the opportunity during the option’s life to profit from increases in the market value of the security covering the call option above the sum of the premium and the strike price of the call, but the Fund retains the risk of loss should the price of the underlying security decline.

The Fund may also write uncovered call options ( i.e. , where the Fund does not own the underlying security or index). Similar to a naked short sale, writing an uncovered call creates the risk of an unlimited loss, in that the price of the underlying security could theoretically increase without limit, thus increasing the cost of buying those securities to cover the call option if it is exercised before it expires. There can be no assurance that the securities necessary to cover the call option will be available for purchase. Purchasing securities to cover an uncovered call option can itself cause the price of the securities to rise, further exacerbating the loss.

The Fund may write put options. As the writer of a put option, the Fund receives the premium from the purchaser of the option and has the obligation, upon exercise of the option, to pay the exercise price and receive delivery of the underlying security. If the option expires without being exercised, the Fund is not required to receive the underlying security in exchange for the exercise price but retains the option premium.

The Fund may write put options that are “covered.” A put option on a security is covered if (a) the Fund segregates liquid assets equal to the exercise price; or (b) the Fund has purchased a put on the same security as the put written, the exercise price of which is (i) equal to or greater than the exercise price of the put written, or (ii) less than the exercise price of the put written, provided the difference is maintained by the Fund in segregated liquid assets.

Selling put options involves the risk that the Fund may be required to buy the underlying security at a disadvantageous price, above the market price of such security, at the time the option is exercised. While the Fund’s potential gain in writing a covered put option is limited to the premium received plus the interest earned on the liquid assets covering the put option, the Fund’s risk of loss is equal to the entire value of the underlying security, offset only by the amount of the premium received.

 

S-7


The Fund may also write uncovered put options. The seller of an uncovered put option theoretically could lose an amount equal to the entire aggregate exercise price of the option if the underlying security were to become valueless.

The Fund may close out an options position which it has written through a closing purchase transaction. The Fund would execute a closing purchase transaction with respect to a call option written by purchasing a call option on the same underlying security and having the same exercise price and expiration date as the call option written by the Fund. The Fund would execute a closing purchase transaction with respect to a put option written by purchasing a put option on the same underlying security and having the same exercise price and expiration date as the put option written by the Fund. A closing purchase transaction may or may not result in a profit to the Fund. The Fund could close out its position as an option writer only if a liquid secondary market exists for options of that series and there is no assurance that such a market will exist with respect to any particular option.

The writer of an option generally has no control over the time when the option is exercised and the option writer is required to deliver or acquire the underlying security. Once an option writer has received an exercise notice, it cannot effect a closing purchase transaction in order to terminate its obligation under the option. Thus, the use of options may require the Fund to buy or sell portfolio securities at inopportune times or for prices other than the current market values of such securities, may limit the amount of appreciation the Fund can realize on an investment, or may cause the Fund to hold a security that it might otherwise sell.

Purchasing Options . The Fund may purchase call and put options. As the buyer of a call option, the Fund pays the premium to the option writer and has the right to purchase the underlying security from the option writer at the exercise price. If the market price of the underlying security rises above the exercise price, the Fund could exercise the option and acquire the underlying security at a below market price, which could result in a gain to the Fund, minus the premium paid. As the buyer of a put option, the Fund pays the premium to the option writer and has the right to sell the underlying security to the option writer at the exercise price. If the market price of the underlying security declines below the exercise price, the Fund could exercise the option and sell the underlying security at an above market price, which could result in a gain to the Fund, minus the premium paid. The Fund may buy call and put options whether or not it holds the underlying securities.

As a buyer of a call or put option, the Fund may sell put or call options that it has purchased at any time prior to such option’s expiration date through a closing sale transaction. The principal factors affecting the market value of a put or a call option include supply and demand, interest rates, the current market price of the underlying security in relation to the exercise price of the option, the volatility of the underlying security, the underlying security’s dividend policy, and the time remaining until the expiration date. A closing sale transaction may or may not result in a profit to the Fund. The Fund’s ability to initiate a closing sale transaction is dependent upon the liquidity of the options market and there is no assurance that such a market will exist with respect to any particular option. If the Fund does not exercise or sell an option prior to its expiration date, the option expires and becomes worthless.

OTC Options . Unlike exchange-traded options, which are standardized with respect to the underlying instrument, expiration date, contract size and strike price, the terms of OTC options generally are established through negotiation between the parties to the options contract. This type of arrangement allows the purchaser and writer greater flexibility to tailor the option to their needs. OTC options are available for a greater variety of securities or baskets of securities, and in a wider range of expiration dates and exercise prices than exchange-traded options. However, unlike exchange-traded options, which are issued and guaranteed by a regulated intermediary, such as the OCC, OTC options are entered into directly with the counterparty. Unless the counterparties provide for it, there is no central clearing or guaranty function for an OTC option. Therefore, OTC options are subject to the risk of default or non-performance by the counterparty. Accordingly, the Investment Adviser must assess the creditworthiness of the counterparty to determine the likelihood that the terms of the option will be satisfied. There can be no assurance that a continuous liquid secondary market will exist for any particular OTC option at any specific time. As a result, the Fund may be unable to enter into closing sale transactions with respect to OTC options.

Index Options . Call and put options on indices operate similarly to options on securities. Rather than the right to buy or sell a single security at a specified price, options on an index give the holder the right to receive, upon exercise of the option, an amount of cash determined by reference to the value of the underlying index. The underlying index may be a broad-based index or a narrower market index. Unlike options on securities, all settlements are in cash. The settlement amount, which the writer of a index option must pay to the holder of the option upon exercise, is generally equal to the difference between the fixed exercise price of the option and the value of the underlying index,

 

S-8


multiplied by a specified multiplier. The multiplier determines the size of the investment position the option represents. Gain or loss to the Fund on index options transactions will depend on price movements in the underlying securities market generally or in a particular segment of the market rather than price movements of individual securities. As with other options, the Fund may close out its position in index options through closing purchase transactions and closing sale transactions provided that a liquid secondary market exists for such options.

Index options written by the Fund may be covered in a manner similar to the covering of other types of options, by holding an offsetting financial position and/or segregating liquid assets. The Fund may cover call options written on an index by owning securities whose price changes, in the opinion of the Investment Adviser, are expected to correlate to those of the underlying index.

Foreign Currency Options . Options on foreign currencies operate similarly to options on securities. Rather than the right to buy or sell a single security at a specified price, options on foreign currencies give the holder the right to buy or sell foreign currency for a fixed amount in U.S. dollars. Options on foreign currencies are traded primarily in the OTC market, but may also be traded on United States and foreign exchanges. The value of a foreign currency option is dependent upon the value of the underlying foreign currency relative to the U.S. dollar. The price of the option may vary with changes in the value of either or both currencies and has no relationship to the investment merits of a foreign security. Options on foreign currencies are affected by all of those factors which influence foreign exchange rates and foreign investment generally. As with other options, the Fund may close out its position in foreign currency options through closing purchase transactions and closing sale transactions provided that a liquid secondary market exists for such options. Foreign currency options written by the Fund may be covered in a manner similar to the covering of other types of options, by holding an offsetting financial position and/or segregating liquid assets.

Additional Risks of Options Transactions . The risks associated with options transactions are different from, and possibly greater than, the risks associated with investing directly in the underlying instruments. Options are highly specialized instruments that require investment techniques and risk analyses different from those associated with other portfolio investments. The use of options requires an understanding not only of the underlying instrument but also of the option itself. Options may be subject to the risk factors generally applicable to derivatives transactions described herein, and may also be subject to certain additional risk factors, including:

 

    The exercise of options written or purchased by the Fund could cause the Fund to sell portfolio securities, thus increasing the Fund’s portfolio turnover.

 

    The Fund pays brokerage commissions each time it writes or purchases an option or buys or sells an underlying security in connection with the exercise of an option. Such brokerage commissions could be higher relative to the commissions for direct purchases of sales of the underlying securities.

 

    The Fund’s options transactions may be limited by limitations on options positions established by the exchanges on which such options are traded.

 

    The hours of trading for exchange listed options may not coincide with the hours during which the underlying securities are traded. To the extent that the options markets close before the markets for the underlying securities, significant price and rate movements can take place in the underlying securities that cannot be reflected in the options markets.

 

    Index options based upon a narrower index of securities may present greater risks than options based on broad market indexes, as narrower indexes are more susceptible to rapid and extreme fluctuations as a result of changes in the values of a small number of securities.

 

    The Fund is subject to the risk of market movements between the time that an option is exercised and the time of performance thereunder, which could increase the extent of any losses suffered by the Fund in connection with options transactions.

 

S-9


Futures Contracts

A futures contract is a standardized agreement between two parties to buy or sell a specific quantity of an underlying instrument at a specific price at a specific future time (the “settlement date”). Futures contracts may be based on a specified equity security (securities futures), a specified debt security or reference rate (interest rate futures), the value of a specified securities index (index futures) or the value of a foreign currency (forward contracts and currency futures). The value of a futures contract tends to increase and decrease in tandem with the value of the underlying instrument. The buyer of a futures contract agrees to purchase the underlying instrument on the settlement date and is said to be “long” the contract. The seller of a futures contract agrees to sell the underlying instrument on the settlement date and is said to be “short” the contract. Futures contracts differ from options in that they are bilateral agreements, with both the purchaser and the seller equally obligated to complete the transaction. Futures contracts call for settlement only on the expiration date and cannot be “exercised” at any other time during their term.

Depending on the terms of the particular contract, futures contracts are settled through either physical delivery of the underlying instrument on the settlement date (such as in the case of securities futures and interest rate futures based on a specified debt security) or by payment of a cash settlement amount on the settlement date (such as in the case of futures contracts relating to interest rates, foreign currencies and broad-based securities indexes). In the case of cash settled futures contracts, the settlement amount is equal to the difference between the reference instrument’s price on the last trading day of the contract and the reference instrument’s price at the time the contract was entered into. Most futures contracts, particularly futures contracts requiring physical delivery, are not held until the settlement date, but instead are offset before the settlement date through the establishment of an opposite and equal futures position (buying a contract that had been sold, or selling a contract that had been purchased). All futures transactions (except currency forward contracts) are effected through a clearinghouse associated with the exchange on which the futures are traded.

The buyer and seller of a futures contract are not required to deliver or pay for the underlying commodity unless the contract is held until the settlement date. However, both the buyer and seller are required to deposit “initial margin” with a futures commodities merchant when the futures contract is entered into. Initial margin deposits are typically calculated as a percentage of the contract’s market value. If the value of either party’s position declines, the party will be required to make additional “variation margin” payments to settle the change in value on a daily basis. The process is known as “marking-to-market.” Upon the closing of a futures position through an the establishment of an offsetting position, a final determination of variation margin will be made and additional cash will be paid by or released to the Fund.

In addition, the Fund may be required to maintain segregated liquid assets in order to cover futures transactions. The Fund will segregate liquid assets in an amount equal to the difference between the market value of a futures contract entered into by the Fund and the aggregate value of the initial and variation margin payments made by the Fund with respect to such contract.

Currency Forward Contracts and Currency Futures . A foreign currency forward contract is a negotiated agreement between two parties to exchange specified amounts of two or more currencies at a specified future time at a specified rate. The rate specified by the forward contract can be higher or lower than the spot rate between the currencies that are the subject of the contract. Settlement of a foreign currency forward contract for the purchase of most currencies typically must occur at a bank based in the issuing nation. Currency futures are similar to currency forward contracts, except that they are traded on an exchange and standardized as to contract size and delivery date. Most currency futures call for payment or delivery in U.S. dollars. Unanticipated changes in currency prices may result in losses to the Fund and poorer overall performance for the Fund than if it had not entered into forward contracts.

Options on Futures Contracts . Options on futures contracts are similar to options on securities except that options on futures contracts give the purchasers the right, in return for the premium paid, to assume a position in a futures contract (a long position in the case of a call option and a short position in the case of a put option) at a specified exercise price at any time prior to the expiration of the option. Upon exercise of the option, the parties will be subject to all of the risks associated with futures transactions and subject to margin requirements. As the writer of options on futures contracts, the Fund would also be subject to initial and variation margin requirements on the option position.

 

S-10


Options on futures contracts written by the Fund may be covered in a manner similar to the covering of other types of options, by holding an offsetting financial position and/or segregating liquid assets. The Fund may cover an option on a futures contract by purchasing or selling the underlying futures contract. In such instances the exercise of the option will serve to close out the Fund’s futures position.

Additional Risks of Futures Transactions . The risks associated with futures contract transactions are different from, and possibly greater than, the risks associated with investing directly in the underlying instruments. Futures are highly specialized instruments that require investment techniques and risk analyses different from those associated with other portfolio investments. The use of futures requires an understanding not only of the underlying instrument but also of the futures contract itself. Futures may be subject to the risk factors generally applicable to derivatives transactions described herein, and may also be subject to certain additional risk factors, including:

 

    The risk of loss in buying and selling futures contracts can be substantial. Small price movements in the commodity underlying a futures position may result in immediate and substantial loss (or gain) to the Fund.

 

    Buying and selling futures contracts may result in losses in excess of the amount invested in the position in the form of initial margin. In the event of adverse price movements in the underlying commodity, security, index, currency or instrument, the Fund would be required to make daily cash payments to maintain its required margin. The Fund may be required to sell portfolio securities in order to meet daily margin requirements at a time when it may be disadvantageous to do so. The Fund could lose margin payments deposited with a futures commodities merchant if the futures commodities merchant breaches its agreement with the Fund, becomes insolvent or declares bankruptcy.

 

    Most exchanges limit the amount of fluctuation permitted in futures contract prices during any single trading day. Once the daily limit has been reached in a particular futures contract, no trades may be made on that day at prices beyond that limit. If futures contract prices were to move to the daily limit for several trading days with little or no trading, the Fund could be prevented from prompt liquidation of a futures position and subject to substantial losses. The daily limit governs only price movements during a single trading day and therefore does not limit the Fund’s potential losses.

 

    Index futures based upon a narrower index of securities may present greater risks than futures based on broad market indexes, as narrower indexes are more susceptible to rapid and extreme fluctuations as a result of changes in value of a small number of securities.

Swap Contracts and Related Derivative Instruments

A swap contract is an agreement between two parties pursuant to which the parties exchange payments at specified dates on the basis of a specified notional amount, with the payments calculated by reference to specified securities, indexes, reference rates, currencies or other instruments. Most swap agreements provide that when the period payment dates for both parties are the same, the payments are made on a net basis ( i.e. , the two payment streams are netted out, with only the net amount paid by one party to the other). The Fund’s obligations or rights under a swap contract entered into on a net basis will generally be equal only to the net amount to be paid or received under the agreement, based on the relative values of the positions held by each counterparty. Swap agreements are not entered into or traded on exchanges and there is no central clearing or guaranty function for swaps. Therefore, swaps are subject to the risk of default or non-performance by the counterparty. Accordingly, the Investment Adviser must assess the creditworthiness of the counterparty to determine the likelihood that the terms of the swap will be satisfied.

Swap agreements allow for a wide variety of transactions. For example, fixed rate payments may be exchanged for floating rate payments, U.S. dollar denominated payments may be exchanged for payments denominated in foreign currencies, and payments tied to the price of one security, index, reference rate, currency or other instrument may be exchanged for payments tied to the price of a different security, index, reference rate, currency or other instrument. Swap contracts are typically individually negotiated and structured to provide exposure to a variety of particular types of investments or market factors. Swap contracts can take many different forms and are known by a variety of names. To the extent consistent with the Fund’s investment objectives and policies, the Fund is not limited to any particular form or variety of swap contract. The Fund may utilize swaps to increase or decrease their exposure to the underlying instrument, reference rate, foreign currency, market index or other asset. The Fund may also enter into related derivative instruments including caps, floors and collars.

 

S-11


The Fund may be required to cover swap transactions. Obligations under swap agreements entered into on a net basis are generally accrued daily and any accrued but unpaid amounts owed by the Fund to the swap counterparty will be covered by segregating liquid assets. If the Fund enters into a swap agreement on other than a net basis, the Fund will segregate liquid assets with a value equal to the full amount of the Fund’s accrued obligations under the agreement.

Interest Rate Swaps, Caps, Floors and Collars . Interest rate swaps consist of an agreement between two parties to exchange their respective commitments to pay or receive interest (e.g., an exchange of floating rate payments for fixed rate payments). Interest rate swaps are generally entered into on a net basis.

The Fund may also buy or sell interest rate caps, floors and collars. The purchase of an interest rate cap entitles the purchaser, to the extent that a specified index exceeds a predetermined interest rate, to receive payments of interest on a specified notional amount from the party selling the interest rate cap. The purchase of an interest rate floor entitles the purchaser, to the extent that a specified index falls below a predetermined interest rate, to receive payments of interest on a specified notional amount from the party selling the interest rate floor. A collar is a combination of a cap and a floor that preserves a certain return within a predetermined range of interest rate of values. Caps, floors and collars may be less liquid that other types of swaps. If the Fund sells caps, floors and collars, it will segregate liquid assets with a value equal to the full amount, accrued daily, of the Fund’s net obligations with respect to the caps, floors or collars.

Index Swaps . An index swap consists of an agreement between two parties in which a party exchanges a cash flow based on a notional amount of a reference index for a cash flow based on a different index or on another specified instrument or reference rate. Index swaps are generally entered into on a net basis.

Currency Swaps . A currency swap consists of an agreement between two parties to exchange cash flows on a notional amount of two or more currencies based on the relative value differential among them, such as exchanging a right to receive a payment in foreign currency for the right to receive U.S. dollars. Currency swap agreements may be entered into on a net basis or may involve the delivery of the entire principal value of one designated currency in exchange for the entire principal value of another designated currency. In such cases, the entire principal value of a currency swap is subject to the risk that the counterparty will default on its contractual delivery obligations.

Credit Default Swaps . The Fund may enter into credit default swap contracts and options thereon. A credit default swap consists of an agreement between two parties in which the “buyer” agrees to pay to the “seller” a periodic stream of payments over the term of the contract and the seller agrees to pay the buyer the par value (or other agreed-upon value ) of a referenced debt obligation upon the occurrence of a credit event with respect to the issuer of the referenced debt obligation. Generally, a credit event means bankruptcy, failure to pay, obligation acceleration or modified restructuring. The Fund may be either the buyer or seller in a credit default swap. As the buyer in a credit default swap, the Fund would pay to the counterparty the periodic stream of payments. If no default occurs, the Fund would receive no benefit from the contract. As the seller in a credit default swap, the Fund would receive the stream of payments but would be subject to exposure on the notional amount of the swap, which it would be required to pay in the event of default. The Fund generally segregates liquid assets to cover any potential obligation under a credit default swap sold by it. The use of credit default swaps could result in losses to the Fund if the Investment Adviser fails to correctly evaluate the creditworthiness of the issuer of the referenced debt obligation.

Inflation Swaps . Inflation swap agreements are contracts in which one party agrees to pay the cumulative percentage increase in a price index, such as the Consumer Price Index, over the term of the swap (with some lag on the referenced inflation index), and the other party pays a compounded fixed rate. Inflation swap agreements may be used to protect the net asset value of the Fund against an unexpected change in the rate of inflation measured by an inflation index. The value of inflation swap agreements is expected to change in response to changes in real interest rates. Real interest rates are tied to the relationship between nominal interest rates and the rate of inflation. If nominal interest rates increase at a faster rate than inflation, real interest rates may rise, leading to a decrease in value of an inflation swap agreement.

 

S-12


Swaptions . An option on a swap agreement, also called a “swaption,” is an option that gives the buyer the right, but not the obligation, to enter into a swap on a future date in exchange for paying a market based “premium.” A receiver swaption gives the owner the right to receive the total return of a specified asset, reference rate, or index. A payer swaption gives the owner the right to pay the total return of a specified asset, reference rate, or index. Swaptions also include options that allow an existing swap to be terminated or extended by one of the counterparties.

General Risks of Swaps . The risks associated with swap transactions are different from, and possibly greater than, the risks associated with investing directly in the underlying instruments. Swaps are highly specialized instruments that require investment techniques and risk analyses different from those associated with other portfolio investments. The use of swaps requires an understanding not only of the underlying instrument but also of the swap contract itself. Swap transactions may be subject to the risk factors generally applicable to derivatives transactions described above, and may also be subject to certain additional risk factors, including:

 

    Swap agreements are not traded on exchanges and not subject to government regulation like exchange-traded derivatives. As a result, parties to a swap agreement are not protected by such government regulations as participants in transactions in derivatives traded on organized exchanges.

 

    In addition to the risk of default by the counterparty, if the creditworthiness of a counterparty to a swap agreement declines, the value of the swap agreement would be likely to decline, potentially resulting in losses.

 

    The swaps market is a relatively new market and is largely unregulated. It is possible that further developments in the swaps market, including potential governmental regulation, could adversely affect the Fund’s ability to utilize swaps, terminate existing swap agreements or realize amounts to be received under such agreements.

Structured Products

The Fund also may invest a portion of its assets in structured notes and other types of structured investments (referred to collectively as “structured products”). A structured note is a derivative security for which the amount of principal repayment and/or interest payments is based on the movement of one or more “factors.” These factors include, but are not limited to, currency exchange rates, interest rates (such as the prime lending rate or LIBOR), referenced bonds and stock indices. The cash flow or rate of return on a structured note may be determined by applying a multiplier to the rate of total return on the referenced factor. Application of a multiplier is comparable to the use of financial leverage, a speculative technique. Leverage magnifies the potential for gain and the risk of loss. As a result, a relatively small decline in the value of the referenced factor could result in a relatively large loss in the value of a structured note.

Investments in structured notes involve risks including interest rate risk, credit risk and market risk. Where the Fund’s investments in structured notes are based upon the movement of one or more factors, including currency exchange rates, interest rates, referenced bonds and stock indices, depending on the factor used and the use of multipliers or deflators, changes in interest rates and movement of the factor may cause significant price fluctuations. Additionally, changes in the reference factor may cause the interest rate on the structured note to be reduced to zero and any further changes in the reference factor may then reduce the principal amount payable on maturity. Structured notes may be less liquid than other types of securities and more volatile than the reference factor underlying the note.

Generally, structured investments are interests in entities organized and operated for the purpose of restructuring the investment characteristics of underlying investment interests or securities. These investment entities may be structured as trusts or other types of pooled investment vehicles. This type of restructuring generally involves the deposit with or purchase by an entity of the underlying investments and the issuance by that entity of one or more classes of securities backed by, or representing interests in, the underlying investments. The cash flow or rate of return on the underlying investments may be apportioned among the newly issued securities to create different investment characteristics, such as varying maturities, credit quality, payment priorities and interest rate provisions. The Fund may have the right to receive payments to which it is entitled only from the structured investment, and generally does not have direct rights against the issuer. Holders of structured investments bear risks of the underlying investment and are subject to counterparty risk. While certain structured investment vehicles enable the

 

S-13


investor to acquire interests in a pool of securities without the brokerage and other expenses associated with directly holding the same securities, investors in structured investment vehicles generally pay their share of the investment vehicle’s administrative and other expenses.

Certain structured products may be thinly traded or have a limited trading market and may have the effect of increasing the Fund’s illiquidity to the extent that the Fund, at a particular point in time, may be unable to find qualified buyers for these securities.

Combined Transactions

Combined transactions involve entering into multiple derivatives transactions (such as multiple options transactions, including purchasing and writing options in combination with each other; multiple futures transactions; and combinations of options, futures, forward and swap transactions) instead of a single derivatives transaction in order to customize the risk and return characteristics of the overall position. Combined transactions typically contain elements of risk that are present in each of the component transactions. The Fund may enter into a combined transaction instead of a single derivatives transaction when, in the opinion of the Investment Adviser, it is in the best interest of the Fund to do so. Because combined transactions involve multiple transactions, they may result in higher transaction costs and may be more difficult to close out.

Regulatory Matters

As described herein, the Fund may be required to cover its potential economic exposure to certain derivatives transactions by holding an offsetting financial position and/or segregating or earmarking liquid assets equal in value to the Fund’s potential economic exposure under the transaction. The Fund will cover such transactions as described herein or in such other manner as may be in accordance with applicable laws and regulations. Assets used to cover derivatives transactions cannot be sold while the derivatives position is open, unless they are replaced by other appropriate assets. Segregated or earmarked liquid assets and assets held in margin accounts are not otherwise available to the Fund for investment purposes. If a large portion of the Fund’s assets are used to cover derivatives transactions or are otherwise segregated, it could affect portfolio management or other current obligations. With respect to derivatives which are cash-settled ( i.e. , have no physical delivery requirement), the Fund is permitted to segregate or earmark cash and/or liquid securities in an amount equal to the Fund’s daily marked-to-market net obligations ( i.e. , the daily net liability) under the derivative, if any, rather than the derivative’s full notional value or the market value of the instrument underlying the derivative, as applicable. By segregating or earmarking cash and/or liquid securities equal to only its net obligations under cash-settled derivatives, the Fund will have the ability to employ a form of leverage through the use of certain derivative transactions to a greater extent than if the Fund were required to segregate assets equal to the full notional amount of the derivative or the market value of the underlying instrument, as applicable.

Each of the exchanges and other trading facilitates on which options are traded has established limitations on the maximum number of put or call options on a given underlying security that may be written by a single investor or group of investors acting in concert, regardless of whether the options are written on different exchanges or through one or more brokers. These position limits may restrict the number of listed options which the Fund may write. Option positions of all investment companies advised by the Investment Adviser are combined for purposes of these limits. An exchange may order the liquidation of positions found to be in excess of these limits and may impose certain other sanctions or restrictions.

INVESTMENT RESTRICTIONS

The Fund operates under the following restrictions that constitute fundamental policies that, except as otherwise noted, cannot be changed without the affirmative vote of the holders of a majority of the outstanding voting securities of the Fund voting together as a single class, which is defined by the 1940 Act as the lesser of (i) 67% or more of the Fund’s voting securities present at a meeting, if the holders of more than 50% of the Fund’s outstanding voting securities are present or represented by proxy; or (ii) more than 50% of the Fund’s outstanding voting securities. Except as otherwise noted, all percentage limitations set forth below apply immediately after a purchase

 

S-14


or initial investment and any subsequent change in any applicable percentage resulting from market fluctuations does not require any action. These restrictions provide that the Fund shall not:

1.    Issue senior securities nor borrow money, except the Fund may issue senior securities or borrow money to the extent permitted by (i) the 1940 Act, as amended from time to time, (ii) the rules and regulations promulgated by the SEC under the 1940 Act, as amended from time to time, or (iii) an exemption or other relief applicable to the Fund from the provisions of the 1940 Act, as amended from time to time.

2.    Act as an underwriter of securities issued by others, except to the extent that, in connection with the disposition of portfolio securities, it may be deemed to be an underwriter under applicable securities laws.

3.    Invest in any security if, as a result, 25% or more of the value of the Fund’s total assets, taken at market value at the time of each investment, are in the securities of issuers in any particular industry, except as otherwise provided by (i) the 1940 Act, as amended from time to time, (ii) the rules and regulations promulgated by the SEC under the 1940 Act, as amended from time to time, or (iii) an exemption or other relief applicable to the Fund from the provisions of the 1940 Act, as amended from time to time; provided, however, that the Fund will, in normal circumstances, invest more than 25% of its assets in the industry or group of industries that constitute the energy sector and may invest to an unlimited degree in securities issued or guaranteed by the U.S. government and its agencies and instrumentalities or tax-exempt securities of state and municipal governments or their political subdivisions.

4.    Purchase or sell real estate except that the Fund may: (a) acquire or lease office space for its own use, (b) invest in securities of issuers that invest in real estate or interests therein or that are engaged in or operate in the real estate industry, (c) invest in securities that are secured by real estate or interests therein, (d) purchase and sell mortgage-related securities, (e) hold and sell real estate acquired by the Fund as a result of the ownership of securities and (f) as otherwise permitted by (i) the 1940 Act, as amended from time to time, (ii) the rules and regulations promulgated by the SEC under the 1940 Act, as amended from time to time, or (iii) an exemption or other relief applicable to the Fund from the provisions of the 1940 Act, as amended from time to time.

5.    Purchase or sell physical commodities unless acquired as a result of ownership of securities or other instruments; provided that this restriction shall not prohibit the Fund from purchasing or selling options, futures contracts and related options thereon, forward contracts, swaps, caps, floors, collars and any other financial instruments or from investing in securities or other instruments backed by physical commodities or as otherwise permitted by (i) the 1940 Act, as amended from time to time, (ii) the rules and regulations promulgated by the SEC under the 1940 Act, as amended from time to time, or (iii) an exemption or other relief applicable to the Fund from the provisions of the 1940 Act, as amended from time to time.

6.    Make loans of money or property to any person, except (a) to the extent that securities or interests in which the respective Fund may invest are considered to be loans, (b) through the loan of portfolio securities, (c) by engaging in repurchase agreements or (d) as may otherwise be permitted by (i) the 1940 Act, as amended from time to time, (ii) the rules and regulations promulgated by the SEC under the 1940 Act, as amended from time to time, or (iii) an exemption or other relief applicable to the respective Fund from the provisions of the 1940 Act, as amended from time to time.

The rest of the Fund’s investment policies, including the Fund’s investment objective and percentage parameters described in the Fund’s Prospectus, are not fundamental policies of the Fund and may be changed without shareholder approval.

MANAGEMENT OF THE FUND

Board of Trustees

The Board of Trustees of the Fund provides broad oversight over the operations and affairs of the Fund and protects the interests of shareholders. The Board of Trustees of the Fund has overall responsibility for monitoring the operations of the Fund and for supervising the services provided by the Investment Adviser and other organizations. The officers of the Fund are responsible for managing the day-to-day operations of the Fund.

 

S-15


The names and ages of the Trustees and officers of the Fund, the year each was first elected or appointed to office, their principal business occupations during the last five years, the number of funds overseen by each Trustee and other directorships or trusteeships during the last five years are shown below. The business address of the Fund, its Trustees and officers is 8117 Preston Road, Suite 440, Dallas, Texas 75225.

 

Name and Year

of Birth

 

Position(s) Held
With the Fund

 

Term of Office
and Length of
Time Served   (1)

 

Principal Occupations

During Past Five

Years

 

Number of
Portfolios in Fund
Complex (2)

Overseen by
Trustee

 

Other

Directorships
Held by Trustee
During the Past

Five Years

Independent Trustees        
Brian R. Bruce (1955)   Lead Independent Trustee   Trustee since 2012   Chief Executive Officer, Hillcrest Asset Management, LLC (2008 to present) (registered investment adviser). Previously, Director of Southern Methodist University’s ENCAP Investment & LCM Group Alternative Asset Management Center (2006 to 2011); Chief Investment Officer of Panagora Asset Management, Inc. (1999 to 2007) (investment management company).   4   CM Advisers Family of Funds (2 series) and Dreman Contrarian Funds (2 series) (2007-present).

Brenda A. Cline

(1960)

  Trustee and Chair of Audit Committee   Trustee since 2017   Executive Vice President, Chief Financial Officer, Secretary and Treasurer of Kimbell Art Foundation (1993-present).   4   American Beacon Funds (25 series) (2004-present); Tyler Technologies, Inc. (2014-present) (software); Range Resources Corporation (2015-present) (natural gas and oil exploration and production).
Ronald P. Trout (1939)   Trustee and Chair of the Nominating and Corporate Governance Committee   Trustee since 2012   Retired. Previously, a founding partner and Senior Vice President of Hourglass Capital Management, Inc. (1989 to 2002) (investment management company).   4   Dorchester Minerals LP (2008-present) (acquisition, ownership and administration of natural gas and crude oil royalty, net profits and leasehold interests in the U.S.).

 

S-16


Interested Trustee        
Jerry V. Swank * (1951)   Trustee, Chair of the Board and Chief Executive Officer and President   Trustee since 2012   Managing Partner of the Investment Adviser and founder of Swank Capital, LLC of (2000 to present).   4   Previously, E-T Energy Ltd. (2008 to 2014) (developing, operating, producing and selling recoverable bitumen); Central Energy Partners, LP (2010 to 2014) (storage and transportation of refined petroleum products and petrochemicals).

 

(1) Each Trustee serves a two year term concurrent with the class of Trustees for which he serves.

 

    Brian R. Bruce and Ronald P. Trout, as Class I Trustees, are expected to stand for re-election at the Fund’s 2019 annual meeting of shareholders.

 

    Jerry V. Swank and Brenda A. Cline, as Class II Trustees, are expected to stand for re-election at the Fund’s 2018 annual meeting of shareholders.

 

(2) The “Fund Complex” includes each other registered investment company for which the Investment Adviser serves as investment adviser. As of the date of this SAI, there are four funds (including the Fund) in the “Fund Complex.”
* Mr. Swank is an “interested person” of the Fund, as defined under the 1940 Act, by virtue of his position as Managing Partner of the Investment Adviser.

Trustee Qualifications

The Board of Trustees has determined that each Trustee should serve as such based on several factors (none of which alone is decisive). Among the factors the Board of Trustees considered when concluding that an individual should serve on the Board of Trustees were the following: (i) availability and commitment to attend meetings and perform the responsibilities of a Trustee, (ii) personal and professional background, (iii) educational background, (iv) financial expertise, and (v) ability, judgment, attributes and expertise. In respect of each current Trustee, the individual’s professional accomplishments and prior experience, including, in some cases, in fields related to the operations of the Fund, were a significant factor in the determination that the individual should serve as a trustee of the Fund.

Following is a summary of various qualifications, experiences and skills of each Trustee (in addition to business experience during the past five years as set forth in the table above) that contributed to the Board of Trustee’s conclusion that an individual should serve on the Board of Trustees. References to the qualifications, attributes and skills of Trustees do not constitute the holding out of any Trustee as being an expert under Section 7 of the 1933 Act or the rules and regulations of the SEC.

Brian R. Bruce . Mr. Bruce has served as a Trustee of the Fund since the Fund’s inception, and has served as a Trustee of the portfolios in the Fund Complex since 2007. Through his experience as a Trustee of and Chairman of the Audit Committee of funds in the Fund Complex and certain other registered investment companies, as a professor at Southern Methodist University’s Cox School of Business and Director of the ENCAP Investments & LCM Group Alternative Asset Management Center and as a chief executive officer, and formerly chief investment officer, of investment management firms, Mr. Bruce is experienced in financial, accounting, regulatory and investment matters.

Brenda A. Cline . Ms. Cline has served as a trustee of a family of investment companies since 2004. Through her organizational management, financial and investment experience as executive vice president, chief financial officer, secretary and treasurer to a private foundation, service as an investment company trustee, service as a director and member of the audit and nominating and governance committees of various publicly held companies, service as a trustee to a private university, and several charitable boards, and extensive experience as an audit senior manager with a large public accounting firm, Ms. Cline is experienced in financial, accounting, regulatory and investment matters.

Ronald P. Trout . Mr. Trout has served as a Trustee of the Fund since the Fund’s inception, and has served as a trustee of the portfolios in the Fund Complex since 2007. Through his experience as a Trustee of Funds in the Fund complex, as founding partner and senior vice president of an investment management firm and his service on the board of a publicly traded natural resources company, Mr. Trout is experienced in financial, regulatory and investment matters.

Jerry V. Swank . Mr. Swank has served as a Trustee of the Fund since the Fund’s inception, and has served as a Trustee of the portfolios in the Fund Complex since 2007. Through his experience as a Trustee and chairman of the

 

S-17


Board of Trustees of Funds in the Fund complex, managing partner of the Investment Adviser and founder of Swank Capital, LLC and his extensive professional experience, with investment firms and an oil & gas research and consulting, Mr. Swank is experienced in financial, regulatory and investment matters.

Board Leadership Structure

The primary responsibility of the Board of Trustees is to represent the interests of the Fund and to provide oversight of the management of the Fund. The Fund’s day-to-day operations are managed by the Investment Adviser and other service providers who have been approved by the Board. The Board is currently comprised of four Trustees, three of whom are classified under the 1940 Act as “non-interested” persons of the Fund (“Independent Trustees”) and one of whom is classified as an interested person of the Fund (“Interested Trustee”). Generally, the Board acts by majority vote of all the Trustees, including a majority vote of the Independent Trustees if required by applicable law.

An Interested Trustee, Mr. Jerry V. Swank, currently serves as Chairman of the Board. The Chairman of the Board presides at meetings of the Board and acts as a liaison with service providers, officers, attorneys and other Trustees generally between meetings, and performs such other functions as may be requested by the Board from time to time.

The Independent Trustees have selected Mr. Brian R. Bruce as lead Independent Trustee. The lead Independent Trustee participates in the planning of Board meetings, seeks to encourage open dialogue and independent inquiry among the trustees and management, and performs such other functions as may be requested by the Independent Trustees from time to time.

The Board meets regularly meets four times each year to discuss and consider matters concerning the Fund, and also holds special meetings to address matters arising between regular meetings. Regular meetings generally take place in-person; other meetings may take place in-person or by telephone. The Independent Trustees are advised by independent legal counsel and regularly meet outside the presence of Fund management.

The Trustees have determined that the efficient conduct of the Trustees’ affairs makes it desirable to delegate responsibility for certain specific matters to committees of the Board. The committees meet as often as necessary, either in conjunction with regular meetings of the Board or otherwise. The committees of the Board are the Audit Committee and the Nominating and Corporate Governance Committee. The functions and role of each Committee are described below under “—Board Committees.” The membership of each Committee consists of all of the Independent Trustees, which the Board believes allows them to participate in the full range of the Board’s oversight duties.

The Board has determined that this leadership structure, including a Chairman of the Board who is an Interested Trustee, a Lead Independent Trustee, a supermajority of Independent Trustees and Committee membership limited to Independent Trustees, is appropriate in light of the characteristics and circumstances of the Fund. In reaching this conclusion, the Board considered, among other things, the role of the Investment Adviser in the day-to-day management of Fund affairs, the extent to which the work of the Board will be conducted through the Committees, the projected net assets of the Fund and the management, distribution and other service arrangements of the Fund. The Board also believes that its structure, including the presence of one Trustee who is an executive officer of the Investment Adviser, facilitates an efficient flow of information concerning the management of the Fund to the Independent Trustees.

Board Committees

Nominating and Corporate Governance Committee . Brian R. Bruce, Ronald P. Trout and Brenda A. Cline, who are not “interested persons” of the Fund, as defined in the 1940 Act, serve on the Fund’s Nominating and Corporate Governance Committee. Ronald P. Trout serves as chair of the Nominating and Corporate Governance Committee. As part of its duties, the Nominating and Corporate Governance Committee makes recommendations to the full Board with respect to candidates for the Board in the event that a position is vacated or created. The Nominating and Corporate Governance Committee would consider Trustee candidates recommended by Shareholders if a vacancy were to exist. Such recommendations should be forwarded to the Secretary of the Fund. In considering candidates submitted by Shareholders, the Nominating and Corporate Governance Committee will take into consideration the needs of the Board and the qualifications of the candidate.

 

S-18


Audit Committee . Brian R. Bruce, Ronald P. Trout and Brenda A. Cline, who are not “interested persons” of the Fund, as defined in the 1940 Act, serve on the Fund’s Audit Committee. Brenda A. Cline serves as chair of the Audit Committee. The Audit Committee is generally responsible for reviewing and evaluating issues related to the accounting and financial reporting policies and internal controls of the Fund and, as appropriate, the internal controls of certain service providers, overseeing the quality and objectivity of the Fund’s financial statements and the audit thereof and acting as a liaison between the Board and the Fund’s independent registered public accounting firm.

Board and Committee Meetings . During the Fund’s fiscal year ended November 30, 2017, the Board held seven (7) meetings and the Audit Committee and the Nominating and Corporate Governance Committee each held one (1) meeting.

Board’s Role in Risk Oversight

The Fund has retained the Investment Adviser to provide investment advisory services and certain administrative services. The Investment Adviser is primarily responsible for the management of risks that may arise from Fund investments and operations. Certain employees of the Investment Adviser serve as the Fund’s officers, including the Fund’s President, Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer. The Board of Trustees oversees the performance of these functions by the Investment Adviser, both directly and through the Committee structure the Board of Trustees has established. The Board of Trustees will receive from the Investment Adviser reports on a regular and as-needed basis relating to the Fund’s investment activities and to the actual and potential risks of the Fund, including reports on investment risks, compliance with applicable laws, and the Fund’s financial accounting and reporting. In addition, the Board of Trustees will meet periodically with the portfolio managers of the Fund to receive reports regarding the portfolio management of the Fund and its performance and investment risks.

In addition, the Board of Trustees has appointed a Chief Compliance Officer (“CCO”). The CCO oversees the development of compliance policies and procedures of the Fund that are reasonably designed to minimize the risk of violations of the federal securities laws (“Compliance Policies”). The CCO reports directly to the Independent Trustees, and will provide presentations to the Board of Trustees at its quarterly meetings and an annual report on the application of the Compliance Policies. The Board of Trustees will discuss relevant risks affecting the Fund with the CCO at these meetings. The Board of Trustees has approved the Compliance Policies and will review the CCO’s reports. Further, the Board of Trustees will annually review the sufficiency of the Compliance Policies, as well as the appointment and compensation of the CCO.

Executive Officers

The following information relates to the executive officers of the Funds who are not Trustees. The officers of the Fund were appointed by the Board of Trustees and will serve until their respective successors are chosen and qualified.

 

Name and Year of Birth    Position    Principal Occupation During the Past Five Years

John H. Alban

(1963)

   Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer    Chief Operating Officer of the Investment Adviser (2010-present); Chief Administrative Officer of NGP Energy Capital Management (2007-2009); COO of Spinnerhawk Capital Management, L.P. (2005-2007).

Barry Y. Greenberg

(1963)

   Chief Compliance Officer and Secretary    General Counsel and Chief Compliance Officer of the Investment Adviser (2010-present); Partner at Akin Gump Strauss Hauer & Feld LLP (2005-2010); Vice President, Legal, Compliance and Administration at American Beacon Advisors (1995-2005); Attorney and Branch Chief at the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission (1988-1995).

Shareholder Communications

Shareholders may send communications to the Fund’s Board of Trustees. Shareholders should send communications intended for the Fund’s Board of Trustees by addressing the communications directly to the Board of Trustees (or individual Board member(s)) and/or otherwise clearly indicating in the salutation that the communication is for the

 

S-19


Board of Trustees (or individual Board members) and by sending the communication to either the Fund’s office or directly to such Board member(s) at the address specified above for each Trustee. Other shareholder communications received by the Fund not directly addressed and sent to the Board of Trustees will be reviewed and generally responded to by management and will be forwarded to the Board of Trustees only at management’s discretion based on the matters contained in those communications.

Remuneration of Trustees and Officers

The following table provides information regarding compensation of the Trustees of each Fund and for the Cushing Funds Complex, each for the fiscal year ended November 30, 2017. Officers of the Funds do not receive any compensation from the Funds. The Trustees do not receive any pension or retirement benefits from the Cushing Funds Complex.

 

Trustee (1)    Aggregate
Estimated
Compensation
From Fund
     Pension or
Retirement
Benefits Accrued
as Part of Fund
Expenses (2)
     Estimated Annual
Benefits Upon
Retirement (2)
     Total
Compensation
from Fund and
Fund Complex
Paid to
Trustees (3)
 

Independent Trustees:

           

Brian R. Bruce

   $ 32,066        None        None      $ 86,000  

Brenda A. Cline (4)

   $ 29,066        None        None      $ 73,000  

Ronald P. Trout

   $ 32,066        None        None      $ 86,000  

 

(1) Trustees not entitled to compensation are not included in the table.
(2) The Fund does not accrue or pay retirement or pension benefits to Trustees as of the date of this SAI.
(3) As of the end of the most recently completed fiscal year. The “Fund Complex” includes the Fund and each other registered investment company for which the Investment Adviser serves as investment adviser. As of the date of this SAI, there are four funds (including the Fund) in the Fund Complex.
(4) Appointed as a trustee effective January 18, 2017.

Trustee Share Ownership

As of December 31, 2017, each Trustee of the Fund beneficially owned equity securities of the Fund and all of the registered investment companies in the family of investment companies overseen by the Trustee in the dollar range amounts specified below.

 

Name of Trustee

   Dollar Range of
Equity Securities in
the Fund
     Aggregate Dollar Range of Equity
Securities in All Registered Investment
Companies Overseen  by Trustee in

Family of Investment Companies (1)
 
Independent Trustees:      
Brian R. Bruce      
Brenda A. Cline      
Ronald P. Trout      
Interested Trustee:      
Jerry V. Swank (2)      

 

(1) The “Family of Investment Companies” includes the Fund and each other registered investment company for which the Investment Adviser serves as investment adviser. As of the date of this SAI, there are four funds (including the Fund) in the Family of Investment Companies.
(2) The Investment Adviser has purchased common shares of the Fund in order to provide the Fund with over $100,000 of net capital as required by the 1940 Act. By virtue of his control of the Investment Adviser, Mr. Swank may be deemed to beneficially own the common shares of the Fund held by the Investment Adviser.

As of December 31, 2017, the Trustees and officers of the Fund as a group owned [less than 1%] of the outstanding common shares of the Fund. There are no control persons of the Fund.

 

S-20


PORTFOLIO MANAGEMENT

Jerry V. Swank, Saket Kumar and Matthew Lemme (the “portfolio managers”) are primarily responsible for the day-to-day management of the Fund’s portfolio. The following section discusses the accounts managed by the portfolio managers, the structure and method of their compensation and potential conflicts of interest.

Other accounts managed by the portfolio managers

The following table reflects information regarding accounts for which each portfolio manager has day-to-day management responsibilities (other than the Fund). Accounts are grouped into three categories: (a) registered investment companies, (b) other pooled investment accounts, and (c) other accounts. To the extent that any of these accounts pay advisory fees that are based on account performance, this information will be reflected in a separate table below. Asset amounts are approximate and have been rounded.

As of November 30, 2017, Mr. Swank managed or was a member of the management team for the following client accounts (excluding the Fund):

 

     Number of
Accounts
   Assets of
Accounts
     Number of
Accounts
Subject to a
Performance
Fee
   Assets
Subject to a
Performance
Fee
 

Registered Investment Companies

   9    $ 1,836,046,548      0    $ 0  

Pooled Investment Vehicles Other Than Registered Investment Companies

   5    $ 225,291,280      5    $ 225,291,280  

Other Accounts

   28    $ 1,365,487,051      7    $ 3,025,820  

As of November 30, 2017, Mr. Kumar managed or was a member of the management team for the following client accounts (excluding the Fund):

 

     Number of
Accounts
   Assets of
Accounts
     Number of
Accounts
Subject to a
Performance
Fee
   Assets
Subject to a
Performance
Fee
 

Registered Investment Companies

   2    $ 345,124,457      0    $ 0  

Pooled Investment Vehicles Other Than Registered Investment Companies

   1    $ 2,146,709      1    $ 2,146,709  

Other Accounts

   1    $ 2,506,215      0    $ 2,506,215  

As of November 30, 2017, Mr. Lemme managed or was a member of the management team for the following client accounts (excluding the Fund):

 

     Number of
Accounts
   Assets of
Accounts
     Number of
Accounts
Subject to a
Performance
Fee
   Assets
Subject to a
Performance
Fee
 

Registered Investment Companies

   3    $ 370,443,545      0    $ 0  

Pooled Investment Vehicles Other Than Registered Investment Companies

   1    $ 2,146,709      1    $ 2,146,709  

Other Accounts

   2    $ 470,859,957      0    $ 0  

Compensation and Potential Conflicts of Interest

Messrs. Swank, Kumar and Lemme are compensated by the Investment Adviser. Mr. Swank is a principal of the Investment Adviser and is compensated through partnership distributions that are based primarily on the profits and losses of the Investment Adviser. The partnership distributions are affected by the amount of assets the Investment Adviser manages and the appreciation of those assets, particularly over the long-term, but are not determined with

 

S-21


specific reference to any particular performance benchmark or time period. Messrs. Kumar and Lemme each receive a fixed salary and a discretionary bonus based on the pre-tax performance of the Fund and other portfolios for which he serves as a portfolio manager. Some of the other accounts managed by Messrs. Swank, Kumar and Lemme have investment strategies that are similar to the Fund’s investment strategy. However, the Investment Adviser manages potential material conflicts of interest by allocating investment opportunities in accordance with its allocation policies and procedures.

Securities Ownership of the Portfolio Managers

As of November 30, 2017, the dollar range of equity securities in the Fund beneficially owned by each portfolio manager was as follows:

Jerry V. Swank . $100,001-$500,000. By virtue of his control of the Investment Adviser, Mr. Swank may be deemed to beneficially own the common shares of the Fund held by the Investment Adviser.

Saket Kumar . None.

Matthew Lemme . $10,001-$50,000.

INVESTMENT MANAGEMENT AGREEMENT

Cushing ® Asset Management, LP acts as the investment adviser to the Fund. The Investment Adviser’s principal business address is 8117 Preston Road, Suite 440, Dallas, Texas 75225.

The Investment Adviser provides investment advisory services to the Fund pursuant to the terms of an Investment Advisory Agreement (the “Investment Management Agreement”), dated July 26, 2012, between the Investment Adviser and the Fund. The Investment Management Agreement has an initial term expiring two years after the date of its execution, and may be continued in effect from year to year thereafter subject to the approval thereof by (1) the Board of Trustees or (2) vote of a majority (as defined by the 1940 Act) of the outstanding voting securities of the Fund, provided that in either event the continuance must also be approved by a majority of the Independent Trustees, by vote cast in person at a meeting called for the purpose of voting on such approval.

The Investment Management Agreement may be terminated at any time, without the payment of any penalty, upon 60 days’ written notice by either party. The Fund may terminate by action of the Board of Trustees or by a vote of a majority of the Fund’s outstanding voting securities (accompanied by appropriate notice), and the Investment Management Agreement will terminate automatically upon its assignment (as defined in the 1940 act and the rules thereunder). The Investment Management Agreement may also be terminated, at any time, without payment of any penalty, by the Board of Trustees or by vote of a majority of outstanding voting securities, in the event that it is established by a court of competent jurisdiction that the Investment Adviser or any principal, officer or employee of the Investment Adviser has taken any action that results in a breach of the covenants of the Investment Adviser set out in the Investment Management Agreement. The Investment Management Agreement will provide that the Investment Adviser will not be liable for any loss sustained by reason of the purchase, sale or retention of any security, whether or not such purchase, sale or retention will have been based upon the investigation and research made by any other individual, firm or corporation, if such recommendation will have been selected with due care and in good faith, except loss resulting from willful misfeasance, bad faith or gross negligence on the part of the Investment Adviser in performance of its obligations and duties, or by reason of its reckless disregard of its obligations and duties under the Investment Management Agreement.

Pursuant to the Investment Management Agreement, the Investment Adviser is responsible for managing the portfolio of the Fund in accordance with its stated investment objective and policies, makes investment decisions for the Fund, placing orders to purchase and sell securities on behalf of the Fund and managing the other business and affairs of the Fund, all subject to the supervision and direction of the Fund’s Board of Trustees. Although the Investment Adviser intends to devote such time and effort to the business of the Fund as is reasonably necessary to perform its duties to the Fund, the services of the Investment Adviser are not exclusive, and the Investment Adviser provides similar services to other clients and may engage in other activities.

 

S-22


Pursuant to the Investment Management Agreement, the Fund has agreed to pay the Investment Adviser a fee, payable at the end of each calendar month, at an annual rate equal to 1.25% of the average weekly value of the Fund’s Managed Assets during such month (the “Management Fee”) for the services and facilities provided by the Investment Adviser to the Fund. “Managed Assets” means the total assets of the Fund, minus all accrued expenses incurred in the normal course of operations other than liabilities or obligations attributable to investment leverage, including, without limitation, investment leverage obtained through (i) indebtedness of any type (including, without limitation, borrowing through a credit facility or the issuance of debt securities), (ii) the issuance of shares of preferred stock or other similar preference securities and/or (iii) the reinvestment of collateral received for securities loaned in accordance with the Fund’s investment objective and policies.

Because the Management Fee is based upon a percentage of the Fund’s Managed Assets, the Management Fee will be higher if the Fund employs leverage. Therefore, the Investment Adviser will have a financial incentive to use leverage, which may create a conflict of interest between the Investment Adviser and the Fund’s common shareholders.

The Investment Adviser also provides such additional administrative services as the Fund may require beyond those furnished by the Administrator and furnishes, at its own expense, such office space, facilities, equipment, clerical help, and other personnel and services as may reasonably be necessary in connection with the operations of the Fund. In addition, the Investment Adviser pays the salaries of officers of the Fund who are employees of the Investment Adviser and any fees and expenses of Trustees of the Fund who are also officers, directors, or employees of the Investment Adviser or who are officers or employees of any company affiliated with the Investment Adviser and bears the cost of telephone service, heat, light, power, and other utilities associated with the services it provides.

Advisory Fees Paid

The following summarizes the investment advisory fees, less any fees waived by the Investment Adviser, paid pursuant to the investment advisory fee agreement in effect during the last three fiscal years ended November 30:

 

2017

  

2016

    

2015

 

$1,762,997

   $ 1,467,185      $ 1,979,660  

PORTFOLIO TRANSACTIONS AND BROKERAGE

Subject to the oversight of the Board of Trustees, the Investment Adviser is responsible for decisions to buy and sell securities for the Fund, the negotiation of the commissions to be paid on brokerage transactions, the prices for principal trades in securities, and the allocation of portfolio brokerage and principal business. It is the policy of the Investment Adviser to seek the best execution at the best security price available with respect to each transaction in light of the overall quality of brokerage and research services provided to the Investment Adviser. In selecting broker/dealers and in negotiating commissions, the Investment Adviser will consider, among other things, the firm’s reliability, the quality of its execution services on a continuing basis and its financial condition.

Section 28(e) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the “1934 Act”), permits an investment adviser, under certain circumstances, to cause an account to pay a broker or dealer who supplies brokerage and research services a commission for effecting a transaction in excess of the amount of commission another broker or dealer would have charged for effecting the transaction. Brokerage and research services include (a) furnishing advice as to the value of securities, the advisability of investing, purchasing or selling securities, and the availability of securities or purchasers or sellers of securities; (b) furnishing analyses and reports concerning issuers, industries, securities, economic factors and trends, portfolio strategy, and the performance of accounts; and (c) effecting securities transactions and performing functions incidental to those transactions (such as clearance, settlement, and custody).

In light of the above, in selecting brokers, the Investment Adviser may consider investment and market information and other research, such as economic, securities and performance measurement research, provided by such brokers, and the quality and reliability of brokerage services, including execution capability, performance, and financial responsibility. Accordingly, the commissions charged by any such broker may be greater than the amount another firm might charge if the Investment Adviser determines in good faith that the amount of such commissions is reasonable in relation to the value of the research information and brokerage services provided by such broker to the Investment Adviser or to the Fund. The Investment Adviser believes that the research information received in this manner provides the Fund with benefits by supplementing the research otherwise available to the Investment Adviser.

 

S-23


The Investment Adviser seeks to allocate portfolio transactions equitably whenever concurrent decisions are made to purchase or sell securities on behalf of the Fund and another advisory account. In some cases, this procedure could have an adverse effect on the price or the amount of securities available to the Fund. In making such allocations between the Fund and other advisory accounts, the main factors considered by the Investment Adviser are the investment objective, the relative size of portfolio holding of the same or comparable securities, the availability of cash for investment and the size of investment commitments generally held, and the views of the persons responsible for recommending investments to the Fund and such other accounts and funds.

Commissions Paid

The Fund paid approximately the following commissions to brokers during the fiscal years shown:

 

Fiscal Year Ended November 30:    All Brokers      Affiliated Brokers  

2012

   $ 107,240        None  

 

Fiscal Year Ended November 30, 2017 Percentages:       

Commissions with affiliate to total Transactions:

     None  

Value of Brokerage Transactions with affiliate to total transactions:

     None  

During the fiscal period ended November 30, 2017, the Fund paid $323,726 in brokerage commissions on transactions totaling $300,223,201 to brokers selected primarily on the basis of research services provided to the Investment Adviser.

U.S. FEDERAL INCOME TAX CONSIDERATIONS

The following discussion is a summary of the U.S. federal income tax considerations generally applicable to the acquisition, ownership and disposition of Common Shares. This discussion is based upon current provisions of the Code, the Treasury regulations promulgated thereunder and judicial and administrative authorities, all of which are subject to change or differing interpretations by the courts or the Internal Revenue Service (the “IRS”), possibly with retroactive effect. This discussion does not address any other U.S. federal tax considerations (such as estate, gift, or net investment taxes) or any state, local or non-U.S. tax considerations. Except as otherwise stated herein, no ruling has been or will be sought from the IRS regarding any matter discussed herein. The Fund’s counsel has not rendered any legal opinion regarding any tax consequences relating to the Fund or an investment in the Fund. No assurance can be given that the IRS would not assert, or that a court would not sustain, a position different from any of the tax aspects set forth below. Unless otherwise noted, this discussion assumes that the Common Shares are held by U.S. persons and that Common Shareholders hold their Common Shares as capital assets for U.S. federal income tax purposes (generally, assets held for investment). No attempt is made to present a detailed explanation of all U.S. federal income tax concerns affecting the Fund and its Common Shareholders (including Common Shareholders owning a large position in the Fund), and the discussions set forth here and in the Prospectus do not constitute tax advice. Investors are urged to consult their own tax advisors regarding the U.S. federal, state, local and foreign tax consequences of investing in the Fund.

Taxation of the Fund

The Fund has elected to be taxed as, and intends to continue to qualify for special tax treatment afforded to, a regulated investment company (“RIC”) under Subchapter M of the Code. As long as it so qualifies, in any taxable year in which it meets the distribution requirements described below, the Fund (but not its Common Shareholders) will not be subject to U.S. federal income tax to the extent that it distributes its investment company taxable income and net recognized capital gains.

In order to qualify to be taxed as a RIC, the Fund must, among other things: (i) derive in each taxable year at least 90% of its gross income from the following sources, which are referred herein as “Qualifying Income”: (a) dividends, interest (including tax-exempt interest), payments with respect to certain securities, loans, and gains from the sale or other disposition of stock, securities, or foreign currencies, or other income (including but not limited to

 

S-24


gain from options, futures and forward contracts) derived with respect to its business of investing in such stock, securities or currencies and (b) net income derived from interests in certain publicly traded partnerships that derive less than 90% of their gross income from the items described in clause (a) above (each a “Qualified Publicly Traded Partnership”); and (ii) diversify its holdings so that, at the end of each quarter of each taxable year (a) at least 50% of the value of the Fund’s total assets is represented by cash and cash items, U.S. government securities, the securities of other regulated investment companies and other securities, with such other securities limited, in respect of any one issuer, to an amount not greater than 5% of the value of the Fund’s total assets and not more than 10% of the outstanding voting securities of such issuer and (b) not more than 25% of the value of the Fund’s total assets is invested in the securities of (I) any one issuer (other than U.S. government securities and the securities of other regulated investment companies), (II) any two or more issuers (other than regulated investment companies) that the Fund controls and that are determined to be engaged in the same business or similar or related trades or businesses or (III) any one or more Qualified Publicly Traded Partnerships. The Fund may generate certain income that might not qualify as good income for purposes of the 90% annual gross income requirement described above. The Fund will monitor the Fund’s transactions to endeavor to prevent the Fund’s disqualification as a RIC.

Income from the Fund’s investments in equity interests of MLPs that are not Qualified Publicly Traded Partnerships (if any) will be Qualifying Income to the extent it is attributable to items of income of such MLP that would be Qualifying Income if earned directly by the Fund.

The Fund’s investments in partnerships, including in Qualified Publicly Traded Partnerships, may result in the Fund being subject to state, local or foreign income, franchise or withholding tax liabilities.

If the Fund fails to satisfy the 90% annual gross income requirement or the asset diversification requirements discussed above in any taxable year, it may be eligible for relief provisions if the failures are due to reasonable cause and not willful neglect and if a penalty tax is paid with respect to each failure to satisfy the applicable requirements. Additionally, relief is provided for certain de minimis failures of the asset diversification requirements where the Fund corrects the failure within a specified period. If the applicable relief provisions are not available or cannot be met, all of the Fund’s income would be subject to corporate-level U.S. federal income tax as described below. The fund cannot provide assurance that the Fund would qualify for any such relief should the Fund fail the 90% annual gross income requirement or the asset diversification requirements discussed above.

As a RIC, the Fund generally is not subject to U.S. federal income tax on income and gains that it distributes each taxable year to its Common Shareholders, provided that in such taxable year it distributes at least 90% of the sum of (i) its investment company taxable income (which includes, among other items, dividends, interest, the excess of any net short-term capital gain over net long-term capital loss and other taxable income, other than net capital gain (as defined below), reduced by deductible expenses) determined without regard to the deduction for dividends and distributions paid and (ii) its net tax-exempt interest income (the excess of its gross tax-exempt interest income over certain disallowed deductions) (the “Annual Distribution Requirement”). The Fund intends to distribute annually all or substantially all of such income and gain on a timely basis. If the Fund retains any investment company taxable income or net capital gain (as defined below), it will be subject to U.S. federal income tax on the retained amount at regular corporate tax rates. In addition, if the Fund fails to qualify as a RIC for any taxable year, and relief is not available as discussed above, it will be subject to U.S. federal income tax on all of its net income and net gains at regular corporate tax rates without any deduction for distributions to Common Shareholders, and distributions generally will be taxable to Common Shareholders as ordinary dividends to the extent of the Fund’s current and accumulated earnings and profits.

The Fund may retain for investment its net capital gain (which consists of the excess of its net long-term capital gain over its net short-term capital loss). However, if the Fund retains any net capital gain or any investment company taxable income, it will be subject to a tax on such amount at regular corporate tax rates. If the Fund retains any net capital gain, it expects to designate the retained amount as undistributed capital gains in a notice to its Common Shareholders, each of whom, if subject to U.S. federal income tax on long-term capital gains, (i) will be required to include in income for U.S. federal income tax purposes its share of such undistributed net capital gain, (ii) will be entitled to credit its proportionate share of the tax paid by the Fund against its U.S. federal income tax liability, if any, and to claim refunds to the extent that the credit exceeds such liability and (iii) will increase its tax basis in its Common Shares by the excess of the amount described in clause (i) over the amount described in clause (ii). A Common Shareholder that is not subject to U.S. federal income tax or otherwise is not required to file a U.S. federal income tax return would be required to file a U.S. federal income tax return on the appropriate form in order to claim a refund for the taxes paid by the Fund.

 

S-25


Amounts not distributed on a timely basis in accordance with a calendar year distribution requirement are subject to a nondeductible 4% U.S. federal excise tax at the Fund level. To avoid the excise tax, the Fund must distribute (or be deemed to have distributed) during each calendar year an amount at least equal to the sum of (i) 98% of its ordinary income (not taking into account any capital gains or losses) for the calendar year and (ii) 98.2% of its capital gains in excess of its capital losses (adjusted for certain ordinary losses) for a one-year period generally ending on October 31 of the calendar year. In addition, the minimum amounts that must be distributed in any year to avoid the excise tax will be increased or decreased to reflect any under-distribution or over-distribution, as the case may be, from the previous year. While the Fund intends to distribute any income and capital gain in the manner necessary to minimize imposition of the 4% federal excise tax, there can be no assurance that sufficient amounts of the Fund’s taxable income and capital gains will be distributed to avoid entirely the imposition of the tax. In that event, the Fund will be liable for the tax only on the amount by which it does not meet the foregoing distribution requirement.

Dividends and distributions will be treated as paid during the calendar year if they are paid during the calendar year or declared by the Fund in October, November or December of the year, payable to Common Shareholders of record on a date during such a month and paid by the Fund during January of the following year. Any such dividend or distribution paid during January of the following year will be deemed to be received by Common Shareholders on December 31 of the year the dividend or distribution was declared, rather than when the dividend or distribution is actually received.

If the Fund were unable to satisfy the 90% distribution requirement or otherwise were to fail to qualify as a RIC in any year, it would be taxed on all of its taxable income in the same manner as an ordinary corporation and distributions to Common Shareholders would not be deductible by the Fund in computing its taxable income. In such case, distributions generally would be eligible (i) for treatment as qualified dividend income in the case of individual Common Shareholders and (ii) for the dividends received deduction in the case of corporate Common Shareholders. To qualify again to be taxed as a RIC in a subsequent year, the Fund would be required to distribute to its Common Shareholders its accumulated earnings and profits attributable to non-RIC years reduced by an interest charge on 50% of such earnings and profits payable by the Fund as an additional tax. In addition, if the Fund failed to qualify as a RIC for a period greater than two taxable years, then, in order to qualify as a RIC in a subsequent year, the Fund would be required to elect to recognize and pay tax on any net built-in gain (the excess of aggregate gain, including items of income, over aggregate loss that would have been realized if the Fund had been liquidated) or, alternatively, be subject to taxation on such built-in gain recognized for a period of ten years.

Gain or loss on the sale of securities by the Fund will generally be long-term capital gain or loss if the securities have been held by the Fund for more than one year. Gain or loss on the sale of securities held for one year or less will be short-term capital gain or loss. If the Fund realizes a net capital loss, the excess of the Fund’s net short term capital loss over the Fund’s net long term capital gain is treated as a short term capital loss arising on the first day of the Fund’s next taxable year and the excess of the Fund’s net long term capital loss over the Fund’s net short term capital gain is treated as a long term capital loss arising on the first day of the Fund’s next taxable year. If future capital gain is offset by carried forward capital losses, such future capital gain is not subject to fund level U.S. federal income tax, regardless of whether they are distributed to Common Shareholders. Accordingly, the Fund does not expect to distribute any such offsetting capital gain. A RIC cannot carry back or carry forward any net operating losses.

The Fund may decide to be taxed as a regular corporation even if the Fund would otherwise qualify as a RIC if the Fund determines that treatment as a corporation for a particular year would be in the Fund’s best interests.

Certain of the Fund’s investment practices are subject to special and complex U.S. federal income tax provisions that may, among other things, (i) disallow, suspend or otherwise limit the allowance of certain losses or deductions (including the dividends received deduction), (ii) convert lower taxed long-term capital gains and qualified dividend income into higher taxed short-term capital gains or ordinary income, (iii) convert ordinary loss or a deduction into capital loss (the deductibility of which is more limited), (iv) cause the Fund to recognize income or gain without a corresponding receipt of cash, (v) adversely affect the time as to when a purchase or sale of stock or securities is deemed to occur, (vi) adversely alter the characterization of certain complex financial transactions and (vii) produce income that will not qualify as good income for purposes of the 90% annual gross income requirement described above. The Fund will monitor its transactions and may make certain tax elections and may be required to borrow money or dispose of securities to mitigate the effect of these rules and prevent disqualification of the Fund as a RIC.

 

S-26


The MLPs in which the Fund intends to invest are expected to be treated as partnerships for U.S. federal income tax purposes. The cash distributions received by the Fund from an MLP may not correspond to the amount of income allocated to the Fund by the MLP in any given taxable year. If the amount of income allocated by an MLP to the Fund exceeds the amount of cash received by the Fund from such MLP, the Fund may have difficulty making distributions to its Common Shareholders in the amounts necessary to satisfy the requirements for maintaining its status as a RIC or avoiding U.S. federal income or excise taxes. Accordingly, the Fund may have to dispose of securities under disadvantageous circumstances in order to generate sufficient cash to satisfy the distribution requirements.

The Fund expects that the income derived by the Fund from the MLPs in which it invests will be Qualifying Income. If, however, an MLP in which the Fund invests is not a Qualified Publicly Traded Partnership, the income derived by the Fund from such investment may not be Qualifying Income and, therefore, could adversely affect the Fund’s status as a RIC. The Fund intends to monitor its investments in MLPs to prevent to disqualification of the Fund as a RIC.

If the Fund invests in foreign securities, its income from such securities may be subject to withholding and other non-U.S. taxes. The Fund will not be eligible to elect to “pass through” to Common Shareholders of the Fund the ability to use the foreign tax deduction or foreign tax credit for foreign taxes paid with respect to qualifying taxes.

If the Fund borrows money, it may be prevented by loan covenants from declaring and paying dividends in certain circumstances. Limits on the Fund’s payment of dividends may prevent it from meeting the Annual Distribution Requirement, and may, therefore, jeopardize the Fund’s qualification for taxation as a RIC, or subject it to the 4% excise tax.

Taxation of U.S. Shareholders

For purposes of this discussion, a “U.S. shareholder” (or in this section, a “shareholder”) is a holder or a beneficial holder of Common Shares which is for U.S. federal income tax purposes (1) a person who is a citizen or resident of the United States, (2) a corporation (or other entity taxable as a corporation for U.S. federal income tax purposes) created or organized in or under the laws of the United States, any State thereof, or the District of Columbia, (3) an estate whose income is subject to U.S. federal income tax regardless of its source, or (4) a trust if (a) a U.S. court is able to exercise primary supervision over the trust’s administration and one or more U.S. persons are authorized to control all substantial decisions of the trust or (b) the trust has in effect a valid election to be treated as a domestic trust for U.S. federal income tax purposes. If a partnership or other entity or arrangement classified as a partnership for U.S. tax purposes holds the Common Shares, the tax treatment of the partnership and each partner generally will depend on the activities of the partnership and the activities of the partner. Partnerships acquiring Common Shares, and partners in such partnerships, should consult their tax advisors. Prospective investors that are not U.S. shareholders should refer to the section “Non U.S. Shareholders” below and are urged to consult their tax advisors with respect to the U.S. federal income tax consequences of an investment in the Fund’s Common Shares, including the potential application of U.S. withholding taxes.

Distributions paid by the Fund from its investment company taxable income (as defined above) (dividends from investment company taxable income referred to hereinafter as “ordinary income dividends”), whether paid in cash or reinvested in Common Shares, are generally taxable to you as ordinary income to the extent of the Fund’s current and accumulated earnings and profits. Certain properly designated distributions may, however, qualify (provided that holding period and other requirements are met by both the Fund and U.S. shareholders) (i) for the dividends received deduction in the case of corporate U.S. shareholders to the extent that the Fund’s income consists of dividend income from U.S. corporations or (ii) in the case of individual U.S. shareholders, as qualified dividend income eligible to be taxed at a reduced maximum rate to the extent that the Fund receives qualified dividend income. Qualified dividend income is, in general, dividend income from taxable domestic corporations and certain foreign corporations. There can be no assurance as to what portion of the Fund’s distributions will qualify for the dividends received deduction or for treatment as qualified dividend income or as to whether the favorable tax treatment for qualified dividend income.

 

S-27


Distributions made from net capital gain, which is the excess of net long-term capital gains over net short-term capital losses (“capital gain dividends”), including capital gain dividends credited to a U.S. shareholder but retained by the Fund, are taxable to U.S. shareholder as long-term capital gains if they have been properly reported by the Fund, regardless of the length of time the U.S. shareholder has owned Common Shares of the Fund. Net long-term capital gain of individuals is generally taxed at a reduced maximum rate. For corporate taxpayers, net long-term capital gain is taxed at ordinary income rates.

If, for any calendar year, the Fund’s total distributions exceed both current earnings and profits and accumulated earnings and profits, the excess will generally be treated as a tax-free return of capital up to the amount of a U.S. shareholder’s tax basis in the Common Shares, reducing that basis accordingly. Such distributions exceeding the U.S. shareholder’s basis will be treated as gain from the sale or exchange of the Common Shares. When you sell your Common Shares, the amount, if any, by which your sales price exceeds your basis in the Fund’s Common Shares is gain subject to tax. Because a return of capital reduces your basis in the Common Shares, it will increase the amount of your gain or decrease the amount of your loss when you sell the Common Shares, all other things being equal.

Generally, after the close of its taxable year, the Fund will provide its U.S. shareholders with a written notice designating the amount of any ordinary income dividends or capital gain dividends and other distributions.

The sale or other disposition of Common Shares will generally result in capital gain or loss to U.S. shareholders measured by the difference between the sale price and the U.S. shareholder’s tax basis in its Common Shares. Generally, a U.S. shareholder’s gain or loss will be long-term gain or loss if the Common Shares have been held for more than one year. Any loss upon the sale or exchange of Common Shares held for six months or less will be treated as long-term capital loss to the extent of any capital gain dividends received (including amounts credited as an undistributed capital gain) by the U.S. shareholder. Any loss a U.S. shareholder realizes on a sale or exchange of Common Shares will be disallowed if the U.S. shareholder acquires other Common Shares (whether through the automatic reinvestment of dividends or otherwise) within a 61-day period beginning 30 days before and ending 30 days after the U.S. shareholder’s sale or exchange of the Common Shares. In such case, the basis of the Common Shares acquired will be adjusted to reflect the disallowed loss. Present law taxes both long-term and short-term capital gains of corporations at the rates applicable to ordinary income. For non-corporate taxpayers, short-term capital gain is taxed at the U.S. federal income tax rates applicable to ordinary income, while long-term capital gain generally is taxed at a reduced maximum U.S. federal income tax rate.

U.S. shareholders may be entitled to offset their capital gain distributions with capital losses. There are several provisions of the Code affecting when capital losses may be offset against capital gain, and limiting the use of losses from certain investments and activities. Accordingly, U.S. shareholders with capital losses are urged to consult their tax advisors.

An investor should be aware that if Common Shares are purchased shortly before the record date for any taxable distribution (including a capital gain dividend), the purchase price likely will reflect the value of the distribution and the investor then would receive a taxable distribution likely to reduce the trading value of such Common Shares, in effect resulting in a taxable return of some of the purchase price.

Dividends and other taxable distributions are taxable to you even though they are reinvested in additional Common Shares. The Fund has the ability to declare a large portion of a dividend in Common Shares. As long as a large enough portion of such dividend is paid in cash (there is no definitive guidance as to what percentage of the dividend must be in cash) and certain requirements are met, the entire distribution will be treated as a dividend for U.S. federal income tax purposes. As a result, U.S. shareholders will be taxed on 100% of the dividend in the same manner as a cash dividend, even though most of the dividend was paid in Common Shares.

Dividends and other distributions paid by the Fund are generally treated for U.S. federal income tax purposes as received by you at the time the dividend or distribution is made. If, however, the Fund pays you a dividend in January that was declared in the previous October, November or December and you were the U.S. shareholder of record on a specified date in one of such months, then such dividend will be treated for U.S. federal income tax purposes as being paid by the Fund and received by you on December 31 of the year in which the dividend was declared. In addition, certain other distributions made after the close of the Fund’s taxable year may be “spilled back” and treated as paid by the Fund (except for purposes of the 4% nondeductible excise tax) during such taxable year. In such case, you will be treated as having received such dividends in the taxable year in which the distributions were actually made.

 

S-28


Non-corporate U.S. shareholders with income in excess of certain thresholds are, in general, subject to an additional tax on their “net investment income,” which ordinarily includes taxable distributions from the Fund and taxable gain on the disposition of the Fund’s common stock.

Withholding at a rate of 30% will be required on dividends in respect of, and, after December 31, 2018, on gross proceeds from the sale of, Common Shares held by or through foreign accounts or foreign intermediaries if certain disclosure requirements related to U.S. accounts or ownership are not satisfied. The Fund will not pay any additional amounts in respect to any amounts withheld.

Taxation of Non-U.S. Shareholders

For purposes of this discussion, a “non-U.S. shareholder” is a holder, other than a partnership (or other entity or arrangement treated as a partnership for U.S. federal income tax purposes), that is not a U.S. shareholder for U.S. federal income tax purposes. Whether an investment in Common Shares is appropriate for a non-U.S. shareholder will depend on that Common Shareholder’s particular circumstances. An investment in Common Shares by a non-U.S. shareholder may have adverse tax consequences. Non-U.S. shareholders should consult their tax advisors before investing in the Common Shares.

A non-U.S. shareholder generally will be subject to U.S. federal withholding tax at a rate of 30% (or possibly a lower rate provided by an applicable tax treaty) on ordinary income dividends to the extent of the Fund’s current and accumulated earnings and profits (except as discussed below). Actual or deemed distributions of the Fund’s net capital gain to a non-U.S. shareholder, and gains recognized by a non-U.S. shareholder upon the sale of Common Shares, will generally not be subject to U.S. federal withholding tax and will not be subject to U.S. federal income tax. Different tax consequences may result if (i) the non-U.S. shareholder is engaged in a trade or business in the United States (and, if an income tax treaty applies, the non-U.S. shareholder’s income or gains are attributable to a permanent establishment maintained by the shareholder in the United States), (ii) in the case of an individual, is present in the United States for 183 days or more during a taxable year and certain other conditions are met, or (iii) the Fund is or has been a “United States real property holding corporation” at any time within the shorter of the five-year period ending on the date the Common Shares are sold or the period that such non-U.S. shareholder held the shares and (as long as the Common Shares are regularly traded on an established securities market at any time during the calendar year in which the sale, exchange or other disposition occurs) such non-U.S. shareholder owns or owned (actually or constructively) more than five percent of the Common Shares at any time during the shorter of the two periods mentioned above. Though the Fund expects that its Common Shares will be treated as “regularly traded” on an established securities market, no assurance can be given in this regard. Special certification requirements apply to a non-U.S. shareholder that is a foreign partnership or a foreign trust, and such entities are urged to consult their tax advisors.

In addition, under certain provisions of the Code referred to as “FATCA,” withholding at a rate of 30% will be required on dividends in respect of, and, after December 31, 2018, on gross proceeds from the sale of, Common Shares held by or through certain foreign financial institutions (including investment funds), unless such institution enters into an agreement with the Treasury to report, on an annual basis, information with respect to interests in, and accounts maintained by, the institution to the extent such interests or accounts are held by certain United States persons or by certain non-U.S. entities that are wholly or partially owned by United States persons and to withhold on certain payments. Accordingly, the entity or entities through which Common Shares are held will affect the determination of whether such withholding is required. Similarly, withholding at a rate of 30% will be required on dividends in respect of, and after December 31, 2018 on the gross proceeds from the sale of, Common Shares held by an investor that is a non-financial non-U.S. entity that does not qualify under certain exemptions, unless such entity either (i) certifies to the Fund that such entity does not have any “substantial United States owners” or (ii) provides certain information regarding the entity’s “substantial United States owners,” which the Fund will in turn provide to the Secretary of the Treasury. An intergovernmental agreement between the United States and an applicable foreign country, or future Treasury regulations or other guidance, may modify these requirements. The Fund will not pay any additional amounts to Common Shareholders in respect of any amounts withheld. Non-U.S. shareholders are encouraged to consult with their tax advisors regarding the possible withholding implications of an investment in Common Shares.

 

S-29


Properly designated dividends paid by the Fund to non-U.S. shareholders are generally exempt from U.S. federal withholding tax where they (i) are paid in respect of the Fund’s “qualified net interest income” (generally, the Fund’s U.S.-source interest income, other than certain contingent interest and interest from obligations of a corporation or partnership in which the Fund is at least a 10% shareholder, reduced by expenses that are allocable to such income) or (ii) are paid in respect of the Fund’s “qualified short-term capital gains” (generally, the excess of the Fund’s net short-term capital gain over the Fund’s long-term capital loss for such taxable year). There can be no assurance that the Fund will distribute any “qualified net interest income” or “qualified short-term capital gains.” In order to qualify for this exemption from withholding, a non-U.S. shareholder must comply with applicable certification requirements relating to its non-U.S. status (including, in general, furnishing an IRS Form W-8BEN or substitute Form). In the case of Common Shares held through an intermediary, the intermediary may withhold even if the Fund designates the payment as qualified net interest income or qualified short-term capital gain. Non-U.S. shareholders should contact their intermediaries with respect to the application of these rules to their accounts.

If the Fund distributes its net capital gains in the form of deemed rather than actual distributions (which the Fund may do in the future), a non-U.S. shareholder will be entitled to a U.S. federal income tax credit or tax refund equal to the shareholder’s allocable share of the tax the Fund pays on the capital gains deemed to have been distributed. In order to obtain the refund, the non-U.S. shareholder must obtain a U.S. taxpayer identification number and file a federal income tax return even if the non-U.S. shareholder is not otherwise required to obtain a U.S. taxpayer identification number or file a federal income tax return. For a corporate non-U.S. shareholder, distributions (both actual and deemed), and gains realized upon the sale of Common Shares that are effectively connected with a U.S. trade or business (or, where an applicable treaty applies, are attributable to a permanent establishment in the United States) may, under certain circumstances, be subject to an additional “branch profits tax” at a 30% rate (or at a lower rate if provided for by an applicable tax treaty). Accordingly, investment in Common Shares may not be appropriate for certain non-U.S. shareholders.

Backup Withholding

The Fund may be required to withhold, for U.S. federal backup withholding purposes, on all taxable distributions to any non-corporate holders of Common Shares who (1) do not furnish the Fund with their correct taxpayer identification number (in the case of individuals, generally their social security number) or a certificate that such Common Shareholder is exempt from backup withholding, or (2) with respect to whom the IRS notifies the Fund that such Common Shareholder has failed to properly report certain interest and dividend income to the IRS and to respond to notices to that effect. A non-U.S. shareholder who is a nonresident alien individual, and who is otherwise subject to withholding of federal income tax, may be subject to backup withholding of federal income tax on dividends unless the non-U.S. shareholder provides the Fund or the dividend paying agent with an IRS Form W-8BEN or IRS Form W-8BEN-E (or an acceptable substitute form) or otherwise meets documentary evidence requirements for establishing that it is a non-U.S. shareholder or otherwise establishes an exemption from backup withholding. Backup withholding is not an additional tax. Any amounts withheld from payments made to a Common Shareholder may be refunded or credited against such Common Shareholder’s U.S. federal income tax liability, if any, provided that the required information is generally furnished to the IRS.

The foregoing is a general summary of the provisions of the Code and the Treasury regulations in effect as they directly govern the taxation of the Fund and its Common Shareholders. These provisions are subject to change by legislative, judicial or administrative action, and any such change may be retroactive. Ordinary income and capital gain dividends may also be subject to state, local and foreign taxes. Investors are urged to consult their tax advisors regarding U.S. federal, state, local and foreign tax consequences of investing in the Fund.

SERVICE PROVIDERS

Administrator

U.S. Bancorp Fund Services LLC, the Administrator, which is located at 615 East Michigan Street, Milwaukee, Wisconsin 53202, serves as the Fund’s administrator pursuant to a fund administration servicing agreement. Pursuant to this agreement, the Administrator provides the Fund with, among other things, compliance oversight, financial reporting oversight and tax reporting. The Fund pays the Administrator a monthly fee computed at an annual rate of 0.09% of the first $100 million of Managed Assets, 0.07% on the next $200 million of Managed

 

S-30


Assets and 0.04% on the balance of Managed Assets, subject to a minimum annual fee of $70,000. The Fund will also pay for the Administrator’s out-of-pocket expenses. The Administrator also serves as fund accountant pursuant to a fund accounting servicing agreement.

Custodian

U.S. Bank, National Association (the “Custodian”), Custody Operations, 1555 N. RiverCenter Drive, Suite 302, Milwaukee, Wisconsin 53212, serves as custodian for the Fund pursuant to the Custodian Agreement with the Fund (the “Custodian Agreement”). The Custodian and the Administrator are affiliates of each other. Under the Custodian Agreement, the Custodian will be responsible for, among other things, receipt of and disbursement of funds from the Fund’s accounts, establishment of segregated accounts as necessary, and transfer, exchange and delivery of Fund portfolio securities.

Transfer Agent

U.S. Bancorp Fund Services, LLC, located at 615 East Michigan Street, Milwaukee, Wisconsin 53202, has entered into a transfer agent servicing agreement with the Fund. Under this agreement, U.S. Bancorp Fund Services, LLC serves as the Fund’s transfer agent, registrar and dividend disbursing agent.

GENERAL INFORMATION

Additional Information

The Prospectus and this SAI constitutes part of a Registration Statement filed by the Fund with the SEC under the Securities Act, and the 1940 Act. The Prospectus and this SAI omit certain of the information contained in the Registration Statement, and reference is hereby made to the Registration Statement and related exhibits for further information with respect to the Fund and the common shares offered hereby. Any statements contained in the Prospectus and herein concerning the provisions of any document are not necessarily complete, and, in each instance, reference is made to the copy of such document filed as an exhibit to the Registration Statement or otherwise filed with the SEC. Each such statement is qualified in its entirety by such reference. The complete Registration Statement may be obtained from the SEC upon payment of the fee prescribed by its rules and regulations or free of charge through the SEC’s website ( http://www.sec.gov ).

Principal Holders

To the Fund’s knowledge, as of November 30, 2017, no person beneficially owned more than 5% of the Fund’s respective outstanding common shares.

Legal Matters

Certain legal matters will be passed on for the Fund by Skadden, Arps, Slate, Meagher & Flom LLP, Chicago, Illinois, in connection with the offering of the Securities.

Independent registered public accounting firm

Ernst & Young LLP, Dallas, Texas, serves as the independent registered public accounting firm of the Fund and will annually render an opinion on the financial statements of the Fund. The Fund’s audited financial statements appearing in the Fund’s annual report to shareholders for the period ended November 30, 2017, including accompanying notes thereto and the report of Ernst & Young LLP thereon, have been incorporated by reference herein in reliance on their report given on their authority as experts in accounting and auditing.

Proxy Voting Policy and Procedures and Proxy Voting Record

The Fund has delegated authority to vote proxies to the Investment Adviser, subject to the supervision of the Board of Trustees. Attached hereto as Appendix B is the Proxy Voting Policy which is currently in effect as of the date of this Statement of Additional Information.

 

S-31


The Proxy Voting Policy is subject to change over time and investors seeking the most current copy of the Proxy Voting Policy should call the Fund toll free at (877) 965-7386. The Fund’s most recent proxy voting record for the period ended June 30 which has been filed with the SEC is available without charge by calling the Fund toll free at (877) 965-7386.

Trustee and Officer Liability

Under the Fund’s Agreement and Declaration of Trust and its Bylaws, and under Delaware law, the Trustees, officers, employees, and certain agents of the Fund are entitled to indemnification under certain circumstances against liabilities, claims, and expenses arising from any threatened, pending, or completed action, suit, or proceeding to which they are made parties by reason of the fact that they are or were such Trustees, officers, employees, or agents of the Fund, subject to the limitations of the 1940 Act that prohibit indemnification that would protect such persons against liabilities to the Fund or its shareholders to which they would otherwise be subject by reason of their own bad faith, willful misfeasance, gross negligence, or reckless disregard of duties.

Code of Ethics

The Fund and the Investment Adviser have adopted a code of ethics under Rule 17j-1 of the 1940 Act. This code permits personnel subject to the code to invest in securities, including securities that may be purchased or held by the Fund. This code of ethics can be reviewed and copied at the SEC’s Public Reference Room in Washington, D.C. Information on the operation of the Public Reference Room may be obtained by calling the SEC at 1-202-551-8090. The code of ethics is available on the EDGAR Database on the SEC’s website ( http://www.sec.gov ), and copies of this code may be obtained, after paying a duplicating fee, by electronic request at the following e-mail address: publicinfo@sec.gov , or by writing the SEC’s Public Reference Section, Washington, D.C. 20549-0102.

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

The Fund’s audited financial statements, including accompanying notes thereto and the report of Ernst & Young LLP thereon, appearing in the Fund’s annual report to shareholders for the period ended             ,         , as contained in the Fund’s Form N-CSR filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission (the “Commission”) on             ,         (Accession Number                    ), are incorporated by reference in this Statement of Additional Information. All other portions of the Fund’s annual and semi-annual reports to shareholders are not incorporated herein by reference and are not part of the Fund’s registration statement, this Statement of Additional Information, the Prospectus or any Prospectus Supplement. Shareholder reports are available upon request and without charge by calling toll-free (877) 965-7386, or you may obtain a copy of such reports from the SEC’s website ( http://www.sec.gov ) or from the Fund’s website at www.cushingcef.com . Information on, or accessible through, the Fund’s website is not a part of, and is not incorporated into, this Statement of Additional Information, the Prospectus or any Prospectus Supplement.

 

 

S-32


Appendix A

Description of Securities Ratings

STANDARD & POOR’S CORPORATION

A brief description of the applicable Standard & Poor’s Corporation (“S&P”) rating symbols and their meanings (as published by S&P) follows.

Issue Credit Ratings Definition

A Standard & Poor’s issue credit rating is a forward-looking opinion about the creditworthiness of an obligor with respect to a specific financial obligation, a specific class of financial obligations, or a specific financial program (including ratings on medium-term note programs and commercial paper programs). It takes into consideration the creditworthiness of guarantors, insurers, or other forms of credit enhancement on the obligation and takes into account the currency in which the obligation is denominated. The opinion reflects S&P’s view of the obligor’s capacity and willingness to meet its financial commitments as they come due, and may assess terms, such as collateral security and subordination, which could affect ultimate payment in the event of default.

Issue credit ratings can be either long term or short term. Short-term ratings are generally assigned to those obligations considered short-term in the relevant market. In the U.S., for example, that means obligations with an original maturity of no more than 365 days—including commercial paper. Short-term ratings are also used to indicate the creditworthiness of an obligor with respect to put features on long-term obligations. The result is a dual rating, in which the short-term rating addresses the put feature, in addition to the usual long-term rating. Medium-term notes are assigned long-term ratings.

Long-Term Issue Credit Ratings*

Issue credit ratings are based, in varying degrees, on S&P’s analysis of the following considerations:

 

    Likelihood of payment—capacity and willingness of the obligor to meet its financial commitment on an obligation in accordance with the terms of the obligation.

 

    Nature of and provisions of the obligation.

 

    Protection afforded by, and relative position of, the obligation in the event of bankruptcy, reorganization, or other arrangement under the laws of bankruptcy and other laws affecting creditors’ rights.

Issue ratings are an assessment of default risk, but may incorporate an assessment of relative seniority or ultimate recovery in the event of default. Junior obligations are typically rated lower than senior obligations, to reflect the lower priority in bankruptcy, as noted above. (Such differentiation may apply when an entity has both senior and subordinated obligations, secured and unsecured obligations, or operating company and holding company obligations.)

AAA An obligation rated ‘AAA’ has the highest rating assigned by S&P. The obligor’s capacity to meet its financial commitment on the obligation is extremely strong.

AA An obligation rated ‘AA’ differs from the highest-rated obligations only to a small degree. The obligor’s capacity to meet its financial commitment on the obligation is very strong.

A An obligation rated ‘A’ is somewhat more susceptible to the adverse effects of changes in circumstances and economic conditions than obligations in higher-rated categories. However, the obligor’s capacity to meet its financial commitment on the obligation is still strong.

 

* Plus (+) or minus (-) The ratings from ‘AA’ to ‘CCC’ may be modified by the addition of a plus (+) or minus (-) sign to show relative standing within the major rating categories.

 

A-1


BBB An obligation rated ‘BBB’ exhibits adequate protection parameters. However, adverse economic conditions or changing circumstances are more likely to lead to a weakened capacity of the obligor to meet its financial commitment on the obligation.

BB; B; CCC; CC; and C Obligations rated ‘BB’, ‘B’, ‘CCC’, ‘CC’, and ‘C’ are regarded as having significant speculative characteristics. ‘BB’ indicates the least degree of speculation and ‘C’ the highest. While such obligations will likely have some quality and protective characteristics, these may be outweighed by large uncertainties or major exposures to adverse conditions.

BB An obligation rated ‘BB’ is less vulnerable to nonpayment than other speculative issues. However, it faces major ongoing uncertainties or exposure to adverse business, financial, or economic conditions which could lead to the obligor’s inadequate capacity to meet its financial commitment on the obligation.

B An obligation rated ‘B’ is more vulnerable to nonpayment than obligations rated ‘BB’, but the obligor currently has the capacity to meet its financial commitment on the obligation. Adverse business, financial, or economic conditions will likely impair the obligor’s capacity or willingness to meet its financial commitment on the obligation.

CCC An obligation rated ‘CCC’ is currently vulnerable to nonpayment, and is dependent upon favorable business, financial, and economic conditions for the obligor to meet its financial commitment on the obligation. In the event of adverse business, financial, or economic conditions, the obligor is not likely to have the capacity to meet its financial commitment on the obligation.

CC An obligation rated ‘CC’ is currently highly vulnerable to nonpayment.

C A ‘C’ rating is assigned to obligations that are currently highly vulnerable to nonpayment, obligations that have payment arrearages allowed by the terms of the documents, or obligations of an issuer that is the subject of a bankruptcy petition or similar action which have not experienced a payment default. Among others, the ‘C’ rating may be assigned to subordinated debt, preferred stock or other obligations on which cash payments have been suspended in accordance with the instrument’s terms or when preferred stock is the subject of a distressed exchange offer, whereby some or all of the issue is either repurchased for an amount of cash or replaced by other instruments having a total value that is less than par.

D An obligation rated ‘D’ is in payment default. The ‘D’ rating category is used when payments on an obligation are not made on the date due, unless Standard & Poor’s believes that such payments will be made within five business days, irrespective of any grace period. The ‘D’ rating also will be used upon the filing of a bankruptcy petition or the taking of similar action if payments on an obligation are jeopardized. An obligation’s rating is lowered to ‘D’ upon completion of a distressed exchange offer, whereby some or all of the issue is either repurchased for an amount of cash or replaced by other instruments having a total value that is less than par.

NR This indicates that no rating has been requested, that there is insufficient information on which to base a rating, or that S&P does not rate a particular obligation as a matter of policy.

Short-Term Issue Credit Ratings

A-1 A short-term obligation rated ‘A-1’ is rated in the highest category by S&P. The obligor’s capacity to meet its financial commitment on the obligation is strong. Within this category, certain obligations are designated with a plus sign (+). This indicates that the obligor’s capacity to meet its financial commitment on these obligations is extremely strong.

A-2 A short-term obligation rated ‘A-2’ is somewhat more susceptible to the adverse effects of changes in circumstances and economic conditions than obligations in higher rating categories. However, the obligor’s capacity to meet its financial commitment on the obligation is satisfactory.

A-3 A short-term obligation rated ‘A-3’ exhibits adequate protection parameters. However, adverse economic conditions or changing circumstances are more likely to lead to a weakened capacity of the obligor to meet its financial commitment on the obligation.

 

A-2


B A short-term obligation rated ‘B’ is regarded as vulnerable and has significant speculative characteristics. The obligor currently has the capacity to meet its financial commitments; however, it faces major ongoing uncertainties which could lead to the obligor’s inadequate capacity to meet its financial commitments.

C A short-term obligation rated ‘C’ is currently vulnerable to nonpayment and is dependent upon favorable business, financial, and economic conditions for the obligor to meet its financial commitment on the obligation.

D A short-term obligation rated ‘D’ is in payment default. The ‘D’ rating category is used when payments on an obligation are not made on the date due, unless Standard & Poor’s believes that such payments will be made within any stated grace period. However, any stated grace period longer than five business days will be treated as five business days. The ‘D’ rating also will be used upon the filing of a bankruptcy petition or the taking of a similar action if payments on an obligation are jeopardized.

SPUR (S&Ps Underlying Rating) A SPUR rating is a rating of a stand-alone capacity of an issue to pay debt service on a credit-enhanced debt issue, without giving effect to the enhancement that applies to it. These ratings are published only at the request of the debt issuer/obligor with the designation SPUR to distinguish them from the credit-enhanced rating that applies to the debt issue. S&P maintains surveillance of an issue with a published SPUR.

Municipal Short-Term Note Ratings Definitions

A S&P’s U.S. Municipal note rating reflects S&P’s opinion about the liquidity factors and market access risks unique to the notes. Notes due in three years or less will likely receive a note rating. Notes with an original maturity of more than three years will most likely receive a long-term debt rating. In determining which type of rating, if any, to assign, S&P’s analysis will review the following considerations:

 

    Amortization schedule — the larger the final maturity relative to other maturities, the more likely it will be treated as a note; and

 

    Source of payment — the more dependent the issue is on the market for its refinancing, the more likely it will be treated as a note.

Note rating symbols are as follows:

SP-1 Strong capacity to pay principal and interest. An issue determined to possess a very strong capacity to pay debt service is given a plus (+) designation.

SP-2 Satisfactory capacity to pay principal and interest, with some vulnerability to adverse financial and economic changes over the term of the notes.

SP-3 Speculative capacity to pay principal and interest.

Dual Ratings S&P assigns “dual” ratings to all debt issues that have a put option or demand feature as part of their structure. The first rating addresses the likelihood of repayment of principal and interest as due, and the second rating addresses only the demand feature. The long-term rating symbols are used for bonds to denote the long-term maturity and the short-term rating symbols for the put option (for example, ‘AAA/A-1+’). With U.S. municipal short-term demand debt, note rating symbols are used with the short-term issue credit rating symbols (for example, ‘SP-1+/A-1+’).

The ratings and other credit related opinions of S&P and its affiliates are statements of opinion as of the date they are expressed and not statements of fact or recommendations to purchase, hold, or sell any securities or make any investment decisions. S&P assumes no obligation to update any information following publication. Users of ratings and credit related opinions should not rely on them in making any investment decision. S&P’s opinions and analyses do not address the suitability of any security. S&P’s Financial Services LLC does not act as a fiduciary or an investment advisor. While S&P has obtained information from sources it believes to be reliable, S&P does not perform an audit and undertakes no duty of due diligence or independent verification of any information it receives. Ratings and credit related opinions may be changed, suspended, or withdrawn at any time.

 

A-3


Active Qualifiers (Currently Applied and/or Outstanding)

i This suffix is used for issues in which the credit factors, terms, or both, that determine the likelihood of receipt of payment of interest are different from the credit factors, terms or both that determine the likelihood of receipt of principal on the obligation. The ‘i’ suffix indicates that the rating addresses the interest portion of the obligation only. The ‘i’ suffix will always be used in conjunction with the ‘p’ suffix, which addresses likelihood of receipt of principal. For example, a rated obligation could be assigned ratings of “AAAp NRi” indicating that the principal portion is rated “AAA” and the interest portion of the obligation is not rated.

L Ratings qualified with ‘L’ apply only to amounts invested up to federal deposit insurance limits.

p This suffix is used for issues in which the credit factors, the terms, or both, that determine the likelihood of receipt of payment of principal are different from the credit factors, terms or both that determine the likelihood of receipt of interest on the obligation. The ‘p’ suffix indicates that the rating addresses the principal portion of the obligation only. The ‘p’ suffix will always be used in conjunction with the ‘i’ suffix, which addresses likelihood of receipt of interest. For example, a rated obligation could be assigned ratings of “AAAp NRi” indicating that the principal portion is rated “AAA” and the interest portion of the obligation is not rated.

pi Ratings with a ‘pi’ suffix are based on an analysis of an issuer’s published financial information, as well as additional information in the public domain. They do not, however, reflect in-depth meetings with an issuer’s management and therefore may be based on less comprehensive information than ratings without a ‘pi’ suffix. Ratings with a ‘pi’ suffix are reviewed annually based on a new year’s financial statements, but may be reviewed on an interim basis if a major event occurs that may affect the issuer’s credit quality.

preliminary Preliminary ratings, with the ‘prelim’ suffix, may be assigned to obligors or obligations, including financial programs, in the circumstances described below. Assignment of a final rating is conditional on the receipt by S&P of appropriate documentation. S&P reserves the right not to issue a final rating. Moreover, if a final rating is issued, it may differ from the preliminary rating.

 

    Preliminary ratings may be assigned to obligations, most commonly structured and project finance issues, pending receipt of final documentation and legal opinions.

 

    Preliminary ratings are assigned to Rule 415 Shelf Registrations. As specific issues, with defined terms, are offered from the master registration, a final rating may be assigned to them in accordance with Standard & Poor’s policies.

 

    Preliminary ratings may be assigned to obligations that will likely be issued upon the obligor’s emergence from bankruptcy or similar reorganization, based on late-stage reorganization plans, documentation and discussions with the obligor. Preliminary ratings may also be assigned to the obligors. These ratings consider the anticipated general credit quality of the reorganized or post-bankruptcy issuer as well as attributes of the anticipated obligation(s).

 

    Preliminary ratings may be assigned to entities that are being formed or that are in the process of being independently established when, in S&P’s opinion, documentation is close to final.

 

    Preliminary ratings may also be assigned to these entities’ obligations.

 

    Preliminary ratings may be assigned when a previously unrated entity is undergoing a well-formulated restructuring, recapitalization, significant financing or other transformative event, generally at the point that investor or lender commitments are invited. The preliminary rating may be assigned to the entity and to its proposed obligation(s). These preliminary ratings consider the anticipated general credit quality of the obligor, as well as attributes of the anticipated obligation(s), assuming successful completion of the transformative event. Should the transformative event not occur, S&P would likely withdraw these preliminary ratings.

 

    A preliminary recovery rating may be assigned to an obligation that has a preliminary issue credit rating.

 

A-4


sf The (sf) suffix is assigned to all issues and issuers to which a regulation, such as the European Union Regulation on Credit Rating Agencies, requires the assignment of an additional symbol which distinguishes a structured finance instrument or obligor (as defined in the regulation) from any other instrument or obligor. The addition of this suffix to a credit rating does not change the definition of that rating or our opinion about the issue’s or issuer’s creditworthiness.

t This symbol indicates termination structures that are designed to honor their contracts to full maturity or, should certain events occur, to terminate and cash settle all their contracts before their final maturity date.

unsolicited Unsolicited ratings are those credit ratings assigned at the initiative of S&P and not at the request of the issuer or its agents.

MOODY’S INVESTORS SERVICE, INC.

A brief description of the applicable Moody’s Investors Service, Inc. (“Moody’s”) rating symbols and their meanings (as published by Moody’s) follows.

Global Rating Scales

Ratings assigned on Moody’s global long-term and short-term rating scales are forward-looking opinions of the relative credit risks of financial obligations issued by non-financial corporates, financial institutions, structured finance vehicles, project finance vehicles, and public sector entities. Long-term ratings are assigned to issuers or obligations with an original maturity of one year or more and reflect both on the likelihood of a default on contractually promised payments and the expected financial loss suffered in the event of default. Short-term ratings are assigned to obligations with an original maturity of thirteen months or less and reflect both on the likelihood of a default on contractually promised payments and the expected financial loss suffered in the event of default.

Moody’s differentiates structured finance ratings from fundamental ratings (i.e., ratings on nonfinancial corporate, financial institution, and public sector entities) on the global long-term scale by adding (sf ) to all structured finance ratings. The addition of (sf ) to structured finance ratings should eliminate any presumption that such ratings and fundamental ratings at the same letter grade level will behave the same. The (sf ) indicator for structured finance security ratings indicates that otherwise similarly rated structured finance and fundamental securities may have different risk characteristics. rough its current methodologies, however, Moody’s aspires to achieve broad expected equivalence in structured finance and fundamental rating performance when measured over a long period of time.

Global Long-Term Rating Scale

Aaa Obligations rated Aaa are judged to be of the highest quality, subject to the lowest level of credit risk.

Aa Obligations rated Aa are judged to be of high quality and are subject to very low credit risk.

A Obligations rated A are judged to be upper-medium grade and are subject to low credit risk.

Baa Obligations rated Baa are judged to be medium-grade and subject to moderate credit risk and as such may possess certain speculative characteristics.

Ba Obligations rated Ba are judged to be speculative and are subject to substantial credit risk.

B Obligations rated B are considered speculative and are subject to high credit risk.

Caa Obligations rated Caa are judged to be speculative of poor standing and are subject to very high credit risk.

Ca Obligations rated Ca are highly speculative and are likely in, or very near, default, with some prospect of recovery of principal and interest.

 

A-5


C Obligations rated C are the lowest rated and are typically in default, with little prospect for recovery of principal or interest.

Note: Moody’s appends numerical modifiers 1, 2, and 3 to each generic rating classification from Aa through Caa. The modifier 1 indicates that the obligation ranks in the higher end of its generic rating category; the modifier 2 indicates a mid-range ranking; and the modifier 3 indicates a ranking in the lower end of that generic rating category. Additionally, a “(hyb)” indicator is appended to all ratings of hybrid securities issued by banks, insurers, finance companies, and securities firms.

By their terms, hybrid securities allow for the omission of scheduled dividends, interest, or principal payments, which can potentially result in impairment if such an omission occurs. Hybrid securities may also be subject to contractually allowable write-downs of principal that could result in impairment. Together with the hybrid indicator, the long-term obligation rating assigned to a hybrid security is an expression of the relative credit risk associated with that security.

Global Short-Term Rating Scale

P-1 Issuers (or supporting institutions) rated Prime-1 have a superior ability to repay short-term debt obligations.

P-2 Issuers (or supporting institutions) rated Prime-2 have a strong ability to repay short-term debt obligations.

P-3 Issuers (or supporting institutions) rated Prime-3 have an acceptable ability to repay short-term obligations.

NP Issuers (or supporting institutions) rated Not Prime do not fall within any of the Prime rating categories.

Short-Term Obligation Ratings. While the global short-term ‘prime’ rating scale is applied to US municipal tax-exempt commercial paper, these programs are typically backed by external letters of credit or liquidity facilities and their short-term prime ratings usually map to the long-term rating of the enhancing bank or financial institution and not the municipality’s rating. Other short-term municipal obligations, which generally have different funding sources for repayment, are rated using two additional short-term rating scales (i.e., the MIG and VMIG scales discussed below).

The Municipal Investment Grade (MIG) scale is used to rate US municipal bond anticipation notes of up to three years maturity. Municipal notes rated on the MIG scale may be secured by either pledged revenues or proceeds of a take-out financing received prior to note maturity. MIG ratings expire at the maturity of the obligation, and the issuer’s long-term rating is only one consideration in assigning the MIG rating. MIG ratings are divided into three levels — MIG1 through MIG3 — while speculative grade short-term obligations are designated SG.

MIG 1 This designation denotes superior credit quality. Excellent protection is afforded by established cash flows, highly reliable liquidity support, or demonstrated broad-based access to the market for refinancing.

MIG 2 This designation denotes strong credit quality. Margins of protection are ample, although not as large as in the preceding group.

MIG 3 This designation denotes acceptable credit quality. Liquidity and cash-flow protection may be narrow, and market access for refinancing is likely to be less well-established.

SG This designation denotes speculative-grade credit quality. Debt instruments in this category may lack sufficient margins of protection.

Demand Obligation Ratings. In the case of variable rate demand obligations (VRDOs), a two-component rating is assigned; a long- or short-term debt rating and a demand obligation rating. The first element represents Moody’s evaluation of risk associated with scheduled principal and interest payments. The second element represents Moody’s evaluation of risk associated with the ability to receive purchase price upon demand (“demand feature”), using a variation of the MIG rating scale, the Variable Municipal Investment Grade or VMIG rating. The rating transitions on the VMIG scale differ from those on the Prime scale to reflect the risk that external liquidity support generally will terminate if the issuer’s long-term rating drops below investment grade.

 

A-6


VMIG 1 This designation denotes superior credit quality. Excellent protection is afforded by the superior short-term credit strength of the liquidity provider and structural and legal protections that ensure the timely payment of purchase price upon demand.

VMIG 2 This designation denotes strong credit quality. Good protection is afforded by the strong short-term credit strength of the liquidity provider and structural and legal protections that ensure the timely payment of purchase price upon demand.

VMIG 3 This designation denotes acceptable credit quality. Adequate protection is afforded by the satisfactory short-term credit strength of the liquidity provider and structural and legal protections that ensure the timely payment of purchase price upon demand.

SG This designation denotes speculative-grade credit quality. Demand features rated in this category may be supported by a liquidity provider that does not have an investment grade short-term rating or may lack the structural and/or legal protections necessary to ensure the timely payment of purchase price upon demand.

Other Ratings Symbols

e Expected Ratings Indicator. To address market demand for timely information on particular types of credit ratings, Moody’s has licensed to certain third parties the right to generate “Expected Ratings.” Expected Ratings are designated by an “e” after the rating code, and are intended to anticipate Moody’s forthcoming rating assignments based on reliable information from third party sources (such as the issuer or underwriter associated with the particular securities) or established Moody’s rating practices (i.e. medium term notes are typically, but not always, assigned the same rating as the note’s program rating). Expected Ratings will exist only until Moody’s confirms the Expected Rating, or issues a different rating for the relevant instrument. Moody’s encourages market participants to contact Moody’s Ratings Desk or visit www.moodys.com if they have questions, or wish Moody’s to confirm an Expected Rating.

(P) Provisional Ratings. As a service to the market and at the request of an issuer, Moody’s will often assign a provisional rating when the assignment of a final rating is subject to the fulfillment of contingencies but it is highly likely that the rating will become definitive after all documents are received or an obligation is issued into the market. A provisional rating is denoted by placing a (P) in front of the rating. Such ratings are typically assigned to shelf registrations under SEC rule 415 or transaction-based structures that require investor education. When a transaction uses a well-established structure and the transaction’s structure and terms are not expected to change prior to sale in a manner that would affect the rating, a definitive rating may be assigned directly.

# Refundeds. Issues that are secured by escrowed funds held in trust, reinvested in direct, non-callable US government obligations or non-callable obligations unconditionally guaranteed by the US Government or Resolution Funding Corporation are identified with a # (hatch mark) symbol, e.g., #Aaa.

WR Withdrawn. When Moody’s no longer rates an obligation on which it previously maintained a rating, the symbol WR is employed.

NR Not Rated. The symbol NR is assigned to unrated obligations, issuers and/or programs.

NAV Not Available. An issue that Moody’s has not yet rated is denoted by the NAV symbol.

TWR Terminated Without Rating. The symbol TWR applies primarily to issues that mature or are redeemed without having been rated.

FITCH RATINGS, INC.

A brief description of the applicable Fitch Ratings, Inc. (“Fitch”) ratings symbols and meanings (as published by Fitch) follows.

 

A-7


Rated entities in a number of sectors, including financial and non-financial corporations, sovereigns and insurance companies, are generally assigned Issuer Default Ratings (IDRs). IDRs opine on an entity’s relative vulnerability to default on financial obligations. The “threshold” default risk addressed by the IDR is generally that of the financial obligations whose non-payment would best reflect the uncured failure of that entity. As such, IDRs also address relative vulnerability to bankruptcy, administrative receivership or similar concepts, although the agency recognizes that issuers may also make pre-emptive and therefore voluntary use of such mechanisms.

In aggregate, IDRs provide an ordinal ranking of issuers based on the agency’s view of their relative vulnerability to default, rather than a prediction of a specific percentage likelihood of default. For historical information on the default experience of Fitch-rated issuers, please consult the transition and default performance studies available from the Fitch Ratings website.

Long-Term Credit Ratings Scales

AAA Highest credit quality. ‘AAA’ ratings denote the lowest expectation of default risk. They are assigned only in cases of exceptionally strong capacity for payment of financial commitments. This capacity is highly unlikely to be adversely affected by foreseeable events.

AA Very high credit quality . ‘AA’ ratings denote expectations of very low default risk. They indicate very strong capacity for payment of financial commitments. This capacity is not significantly vulnerable to foreseeable events.

A High credit quality. ‘A’ ratings denote expectations of low default risk. The capacity for payment of financial commitments is considered strong. This capacity may, nevertheless, be more vulnerable to adverse business or economic conditions than is the case for higher ratings.

BBB Good credit quality. ‘BBB’ ratings indicate that expectations of default risk are currently low. The capacity for payment of financial commitments is considered adequate but adverse business or economic conditions are more likely to impair this capacity.

BB Speculative . ‘BB’ ratings indicate an elevated vulnerability to default risk, particularly in the event of adverse changes in business or economic conditions over time; however, business or financial flexibility exists which supports the servicing of financial commitments.

B Highly speculative. ‘B’ ratings indicate that material default risk is present, but a limited margin of safety remains. Financial commitments are currently being met; however, capacity for continued payment is vulnerable to deterioration in the business and economic environment.

CCC Substantial credit risk. Default is a real possibility.

CC Very high levels of credit risk. Default of some kind appears probable.

C Exceptionally High Levels of Credit Risk . Default is imminent or inevitable, or the issuer is in standstill.

Conditions that are indicative of a ‘C’ category rating for an issuer include:

 

  a. the issuer has entered into a grace or cure period following non-payment of a material financial obligation;

 

  b. the issuer has entered into a temporary negotiated waiver or standstill agreement following a payment default on a material financial obligation; or

 

  c. Fitch Ratings otherwise believes a condition of ‘RD’ or ‘D’ to be imminent or inevitable, including through the formal announcement of a distressed debt exchange.

RD Restricted default. ‘RD’ ratings indicate an issuer that in Fitch’s opinion has experienced an uncured payment default on a bond, loan or other material financial obligation but which has not entered into bankruptcy filings, administration, receivership, liquidation or other formal winding-up procedure, and which has not otherwise ceased operating. This would include:

 

  a. the selective payment default on a specific class or currency of debt;

 

A-8


  b. the uncured expiry of any applicable grace period, cure period or default forbearance period following a payment default on a bank loan, capital markets security or other material financial obligation;

 

  c. the extension of multiple waivers or forbearance periods upon a payment default on one or more material financial obligations, either in series or in parallel; or

 

  d. execution of a distressed debt exchange on one or more material financial obligations.

D Default. ‘D’ ratings indicate an issuer that in Fitch Ratings’ opinion has entered into bankruptcy filings, administration, receivership, liquidation or other formal winding-up procedure, or which has otherwise ceased business.

Default ratings are not assigned prospectively to entities or their obligations; within this context, non-payment on an instrument that contains a deferral feature or grace period will generally not be considered a default until after the expiration of the deferral or grace period, unless a default is otherwise driven by bankruptcy or other similar circumstance, or by a distressed debt exchange.

“Imminent” default typically refers to the occasion where a payment default has been intimated by the issuer, and is all but inevitable. This may, for example, be where an issuer has missed a scheduled payment, but (as is typical) has a grace period during which it may cure the payment default. Another alternative would be where an issuer has formally announced a distressed debt exchange, but the date of the exchange still lies several days or weeks in the immediate future.

In all cases, the assignment of a default rating reflects the agency’s opinion as to the most appropriate rating category consistent with the rest of its universe of ratings, and may differ from the definition of default under the terms of an issuer’s financial obligations or local commercial practice.

Note: The modifiers “+” or “-” may be appended to a rating to denote relative status within major rating categories. Such suffixes are not added to the ‘AAA’ Long-Term IDR category, or to Long-Term IDR categories below ‘B’.

Limitations for the Issuer Credit Rating Scale:

Specific limitations relevant to the issuer credit rating scale include:

 

    The ratings do not predict a specific percentage of default likelihood over any given time period.

 

    The ratings do not opine on the market value of any issuer’s securities or stock, or the likelihood that this value may change.

 

    The ratings do not opine on the liquidity of the issuer’s securities or stock.

 

    The ratings do not opine on the possible loss severity on an obligation should an issuer default.

 

    The ratings do not opine on the suitability of an issuer as counterparty to trade credit.

 

    The ratings do not opine on any quality related to an issuer’s business, operational or financial profile other than the agency’s opinion on its relative vulnerability to default.

Ratings assigned by Fitch Ratings articulate an opinion on discrete and specific areas of risk. The above list is not exhaustive, and is provided for the reader’s convenience.

Short-Term Ratings Assigned to Issuers or Obligations in Corporate, Public and Structured Finance. A short-term issuer or obligation rating is based in all cases on the short-term vulnerability to default of the rated entity or security stream and relates to the capacity to meet financial obligations in accordance with the documentation governing the relevant obligation. Short-Term Ratings are assigned to obligations whose initial maturity is viewed as “short term” based on market convention. Typically, this means up to 13 months for corporate, sovereign, and structured obligations, and up to 36 months for obligations in U.S. public finance markets.

 

A-9


F1: Highest short-term credit quality. Indicates the strongest intrinsic capacity for timely payment of financial commitments; may have an added “+” to denote any exceptionally strong credit feature.

F2: Good short-term credit quality. Good intrinsic capacity for timely payment of financial commitments.

F3: Fair short-term credit quality. The intrinsic capacity for timely payment of financial commitments is adequate.

B: Speculative short-term credit quality. Minimal capacity for timely payment of financial commitments, plus heightened vulnerability to near term adverse changes in financial and economic conditions.

C: High short-term default risk. Default is a real possibility.

RD: Restricted default. Indicates an entity that has defaulted on one or more of its financial commitments, although it continues to meet other financial obligations. Applicable to entity ratings only.

D: Default. Indicates a broad-based default event for an entity, or the default of a short-term obligation.

Limitations of the Short-Term Ratings Scale:

Specific limitations relevant to the Short-Term Ratings scale include:

 

    The ratings do not predict a specific percentage of default likelihood over any given time period.

 

    The ratings do not opine on the market value of any issuer’s securities or stock, or the likelihood that this value may change.

 

    The ratings do not opine on the liquidity of the issuer’s securities or stock.

 

    The ratings do not opine on the possible loss severity on an obligation should an obligation default.

 

    The ratings do not opine on any quality related to an issuer or transaction’s profile other than the agency’s opinion on the relative vulnerability to default of the rated issuer or obligation.

Ratings assigned by Fitch Ratings articulate an opinion on discrete and specific areas of risk. The above list is not exhaustive, and is provided for the reader’s convenience.

 

A-10


Appendix B

PROXY VOTING POLICY AND PROCEDURES

Cushing ® Asset Management, L.P. (the “Investment Manager”) serves as the investment adviser and general partner, respectively, of certain the investment accounts and pooled investment (each a “Client” and collectively, the “Clients”). Through these relationships the Investment Manager is sometimes delegated the right to vote, on behalf of the Clients, proxies received from companies, the securities of which are owned by the Clients.

Purpose

The Investment Manager follows this proxy voting policy (the “Policy”) to ensure that proxies the Investment Manager votes, on behalf of each Client, are voted to further the best interest of that Client. The Policy establishes a mechanism to address any conflicts of interests between the Investment Manager and the Client. Further, the Policy establishes how Clients may obtain information on how the proxies have been voted.

Determination of Vote

The Investment Manager determines how to vote after studying the proxy materials and any other materials that may be necessary or beneficial to voting. The Investment Manager votes in a manner that the Investment Manager believes reasonably furthers the best interests of the Client and is consistent with the Client’s investment philosophy as set forth in the relevant investment management documents.

The major proxy-related issues generally fall within five categories: corporate governance, takeover defenses, compensation plans, capital structure, and social responsibility. The Investment Manager will cast votes for these matters on a case-by-case basis. The Investment Manager will generally vote in favor of matters which follow an agreeable corporate strategic direction, support an ownership structure that enhances shareholder value without diluting management’s accountability to shareholders and/or present compensation plans that are commensurate with enhanced manager performance and market practices.

Resolution of any Conflicts of Interest

If a proxy vote creates a material conflict between the interests of the Investment Manager and a Client, the Investment Manager will resolve the conflict before voting the proxies. The Investment Manager will either disclose the conflict to the Client and obtain a consent or take other steps designed to ensure that a decision to vote the proxy was based on the Investment Manager’s determination of the Client’s best interest and was not the product of the conflict.

Records

The Investment Manager maintains records of (i) all proxy statements and materials the Investment Manager receives on behalf of Clients; (ii) all proxy votes that are made on behalf of the Clients; (iii) all documents that were material to a proxy vote; (iv) all written requests from Clients regarding voting history; and (v) all responses (written and oral) to Clients’ requests. Such records are available to the Clients (and owners of a Client that is an investment vehicle) upon request.

 

B-1


PART C

OTHER INFORMATION

 

Item 25. Financial Statements And Exhibits

 

(1) Included in Part A: Financial highlights

Incorporated by reference into Part B: The Registrant’s audited financial statements, notes to such financial statements and the report of independent registered public accounting firm thereon, by reference to the Registrant’s Annual Report for the period ended             ,         , as contained in the Registrant’s Form N-CSR filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission (the “Commission”) on             ,          (Accession Number                     ).

 

(2) Exhibits

 

(a)    Amended and Restated Agreement and Declaration of Trust of Registrant(2)
(b)    Amended and Restated Bylaws of Registrant(2)
(c)    Not applicable
(d)    Form of Subscription Documents for Rights++
(e)    Dividend reinvestment Plan of Registrant(2)
(f)    Not applicable
(g)(i)    Investment Management Agreement between Registrant and Cushing ® Asset Management, LP (the “Investment Adviser”)(3)
(h)    Form of Underwriting/Sales/Dealer Manager Agreement++
(i)    Not applicable
(j)(i)    Custody Agreement(3)
(k)(i)    Transfer Agent Servicing Agreement(3)
(ii)    Fund Administration Agreement(3)
(iii)    Fund Accounting Servicing Agreement(3)
(iv)    Committed Lending Agreement*
(v)    Lending Services Agreement*
(vi)    Special Custody and Pledge Agreement*
(vii)    Amendment to Committed Lending Agreement*
(l)    Opinion and Consent of Skadden, Arps, Slate, Meagher & Flom LLP+
(m)    Not applicable
(n)    Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm*
(o)    Not applicable
(p)    Initial Subscription Agreement(2)
(q)    Not applicable
(r)(i)    Code of Ethics of the Registrant*
(ii)    Code of Ethics of the Investment Adviser*
(s)    Power of Attorney*
(z)(i)    Form of Prospectus Supplement for Common Share Offering*
(z)(ii)    Form of Prospectus Supplement for Rights Offering*

 

* Filed herewith.

 

C-1


+ To be filed by further amendment.
++ To be filed by post-effective amendment.
(1) Incorporated by reference to Pre-Effective Amendment No. 1 to the Registrant’s Registration Statement on Form N-2 under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, and the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended (Securities Act File No. 333-170869 and Investment Company Act File No. 811-22499), filed on July 12, 2012.
(2) Incorporated by reference to Pre-Effective Amendment No. 2 to the Registrant’s Registration Statement on Form N-2 under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, and the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended (Securities Act File No. 333-170869 and Investment Company Act File No. 811-22499), on Form N-2, filed on August 30, 2012.
(3) Incorporated by reference to the Registrant’s Registration Statement on Form N-2 under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, and the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended (Securities Act File No. 333-191810 and Investment Company Act File No. 811-22499), on Form N-2, filed on October 18, 2013.

 

Item 26. Marketing Arrangements

The information contained under the heading “Plan of Distribution” in this Registration Statement is incorporated herein by reference and any information concerning any underwriters for a particular offering will be contained in the Prospectus Supplement related to that offering.

 

Item 27. Other Expenses of Issuance and Distribution

The following table sets forth the estimated expenses to be incurred in connection with the offering described in this Registration Statement:

 

SEC Fees

   $               

FINRA Fees

  

Printing and Mailing Expenses

  

Subscription Agent Fees

  

Information Agent Fees

  

Legal Fees

  

Exchange Listing Fees

  

Audit Fees

  

Reimbursement Expenses

  

Miscellaneous Expenses

  

Total

  

 

Item 28. Persons Controlled by or Under Common Control with Registrant

None

 

Item 29. Number of Holders of Securities

 

Title Class

   Number of Record Shareholders
as of December 20, 2017

Common shares of beneficial interest, par value $0.001 per share

   5

 

C-2


Item 30. Indemnification

Article IV of the Registrant’s Amended and Restated Agreement and Declaration of Trust provides as follows:

Section 2. Limitation of Liability . All persons contracting with or having any claim against the Trust or a particular Series shall look only to the assets of the Trust or, as applicable, all Series or such particular Series for payment under such contract or claim; and neither the Trustees nor, when acting in such capacity, any of the Trust’s officers, employees or agents, whether past, present or future, shall be personally liable therefor. Every written instrument or obligation on behalf of the Trust or any Series shall contain a statement to the foregoing effect, but the absence of such statement shall not operate to make any Trustee or officer of the Trust liable thereunder. Provided they have exercised reasonable care and have acted under the reasonable belief that their actions are in the best interest of the Trust, the Trustees and officers of the Trust shall not be responsible or liable for any act or omission or for neglect or wrongdoing of them or any officer, agent, employee, investment adviser or independent contractor of the Trust, but nothing contained in this Declaration or in the Delaware Act shall protect any Trustee or officer of the Trust against liability to the Trust or to Shareholders to which he would otherwise be subject by reason of willful misfeasance, bad faith, gross negligence or reckless disregard of the duties involved in the conduct of his office.

Section 3. Indemnification .

(a)     Subject to the exceptions and limitations contained in subsection (b) below:

(i)     every person who is, or has been, a Trustee or an officer, employee or agent of the Trust (including any individual who serves at its request as director, officer, partner, employee, trustee, agent or the like of another organization in which it has any interest as a shareholder, creditor or otherwise) (“Covered Person”) shall be indemnified by the Trust or the appropriate Series to the fullest extent permitted by law against liability and against all expenses reasonably incurred or paid by him in connection with any claim, action, suit or proceeding in which he becomes involved as a party or otherwise by virtue of his being or having been a Covered Person and against amounts paid or incurred by him in the settlement thereof; and

(ii)     as used herein, the words “claim,” “action,” “suit,” or “proceeding” shall apply to all claims, actions, suits or proceedings (civil, criminal, administrative, investigative, arbitration or other, including appeals), actual or threatened, and the words “liability” and “expenses” shall include, without limitation, attorneys’ fees, costs, judgments, amounts paid in settlement, fines, penalties and other liabilities.

(b)     No indemnification shall be provided hereunder to a Covered Person:

(i)     who shall have been adjudicated by a court or body before which the proceeding was brought (A) to be liable to the Trust or its Shareholders by reason of willful misfeasance, bad faith, gross negligence or reckless disregard of the duties involved in the conduct of his office, or (B) not to have acted in good faith and in a manner the person reasonably believed to be in or not opposed to the best interests of the Trust; or

(ii)     in the event of a settlement, unless there has been a determination that such Covered Person did not engage in willful misfeasance, bad faith, gross negligence or reckless disregard of the duties involved in the conduct of his office; (A) by the court or other body approving the settlement; (B) by at least a majority of those Trustees who are neither Interested Persons of the Trust nor are parties to the matter based upon a review of readily available facts (as opposed to a full trial-type inquiry); (C) by written opinion of independent legal counsel based upon a review of readily available facts (as opposed to a full trial-type inquiry) or (D) by a vote of a majority of the Outstanding Shares entitled to vote (excluding any Outstanding Shares owned of record or beneficially by such individual).

(c)     The rights of indemnification herein provided may be insured against by policies maintained by the Trust, shall be severable, shall not be exclusive of or affect any other rights to which any Covered Person may now or hereafter be entitled, and shall inure to the benefit of the heirs, executors and administrators of a Covered Person.

 

C-3


(d)     To the maximum extent permitted by applicable law, expenses in connection with the preparation and presentation of a defense to any claim, action, suit or proceeding of the character described in subsection (a) of this Section may be paid by the Trust or applicable Series from time to time prior to final disposition thereof upon receipt of an undertaking by or on behalf of such Covered Person that such amount will be paid over by him to the Trust or applicable Series if it is ultimately determined that he is not entitled to indemnification under this Section; provided, however, that either (i) such Covered Person shall have provided appropriate security for such undertaking, (ii) the Trust is insured against losses arising out of any such advance payments or (iii) either a majority of a quorum of the Trustees who are neither Interested Persons of the Trust nor parties to the matter, or independent legal counsel in a written opinion, shall have determined, based upon a review of readily available facts (as opposed to a full trial-type inquiry) that there is reason to believe that such Covered Person will not be disqualified from indemnification under this Section. Independent counsel retained for the purpose of rendering an opinion regarding advancement of expenses and/or a majority of a quorum of the Trustees who are neither Interested Persons of the Trust nor parties to the matter, may proceed under a rebuttable presumption that the Covered Person has not engaged in willful misfeasance, bad faith, gross negligence or reckless disregard of the Covered Person’s duties to the Trust and were based on the Covered Person’s determination that those actions were in the best interests of the Trust and its Shareholders; provided that the Covered Person is not an Interested Person (or is an Interested Person solely by reason of being an officer of the Trust).

(e)     Any repeal or modification of this Article IV by the Shareholders, or adoption or modification of any other provision of the Declaration or By-Laws inconsistent with this Article, shall be prospective only, to the extent that such repeal, or modification would, if applied retrospectively, adversely affect any limitation on the liability of any Covered Person or indemnification available to any Covered Person with respect to any act or omission which occurred prior to such repeal, modification or adoption. Any such repeal or modification by the Shareholders shall require a vote of at least two-thirds of the Outstanding Shares entitled to vote and present in person or by proxy at any meeting of the Shareholders.

Section 4. Indemnification of Shareholders .

(a)     If any Shareholder or former Shareholder of the Trust (as opposed to a Shareholder or former Shareholder of any Series) shall be held personally liable solely by reason of his being or having been a Shareholder and not because of his acts or omissions or for some other reason, the Shareholder or former Shareholder (or his heirs, executors, administrators or other legal representatives or in the case of any entity, its general successor) shall be entitled out of the assets belonging to the Trust to be held harmless from and indemnified against all loss and expense arising from such liability. The Trust shall, upon request by such Shareholder, assume the defense of any claim made against such Shareholder for any act or obligation of the Trust and satisfy any judgment thereon from the assets of the Series.

(b)     If any Shareholder or former Shareholder of any Series shall be held personally liable solely by reason of his being or having been a Shareholder and not because of his acts or omissions or for some other reason, the Shareholder or former Shareholder (or his heirs, executors, administrators or other legal representatives or in the case of any entity, its general successor) shall be entitled out of the assets belonging to the applicable Series to be held harmless from and indemnified against all loss and expense arising from such liability. The Trust, on behalf of the affected Series, shall, upon request by such Shareholder, assume the defense of any claim made against such Shareholder for any act or obligation of the Series and satisfy any judgment thereon from the assets of the Series.

Section 5. No Bond Required of Trustees . No Trustee shall be obligated to give any bond or other security for the performance of any of his duties hereunder.

Section 6. No Duty of Investigation; Notice in Trust Instruments, Etc. No purchaser, lender, transfer agent or other Person dealing with the Trustees or any officer, employee or agent of the Trust or a Series thereof shall be bound to make any inquiry concerning the validity of any transaction purporting to be made by the Trustees or by said officer, employee or agent or be liable for the application of money or property paid, loaned, or delivered to or on the order of the Trustees or of said officer, employee or agent. Every obligation, contract, instrument, certificate, Share, other security of the Trust or a Series thereof or undertaking, and every other act or thing whatsoever executed in connection with the Trust shall be

 

C-4


conclusively presumed to have been executed or done by the executors thereof only in their capacity as Trustees under this Declaration or in their capacity as officers, employees or agents of the Trust or a Series thereof. Every written obligation, contract, instrument, certificate, Share, other security of the Trust or a Series thereof or undertaking made or issued by the Trustees may recite that the same is executed or made by them not individually, but as Trustees under the Declaration, and that the obligations of the Trust or a Series thereof under any such instrument are not binding upon any of the Trustees or Shareholders individually, but bind only the Trust Property or the Trust Property of the applicable Series, and may contain any further recital which they may deem appropriate, but the omission of such recital shall not operate to bind the Trustees individually. The Trustees may maintain insurance for the protection of the Trust Property or the Trust Property of the applicable Series, its Shareholders, Trustees, officers, employees and agents in such amount as the Trustees shall deem adequate to cover possible tort liability, and such other insurance as the Trustees in their sole judgment shall deem advisable.

Section 7. Reliance on Experts, Etc. Each Trustee, officer or employee of the Trust or a Series thereof shall, in the performance of his duties, powers and discretions hereunder be fully and completely justified and protected with regard to any act or any failure to act resulting from reliance in good faith upon the books of account or other records of the Trust or a Series thereof, upon an opinion of counsel, or upon reports made to the Trust or a Series thereof by any of its officers or employees or by the Investment Adviser, the Administrator, the Distributor, the Principal Underwriter, Transfer Agent, selected dealers, accountants, appraisers or other experts or consultants selected with reasonable care by the Trustees, officers or employees of the Trust, regardless of whether such counsel or expert may also be a Trustee.

Section 18 of the Investment Management Agreement between Registrant and Cushing ® Asset Management, LP provides as follows:

18. Limitation of Liability of the Fund and the Shareholders . None of the Trustees, officers, agents or shareholders of the Fund will be personally liable under this Agreement. The name “The Cushing ® Renaissance Fund” is the designation of the Fund for the time being under the Amended and Restated Agreement and Declaration of Trust and all persons dealing with the Fund must look solely to the property of the Fund for the enforcement of any claims against the Fund, as none of the Trustees, officers, agents or shareholders assume any personal liability for obligations entered into on behalf of the Fund.

 

Item 31. Business and Other Connections of the Advisor

The Investment Adviser is not engaged in any other business, profession, vocation or employment of a substantial nature. A description of any other business, profession, vocation or employment of a substantial nature in which each limited partner or executive officer of the Investment Adviser is or has been during the past two fiscal years engaged in for his or her own account or in his or her capacity as trustee, officer, or portfolio manager of the Fund, is set forth in Part A and Part B of this Registration Statement in the sections entitled “Management of the Fund” or in the Investment Adviser’s Form ADV, as filed with the SEC (SEC File No. 801-63255), and which Form ADV is incorporated herein by reference.

 

Item 32. Location of Accounts and Records

The accounts, books or other documents required to be maintained by Section 31(a) of the 1940 Act, and the rules promulgated under the 1940 Act, are kept by the Registrant or its custodian, transfer agent, administrator and fund accountant. The Registrant is located at the following address: The Cushing ® Renaissance Fund, 8117 Preston Road, Suite 440, Dallas, Texas 75225. The Fund’s custodian is located at the following address: U.S. Bank National Association, 1555 N. Riveright Dr., Suite 302, Milwaukee, Wisconsin 53212. The Fund’s transfer agent, registrar and administrator is located at the following address: U.S. Bancorp Fund Services, LLC, located at 615 East Michigan Street, Milwaukee, Wisconsin 53202.

 

Item 33. Management Services

Not applicable.

 

C-5


Item 34. Undertakings

 

  1. Registrant undertakes to suspend the offering of common shares until the prospectus is amended, if subsequent to the effective date of this registration statement, its net asset value declines more than ten percent from its net asset value, as of the effective date of the registration statement or its net asset value increases to an amount greater than its net proceeds as stated in the prospectus.

 

  2. Not applicable.

 

  3. Not applicable.

 

  4. Registrant undertakes:

 

  (a) to file, during any period in which offers or sales are being made, a post-effective amendment to the Registration Statement:

 

  (1) to include any prospectus required by Section 10(a)(3) of the Securities Act;

 

  (2) to reflect in the prospectus any facts or events after the effective date of the Registration Statement (or the most recent post-effective amendment thereof) which, individually or in the aggregate, represents a fundamental change in the information set forth in the Registration Statement; and

 

  (3) to include any material information with respect to the plan of distribution not previously disclosed in the Registration Statement or any material change to such information in the Registration Statement;

 

  (b) that, for the purpose of determining any liability under the Securities Act, each post-effective amendment shall be deemed to be a new registration statement relating to the securities offered therein, and the offering of such securities at that time shall be deemed to be the initial bona fide offering thereof;

 

  (c) to remove from registration by means of a post-effective amendment any of the securities being registered which remain unsold at the termination of the offering;

 

  (d) that, for the purpose of determining liability under the Securities Act to any purchaser, if the Registrant is subject to Rule 430C: Each prospectus filed pursuant to Rule 497(b), (c), (d) or (e) under the Securities Act as part of a registration statement relating to an offering, other than prospectuses filed in reliance on Rule 430A under the Securities Act shall be deemed to be part of and included in the registration statement as of the date it is first used after effectiveness. Provided, however, that no statement made in a registration statement or prospectus that is part of the registration or made in a document incorporated or deemed incorporated by reference into the registration statement or prospectus that is part of the registration statement will, as to a purchaser with a time of contract of sale prior to such first use, supersede or modify any statement that was made in the registration statement or prospectus that was part of the registration statement or made in any such document immediately prior to such date of first use;

 

  (e) that for the purpose of determining liability of the Registrant under the Securities Act to any purchaser in the initial distribution of securities;

The undersigned Registrant undertakes that in a primary offering of securities of the undersigned Registrant pursuant to this registration statement, regardless of the underwriting method used to sell the securities to the purchaser, if the securities are offered or sold to such purchaser by means of any of the following communications, the undersigned Registrant will be a seller to the purchaser and will be considered to offer or sell such securities to the purchaser:

 

  (1) any preliminary prospectus or prospectus of the undersigned Registrant relating to the offering required to be filed pursuant to Rule 497 under the 1933 Act.

 

C-6


  (2) the portion of any advertisement pursuant to Rule 482 under the 1933 Act relating to the offering containing material information about the undersigned Registrant or its securities provided by or on behalf of the undersigned Registrant; and

 

  (3) any other communication that is an offer in the offering made by the undersigned Registrant to the purchaser.

 

  5. Registrant undertakes that:

 

  a. For purposes of determining any liability under the Securities Act of 1933, the information omitted from the form of prospectus filed as part of this registration statement in reliance upon Rule 430A and contained in the form of prospectus filed by the Registrant under Rule 497(h) under the Securities Act of 1933 shall be deemed to be part of this registration statement as of the time it was declared effective; and

 

  b. For the purpose of determining any liability under the Securities Act of 1933, each post-effective amendment that contains a form of prospectus shall be deemed to be a new registration statement relating to the securities offered therein, and the offering of the securities at that time shall be deemed to be the initial bona fide offering thereof.

 

  6. Registrant undertakes to send by first class mail or other means designed to ensure equally prompt delivery, within two business days of receipt of a written or oral request, any Statement of Additional Information constituting Part B of this Registration Statement.

 

C-7


SIGNATURES

As required by the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, and the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended, this Registrant’s Registration Statement has been signed on behalf of the Registrant, in the City of Dallas, State of Texas, on the 29 th day of December, 2017.

 

THE CUSHING ®  RENAISSANCE FUND
By:  

/s/ Jerry V. Swank

Name:   Jerry V. Swank
Title:  

Trustee, Chairman of the Board and

Chief Executive Officer

As required by the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, this Registration Statement has been signed below by the following persons in the capacities set forth below on the 29 th day of December, 2017.

 

NAME         TITLE

/s/ Jerry V. Swank

Jerry V. Swank

      Trustee, Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive Officer

/s/ John Alban

John Alban

      Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

Brian R. Bruce*

Brian R. Bruce

      Trustee

Brenda A. Cline*

Brenda A. Cline

      Trustee

Ronald P. Trout*

Ronald P. Trout

      Trustee

 

* By:  

/s/ Barry Y. Greenberg

  Barry Y. Greenberg
  As Attorney-In-Fact, Pursuant to a Power of Attorney Filed Herewith
  December 29, 2017

 

C-8


EXHIBIT INDEX

 

(k)(iv)

  

Committed Lending Agreement

(k)(v)

  

Lending Services Agreement

(k)(vi)

  

Special Custody and Pledge Agreement

(k)(vii)

  

Amendment to Committed Lending Agreement

(n)

  

Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

(r)(i)

  

Code of Ethics of the Registrant

(r)(ii)

  

Code of Ethics of the Investment Adviser

(s)

  

Power of Attorney

(z)(i)

  

Form of Prospectus Supplement for Common Share Offering

(z)(ii)

  

Form of Prospectus Supplement for Rights Offering

 

C-9

Exhibit (k)(iv)

Committed Lending Agreement

THE BANK OF NOVA SCOTIA, ACTING THROUGH ITS HOUSTON BRANCH (“Scotia”) and THE CUSHING RENAISSANCE FUND (“Customer”) , hereby enter into this Committed Lending Agreement (this “Agreement”), dated as of August 26, 2014.

Whereas Scotia and Customer have entered into the Lending Services Agreement, dated as of the date hereof (the “Lending Services Agreement”);

Whereas Scotia, Customer and U.S. Bank National Association (“Custodian”) have entered into the Special Custody and Pledge Agreement, dated as of August 26, 2014 (the “Control Agreement” and together with this Agreement and the Lending Services Agreement, the “Loan Agreements”); and

Whereas this Agreement supplements and forms part of the other Loan Agreements and sets out the terms of the commitment of Scotia to provide cash loans to Customer under the Loan Agreements.

Now, therefore , in consideration of the foregoing promises and for other good and valuable consideration, the receipt and adequacy of which is hereby acknowledged, the parties agree as follows:

 

1. Definitions -

 

  (a) Capitalized terms not defined in this Agreement have the respective meanings assigned to them in the Lending Services Agreement.

 

  (b) Asset Coverage Ratio ” means the ratio of (i) the aggregate value of Customer’s assets less current liabilities to (ii) the Customer’s total debt outstanding.

 

  (c) Collateral Requirement s” shall have the meaning specified in Appendix A attached hereto.

 

  (d) Commitment Term ” shall be the number of days specified in Appendix B attached hereto.

 

  (e) Maximum Loan Amount ” shall be the amount specified in Appendix B attached hereto.

 

  (f) Net Asset Value ” means, with respect to Customer, as of the relevant date, the USD equivalent of the aggregate net asset value of the Customer determined in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles in the United States of America for balance sheet purposes.

 

  (g) Net Asset Value Per Share ” means the amount determined by dividing the Net Asset Value by the number of outstanding shares issued by the Customer.


  (h) Outstanding Cash Loans ” means, at any given time of determination, the aggregate outstanding cash borrowings under the Loan Agreements as of such time. For the purposes of calculating such aggregate cash borrowings, if Customer holds debit cash balances in non-USD currencies, Scotia will convert each of these balances into USD at prevailing market rates to determine Customer’s aggregate cash borrowings.

 

  (i) 1940 Act ” means the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended. Borrowings

 

2. Borrowings

Subject to the terms hereof, and provided that: (i) a Commitment Termination Event has not occurred, (ii) an event which would constitute a Commitment Termination Event, but for the passage of time, has not occurred, (iii) compliance with a request for a Borrowing (as defined below) would: (a) cause a Commitment Termination Event to occur; (b) result in the Outstanding Cash Loans exceeding the Maximum Loan Amount, or (c) create a margin or collateral delivery obligation for the Customer hereunder, and (iv) neither party has received notice of termination of this Agreement by the other party in accordance with the terms hereof Scotia shall make available cash financing under the Loan Agreements (each, a “ Borrowing ”) in an aggregate amount (including any other outstanding Borrowings) up to the Maximum Loan Amount.

If a Borrowing request is received by Scotia: (i) on or before 12:00 p.m. (New York time) on a Business Day (the “ Borrow Request Date ”), then Scotia shall make such cash financing available as of the 4:00 p.m. (New York time) on the same Business Day, and (ii) after 12:00 p.m. (New York time) on a Borrow Request Date, then Scotia shall make such cash financing available by 11:00 a.m. (New York time) on the next Business Day following such Borrow Request Date. If Scotia is unable to loan or transfer any such amounts pursuant to a restriction, as identified in this Section 2 or Section 15(a), Scotia shall notify the Customer of such restriction as soon as reasonably practical, but in any event no later than 4:00 p.m. (New York time) on the first Business Day following the Business Day Scotia received the Financing Request.

Such cash financing shall be made available in immediately available funds. Customer may borrow under this Section 2, prepay pursuant to Section 4 and reborrow under this Section 2 without premium or penalty.

 

3. Repayment -

Upon the occurrence of a Commitment Termination Event, an event described in Section 15(a) hereof, or the date specified in the Facility Modification Notice as described in Section 6, all Borrowings (including all accrued and unpaid interest thereon and all other amounts owing or payable hereunder) may be recalled by Scotia and shall be due and payable in accordance with the provisions of Section 2 of the Lending Services Agreement.

 

2


4. Prepayments -

Customer may, upon at least one Business Days’ written notice to Scotia stating the proposed date and aggregate principal amount of the prepayment, prepay all or any portion of the outstanding principal amount of Borrowings outstanding, together with the interest accrued up to the date of such prepayment on the principal amount prepaid, without premium or penalty.

 

5. Interest-

Customer shall pay interest on the aggregate amount of any Borrowings outstanding from the date of the relevant Borrowing through but excluding the date such principal amount has been paid in full, at the rates specified in Appendix B attached hereto. Such interest shall accrue at the rate specified in Appendix B attached hereto and shall be calculated daily by Scotia on the basis of a 360-day year and actual days elapsed. Such interest shall be payable monthly on the 1st Business Day of each calendar month, and if not paid when due, any unpaid interest shall be capitalized on the principal balance as additional cash borrowing by the Customer.

 

6. Scope of Committed Facility -

Subject to Section 7, Scotia may not take any of the following actions except on or after the day that is a number of days equal to the Commitment Term immediately following delivery of notice of such termination to Customer by Scotia (the “ Facility Modification Notice ”):

 

  (a) modify Appendix A;

 

  (b) recall or cause repayment of any cash loans under the Loan Agreements; provided that, if, on any day, the Outstanding Cash Loans exceed the Maximum Loan Amount (the amount of such excess, the “ Loan Excess ”), Scotia may recall cash loans with a principal balance not to exceed the Loan Excess and such loans shall be due and payable in accordance with the provisions of Section 2 of the Lending Services Agreement.

 

  (c) modify the interest rate spread on cash loans under the Loan Agreements, as set forth in Appendix B attached hereto; provided that, Scotia may modify the interest rate spread with respect to Borrowings with a principal amount up to any Loan Excess;

 

  (d) modify any other fees, charges or expenses set forth in Appendix B (the “ Fees ”), provided that Scotia may modify any Fees immediately upon written notice thereof (which notice, for the avoidance of doubt, may be delivered via electronic mail) if (i) the amount of such Fees charged to Scotia, as the case may be, have been increased by the provider of the relevant services or (ii) such modification is consistent with increases generally to customers; or

 

  (e) terminate this Agreement or any of the Loan Agreements.

 

3


7. Conditions for Committed Facility -

The commitment as set forth in Sections 2 and 6 only applies so long as —

 

  (a) Customer satisfies the Collateral Requirements;

 

  (b) no Commitment Termination Event has occurred; and

 

  (c) no termination of this Agreement has occurred (including, without limitation, pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15).

 

8. Reserved

 

9. Substitution -

 

  (a) After Scotia sends a Facility Modification Notice, Customer may not substitute any collateral, provided that Scotia may permit substitutions upon request in its sole discretion;

 

  (b) Prior to Scotia sending a Facility Modification Notice, Customer may, subject to the Control Agreement, substitute collateral.

 

10. Collateral Delivery -

If notice of a Collateral Requirement is sent to Customer: (i) on or before 12:00 p.m. (New York time) on any Business Day, then Customer shall deliver all required Collateral no later than 4:00 p.m. (New York time) on such Business Day, and (ii) after 12:00 p.m. (New York time) on any Business Day, then Customer shall deliver all required Collateral no later than 11:00 a.m. (New York time) on the immediately succeeding Business Day. For the avoidance of doubt, the requirement to deliver Collateral in accordance with this Section 10 shall constitute an Obligation under the Lending Services Agreement.

 

11. Representations and Warranties -

Customer hereby makes all the representations, warranties and covenants set forth in Sections 10 and 11 of the Lending Services Agreement, which are deemed to refer to this Agreement, and such representations, warranties and covenants shall survive each transaction and the termination of the Loan Agreements.

 

12. Financial Information -

Customer shall provide Scotia with copies of —

 

  (a) within 30 days after the last day of each calendar month, a statement of total assets and performance and a calculation of the Net Asset Value per Share and Asset Coverage Ratio as of the relevant calendar month end in a form reasonably satisfactory to Scotia; provided that publication of such information on the Customer’s website, www.oushingcetcorn, shall constitute delivery for purposes of this Section;

 

4


  (b) as soon as available and in any event within 90 days after the end of each fiscal year of the Customer a statement of assets and liabilities and a calculation of the Net Asset Value per Share of the Customer as at their fiscal year end, including a disclosure of total assets, as of the end of such fiscal year, and the related financial statements for such fiscal year prepared in accordance with United States generally accepted accounting principles, together with an audit report issued by an independent registered public accounting firm; provided that publication of such information on the Customer’s website, www.cushinqcetcom, shall constitute delivery for purposes of this Section;

 

  (c) the estimated Net Asset Value statement of Customer as of any Business Day on which the Customer’s Net Asset Value is calculated, upon request therefor by Scotia; provided that publication of such information on the Customer’s website, www.cushingcef.com, shall constitute delivery for purposes of this Section; and

 

  (d) any other documents relating to the Customer as Scotia may reasonably request.

For the avoidance of doubt, the requirement to deliver the information in accordance with this Section 12 shall constitute an Obligation under the Lending Services Agreement.

 

13. Termination -

 

  (a) Upon the occurrence of a Commitment Termination Event, Scotia shall have the right to terminate this Agreement, accelerate the maturity of any and all Borrowings to be immediately due and payable, modify Appendix A and modify any interest rate spread, fees, charges, or expenses, in each case, in accordance with the timeframes specified in the Lending Services Agreement and with prior written notice to Customer (which notice, for the avoidance of doubt, may be delivered via electronic mail).

 

  (b) Each of the following events constitutes a “ Commitment Termination Event ”:

 

  i the Customer: (i) defaults under the Lending Services Agreement; or (ii) defaults under any other agreement of a financial nature, including but not limited to any loan agreement, credit agreement, derivative agreement, margin agreement, option agreement, forward agreement, swap agreement, repurchase or reverse repurchase agreement, securities lending agreement, any agreement in respect of transactions similar to the aforementioned transactions, or any other agreements in respect of a transaction which currently is, or in the future becomes recurrently entered into in the financial markets, in each case between the Customer and Scotia or any affiliate of Scotia which has resulted in (after giving effect to any applicable notice requirement or grace period) any amounts under any such agreement becoming, or becoming capable at such time of being declared due and payable before it would otherwise have been due and payable;

 

5


  ii the occurrence of a default, termination event or similar condition (howsoever characterized, which, for the avoidance of doubt, includes the occurrence of an Additional Termination Event under an ISDA Master Agreement) by Customer under any contract or agreement with a third party, where the aggregate principal amount of any such contract or agreement (which, for the avoidance of doubt, includes any obligations with respect to borrowed money or other assets in connection with such contract or agreement) is not less than the lesser of (a) 5% of Customer’s Net Asset Value as of last day of the month immediately preceding the date of determination and (b) USD 10,000,000 and which has resulted in (after giving effect to any applicable notice requirement or grace period) any amounts under any such contract or agreement becoming, or becoming capable at such time of being declared due and payable before it would otherwise have been due and payable;

 

  iii Customer fails to make any filing necessary to comply with the rules of any exchange in which its shares are listed and the Customer fails to make such filing within the three (3) business days after such lapse;

 

  iv Customer is no longer classified as a “closed-end company” as defined in Section 5 of the 1940 Act;

 

  v Customer or Custodian terminates the Control Agreement without the prior consent of Scotia or Customer revokes the instructions to Custodian provided under Paragraph 2(a) of the Control Agreement;

 

  vi Custodian’s long-term credit rating declines below either (i) A by S&P or (ii) A2 by Moody’s (a “ Custodian Downgrade Event ”) and Customer fails to transfer the Collateral to an alternative custodian acceptable to Scotia in its sole discretion within 30 days after Customer becomes aware of or should have become aware of the occurrence of such Custodian Downgrade Event;

 

  vii the Customer fails to comply in any material respect with the investment policies, strategies, guidelines and restrictions set forth in its disclosure documents, trust agreement, constituent documentations or investment management agreements in effect as of the date hereof (the foregoing policies, strategies, guidelines and restrictions being hereinafter referred to as the “ Investment Policies ”);

 

  viii the Customer materially changes the Investment Policies without the prior written consent of Scotia that such change shall not constitute a Commitment Termination Event (consent not to be unreasonably withheld, delayed or conditioned);

 

  ix

there occurs any change in any applicable law or regulation (or the interpretation thereof) including, without limitation, tax legislation, the

 

6


  Bank Act (Canada), securities legislation, or the issuance of any order, judgment, ruling, administrative guideline or policy of or by any court, governmental authority, administrative or regulatory body or tribunal of competent jurisdiction, in each case that would, in the reasonable opinion of Scotia, either: (i) impede or prohibit Scotia or the Customer from performing its obligations hereunder, or render any such obligation unlawful, or (ii) result in this Agreement and the Lending Services Agreement becoming, or being materially less profitable either on a percentage or absolute basis for Scotia or materially adversely affects the capital or tax treatment accorded Scotia in respect of this Agreement and the Lending Services Agreement, unless the Customer agrees to compensate Scotia for any such losses or costs, in writing, in a form reasonably acceptable to Scotia within ten (10) days of Scotia’s notice to the Customer of any such changes;

 

  x the Customer fails to deliver any statement required to be delivered pursuant to Section 12 of this Agreement within three (3) Business Days after the Customer’s receipt of written notice of such failure from Scotia;

 

  xi Cushing Asset Management, LP ceases to be the investment adviser of the Customer or ceases to have authority over the trading and investment activities of the Customer (including, without limitation, the authority to exercise all rights of the Customer under the Customer’s Declaration of Trust and By-Laws) as such entity had upon the execution of this Agreement (if any) unless such entity is replaced by either an entity that is an affiliate of Cushing Asset Management, LP or an investment adviser acceptable to Scotia in its good faith discretion;

 

  xii the Customer’s Asset Coverage Ratio is less than 3.00:1.00 at any time; or

 

  xiii the Customer incurs any indebtedness at any time, other than the indebtedness incurred under the Loan Agreements.

 

  (c) Customer may terminate this agreement on or after the day that is thirty (30) days immediately following delivery of notice of such termination to Scotia by Customer.

 

14. Notices -

Notices under this Agreement shall be provided pursuant to Section 17 of the Lending Services Agreement.

 

15. Compliance with Applicable Law -

 

  (a) Notwithstanding any of the foregoing, if required by Applicable Law, subject to using commercially reasonable efforts to notify Customer as is reasonably practicable under the circumstances, (the failure of which shall not prejudice the Scotia Entities’ rights under this Section) —

 

7


  i the Scotia Entities may terminate any Loan Agreement and any Contract;

 

  ii Scotia may recall any outstanding cash loan under the Loan Agreements;

 

  iii Scotia may modify the method for calculating the Collateral Requirements; and

 

  iv the Scotia Entities may take any other action as required by Applicable Law.

 

  (b) This Agreement will not limit the ability of Scotia to amend or modify this Agreement or any other Loan Agreement or change the product provided under this Agreement and the Loan Agreements as necessary to comply with Applicable Law.

 

  (c) The Scotia Entities may exercise any remedies permitted under the Contracts if Customer fails to comply with Applicable Law.

 

16. Miscellaneous -

 

  (a) In the event of a conflict between any provision of this Agreement and the other Loan Agreements, this Agreement prevails.

 

  (b) This Agreement is governed by and construed in accordance with the laws of the State of New York, without regard to the conflict of laws rules (other than Section 5-1401 of the General Obligations Law).

 

  (c) Section 20(d) of the Lending Services Agreement is hereby incorporated by reference in its entirety and shall be deemed to be a part of this Agreement to the same extent as if such provision had been set forth in full herein.

 

  (d) This Agreement may be executed in counterparts, each of which will be deemed an original instrument and all of which together will constitute one and the same agreement.

 

  (e) The other Scotia Entities are express third party beneficiaries of this Agreement.

 

8


IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties have caused this Agreement to be duly executed and delivered as of the date first written above.

 

THE CUSHING RENAISSANCE FUND
By:  

/s/ Jerry V. Swank

Name:  

Jerry V. Swank

Title:   CEO
THE BANK OF NOVA SCOTIA, ACTING THROUGH ITS HOUSTON BRANCH
By:  

/s/ Authorized Person

Name:   Authorized Person
Title:  

 

9


Appendix A — Collateral Requirements

THIS APPENDIX forms a part of the Committed Lending Agreement dated August 26, 2014, entered into between The Bank of Nova Scotia, acting through its Houston Branch (“Scotia”) and The Cushing Renaissance Fund (“Customer”) (the “Committed Lending Agreement”).

 

1. Collateral Requirement -

The “ Collateral Requirements ” with respect to all positions held in the accounts established pursuant to the Loan Agreements (each a “Position”), shall be equal to the greater of (a) the sum of (i) the product of (A) 50% and (B) the aggregate Gross Market Value of all Positions in the Eligible Portfolio, (ii) the product of (A) 50% and (B) the aggregate Gross Market Value of all Overage Positions and (iii) the aggregate Gross Market Value of all Positions which are not Eligible Securities, and (b) the requirements with respect to all Positions as per Regulation U of the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System, as amended from time to time.

 

2. Eligible Securities -

 

  (a) Equity Securities covered under the Committed Lending Agreement (“ Eligible Equity Securities ”) must:

 

  (i) be Equity Securities where the relevant Issuer has a current market capitalization of at least USD 1,000,000,000;

 

  (ii) be USD denominated;

 

  (iii) be traded on any of the New York Stock Exchange, NYSE MKT, NYSE Arca or NASDAQ; and

 

  (iv) when aggregated with all other positions of the same Equity Security beneficially owned by Customer (whether with Scotia or otherwise), not result in Customer and its affiliates becoming the beneficial owner, directly or indirectly, of more than nine (9) percent of the outstanding float of such Equity Security.

 

  (b) Debt Securities covered under the Committed Lending Agreement (“ Eligible Debt Securities ” and together with Eligible Equity Securities, “ Eligible Securities ”) must:

 

  (i) be USD denominated;

 

  (ii) have a long-term credit rating of at least (i) CCC+ by S&P or (ii) Caa1 by Moody’s;

 

  (iii) have a current market price of at least 70% of par;

 

10


  (iv) be part of an issuance of at least USD 100 million; and

 

  (v) not be issued by an Issuer who is in default.

 

  (c) Notwithstanding the foregoing, the following will not be part of the commitment in the Committed Lending Agreement and shall not be Eligible Equity Securities or Eligible Debt Securities:

 

  (i) any security that is not capable of being valued by Scotia on a daily basis through its internal or external pricing sources;

 

  (ii) any security type not covered above, as determined by Scotia in its sole discretion;

 

  (iii) any short security position;

 

  (iv) any security offered through a private placement or any restricted securities (excluding, for the purposes of this sub-clause, corporate debt or preferred securities offered under Rule 144A of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended);

 

  (v) any commodity positions;

 

  (vi) any security over which Scotia does not have a first-priority perfected security interest;

 

  (vii) any derivatives (including, without limitation, warrants);

 

  (viii) any exchange-traded-funds that represent leveraged or short exposure to their reference index or sector;

 

  (ix) any securities that are municipal securities, catastrophe bonds, asset-backed securities, mortgage securities, Payment-in-Kind Securities or Structured Securities (notwithstanding the fact that such securities would otherwise be covered), which, for the avoidance of doubt, shall not include any depository receipts;

 

  (x) to the extent that any Aggregate Position in an Equity Security has a Days of Trading Volume in excess of 3, the portion of such Aggregate Position in excess of 3 Days of Trading Volume (and Scotia shall determine in its sole discretion which specific Positions in such Aggregate Position shall be considered to be in excess of such 3 Days of Trading Volume threshold);

 

  (xi) to the extent that any Aggregate Position in an Equity Security represents more than 4% of the outstanding float of such Equity Security, the portion of such Aggregate Position in excess of such 4% threshold (and Scotia shall determine in its sole discretion which specific Positions in such Aggregate Position shall be considered to be in excess of such 4% threshold);

 

11


  (xii) to the extent that any Aggregate Position in a Debt Security has a Percentage of Outstanding Issue Size greater than 10%, the portion of such Aggregate Position in excess of such 10% threshold (and Scotia shall determine in its sole discretion which specific Positions in such Aggregate Position shall be considered to be in excess of such 10% threshold); and

 

  (xiii) any securities that have a Country of Risk in an Emerging Market.

 

3. Portfolio Constraints

The following constraints shall apply to all Positions comprised of Eligible Securities:

 

  (a) To the extent that the Gross Market Value of any Issuer Position exceeds 10% of the Gross Market Value of the Eligible Portfolio, the portion of such Issuer Position (determined by Scotia in its sole discretion) in excess of such 10% threshold shall be deemed Overage Positions; and

 

  (b) To the extent the Gross Market Value of all Positions in Debt Securities is in excess of 30% of the Gross Market Value of the Eligible Portfolio, the portion of such Positions in excess of such 30% threshold shall be deemed Overage Positions.

 

4. Positions Outside the Scope of this Appendix -

For the avoidance of doubt, the Collateral Requirement set forth herein is limited to the types and sizes of securities specified herein. The Collateral Requirement for any Position or portion of a Position not covered by the terms of this Appendix shall be determined by Scotia in its sole discretion.

 

5. One-off Collateral Requirements -

From time to time Scotia, in its sole discretion, may agree to a lower Collateral Requirement than the Collateral Requirement determined pursuant to this Appendix for a particular Position; provided that, for the avoidance of doubt, the commitment set forth in Section 2 of the Committed Lending Agreement shall apply only with respect to the Collateral Requirement determined pursuant to Sections 1 and 3 hereof and Scotia shall have the right at any time to increase the Collateral Requirement for such Position up to the Collateral Requirement that would be required pursuant to Sections 1 and 3 hereof.

 

6. Certain Definitions -

 

  (a) Aggregate Position ” means all Positions in the same security.

 

  (b) Bloomberg ” means the Bloomberg Professional Service.

 

12


  (c) Country of Risk ” means the country of risk of a Position as determined by Scotia.

 

  (d) Current Market Value ” means, with respect to a Position, an amount equal to the product of (i) number of the relevant security and (ii) the price per security of the relevant security (as determined by Scotia in its sole discretion). To the extent any Positions are quoted in a currency other than USD, Scotia shall convert such quote into USD at a rate determined by Scotia in its sole discretion.

 

  (e) Days of Trading Volume ” means, with respect to an Aggregate Position in an Equity Security, an amount equal to the quotient of (i) the number of shares comprising such Aggregate Position and (H) the 30-day average daily trading volume of such security as published by Bloomberg. Notwithstanding the preceding sentence, to the extent that the 30-day average daily trading volume for a particular Equity Security is unavailable on any day, the “Days of Trading Volume” shall be determined by Scotia in its sole discretion.

 

  (f) Debt Security ” means any of the following: corporate bonds (both convertible and non-convertible), preferred stock (both convertible and non-convertible), and similar securities as determined by Scotia.

 

  (g) Eligible Portfolio ” means all Positions in Eligible Securities.

 

  (h) Emerging Market ” means any country other than Australia, Austria, Belgium, Canada, Denmark, Finland, France, Germany, Japan, Luxembourg, the Netherlands, Norway, Singapore, Sweden, Switzerland, the United Kingdom and the United States.

 

  (i) Equity Security ” means any listed common stock share, exchange traded fund, master limited partnership or similar security as determined by Scotia in its sole discretion.

 

  (j) Gross Market Value ” means, with respect to one or more Positions (or portions thereof), an amount equal to the sum of the Current Market Value of all such Positions.

 

  (k) Issuer ” means, with respect to a security, the ultimate parent company or similar term as used by Bloomberg; provided that, with respect to any exchange-traded funds, the Issuer of such securities shall be the index to which the relevant securities relate, if any.

 

  (l) Issuer Position ” means all Positions in Eligible Securities issued by the same Issuer.

 

  (m) Overage Position ” means any Position deemed to be an Overage Position in accordance with Section 3 hereof.

 

13


  (n) Payment-in-Kind Security ” means any security that permits the Issuer to pay the holder of such security with additional securities or assets in place of cash.

 

  (o) Percentage of Outstanding Issue Size ” means, with respect to any Aggregate Position in a Debt Security, the quotient of (i) the Gross Market Value of such Aggregate Position and (ii) the aggregate market value of all such Debt Security issued and still outstanding.

 

  (p) Structured Security ” means any security which provides a payment to the holder linked to a different security issued by a different issuer.

 

14


Appendix B — Pricing and Commitment Term

THIS APPENDIX forms a part of the Committed Lending Agreement dated [            ], 2014, entered into between The Bank of Nova Scotia, acting through its Houston Branch (“Scotia”) and The Cushing Renaissance Fund (“Customer”) (the “Agreement”).

 

Customer Debit Rate
1-month LIBOR (Bloomberg: US0001M Index) + 70 bps
Maximum Loan Amount
USD 90,000,000

Commitment Term

 

60 calendar days

 

15

Exhibit (k)(v)

The Bank of Nova Scotia, acting through its Houston Branch

Lending Services Agreement

LENDING SERVICES AGREEMENT dated as of August 26, 2014 (the “ Agreement ”) between THE CUSHING RENAISSANCE FUND , a closed-end management investment company established as a statutory trust under the laws of the State of Delaware with its principal place of business at 8117 Preston Road, Suite 440, Dallas, Texas 75225 (the “ Customer ”) and THE BANK OF NOVA SCOTIA, ACTING THROUGH ITS HOUSTON BRANCH (“ Scotia ”).

As Customer has requested Scotia to provide to it one or more margin accounts (the “ Accounts ”) and financing services and Scotia has agreed to do so, both parties agree to the following:

 

1. Definitions .

 

  (a) Act ” means The Investment Company Act of 1940, including the rules and regulations promulgated hereunder, as amended, or revised from time to time.

 

  (b) Bankruptcy Event ” means that a party: (i) is dissolved (other than pursuant to a consolidation, amalgamation or merger); (ii) becomes insolvent or is unable to pay its debts or fails or admits in writing its inability generally to pay its debts as they become due; (iii) makes a general assignment, arrangement or composition with or for the benefit of its creditors; (iv) institutes or has instituted against it a proceeding seeking a judgment of insolvency or bankruptcy or any other relief under any bankruptcy or insolvency law or other similar law affecting creditors’ rights, or a petition is presented for its winding-up or liquidation; (v) has a resolution passed for its winding-up, official management or liquidation (other than pursuant to a consolidation, amalgamation or merger); (vi) seeks or becomes subject to the appointment of an administrator, provisional liquidator, conservator, receiver, trustee, custodian or other similar official for it or for all or substantially all its assets; (vii) has a secured party take possession of all or substantially all of its assets or has a distress, execution, attachment, sequestration or other legal process levied, enforced or sued on or against all or substantially all of its assets and such secured party maintains possession, or any such process is not dismissed, discharged, stayed or restrained, in each case within fifteen days thereafter; (viii) causes or is subject to any event with respect to it which, under the applicable laws of any jurisdiction, has an analogous effect to any of the events specified in sub-clauses (i) to (vii), inclusive, hereof; or (ix) takes any action in furtherance of, or indicating its consent to, approval of, or acquiescence in, any of the foregoing acts.

 

  (c) Business Day ” means any day on which regular trading occurs on the New York Stock Exchange.


  (d) Collateral ” means (i) any account maintained for Customer by or with any Scotia Entity (including, without limitation, the Special Custody Account (as defined in the Special Custody and Pledge Agreement dated as of August 26, 2014 (the “ Special Custody Agreement ”) among Scotia, Customer and U.S. Bank N.A. (the “ Custodian ”)); (ii) all property now or hereafter credited to or held in any such account or otherwise held, or carried by or through, or subject to the control of any Scotia Entity or agent thereof, including all margin, Securities, Securities Accounts, monies, Commodity Contracts, Commodity Accounts, and Investment Property (including all Financial Assets and Instruments) whether fully paid or otherwise; (iii) any property of Customer in which any of the Scotia Entities is granted a security interest under any Contract with any Scotia Entity or otherwise (however held); (iv) all rights of Customer in any Obligation of any Scotia Entity; (v) all rights of Customer in any Contract with any Scotia entity; (vi) all rights of Customer in any unsettled Transactions; and (vii) all Proceeds of or distributions on any of the foregoing. The description of any property that is Collateral contained in any Contract with any Scotia Entity is incorporated into this Agreement as if fully set forth herein and constitutes Collateral hereunder. Each item of property, including Investment Property, a Security, a general intangible, contract rights, an Investment, and cash, held in or credited to any Securities Account at a Securities Intermediary shall be treated as a Financial Asset.

 

  (e) Contract ” means this Agreement as well as any swap agreement, option on a security or commodity, credit default swap, forward, any repurchase or reverse repurchase agreement, any securities lending or borrowing agreement or transaction, any buy-sell agreement, loan sale or purchase or loan participation, any contract relating to currencies, any agreement for prime brokerage or the settlement of securities transactions, any margin lending, securities lending, custody account and sweep account agreement or other agreement relating to extensions of credit, any contract for the purchase or sale of any security or commodity, any guarantee or other credit support document related to any of the foregoing and any other agreement, contract, instrument or document of any kind or nature whatsoever, whether or not similar to any of the foregoing, as to which, in each case, Customer is a party, has any obligations or holds any rights, regardless of how documented and whether written or oral and a Scotia Entity is the counterparty, together with all such purchases and sales, agreements, instruments and other documents, including, without limitation, payment and delivery obligations, obligations relating to the extension of credit or to pay damages (including costs of cover) and payment of legal and other expenses incurred in connection with the enforcement of Contracts.

 

  (f)

NYUCC ” means the Uniform Commercial Code as adopted in the State of New York as in effect from time to time. The following terms used in

 

2


  this Agreement shall have the same meanings herein as set forth in the NYUCC: “ Commodity Account ,” “ Commodity Contract ,” “ Commodity Intermediary ,” “ Entitlement Order ,” “ Financial Asset ,” “ Instrument ,” “ Investment Property ,” “ Proceeds ,” “ Securities ,” “ Securities Account ,” “ Securities Entitlement ,” and “ Securities Intermediary .”

 

  (g) Obligation ” means (i) as the context requires each of Customer’s obligations or liabilities to a Scotia Entity and of a Scotia Entity to Customer, including (A) a requirement to make a margin payment or settlement payment or to maintain margin; (B) any obligation in connection with any Transaction; (C) any requirement under this Agreement or with respect to any other Contract with a Scotia Entity; and (D) any “debt” as defined in the United States Bankruptcy Code; and (ii) any obligation or requirement Customer has to liquidate or otherwise reduce a position, account, or Transaction, or to pay or perform under a guarantee or indemnity; whether or not payment or performance is due, including with respect to its acceleration, cancellation, termination, or liquidation, whenever arising and whether fixed, matured, unmatured, liquidated, unliquidated, or contingent.

 

  (h) Regulatory Authorities ” means any relevant banking authority, securities commission, exchange, market, clearing corporation or similar agency having authority over Scotia, Customer, any Transaction or any securities relating thereto, as the case may be.

 

  (i) Scotia Entities ” means Scotia and each trust, limited liability company, corporation, partnership, and any other entity that owns Scotia, directly or indirectly, or is owned directly or directly by Scotia, or which controls, is controlled by or is under common control with Scotia, whether such entity exists as of the date hereof or is later created or acquired.

 

  (j) Transactions ” means all actions, agreements, promises of performance, transactions, or extension or maintenance of credit relating to the execution, clearance, settlement of transactions in or maintenance of accounts for the purpose of carrying, custodying, or financing positions in, securities, loans (including whole mortgage loans and bank debt), currencies, commodities, or derivatives, in each case, for Customer by any Scotia Entity and all transactions in which any Scotia Entity provides clearing, fixed income clearing, custody, or settlement services to or for Customer (including as prime broker in connection with prime broker transactions or fixed income clearing transactions, or in connection with any give-up, free delivery, or unsettled transaction, or when acting as a clearance and/or settlement agent in any clearing system, market, or exchange, domestic or international) or transactions in, or the custody of, cash made in connection with, or in contemplation of, any of the foregoing.

 

3


2. Margin Requirements . The provisions of this Section 2 shall apply except to the extent any such provisions contravene the Committed Lending Agreement dated as of August 26, 2014 between Scotia and Customer (the “ Committed Lending Agreement ”) and such Committed Lending Agreement has not been terminated or the commitment therein has not expired. Customer will at all times maintain in, and upon written demand deposit or credit to the Accounts, or otherwise provide to the Scotia Entities in a manner satisfactory to the Scotia Entities, assets of the types and in the amounts required by the Scotia Entities in light of outstanding Contracts with Scotia Entities, in accordance with the terms of such Contracts. Immediately upon written demand by Scotia, Customer shall pay to Scotia in immediately available U.S. funds any principal balance of, accrued unpaid interest on, and any other Obligation owing in respect of, any Account or Contract, otherwise due and payable in accordance with the terms thereof.

 

3. Security Interest .

 

  (a) Grant of Security Interest . As security and margin for the payment and performance of each of Customer’s Obligations to each Scotia Entity, Customer grants to each Scotia Entity a continuing security interest in and lien upon and assigns to each Scotia Entity all of Customer’s rights, title, and interests in Collateral, irrespective of which of the Scotia Entities maintains or carries Collateral or has made advances in connection with the Collateral or is owed amounts under applicable Contracts with such Scotia Entities and irrespective of the number of accounts Customer may have with any Scotia Entities. As between Scotia Entities, Scotia shall have a first priority interest and shall have priority over other Scotia Entities as to collateral held in a Customer account at Scotia, including, for the avoidance of doubt, any Collateral recorded in a Scotia cash, margin or good faith account. Without limiting the preceding sentence, all Collateral pledged by Customer in connection with a particular Contract shall secure first the Obligations to the Scotia Entities under that Contract and second the Obligations to the Scotia Entities under all other Contracts.

 

  (b)

Collateral for All of Customer s Obligations . Notwithstanding any provision to the contrary contained in any Contract, all Collateral pledged by Customer to a Scotia Entity, whether under this Agreement or any other Contract with a Scotia Entity, shall be and shall constitute, to the fullest extent of any rights Customer has in such assets, Collateral pledged by Customer under and in connection with this Agreement and each other Contract with a Scotia Entity, to margin and secure Customer’s Obligations under this Agreement and each Contract with a Scotia Entity, and each Contract, whenever entered into, shall be deemed amended accordingly. Each Scotia Entity shall, without Customer’s further consent, comply with any orders or instructions of each other Scotia Entity with respect to Collateral, including (i) any Entitlement Orders or other instructions, including to transfer to a Scotia Entity or other person or to redeem any Collateral; and (ii) if the Scotia Entity is a Commodity

 

4


  Intermediary, any instructions to such Scotia Entity to apply any value distributed on account of a Commodity Contract as directed by each other Scotia Entity. All Collateral is held or controlled as Collateral by each Scotia Entity both for itself as a secured party and as agent and bailee of each other Scotia Entity, and each Scotia Entity acknowledges that it is so acting and that it is on notice of the security interest Customer has granted to each other Scotia Entity.

 

  (c) Certain Rights with Respect to Collateral . Each Scotia Entity is authorized, at any time and upon notice to Customer, to use, credit, apply, or transfer Collateral held or maintained by such Scotia Entity to any other Scotia Entity to which Customer has an Obligation (including under a Master Repurchase Agreement, in which event such transferred Collateral shall become Additional Purchased Securities or Margin Securities, as the case may be, as defined in the applicable Master Repurchase Agreement). Each Scotia Entity has the right not to comply with (i) any Entitlement Order or other instruction originated by Customer or a third party that would require a Scotia Entity to make a delivery of Collateral to Customer or any other person; and (ii) any instruction from Customer to apply any value on account of any Commodity Contract (whether such value is distributable or not), in each case to the extent that delivery of such Collateral would result in Customer’s Collateral being less than the amount required, in the Scotia Entity’s discretion pursuant to the terms of the applicable Contract(s), to secure any remaining Obligations of Customer to any Scotia Entity. Customer agrees that the actions of a Scotia Entity in not complying with Customer’s instructions as allowed in this Section 3(c) satisfy any duties any Scotia Entity may have as a Securities Intermediary or Commodity Intermediary.

 

  (d) Covenants in Respect of Collateral . Customer covenants that with respect to Collateral and the delivery of Collateral:

 

  (i) Customer will take such action as is necessary to cooperate with the Scotia Entities to perfect or preserve each of their first priority security interest, legal or equitable charge or other mortgage or assignment of the Collateral;

 

  (ii) Customer irrevocably appoints each Scotia Entity to be Customer’s attorney-in-fact and Customer’s agent (with full powers of substitution and delegation) to:

 

  (A)

act in Customer’s name and on Customer’s behalf and as Customer’s act and deed or otherwise under a power coupled with an interest to do any act whatsoever required to be done under this Agreement as fully as Customer may do personally, including actions required to execute, sign, seal, deliver, lodge and file any documents which such

 

5


  Scotia Entity may require for perfecting or preserving its first priority security interest, legal or equitable charge, or other mortgage or assignment in the Collateral, including financing statements or register notations; and

 

  (B) do all such acts and things as may be required for the full exercise of the powers conferred, including upon the occurrence of an Event of Default, executing and filing such documents as are appropriate to effect any sale, lease, liquidation, disposition, realization, receipt of such Collateral, vesting the Collateral in the Scotia Entity or the enforcement of any of the Scotia Entity’s rights hereunder; and

 

  (iii) on request, Customer will ratify and confirm any deed, document, act, and thing and all transactions that any such attorney-in-fact or agent may do which falls under the scope of this power of attorney.

 

4. Reserved .

 

5. General Obligations . Customer agrees to pay and perform all of its Obligations in accordance with their terms, including in connection with any acceleration thereof. Notwithstanding anything herein to the contrary, Customer shall remain liable for all Obligations until the same have been fully performed or waived in writing.

Customer agrees to timely provide any security, commodity, other financial product, or money required for the timely completion of any transaction executed, settled, or cleared through any Scotia Entity in accordance with the terms of the applicable Contract.

 

6. Applicable Law . This Agreement and all services rendered and all transactions effected or entered into hereunder are subject to and shall be conducted in accordance with all applicable laws, rules, regulations and customs of governmental authorities, self-regulatory organizations, markets, exchanges, and clearing facilities as from time to time in effect (hereinafter “ Applicable Law ”).

 

7. Reserved.

 

8. Reserved .

 

9. Taxes .

 

  (a)

Withholding Tax . Except as required by Applicable Law, each payment by Customer and all deliveries of margin or Collateral under this Agreement shall be made, and the value of any margin or Collateral shall be calculated, without withholding or deducting any Taxes. Except for Excluded Taxes, if any Taxes are required to be withheld or deducted,

 

6


  Customer shall pay such additional amounts as necessary to ensure that the actual net amount received by the Scotia Entities is equal to the amount that the Scotia Entities would have received had no such withholding or deduction been required. Customer will provide the Scotia Entities with any forms or documentation reasonably requested by the Scotia Entities in order to reduce or eliminate withholding tax on payments made to Customer with respect to this Agreement. The Scotia Entities are hereby authorized to withhold Taxes from any payment in delivery made under this Agreement and remit such Taxes to the relevant taxing authorities to the extent required by Applicable Law.

Taxes ” means any present or future tax, levy, impost, duty, charge, assessment or fee of any nature (including interest, penalties and additions thereto) that is imposed by any government or other taxing authority in respect of any payment under this Agreement other than a stamp, registration, documentation or similar tax.

Excluded Taxes ” means any of the following taxes imposed on or with respect to any of the Scotia Entities or required to be withheld or deducted from a payment to any of the Scotia Entities, (a) taxes imposed on or measured by net income (however denominated), franchise taxes, and branch profits taxes, and (b) taxes attributable to such Scotia Entity’s failure to provide Customer with the forms necessary to reduce or avoid withholding.

 

  (b) Qualified Dividends . Customer acknowledges that, with respect to the reduced U.S. federal income tax rate that applies to dividends received from U.S. corporations and certain foreign corporations by individuals who are citizens or residents of the United States, (i) the individual must satisfy applicable holding period requirements in order to be eligible for the reduced tax rate; (ii) the reduced tax rate does not apply to substitute or “in lieu” dividend payments paid to shareholders by broker-dealers under margin or securities lending arrangements under which the broker-dealers have borrowed securities from investors on the relevant dividend record date; and (iii) the reduced tax rate may not apply to dividends received from certain corporations, including money market funds, bond mutual funds, and Real Estate Investment Trusts. Customer further acknowledges that although Customer may receive from Scotia a Form 1099-DIV indicating which dividends may qualify for the reduced tax rate, as required by applicable rules, Customer is responsible for determining which dividends qualify for the reduced tax rate based on Customer’s own tax situation.

 

10. Representations and Warranties . Customer hereby represents and warrants to each of the Scotia Entities (which representations will be deemed to be repeated on each date on which a Transaction is entered into or settled under this Agreement or any other Contract) that:

 

  (a) it is duly organized and validly existing under the laws of the jurisdiction of its organization or incorporation and, if relevant under such laws, is in good standing;

 

7


  (b) Customer’s jurisdiction of organization, type of organization, place of business (if it has only one place of business) or chief executive office (if it has more than one place of business), and organizational identification number are, in each case, as set forth in Section 17 hereof or as shall have been notified to Scotia in accordance with Section 17 not less than 30 days prior to any change of such information;

 

  (c) it has the power and is duly authorized to execute this Agreement and any other documentation relating to this Agreement to which it is or may be a party, to deliver this Agreement and any other documentation relating to this Agreement that it is required by this Agreement to deliver and has taken all necessary action to authorize such execution, delivery and performance;

 

  (d) such execution, delivery and performance do not violate or conflict with any Applicable Law, any provision of its constitutional documents, any order or judgment of any court or other agency of government applicable to it or any of its assets or any contractual restriction binding on or affecting it or any of its assets;

 

  (e) there are and have been no legal or governmental proceedings or investigations pending or threatened involving (i) fraud, (ii) felony, (iii) activities related to Customer’s business or (iv) a violation of any securities regulations that (a) would have a material adverse effect on Customer’s ability to perform under this Agreement and (b) to which Customer, Customer’s investment adviser, or any of Customer’s trustees or Customer’s investment adviser’s principals, directors, or senior employees are a party, or to which any of the material properties or assets of Customer are subject;

 

  (f) Customer has obtained all governmental and other consents that are required to have been obtained, and such consents are in full force and effect, (i) for the due execution, delivery, and performance by Customer of this Agreement or any other Contract; and (ii) for the exercise by any of the Scotia Entities of the rights or remedies provided for in this Agreement, including rights and remedies in respect of the Collateral;

 

  (g) each Transaction will be subject to, and Customer will abide by, the prevailing by-laws, regulations, policies and customs of the Regulatory Authorities;

 

  (h)

its Obligations constitute legal, valid and binding obligations, enforceable against Customer in accordance with their respective terms (subject to

 

8


  applicable bankruptcy, reorganization, insolvency, moratorium or similar laws affecting creditors’ rights generally and subject, as to enforceability, to equitable principles of general application (regardless of whether enforcement is sought in a proceeding in equity or at law));

 

  (i) no Event of Default, as defined below, with respect to it has occurred, and no such Event of Default would occur as a result of its entering into this Agreement or performing its Obligations hereunder or under the applicable Contract;

 

  (j) all applicable information that is furnished in writing by it or on its behalf to the Scotia Entities is, as of the date of the information, true, accurate and complete in all material respects, and Customer agrees to notify the relevant Scotia Entity as soon as practicable in writing in the event of a material inaccuracy in any such information;

 

  (k) without limiting the generality of the foregoing, Customer’s financial statements or similar documents previously or hereafter provided to any Scotia Entity (i) do or will fairly present the financial condition of Customer as of the date of such financial statements and the results of its operations for the period for which such financial statements are applicable; (ii) have been prepared in accordance with applicable generally accepted accounting principles; (iii) if audited, have been certified without reservation by a firm of independent public accountants; and (iv) are accurate and complete;

 

  (l) Customer is the lawful owner of all Collateral, free and clear of all liens, claims, encumbrances and transfer restrictions, except such as are created under this Agreement and other liens in favor of one or more Scotia Entities, and Customer will not cause or allow any of the Collateral, whether now owned or hereafter acquired, to be or become subject to any liens, security interests, mortgages or encumbrances of any nature other than those in favor of the Scotia Entities;

 

  (m) no person (other than Customer or any Scotia Entity) has an interest in any Account or any other accounts of Customer with any of the Scotia Entities, any Collateral or other assets or property held therein or credited thereto, or any other Collateral;

 

  (n)

to the best of Customer’s knowledge, none of Customer, any person controlling or controlled by Customer, or any person for whom Customer acts as agent or nominee in connection herewith is: (i) an individual or entity, country or territory, that is named on a list issued by the U.S. Department of the Treasury’s Office of Foreign Assets Control (“ OFAC ”), or an individual or entity that resides, is organized or chartered, or has a place of business, in a country or territory subject to OFAC’s various sanctions/embargo programs; (ii) a resident in, or organized or chartered

 

9


  under the laws of (A) a jurisdiction that has been designated by the Secretary of the Treasury under the USA PATRIOT Act as warranting special measures and/or as being of primary money laundering concern, or (B) a jurisdiction that has been designated as non-cooperative with international anti-money laundering principles by a multinational or inter-governmental group such as the Financial Action Task Force on Money Laundering of which the United States is a member; (iii) a financial institution that has been designated by the Secretary of the Treasury as warranting special measures and/or as being of primary money laundering concern; (iv) a “senior foreign political figure,” or any “immediate family” member or “close associate” of a senior foreign political figure, in each case within the meaning of Section 5318(i) of Title 31 of the United States Code or regulations issued thereunder; or (v) a prohibited “foreign shell bank” as defined in Section 5318(j) of Title 31 of the United States Code or regulations issued thereunder, or a U.S. financial institution that has established, maintains, administers or manages an account in the U.S. for, or on behalf of, a prohibited “foreign shell bank”;

 

  (o) the assets used to consummate the transactions provided hereunder shall not constitute the assets of: (i) an “employee benefit plan” that is subject to Title I of the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, as amended (“ ERISA ”); (ii) a “plan” within the meaning of Section 4975 of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the “ Internal Revenue Code ”); (iii) a person or entity the underlying assets of which include the assets of any such employee benefit plan or plan by reason of Department of Labor Regulation Section 2510.3-101, as modified by Section 3(42) of ERISA, or otherwise; or (iv) a governmental or other plan that is subject to any federal, state, local or non-U.S. law, rule or regulation that is substantially similar to the provisions of Section 406 of ERISA or Section 4975 of the Internal Revenue Code, and Customer will notify Scotia in writing reasonably in advance of any of its assets becoming subject to Title I of ERISA, the prohibited transaction provisions of the Internal Revenue Code or any federal, state, local or non-U.S. law, rule or regulation that is similar to the prohibited transaction provisions of Section 406 of ERISA or Section 4975 of the Internal Revenue Code and, upon a Scotia Entity’s request, Customer will immediately terminate any or all transactions prior to its assets becoming subject to such laws, rules or regulations.

 

11. Covenants . Customer hereby covenants and agrees with Scotia that, so long as Customer has or may have any Obligations under this Agreement:

 

  (a) it will abide by the prevailing by-laws, rules, regulations, policies and customs of the Regulatory Authorities, as defined herein;

 

  (b) it will use all reasonable efforts to maintain in full force and effect all consents of any governmental or other authority that are required to be obtained by it with respect to this Agreement and will use all reasonable efforts to obtain any that may become necessary in future; and

 

10


  (c) it will comply with Applicable Law.

 

12. Events of Default . The occurrence at any time with respect to Customer of any of the following events constitutes an event of default (“ Event of Default ”) under this Agreement:

 

  (a) Customer breaches, repudiates, or defaults (however denominated) under or in connection with any Obligation, this Agreement, or any other Contract with a Scotia Entity;

 

  (b) a representation made or repeated or deemed to have been made or repeated by Customer in this Agreement proves to have been incorrect or misleading in any material respect when made or repeated or deemed to have been made or repeated;

 

  (c) a Bankruptcy Event, as defined herein, occurs with respect to Customer; or

 

  (d) Customer suffers a sustained, material adverse change in its financial condition, results, operations, properties, or business as determined by Scotia in its commercially reasonable discretion.

 

13. Rights and Remedies upon the occurrence of an Event of Default . In the event that an Event of Default occurs, then, in addition to any other right or remedy to which Scotia is entitled, the Scotia Entities may immediately and without prior notice or demand to Customer:

 

  (a) prevent the withdrawal of the cash and securities then in any or all of the Accounts and withdraw the provision of financing services hereunder;

 

  (b) terminate, liquidate, and accelerate any and all Contracts with any Scotia Entity;

 

  (c) exercise any right under any security relating to any Contract with any Scotia Entity;

 

  (d) net or set off payments which may arise under any Contract with any Scotia Entity or other agreement or under Applicable Law;

 

  (e) sell, apply, or collect on any or all of the Collateral (either jointly or with others);

 

  (f) exercise any rights and remedies available to a secured creditor under any Applicable Law or under the NYUCC (whether or not the NYUCC is otherwise applicable in the relevant jurisdiction);

 

11


  (g) sell, contract to sell, otherwise dispose of, or value any or all of the securities or other property in the Accounts or in any other account of Customer with any Scotia Entity on behalf of Customer whereupon such Scotia Entity’s obligation with respect to those securities or property will be an obligation to pay to Customer an amount equal to the excess of any net proceeds of the sale or disposition, or the excess of the value of the securities or other property, over Customer’s Obligations;

 

  (h) purchase or borrow any securities or other property necessary to cover any short sales or any other sales made on Customer’s behalf in respect of which delivery of securities or other property in an acceptable form has not already been effected by a Scotia Entity on Customer’s behalf, in which case all costs, expenses and losses arising as a result thereof will be debited from the Account and will be the responsibility of Customer;

 

  (i) cancel any outstanding orders in respect to the Account; and

 

  (j) exercise any other set-off rights available to a Scotia Entity pursuant to the provisions of this Agreement or any other agreement to which Customer is a party.

Notwithstanding the foregoing, if an Event of Default has occurred with respect to Customer, if Customer delivers a notice (a “Default Notice” ) to the Scotia Entities (i) stating that an Event of Default has occurred and (ii) requesting a waiver of such Event of Default, then the Scotia Entities shall have 45 calendar days from the date such Default Notice is delivered in which to exercise their rights under this Section 13 and the right to withhold performance pursuant to Section 23(m). If the Scotia Entities choose to reject such waiver and exercise their rights under this Section 13, the Scotia Entities will notify Customer of such rejection prior to or concurrently with the exercise of their rights under this Section 13 if reasonably practicable under the circumstances or as soon as reasonably practicable thereafter. If the Scotia Entities have not declared an Event of Default and terminated this Agreement by the 45th day following the delivery of the Default Notice, then the Scotia Entities shall be deemed to have waived (i) their rights with respect to the Event of Default identified in the Default Notice and (ii) the occurrence of such Event of Default. The parties hereto agree that any such waiver shall not apply to any subsequent Events of Default whether related to such Event of Default or not.

Any such sales or purchases for any of the Accounts may be made upon any exchange or market or at a public or private sale upon such terms and in such manner as a Scotia Entity deems advisable. If demand is made or a Scotia Entity gives notice to Customer, it shall not constitute a waiver of any of the Scotia Entities’ rights to act hereunder without demand or notice. Any and all expenses (including any legal expenses) reasonably incurred by any Scotia Entity in connection with exercising any right pursuant to this Section may be charged to the Accounts.

 

12


Customer agrees and acknowledges that it shall remain liable to the Scotia Entities for any Obligations remaining unpaid or outstanding following the exercise by any Scotia Entity of any or all of the foregoing rights and that the rights which the Scotia Entities are entitled to exercise pursuant to this section are reasonable and necessary for their protection having regard for the nature of the securities markets, including, in particular, their volatility.

Customer further acknowledges that Customer is not entitled to prior notice of any sale of the securities, except such notice as may be required by Applicable Law that cannot be waived.

For greater clarity, such rights of the Scotia Entities may be exercised separately, successively or concurrently. The Scotia Entities will not be required by this Agreement to exercise any such rights nor will they be required to exercise any right prior to exercising any other right. The failure to exercise any or all of such rights or the granting of any indulgence will not in any way limit, restrict or prevent the Scotia Entities from exercising such rights at any subsequent time and will not limit, reduce or discharge any Obligations or part thereof until such is actually paid in full. Any sale or purchase of securities pursuant to the rights above may be made by or on behalf of any Scotia Entity upon any exchange or market or at a public or private sale upon such terms and in such manner as the Scotia Entities deem advisable, in their commercially reasonable discretion.

 

14. Set-off Rights. Each Scotia Entity is hereby authorized, at its option and in its discretion at any time following the occurrence of an Event of Default, to reduce any Obligation owed by it or any other Scotia Entity to Customer against any Obligations of Customer to the Scotia Entity or to any other Scotia Entity, in each case regardless of whether the Obligation is mature or unmatured. Customer expressly waives any requirement of mutuality to allow one Scotia Entity to set off, net or recoup any Obligation owed to Customer by a Scotia Entity against any Obligation of Customer to a different Scotia Entity and Customer agrees that the Scotia Entities may reconcile any such set off, netting or recoupment as they determine.

Any Scotia Entity may estimate in good faith any Obligation that is unascertained, subject to the relevant party accounting to the other when the Obligation is ascertained. Notwithstanding anything else herein to the contrary, any Obligation of any Scotia Entity to Customer shall be contingent upon Customer’s satisfaction in full of its outstanding Obligations to the Scotia Entities in the aggregate. The rights granted hereby shall be without prejudice and in addition to any right of set off, combination of accounts, lien or other right to which any party is at any time otherwise entitled (whether by operation of law, contract or otherwise).

 

15.

Indemnification. Customer agrees that it will indemnify and hold harmless each of the Scotia Entities and any of their employees, officers, or directors (each Scotia Entity, employee, officer, or director, an “ Indemnified Person ”) against, and shall pay the applicable Indemnified Person on demand, any and all costs and

 

13


  expenses, damages, losses and liabilities which any Indemnified Person may suffer or incur, directly or indirectly, as a result, or in connection with, or arising out of (i) this Agreement or any other Contract with any Scotia Entity; (ii) any Transaction; (iii) Customer’s Obligations; (iv) any activities or services of the Indemnified Persons in connection with this Agreement or otherwise; (v) any Indemnified Person acting in reliance upon instructions the Indemnified Person reasonably believes to be transmitted by an Authorized Person; (vi) a breach by Customer of any covenant, representation, or warranty under this Agreement or under any other Contract or with respect to any Obligation; (vii) any Scotia Entity’s enforcement of its rights under this Agreement; and (viii) any claim, action, proceeding, or investigation arising out of or in connection with this Agreement or any Transaction.

Customer authorizes Scotia, on its own behalf or on behalf of any Indemnified Person upon written demand, to debit any of Customer’s Accounts for any and all costs arising from or related to the foregoing. This indemnity will survive and stay in effect notwithstanding the termination of this Agreement for any reason whatsoever. The indemnities under this Section 15 shall be separate from and in addition to any other indemnity under any Contract with any Scotia Entity.

This indemnity will not extend to any Indemnified Person insofar as costs, expenses, damages, liabilities and losses result primarily from any act of bad faith, willful default, fraud or gross negligence of any Indemnified Person, apply to the extent that it would infringe Applicable Law.

 

16. Limitation of Liability; Related Matters.

 

  (a) None of the Scotia Entities, nor any of their respective employees, officers, directors, agents, or counsel, shall be liable for any action taken or omitted to be taken by any of them under or in connection with this Agreement except for the gross negligence or willful misconduct of the applicable Scotia Entity. No Scotia Entity shall be liable for any error of judgment made by it in good faith. The Scotia Entities may consult with legal counsel and any action taken or suffered in good faith in accordance with the advice of such counsel shall be full justification for and protection to them.

 

  (b) The Scotia Entities may execute any of their duties and exercise their rights under this Agreement by or through agents (which may include affiliates) or employees. None of the Scotia Entities shall be liable for the acts or omissions of any sub-custodian or other agent. All transactions effected with a third party for Customer shall be for the account of Customer and the Scotia Entities shall have no responsibility to Customer or such third party with respect to such transactions. Nothing in this Agreement shall create, or shall be deemed to create, any third party beneficiary rights in any person or entity (including any investor or adviser of Customer), other than the Scotia Entities.

 

14


  (c) In no event shall the Scotia Entities be held liable for any loss of any kind caused, directly or indirectly, by government restrictions, exchange or market actions or rulings, suspension of trading, war (whether declared or undeclared), terrorist acts, insurrection, riots, fires, floods, strikes, failure of utility or similar services, accidents, adverse weather or other events of nature (including but not limited to earthquakes, hurricanes, and tornadoes) and any other conditions beyond the Scotia Entities’ control and any event in which any communications network, data processing system, or computer system used by any of the Scotia Entities or Customer or by market participants is rendered wholly or partially inoperable.

 

  (d) In no event shall the Customer or the Scotia Entities be held liable for indirect, consequential, exemplary, or punitive damages.

 

17. Notices; Communications; Instructions.

 

  (a) Notices and Communications . Any notices or other communications from Customer to Scotia under this Agreement shall be in writing, addressed to:

Scotia Capital (USA) Inc.

250 Vesey Street, 24 th Floor

New York, NY 10281

Attention: US Prime Brokerage Client Services

Telephone: 1-212-225-6613

Fax: 1-212-225-6645

With a copy to:

711 Louisiana Street, Suite 1400

Houston, TX 77002 United States

Attention: Global Prime Finance

Telephone: 713-759-3450

Fax Number: 713-759-3486

And to:

Scotia Plaza, 65 th Floor 40 King Street West

Toronto, Ontario, Canada M5W 2X6

Attention: Managing Director, Global Head of Prime Brokerage

Facsimile No: 416-862-3914

 

15


  (b) Addresses and Communications to Customer .

 

  (i) Any notices or other communications from Scotia Entities to Customer under this Agreement shall be written, addressed to:

Cushing Renaissance Fund

8117 Preston Road, Suite 440

Dallas, TX 75225

Attention: Operations Department

Telephone: 1-214-692-6334

Fax: 1-214-219-2353

Email: operations@swankcapital.com

 

  (ii) Subject to the specific requirements set forth in any other section herein or under any other Contract, any notice or other communication to Customer in respect to this Agreement may be given in any manner set forth below (except that service of process may not be given by facsimile transmission or electronic messaging system) to the most recent address or number or in accordance with the most recent electronic messaging system details provided by Customer. All communications sent to Customer will be deemed delivered to Customer as indicated below:

 

  (A) if in writing and delivered by messenger, on the date the messenger effects delivery thereof at Customer’s address as set forth on the signature page of this Agreement;

 

  (B) if sent by facsimile transmission, on the date that transmission is sent;

 

  (C) if sent by electronic messaging, on the date that electronic message is sent;

 

  (D) if posted to the Internet (only in respect of reporting through Scotia’s PrimeOne system), on the date that communication is posted; or

 

  (E) if sent by overnight mail, on the earlier of the date received or two Business Day after the communication is sent;

in each case, whether actually received or not , provided that if sent by either facsimile or electronic messaging and sender receives an error message or a non-deliverable response, sender shall use at least one additional alternate method in Section 17(b) of this Agreement. Failure by Customer to object in writing to any confirmation or statement within three Business Days of delivery shall be deemed evidence, in the absence of manifest error, that such confirmation or statement is complete and correct.

 

  (c) Instructions . Notwithstanding anything to the contrary, Customer agrees that the Scotia Entities may rely upon any authorized instructions or any notice, request, waiver, consent, receipt, or other document which the Scotia Entities reasonably believe to be genuine and transmitted by authorized persons.

 

16


  (d) Change of Address . Either party may, by notice to the other, change the address, telex or facsimile number or electronic messaging system details at which notices or communications are to be given to it.

 

18. Consent to Electronic Delivery . If Customer has consented to electronic delivery of account statements on the signature page of this Agreement:

 

  (a) Customer understands and agrees that Scotia will only send Customer paper copies of account statements upon Customer’s request.

 

  (b) Customer agrees that electronic delivery of account statements will be good delivery to Customer and be deemed received by Customer in accordance with Section 17 of this Agreement.

 

  (c) Customer understands that Customer will not be charged by Scotia for electronic delivery of account statements. Customer further understands that Customer can obtain paper copies of account statements with no charge at any time by contacting Customer’s client service representative.

 

  (d) Customer may withdraw Customer’s consent to electronic delivery at any time by contacting Customer’s client service representative. Customer will not incur any fees by withdrawing its consent to electronic delivery. Customer’s consent to electronic delivery will be effective until the termination of this Agreement or Customer’s earlier withdrawal of consent.

 

19.

Scotia Entities Not Providing Advice; Not Fiduciaries . Customer represents that it is capable of assessing the merits (on its own behalf or through independent professional advice), and understands and accepts, the terms and conditions set forth in this Agreement and any transaction it may undertake with the Scotia Entities. Customer acknowledges that (a) none of the Scotia Entities is (i) acting as a fiduciary for or an adviser to Customer in respect of this Agreement or any transaction it may undertake with the Scotia Entities; (ii) advising it, performing any analysis, or making any judgment on any matters pertaining to the suitability of any transaction, or (iii) offering any opinion, judgment or other type of information pertaining to the nature, value, potential or suitability of any particular investment or transaction, (b) the Scotia Entities do not guarantee or warrant the accuracy, reliability or timeliness of any information that the Scotia Entities may from time to time provide or make available to Customer; and (c) the Scotia Entities may take positions in financial instruments discussed in the information provided to Customer (which positions may be inconsistent with the information provided) and may execute transactions for themselves or others in those instruments and may provide investment banking and other services to the issuers of those instruments or with respect to those instruments.

 

17


Customer agrees that (x) it is solely responsible for monitoring compliance with its own internal restrictions and procedures governing investments, trading limits and manner of authorizing investments, and with the Applicable Law affecting its authority and ability to trade and invest; and (y) in no event shall a Scotia Entity undertake to assess whether a Contract or transaction is appropriate or legal for Customer.

 

20. Amendment; Termination; Assignment .

 

  (a) Amendment . Scotia may modify the terms of this Agreement at any time upon prior written notice to Customer if such modifications are required in connection with Applicable Law or regulation as determined by Scotia in its good faith discretion. I n any other circumstance, Scotia may amend this Agreement upon no less than thirty (30) Business Days’ prior written notice. Customer will be deemed to have agreed to any such modification if Customer accepts services from or engages in Transactions with Scotia after receipt such written notice to Customer. If Customer does not wish to accept any such modification, Customer may notify Scotia in writing within ten (10) calendar days of such written notification and Customer’s accounts and this Agreement may then be terminated as provided in Section 20(b). Otherwise, this Agreement may not be waived or modified absent a written instrument signed by an authorized representative of Scotia.

 

  (b) Termination . If the Committed Lending Agreement has been terminated or the Commitment Term has otherwise expired, either Scotia or Customer may terminate this Agreement upon delivery of written notice to the other party, provided that Customer’s termination notice is only effective if (i) it is accompanied by instructions as to the transfer of all property held in the Accounts; and (ii) Customer has satisfied all Obligations.

 

  (c) Survival . Sections 2, 3, 5, 10-17, and 19-21 an each representation and covenant made under this Agreement shall survive any termination. Declining to accept certain property as margin in accordance with the terms of this Agreement does not constitute a termination of this Agreement.

 

  (d) Assignment . Scotia and any Scotia Entity may assign its rights under this Agreement or any interest in this Agreement or under any other Contract with any Scotia Entity (i) to any Scotia Entity on prior written notice to Customer; or (ii) to any other party on thirty days’ prior written notice to Customer.

Customer may not assign its rights under or any interest in (x) any Contract without the prior written consent of Scotia and each Scotia Entity that is a party to the Contract (in their sole good faith discretion); or (y) this Agreement, including without limitation Customer’s right to any

 

18


Close-Out Amount, without the prior written consent of each Scotia Entity (in their sole good faith discretion). Any attempted assignment by Customer in violation of this Agreement shall be null, void, and without effect.

 

21. RESOLUTION OF DISPUTES .

 

  (a) Exclusive Jurisdiction . With respect to any application for a provisional remedy, any application for judgment on an arbitration award, and with regard to any suit, action, or other proceeding with respect to, based upon, or relating to a Dispute, each party irrevocably (i) submits to the exclusive jurisdiction of the United States District Court for the Southern District of New York (located in New York County), or, if such court does not have jurisdiction, the Supreme Court of the State of New York, County of New York (each, the “Court,” as applicable); (ii) waives any objection that it may have at any time to the laying of venue of any proceedings brought in any such Court, waives any claim that such proceedings have been brought in an inconvenient or improper forum and further waives the right to object, with respect to such proceedings, that such Court does not have any jurisdiction over such party; (iii) will not commence any action or proceeding with respect to, based upon, or relating to a Dispute in any other court; (iv) agrees that all claims with respect to, based upon or relating to any Dispute may be heard and determined in such Court; and (v) waives and agrees not to assert any claim of immunity from any legal process (whether through service or notice, attachment prior to judgment, attachment in aid of execution, execution or otherwise) with respect to such party or its property.

 

  (b) Consent to Service of Process . Notwithstanding any contrary provisions in Section 17, the parties consent to service of process or delivery of any notice with respect to, or based upon or relating to any Dispute, judicial proceeding or arbitration, in each case, by personal delivery, delivery by mail, return receipt requested, delivery by a recognized overnight delivery service and by any other means authorized by Applicable Laws and, if applicable, by the rules governing any Dispute, judicial proceeding or arbitration, addressed, if to a Scotia Entity, as provided in Section 17 of this Agreement, and, if to Customer, to an address contained in the records of Scotia on which Scotia customarily relies.

 

  (c) Enforcement . Any judgment or award obtained with respect to a Dispute may be enforced in the courts of any jurisdiction where the party and/or any of its property may be found without re-examination of the matters previously adjudicated or determined, and each party irrevocably submits to the jurisdiction of each such court for such purpose.

 

  (d)

Service of Process . Customer irrevocably designates and appoints the individual or entity indicated on the signature page hereto as an authorized

 

19


  agent to receive service of process on Customer’s behalf in connection with any Dispute, including with respect to any arbitration or other proceeding, such appointment to continue until Customer appoints a different authorized agent acceptable to Scotia. If for any reason such authorized agent is unable to act as such, Customer will promptly notify Scotia and promptly appoint an authorized agent acceptable to Scotia.

 

  (e) WAIVER OF JURY TRIAL . EACH OF CUSTOMER AND SCOTIA (AND, TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY LAW, ON BEHALF OF THEIR RESPECTIVE EQUITY HOLDERS AND CREDITORS) KNOWINGLY, VOLUNTARILY AND IRREVOCABLY WAIVES, TO THE FULLEST EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW, ANY RIGHT IT MAY HAVE TO A TRIAL BY JURY IN RESPECT OF ANY DISPUTE AND ANY RIGHT IT MAY HAVE TO CONSOLIDATE ANY SUCH ACTION WITH ANY OTHER ACTION IN WHICH A JURY TRIAL CANNOT BE OR HAS NOT BEEN WAIVED. EACH PARTY (I) CERTIFIES THAT NO REPRESENTATIVE, AGENT OR ATTORNEY OF ANY OTHER PARTY HAS REPRESENTED, EXPRESSLY OR OTHERWISE, THAT SUCH OTHER PARTY WOULD NOT, IN THE EVENT OF DISPUTE, SEEK TO ENFORCE THE FOREGOING WAIVER AND (II) ACKNOWLEDGES THAT IT AND THE OTHER PARTIES HAVE BEEN INDUCED TO ENTER INTO THIS AGREEMENT BY, AMONG OTHER THINGS, THE MUTUAL WAIVERS AND CERTIFICATIONS IN THIS SECTION. IN THE EVENT OF DISPUTE, THIS AGREEMENT MAY BE FILED AS A WRITTEN CONSENT TO A TRIAL BY THE COURT.

 

22. Applicable Law; Enforceability . This Agreement shall be governed by and construed in accordance with the laws of the State of New York without reference to any choice of law rules that would result in the application of the law of any other jurisdiction.

The parties hereto further agree that (i) the securities intermediary’s jurisdiction, within the meaning of Section 8-110(e) of the NYUCC, in respect of any securities account constituting Collateral or to which any Collateral is credited or in which any Collateral is held or carried and in respect of any Collateral consisting of security entitlements; (ii) the bank’s jurisdiction, within the meaning of Section 9-304(b) of the NYUCC, in respect of any deposit account constituting Collateral, or to which any Collateral is credited or in which any Collateral is held or carried; and (iii) the commodity intermediary’s jurisdiction, within the meaning of Section 9-305(b) of the NYUCC, in respect of any commodity account constituting Collateral, or to which any Collateral is credited or in which any Collateral is held or carried and in respect of any Collateral consisting of commodity contracts, is the State of New York and agree that none of them has or will enter into any agreement to the contrary. Customer and Scotia agree that, in respect of any account maintained by Scotia, the law applicable to all the issues specified in Article 2(1) of the “Hague Convention on the Law Applicable to

 

20


Certain Rights in Respect of Securities Held with an Intermediary (Hague Securities Convention)” is the law in force in the State of New York and agree that none of them has or will enter into any agreement to the contrary.

 

23. General; Miscellaneous.

 

  (a) No Obligation To Effect or Settle or Accept Particular Assets as Margin . No Scotia Entity shall be under any obligation to effect or settle or clear any transaction on behalf of Customer, except as expressly provided in a Contract. Without limiting the generality of the foregoing, each Scotia Entity reserves the right to limit the transactions that it will effect or settle or clear on behalf of Customer and has no obligation to continue, extend, renew or “roll-over” any transaction. The valuation of Collateral and the determination of whether to accept any property as margin shall be entirely within the discretion of the relevant Scotia Entity.

 

  (b) Payment . Without limiting Customer’s general obligation to pay and perform all of its Obligations, Customer agrees to pay all brokerage commissions, markups or markdowns in connection with the execution of transactions and other reasonable and customary fees for custody and other services rendered to Customer as reasonably determined by any Scotia Entity. Customer agrees to pay promptly:

 

    such fees for services as any Scotia Entity may impose from time to time in accordance with the terms of the applicable Contract;

 

    interest charges, as such Scotia Entity may impose in accordance with the terms of the applicable Contract, with respect to (i) debit balances (in any account, including the Account), (ii) late payments by Customer, and (iii) prepayments ( i.e. , the crediting of proceeds of sale prior to settlement date or prior to receipt by any Scotia Entity of the item sold in good deliverable forms);

 

    such other fees, charges, costs, expenses or the like as are otherwise provided herein or in a Contract; and

 

    any costs of collection, including reasonable attorneys’ fees, related to the foregoing.

Customer specifically authorizes any Scotia Entity to charge Customer’s account at any such entity, including the Account, for any such payments owed but acknowledges that, notwithstanding such authorization, the Scotia Entities shall have no obligation to charge Customer’s account for any outstanding payments and that absent such charge being made Customer shall remain obligated to make any such payment and to pay any late fees or interest that may accrue from such failure or delay, as specified in the applicable Contract.

 

21


  (c) Application of Payments Received . Customer specifically authorizes any Scotia Entity to apply any payment received on Customer’s behalf, including interest, dividends, premiums, principal or other payments, to any Obligation to such Scotia Entity or to any other Scotia Entity after the occurrence of an Event of Default.

 

  (d) Procedures and Conditions . Customer agrees to comply with such customary and reasonable procedures, conditions, instructions or other requirements as any Scotia Entity shall impose from time to time by notice to Customer, with respect to the services to be provided by such Scotia Entity.

 

  (e) No Waiver . No failure or delay in exercising any right, or any partial exercise of a right will operate as a waiver of the full exercise of that right. The rights provided in the Contracts with the Scotia Entities are cumulative and not exclusive of any rights provided by law.

 

  (f) Anti -Money Laundering . Customer understands and acknowledges that the Scotia Entities are and will be subject to money laundering statutes, regulations and conventions of the United States or other international jurisdictions, and Customer agrees to execute instruments, provide information, or perform any other acts as may reasonably be requested by any Scotia Entity for the purpose of carrying out due diligence as may be required by Applicable Law. Customer agrees that it will provide the Scotia Entities with such information as any Scotia Entity may reasonably require to comply with applicable anti-money laundering laws or regulations. Notwithstanding anything herein to the contrary, Customer understands, acknowledges and agrees that to the extent permitted by Applicable Law, any Scotia Entity may provide information, including confidential information, to the Financial Crimes Enforcement Network, a bureau of the U.S. Department of the Treasury, or any other agency or instrumentality of the U.S. Government, or as otherwise required by Applicable Law, in connection with a request for information on behalf of a law enforcement agency investigating terrorist activity or money laundering.

 

  (g) Money Market Funds . Customer agrees that with respect to transactions effected in shares of any money market fund and any other transactions listed in Rule 10b-10(b)(1) under the Securities Exchange Act, any Scotia Entity may provide Customer with a monthly or quarterly written statement pursuant to Rule 10b-10(b) under the Securities Exchange Act in lieu of an immediate confirmation.

 

  (h)

Truth-in-Lending Statement . Customer hereby acknowledges receipt of Scotia’s Truth-in-Lending disclosure statement. Interest will be charged on any debit balances in any accounts in accordance with the methods described in such statement or in any amendment or revision thereto that

 

22


  may be provided to Customer. Any debit balance that is not paid at the close of an interest period will be added to the opening balance for the next interest period. Customer acknowledges that this Truth-in-Lending statement shall also be deemed to be the Truth-in-lending disclosure statement of any other Scotia Entity that is a registered U.S. broker-dealer, but only to the extent any such Scotia Entity has not provided Customer with a separate Truth-in-Lending statement.

 

  (i) Disclosure Notices . Customer hereby acknowledges receipt from Scotia of a copy of this Agreement and acknowledges that it has separately received one or more notices as follows:

 

    a notice containing the address and telephone number of the department of Scotia to which any complaints as to Customer’s account may be directed; and

 

    a notice concerning Scotia’s payment for order flow practices.

A copy of Scotia’s business continuity plan can be obtained upon written request to scotia.uspb@scotia.com .

 

  (j) Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation . Unless explicitly stated otherwise, transactions hereunder and funds held in any account by any Scotia Entity pursuant to this Agreement (i) are not insured by the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation or the Canadian Deposit Insurance or any government agency, and (ii) involve market and investment risks, including possible loss of the principal amount invested.

 

  (k) Confidentiality . Customer agrees that it will neither use the name of any Scotia Entity nor make any disclosure with respect to Customer’s relationship with any Scotia Entity, including in any solicitation, marketing or advertising material or any filing or news release without the prior written consent of the relevant Scotia Entity; provided, however, that notwithstanding the foregoing, Customer shall be allowed, without prior written consent of any Scotia Entity, to include the name of any Scotia Entity within a description of Customer’s service providers in disclosure documents, regulatory filings or marketing or advertising material provided that any such description of the relationship between any Scotia Entity and Customer is true and accurate at the time of such disclosure.

 

  (l) Recording of Conversations . Customer is aware that the Scotia Entities may record conversations between any of them and Customer or Customer’s representatives relating to the matters referred to in this Agreement and Customer has no objection and hereby agrees to such recording.

 

23


  (m) Contingency . The fulfillment of the Obligations of any Scotia Entity to Customer under any Contract is contingent upon there being no breach, repudiation, misrepresentation or default (however characterized) by Customer which has occurred and is continuing under any Contract.

 

  (n) Proxy Disclosure . With respect to Collateral, the Scotia Entities are under no obligation to vote or otherwise act in accordance with Customer’s instructions.

 

  (o) Rule 14b-1(b)(3) . Customer understands Scotia Entities that are registered in the U.S. as broker-dealers are required to disclose to an issuer the name, address, and position of each customer who is a beneficial owner of that issuer’s securities unless such customer objects. This is done to comply with Rule 14b-1(b)(3) under the Securities Exchange Act. By checking the 14(b)-1(b)(3) box beside Customer’s signature, Customer requests that such information not be disclosed by any Scotia Entities subject to such rule.

 

  (p) Background Information; Sharing of Information . Customer authorizes the Scotia Entities and any agent or service provider to verify and confirm any information that Customer or its agent provides, to obtain reports or other information concerning Customer’s (and its principals’) background, credit standing and business conduct. Customer also acknowledges that the Scotia Entities share many computer systems and employees and also share information concerning their respective customers for the purpose of monitoring and approving credit, legal, regulatory and underwriting exposures and administration of accounts with and transactions with or through any Scotia Entity. The Scotia Entities will treat such information pursuant to its policies and procedures designed to protect the confidentiality and security of customer information and to ensure that such information is used only in a manner that is consistent with Applicable Law.

 

  (q) Communications Technology . Customer will safeguard any test keys, identification codes or other security devices that any Scotia Entity makes available to Customer, including any of the foregoing used to transmit instructions. No Scotia Entity will be liable for any loss incurred by Customer arising from any failure or misuse of any electronic or on-line system used to transmit instructions.

 

  (r) Securities in Deliverable Form . Customer will deliver all securities (including Collateral consisting of securities) to the Scotia Entities in good deliverable form (failing which, the Scotia Entities have the power to place such securities in good deliverable form) in accordance with the requirements of the primary market or markets for such securities.

 

24


  (s) Estimated Price or Indicative Valuation . Any estimated price or indicative valuation provided to Customer by any Scotia Entity should not be Customer’s primary basis for determining the value of any security, commodity or derivative transaction or in making any investment decision. Customer hereby agrees that it will not provide any estimated price or indicative valuation (or any part thereof) to any third party without the relevant Scotia Entity’s consent.

 

  (t) Direct Borrow Disclosure . If Customer has a margin Account with Scotia, as permitted by law, Scotia may use certain securities in Customer’s Account for, among other things, settling short sales and lending the securities for short sales. In addition, if Customer chooses to enter into a securities lending agreement with Scotia, separate and apart from this Agreement, and elects to lend any fully-paid securities to Scotia pursuant to that securities lending agreement, Scotia may use the loaned securities to make delivery in connection with short sales or to lend to others who may similarly use them in connection with short sales. Customer may elect not to allow fully-paid securities to be used in connection with short sales by deciding not to lend a specific security or by terminating the securities loan, subject to the termination provisions of the securities lending agreement. Scotia may receive compensation as a result of the use of Customer’s securities as described above, as well as in connection with any fully-paid securities Customer elects to lend to Scotia under a separate securities lending agreement.

 

24. Agreement .

 

  (a) This Agreement constitutes the entire agreement and understanding of the parties with respect to the subject matter hereof and supersedes all oral communications and prior writings with respect hereto. To the extent this Agreement contains any provision that is inconsistent with provisions in any other Contract or agreement between Customer and any of the Scotia Entities, or of which Customer is a beneficiary, the provisions of this Agreement shall control except if such other Contract explicitly states that it is intended to supersede this Agreement by name, in which case such other Contract shall prevail.

 

  (b) If any statute or any statutory regulation or any by-law, rule, regulation, policy or custom of the Regulatory Authorities is enacted, made, amended or otherwise changed with the result that any term or condition of this Agreement is, in whole or in part, invalid, then such term or condition will be deemed to be varied or superseded to the extent necessary to give effect to such statute, regulation, by-law, rule, policy or custom; provided, however that the parties hereto will then enter into good faith negotiations to attempt to replace such invalid term or condition or give effect to the economic effect thereof. Any term or condition of this Agreement which notwithstanding any such variation is invalid will not invalidate the remaining terms and conditions hereof.

 

25


  (c) This Agreement may be executed in counterparts, each of which will be deemed an original instrument and all of which together will constitute one and the same agreement.

 

  (d) This Agreement will inure to the benefit of and will be binding upon Scotia and Customer and their respective permitted successors and assigns.

 

  (e) Whenever this Agreement entitles a Scotia Entity to alternative courses of action, such Scotia Entity shall be entitled to choose any, none or all of such alternative courses of action in its sole unfettered discretion.

 

  (f) The headings used in this Agreement are for convenience of reference only and shall not in any way affect its interpretation. In this Agreement, where singular is used, it shall include the plural and vice versa.

 

  (g) Each party in good faith and in a commercially reasonable manner will make performance of all Obligations under this Agreement.

[The remainder of this page is intentionally left blank.]

 

26


IN WITNESS WHEREOF the parties have duly executed this Agreement as of the date and year first written above.

 

  By checking this box, Customer requests that Scotia not disclose any information to any issuer pursuant to Rule 14b-1(b)(3).

 

  By checking this box, Customer consents to the electronic delivery of account statements as set forth in Section 17 of this Agreement.

 

THE CUSHING RENAISSANCE FUND    

THE BANK OF NOVA SCOTIA,

ACTING THROUGH ITS

      HOUSTON BRANCH
By:  

/s/ Jerry V. Swank

    By:  

/s/ Authorized Person

Name:   Jerry V. Swank     Name:   Authorized Person
Title:   Chief Executive Officer     Title:  

Agent Authorized to Receive Service of Process

On behalf of Customer:

Name:

Address:

 

27

Exhibit (k)(vi)

SPECIAL CUSTODY and PLEDGE AGREEMENT

(Margin Account)

AGREEMENT (hereinafter “ Agreement ”) dated as of August 26, 2014, among The Cushing Renaissance Fund (“ Customer ”), The Bank of Nova Scotia, acting through its Houston branch (“ Broker ”) and U.S. Bank, N.A. as Custodian hereunder (“ Custodian ”).

WHEREAS , Customer has opened a margin account (the “ Margin Account ”) with Broker in which Customer may obtain extensions of credit and for those purposes has signed a Lending Services Agreement, dated as of August 26, 2014 with Broker (as amended, restated, supplemented or replaced from time to time, with attachments thereto, the “ Account Agreement ”) and a Committed Lending Agreement, dated as of August 26, 2014 with Broker (as amended, restated, supplemented or replaced from time to time, with attachments thereto, the “ Committed Lending Agreement ” and together with the Account Agreement, the “ Loan Agreements ”); and

WHEREAS , Broker is required to comply with applicable laws and regulations pertaining to extensions of credit, including the margin regulations of the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System and of any relevant securities exchanges and other self-regulatory associations (the “ Margin Rules ”) and Broker’s internal policies; and

WHEREAS , to facilitate extensions of credit hereunder and under the Loan Agreements, Customer and Broker desire to establish procedures for compliance with the Margin Rules; and

WHEREAS , Custodian, as custodian of certain assets of the Customer pursuant to a custody agreement dated as of August 21, 2012 (the “ Custodian Agreement ”) is prepared to act as custodian for Collateral (as hereinafter defined) pursuant to the terms and conditions of this Agreement;

NOW, THEREFORE , be it agreed as follows:

(1)    As used herein, capitalized terms have the following meanings unless otherwise defined herein:

Adequate Performance Assurance ” shall mean such Collateral held in or credited to the Special Custody Account (as such term is hereinafter defined) as is adequate under the Margin Rules and the Committed Lending Agreement and, to the extent such Committed Lending Agreement (i) has been terminated or the commitment therein has expired or (ii) is otherwise inapplicable to any portion of the Collateral, the Account Agreement.

Advice from Broker ” means a notice or entitlement order (as defined in Section 8-102 of the UCC (as defined herein)) or instruction (within the meaning of Section 9-104 of the UCC) delivered to Customer or Custodian by an Authorized Representative (as defined below) of Broker, as applicable hereunder, communicated: (i) in writing (including, for the avoidance of doubt, electronic mail); (ii) by a facsimile- sending device; or (iii) in cases of calls for additional Collateral (as such term is hereinafter defined) or notices referred to in paragraph 7 hereof, by telephone to a person designated by Customer or Custodian in writing as authorized to receive such advice or, in the event that no such person is available, to any officer of the Customer or Custodian. An officer of Broker will certify in writing to Custodian the names and signatures of those Authorized Representatives, which certification may be amended in writing from time to time.

 

1


Authorized Representative ” shall mean any person, whether or not an officer or employee of Broker or Customer, duly authorized by Broker or Customer, respectively to give, in the case of Broker, Advice from Broker or, in the case of Customer, Instructions from Customer, such persons to be designated in a Certificate of Authorized Persons which contains a specimen signature of such person.

Business Day ” means a day on which both Custodian and Broker are open for business.

Collateral ” means cash, U.S. Government securities or other margin-eligible securities acceptable to Broker which are pledged to Broker as provided herein.

Certificate of Authorized Persons ” means a certificate in the form attached hereto as Annex A.

Customer Default ” means an Event of Default (as defined in the Account Agreement) or a failure by Customer to perform any obligation under this Agreement.

Instructions from Customer ” means a request, direction or certification in writing signed in the name of the Customer by an Authorized Representative of Customer and delivered to Custodian or transmitted to it by a facsimile-sending device, S.W.I.F.T. or other method or system specified by Custodian as available for use in connection with this Agreement, except that instructions to pledge initial or additional Collateral may be given by telephone and thereafter confirmed in a writing signed in the name of Customer by a person authorized in writing by Customer. An officer of Customer will certify in writing in a Certificate of Authorized Persons to Custodian the names and signatures of those persons authorized to provide Instructions from Customer, which certification may be amended in writing from time to time.

(2)    (a) Custodian, in its capacity as a Securities Intermediary as defined in Section 8-102 of the Uniform Commercial Code as in effect from time to time in the State of New York (the “ UCC ”) and Bank as defined in Section 9-102 of the UCC, to the extent the same may be applicable, or in applicable federal law or regulations, shall open a separate account on its books entitled “Special Custody Account for The Bank of Nova Scotia as Pledgee of The Cushing Renaissance Fund” (“ Special Custody Account ”) and shall hold therein for Broker as pledgee upon the terms of this Agreement all Collateral, all monies or other property paid or distributed with respect thereto or realized on any sale thereof made pursuant to this Agreement. The Special Custody Account shall be deemed to consist of: (i) a securities sub-account, which shall constitute a “securities account” (as defined in Section 8-501(a) of the UCC), to which all Collateral in the form of securities pledged to Broker shall be credited (the “ Securities Subaccount ”); and (ii) a deposit sub-account, which shall constitute a “deposit account” (as defined in Section 9-102(a)(29) of the UCC), in which all Collateral in the form of cash pledged to Broker shall be held (the “ Deposit Subaccount ”). Custodian hereby agrees that any Collateral held in the Securities Subaccount shall be treated as a financial asset for purposes of the UCC to the extent the same may be applicable. All Collateral in the form of cash, whether cash posted as initial Collateral or cash in the form of distributions on, or other proceeds of, Collateral in the form of securities, shall be held in the Deposit Subaccount. Customer agrees to instruct

 

2


Custodian through an Instruction from Customer as to the cash and specific securities which Custodian is to identify on its books and records as pledged to the Broker as Collateral in the Special Custody Account.

(b)    Customer agrees to provide and at all times maintain Adequate Performance Assurance in the Special Custody Account pursuant to the terms and conditions of this Agreement and the Loan Agreements. Customer agrees that it shall not instruct Custodian to transfer or credit to the Special Custody Account any securities which are not fully paid for or which are otherwise encumbered.

(c)    Customer, Broker and Custodian agree (i) that Collateral will be held for Broker in the Special Custody Account by Custodian, (H) that the Custodian will take such actions with respect to any Collateral (including without limitation, complying with any entitlement orders (as such term is defined in Section 8-102 of the UCC) concerning the Securities Subaccount and any instructions directing the disposition of cash in the Deposit Subaccount) as Broker shall direct in an Advice from Broker, (iii) that in no event shall any consent of Customer be required for the taking of any such action by Custodian and (iv) that in no event shall Custodian permit any withdrawal or release of Collateral otherwise than pursuant to an Advice from Broker.

(d)    Customer hereby grants a continuing security interest to Broker: (i) in Collateral and any proceeds thereof; (H) all other property in the Margin Account and the Special Custody Account; and (iii) in its accounts (including the Margin Account) with Broker and the Special Custody Account, to secure Customer’s obligations to Broker hereunder and under the Loan Agreements. Custodian shall have no responsibility for the validity or enforceability of such security interest.

(3)    Custodian will make available to Broker and Customer by use of a secured web site with respect to the Special Custody Account (“TrustNow Essentials”), all pledges, releases or substitutions of Collateral effected hereunder within one Business Day of all pledges, releases or substitutions of Collateral and will supply Broker and Customer within five Business Days of the end of the calendar month a monthly statement of Collateral in the Special Custody Account and transactions in the Special Custody Account during the preceding month. Custodian will also advise Broker or Customer upon reasonable request, of the kind and amount of Collateral pledged to Broker.

(4)    Custodian agrees to release Collateral to Customer from the pledge hereunder only upon receipt of an Advice from Broker. Broker agrees, upon request of Customer, to provide such an Advice from Broker with respect to Collateral selected by Customer: (i) if said Collateral represents an excess in value of the Collateral necessary to constitute Adequate Performance Assurance at that time; (H) against prior receipt in the Special Custody Account of substitute Collateral (if such substitution is permitted under the terms of the Committed Lending Agreement or Account Agreement, as applicable) having a value at least equal (with any remaining Collateral) to Adequate Performance Assurance; or (Hi) upon termination of Customer’s accounts with Broker including the Margin Account (if any) and settlement in full of all transactions therein and any amounts owed to Broker with respect thereto. It is understood that Broker will be responsible for valuing Collateral; Custodian at no time has any responsibility for determining whether the value of Collateral is equal in value to Adequate Performance Assurance.

 

3


(5)    Customer represents and warrants to Broker that securities pledged to Broker shall be in good deliverable form (or Custodian shall have the unrestricted power to put such securities into good deliverable form), and that Collateral will not be subject to any liens or encumbrances other than the lien in favor of Broker contemplated hereby.

(6)    Collateral shall at all times remain the property of the Customer subject only to the extent of the interest and rights therein of Broker as the pledgee and secured party thereof. Custodian represents that Collateral is not subject to any other lien, charge, security interest or other right or claim of the Custodian or any person claiming through Custodian, and Custodian hereby waives any right, charge, security interest, lien or right of set off of any kind which it may have or acquire with respect to Collateral. Custodian shall notify Broker and Customer as soon as possible if any notice of levy, lien, court order or other process purporting to affect the Collateral is received by it.

Customer hereby confirms that any advances by the Custodian to purchase, or to make payment on or against delivery of any assets to be held in the Special Custody Account, shall be secured by the lien, security interest and right of setoff in the Customer’s securities and other assets pursuant to the Custodian Agreement, and not the securities and other assets in the Special Custody Account that are securing the Customer’s obligations to the Broker.

(7)    Upon Broker’s determination that a Customer Default has occurred, if Broker wishes to declare such default, Broker shall notify the Customer in an Advice from Broker of such Customer Default. Upon transmittal by Broker of such Advice from Broker, Broker may thereupon take any action permitted pursuant to the Account Agreement, including without limitation, the conversion of any convertible securities or exercise of Customer’s rights in warrants (if any) held in the Margin Account and the Special Custody Account, and the sale of any or all property or securities in the Margin Account and the Special Custody Account (in which event such Collateral shall be delivered to Broker by Custodian as directed in an Advice from Broker). Customer shall be liable to Broker for any deficiency which may exist after the exercise by Broker of its rights and remedies as aforesaid. Any surplus resulting from the sale of Collateral shall be transmitted to Custodian by Broker.

(8)    Broker hereby covenants, for the benefit of Customer, that Broker will not instruct Custodian to deliver Collateral free of payment with respect to any sale of Collateral pursuant to paragraph 7 until after the occurrence of a Customer Default. The foregoing covenant is for the benefit of Customer only and shall in no way be deemed to constitute a limitation on or condition to Broker’s right at any time to instruct Custodian pursuant to an Advice of Broker and Custodian’s obligation to act upon such instructions. Custodian shall not be required to make any determination as to whether such delivery is made in accordance with any provisions of this Agreement or any other agreement between Broker and Customer. Custodian will, however, provide prompt telephone notice to an officer of Customer of receipt by Custodian of an Advice from Broker to deliver Collateral.

(9)    Custodian’s duties and responsibilities are set forth in this Agreement. Custodian shall act only upon receipt of an Advice from Broker regarding release of Collateral. Custodian shall not be liable or responsible for anything done, or omitted to be done by it in good faith and in the absence of negligence or willful misconduct and may rely and shall be protected in acting upon any Advice from Broker which it reasonably believes to be genuine and authorized. As between Customer and Custodian, the terms of the Custodian Agreement shall apply with respect

 

4


to any losses or liabilities of such parties arising out of matters covered by this Agreement. Custodian shall not be liable for the acts or omissions of any of the other parties to this Agreement. In matters concerning or relating to this Agreement, Custodian shall not be responsible for compliance with any statute or regulation regarding the establishment or maintenance of margin credit, including but not limited to Regulations T, U or X of the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System or the rules and regulations of the OCC or the Securities and Exchange Commission. Custodian shall have no duty to require any cash or securities to be delivered to it or to determine that the amount and form of assets deposited in the Special Custody Account comply with any applicable requirements. Custodian may hold the securities in the Securities Subaccount in bearer, nominee, book-entry, or other form and in any depository or clearing corporation (including omnibus accounts), with or without indicating that the securities are held hereunder; provided, however, that all securities held in the Securities Subaccount shall be identified on Custodian’s records as subject to this Agreement and shall be in a form that permits transfer at the direction of Broker without additional authorization or consent of Customer. Neither Broker nor Custodian shall be responsible or liable for any losses resulting from nationalization, expropriation, devaluation, seizure, or similar action by any governmental authority, de facto or de jure; or enactment, promulgation, imposition or enforcement by any such governmental authority of currency restrictions, exchange controls, levies or other charges affecting the property in the Special Custody Account, for the acts or omissions of any securities depositary, any third party, or the Federal Reserve/U S Treasury book-entry system for government securities, or acts of war, terrorism, insurrection or revolution, or acts of God, or any other similar event beyond the control of such party or its agents. Neither Broker nor Custodian shall be liable for indirect, special or consequential damage even if advised of the possibility or likelihood thereof. This Section shall survive the termination of this Agreement.

(10)    All charges for Custodian’s services under this Agreement shall be paid by Customer.

(11)    Broker shall not be liable for any losses, costs, damages, liabilities or expenses suffered or incurred by Customer as a result of any transaction executed hereunder, or any other action taken or not taken by Broker hereunder for Customer’s account at Customer’s direction or otherwise, except to the extent that such loss, cost, damage, liability or expense is the result of Broker’s own negligence or willful misconduct.

(12)    No modification or amendment of this Agreement shall be effective unless in writing and signed by an authorized officer of each of Broker, Customer and Custodian.

(13)    Written communications hereunder, other than an Advice from Broker, shall be sent by facsimile-sending device when required herein, hand delivered, electronic mail or mailed first class postage prepaid, except that written notice of termination shall be sent by certified mail, in any such case addressed (oral communications shall be directed to the following telephone numbers):

 

(a)    if to Custodian, to:   
     

U.S Bank, N.A.

1555 N. Rivercenter Dr., MK-WI-5302

Milwaukee, WI 53212

Attn: Tom Fuller

Phone: 414-905-6118

Fax: 866-350-5066

 

5


(b)      

The Cushing Renaissance Fund

c/o Cushing Asset Management LP

8117 Preston Road, Suite 440

Dallas, TX 75225

     

Attn: John Alban

Telephone: 214-692-6334

Fax Number: 214-219-2353

(c)    if to Broker, to   

The Bank of Nova Scotia, Houston branch

711 Louisiana Street, Suite 1400

Houston, TX 77002 United States

Attention: Global Prime Finance

Telephone: 1-713-759-3450

Fax Number: 1-713-759-3486

   With a copy to:   

Scotia Capital (USA) Inc.

250 Vesey Street, 2416 Floor

New York, NY 10281

United States of America

Attention: US Prime Brokerage Client Services

Telephone: 1-212-225-6613

Fax: 1-212-225-6645

(14)    Custodian has not entered into, and until the termination of this Agreement will not enter into, any agreement with any person (other than Broker) relating to the Special Custody Account and/or any financial asset credited thereto or cash held therein pursuant to which it has agreed, or will agree, to comply with entitlement orders or other instructions of such person.

(15)    Any of the parties hereto may terminate this Agreement by notice in writing to the other parties hereto; provided, however, that the status of any Collateral pledged to Broker at the time of such notice shall not be affected by such termination until the release of such pledge pursuant to the terms of the Account Agreement and any applicable Margin Rules.

The Custodian may resign and be discharged from its duties hereunder at any time by giving written notice of such resignation to Customer and Broker specifying a date when such resignation shall take effect and upon delivery of the Collateral to the successor custodian designated by the Customer and the Broker in writing. Upon such notice, a successor custodian shall be appointed with the mutual consent of the Customer and the Broker. If the Customer and the Broker are unable to agree upon a successor custodian within thirty (30) days after such notice, the Custodian shall be entitled to apply to a court of competent jurisdiction for the appointment of a successor. The Custodian shall continue to serve until its successor accepts the appointment as successor custodian and receives the Collateral. The Customer and the Broker shall have the right at any time upon their mutual consent to substitute a new custodian by giving notice thereof to the Custodian then acting.

 

6


(16)    Nothing in this Agreement prohibits Broker, Customer or Custodian from entering into similar agreements with others in order to facilitate options transactions.

(17)    If any provision or condition of this Agreement shall be held to be invalid or unenforceable by any court, or regulatory or self-regulatory agency or body, such invalidity or unenforceability shall attach only to such provision or condition. The validity of the remaining provisions and conditions shall not be affected thereby and this Agreement shall be carried out as if any such invalid or unenforceable provision or condition were not contained herein, provided that the essential provisions of this Agreement for each party remain valid, binding and enforceable.

(18)    All references herein to times of day shall mean the time in New York, New York, U.S.A.

(19)    Reserved.

(20)    This Agreement and its enforcement (including, without limitation, the establishment and maintenance of the Special Custody Account and all interests, duties and obligations related thereto) shall be governed by the laws of the State of New York without regard to its conflict of laws rules (other than Section 5-1401 of the General Obligations Law) and the “securities intermediary’s jurisdiction” and “bank’s jurisdiction” within the meaning of Articles 8 and 9 of the UCC for purposes of his Agreement is the State of New York. This Agreement shall be binding on the parties and any successor organizations thereof irrespective of any change or changes in personnel thereof.

(21)    Each of Customer, Custodian and Broker agrees that any litigation between any of them hereunder must be instituted in the United States District Court for the Southern District of New York or the Supreme Court of the State of New York for the County of New York. Each party hereby irrevocably waives, to the fullest extent permitted by applicable law, any objection, including any objection to the laying of venue or based on the grounds of forum non conveniens, which it may now or hereafter have to the bringing of any such action or proceeding in such courts. Each party hereby agrees that a judgment in any such dispute may be enforced in other jurisdictions by suit on the judgment or in any other manner provided by law. ANY RIGHT TO TRIAL BY JURY WITH RESPECT TO ANY CLAIM, ACTION, PROCEEDING OR COUNTERCLAIM OR OTHER LEGAL ACTION RELATING TO THIS AGREEMENT IS HEREBY WAIVED BY ALL PARTIES TO THIS AGREEMENT. Customer hereby consents to process being served by Broker on Customer in any suit, action or proceeding referred to above by the mailing of a copy thereof by registered or certified mail, postage pre-paid to Customer at the address set forth above. Nothing contained herein shall affect the right to serve process in any other manner permitted by law.

(22)    This Agreement supersedes all prior agreements as to matters within its scope. To the extent this Agreement contains any provision which is inconsistent with provisions in any other contract or agreement (other than the Committed Lending Agreement) between Customer and Broker, the provisions of this Agreement shall control.

 

7


(23)    This Agreement may be executed in counterparts, each of which will be deemed an original instrument and all of which together will constitute one and the same agreement.

(24)    The Customer’s Declaration of Trust is on file with the Custodian. Customer is a duly formed Delaware statutory trust in good standing with full power and authority to enter into this Agreement and perform all of its obligations hereunder. This Agreement is executed on behalf of the Customer by the Customer’s officers as officers and not individually and the obligations imposed upon the Customer by this Agreement are not binding upon any of the Customer’s trustees, officers or shareholders individually but are binding only upon the assets and property of the Customer.

[The remainder of this page is left intentionally blank.]

 

8


IN WITNESS WHEREOF the parties have duly executed this Agreement as of the date and year first written above.

 

THE CUSHING RENAISSANCE FUND
 

/s/ Jerry V. Swank

By:  

Jerry V. Swank                     

Title:  

Chief Executive Officer                     

THE BANK OF NOVA SCOTIA, ACTING THROUGH ITS HOUSTON BRANCH

 

 

/s/ Authorized Person

By:  

Authorized Person                     

Title:  

                     

U.S. BANK, N.A.
 

/s/ Authorized Person

By:  

Authorized Person

Title:  

                     

 

9

Exhibit (k)(vii)

AMENDING AGREEMENT

THIS AMENDING AGREEMENT dated as of the 19th day of September, 2016 (the “ Amending Agreement ”) MADE BETWEEN :

THE CUSHING RENAISSANCE FUND (“Customer”)

AND

THE BANK OF NOVA SCOTIA, ACTING THROUGH ITS HOUSTON BRANCH (“Scotia”)

WHEREAS Scotia and Customer have entered into a Committed Lending Agreement, dated as of August 26, 2014, as amended from time to time (the “ Committed Lending Agreement ”);

AND WHEREAS the parties hereto wish to effect certain amendments to the terms of the Committed Lending Agreement as provided for herein;

NOW THEREFORE in consideration of the premises and other good and valuable consideration the receipt and sufficiency of which is hereby acknowledged by the parties hereto, the parties hereby agree as follows:

 

  (1) Appendix B to the Committed Lending Agreement is deleted in its entirety and replaced with the Appendix B hereto.

 

  (2) The parties hereto agree that the amendment to the Committed Lending Agreement set forth in Section (1) of this Amending Agreement shall be effective from and after the date hereof.

 

  (3) Customer represents and warrants to Scotia that:

 

  (i) It is duly organized and validly existing under the laws of the jurisdiction of its organization or incorporation and, if relevant under such laws, in good standing;

 

  (ii) It has the power to execute this Amending Agreement, to deliver this Amending Agreement and has taken all necessary action to authorize such execution, delivery and performance;

 

  (iii) Such execution, delivery and performance do not violate or conflict with any law applicable to ii, any provision of its constitutional documents, any order or judgment of any court or other agency of government applicable to it or any of its assets;

 

  (iv) All governmental and other consents that are required to have been obtained by ii with respect to this Amending Agreement have been obtained and are in full force and effect and all conditions of any such consents have been complied with; and

 

  (v) Its obligations under this Amending Agreement constitute its legal, valid and binding obligations, enforceable in accordance with their respective terms (subject to applicable bankruptcy, reorganization, insolvency, moratorium or similar laws affecting creditors’ rights generally and subject, as to enforceability, to equitable principles of general application (regardless of whether enforcement is sought in a proceeding in equity or at law)).


  (4) From and after the date of this Amending Agreement, all references in the Committed Lending Agreement to “this Agreement” (or words or phrases of similar meaning) shall be deemed to be references to the Committed Lending Agreement as amended hereby.

 

  (5) This Amending Agreement shall be governed and construed in accordance with the governing law of the Committed Lending Agreement.

 

  (6) All capitalized terms used but not defined herein shall have the meaning ascribed to such terms in the Committed Lending Agreement.

 

  (7) All other provisions of the Committed Lending Agreement shall remain in full force and effect unamended and are hereby ratified by the parties hereto in all respects.

 

  (8) This Amending Agreement may be executed and delivered in counterparts which when taken together shall constitute a single and original agreement between the parties.

 

  (9) This Amending Agreement shall ensure to the benefit of and be binding upon the parties hereto and their respective successors and permitted assigns.

[Signature Page Follows]


IN WITNESS WHEREOF the parties hereto have executed this Amending Agreement as of the day and year first above written.

 

THE CUSHING RENAISSANCE FUND
By:   /s/ Jerry V. Swank
Name:   Jerry V. Swank
Title:   Chief Executive Officer
THE BANK OF NOVA SCOTIA, ACTING THROUGH ITS HOUSTON BRANCH
By:  

/s/ Authorized Person

Name:   Authorized Person
Title:  


Appendix B - Pricing and Commitment Term

 

 

THIS APPENDIX forms a part of the Committed Lending Agreement dated August 26, 2014, as amended from time to time, entered into between The Bank of Nova Scotia, acting through its Houston Branch (“Scotia”) and The Cushing Renaissance Fund (“Customer”) (the “Agreement”) .

Customer Debit Rate

1-month LIBOR (Bloomberg: US0001M Index) + 100 bps

Maximum Loan Amount

USO 50,000,000

Commitment Term

60 calendar days

Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

We consent to the references to our firm under the captions “Financial Highlights,” “Senior Securities” and “Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm” in the Prospectus and “Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm” and “Financial Statements” in the Statement of Additional Information and to the incorporation by reference of our report dated January 27, 2017 on the financial statements and financial highlights of The Cushing Renaissance Fund included in the November 30, 2016 Annual Report to Shareholders in this Registration Statement (Form N-2) of The Cushing Renaissance Fund under the Securities Act of 1933.

/s/ Ernst & Young LLP

Dallas, Texas

December 29, 2017

Effective as of: September 22, 2017

CUSHING ASSET MANAGEMENT, L.P.

CUSHING REGISTERED FUNDS

CODE OF ETHICS AND PERSONAL TRADING POLICY

 

I. STATEMENT OF GENERAL POLICY

Rule 204A-1 under the Investment Advisers Act of 1940, as amended (the “Rule”) requires Cushing Asset Management, L.P. (“Cushing” or the “Adviser”) adopt a code of ethics containing provisions reasonably necessary to prevent Access Persons (as defined below) from engaging in any act, practice or course of business prohibited by the Rule.

Paragraph (c) of Rule 17j-1 under the Investment Company Act of 1940 (the “Rule 17j-1”) requires that the Cushing Funds listed in Appendix V-1 (each, a “Fund” and, together with the Adviser, the “Firm”) to adopt a code of ethics containing provisions reasonably necessary to prevent fraudulent or manipulative practices with respect to purchases or sales of Covered Securities (as defined below) by investment companies, if effected by associated persons of such companies.

Under paragraph (b) of Rule 17j-1 it is unlawful for any affiliated person of, or principal underwriter for, a registered investment company, or any affiliated person of an investment adviser of, or principal underwriter for, a registered investment company, in connection with the purchase or sale, directly or indirectly, by the Access Person of a Security Held or to be Acquired (as defined below) by the investment company:

 

  a) To employ any device, scheme or artifice to defraud the investment company;

 

  b) To make any untrue statement of a material fact to the investment company or omit to state a material fact necessary in order to make the statements made to the investment company, in light of the circumstances under which they are made, not misleading;

 

  c) To engage in any act, practice, or course of business that operates or would operate as a fraud or deceit on the investment company; or

 

  d) To engage in any manipulative practice with respect to the investment company.


Accordingly, this Code of Ethics (the “Code”) has been adopted to ensure that all Access Persons:

 

    are aware of the fiduciary duty that they and the Firm owe to Clients and the responsibility that comes with such duty;

 

    are aware of their obligation to abide by all applicable securities laws and regulations;

 

    limit their trading in securities in which the Firm’s clients trade;

 

    report their personal securities transactions;

 

    are aware of the Firm’s policy and procedures regarding potential conflicts of interest, including the giving or receipt of gifts and board service; and

 

    report suspected violations of the Code.

The Code does not purport comprehensively to cover all types of conduct or transactions which may be prohibited or regulated by the laws and regulations applicable to the Firm and persons connected with it. It is the responsibility of each Access Person to conduct personal securities transactions in a manner that does not interfere with the transactions of the Firm or otherwise take unfair advantage of the Firm, and to understand the various laws applicable to such person.

 

II. RESPONSIBILITIES

The Firm expects all Access Persons to adhere to the highest standards with respect to any potential conflicts of interest with Clients. As a fiduciary, the Firm must act in its Clients’ best interests. Neither the Firm, nor any Access Person should ever benefit at the expense of any Client. Therefore, an Access Person should not place his or her own interests ahead of the interests of Clients or engage in any transaction which interferes with, derives undue benefit other than customary compensation for investment management services, deprives a Client of an investment opportunity or is inconsistent with the investments undertaken for a Client.

This Code is intended to assist Access Persons in meeting the high ethical standards the Firm follows in conducting its business. The following general fiduciary principles must govern the activities of all Access Persons:

 

    a duty to place the interests of Clients first

 

    seek to avoid any actual or potential conflicts of interest

 

    do not take inappropriate advantage of your position with the Firm

 

    comply with all applicable Federal Securities Laws

 

2


Access Persons are expected to adhere to the general principles of this Code as well as comply with the Code’s specific provisions. Technical compliance with the Code’s procedures will not necessarily insulate from scrutiny personal trades which show a pattern of abuse of fiduciary duties to Clients. Any questions regarding the application of the Code in a particular circumstance should be directed to the Compliance Officer promptly.

 

III. DEFINITIONS

 

  (a) “Access Person” means each Fund’s and the Adviser’s officers, trustees, general partners, and Advisory Persons (which means, with respect to the Fund or the Adviser: (i) any trustee, officer, general partner or employee of the Fund or the Adviser, or any company in a Control relationship to the Fund or the Adviser, who in connection with his/her regular functions or duties, makes, participates in, or obtains information regarding the purchase or sale of any Covered Security by the Fund, or whose functions relate to the making of any recommendations with respect to such purchases or sales; and (ii) any natural person in a Control relationship to the Fund or the Adviser who obtains information concerning recommendations made to the Fund with regard to the purchase or sale of any Covered Security by the Fund).

 

  (b) “Automatic Investment Plan” means a program, including a dividend reinvestment plan, in which regular periodic purchases (or withdrawals) are made automatically in (or from) investment accounts in accordance with a predetermined schedule and allocation.

 

  (c) “Beneficial interest” shall be interpreted in the same manner as it would be in determining whether a person is subject to the provisions of Section 16 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 and Rule 16a-1(a)(2) thereunder, which includes any interest in which a person, directly or indirectly, has or shares a direct or indirect pecuniary interest. A pecuniary interest is the opportunity, directly or indirectly, to profit or share in any profit derived from any transaction. In general, “Beneficial interest” shall mean, ownership of securities or securities accounts by or for the benefit of a person, including any account in which the Access Person holds a direct or indirect beneficial interest, retains discretionary investment authority or other investment authority (e.g., a power of attorney), including immediate family members and trusts in which they have a pecuniary interest.

 

3


  (d) “Business Entertainment” refers to meals, attendance at cultural or sporting events, recreational activities (e.g. golf), or other reasonable entertainment provided or received in connection with discussing or conducting business related to the Firm. Incidental transportation offered in connection with attending an event (such as a taxi to the venue) may also be considered “Business Entertainment.” To be deemed “Business Entertainment,” a Access Person and the other party must be present. If an Access Person and the other party do not both plan to be present, the expense will be considered a Gift. “Business Entertainment” does not include (a) meals or entertainment provided during a research trip or business conference; or (b) a social event or trip where each participant pays his or her own expenses.

 

  (e) “Client” shall mean any investment account managed by the Firm, including pooled investment vehicles.

 

  (f) “Code” shall mean this Code of Ethics.

 

  (g) “Compliance Officer” shall mean Barry Greenberg, Katy Whitt or his or her designee.

 

  (h) “Covered Security” shall mean any “Security”, and any security related to or connected with such security, except that it shall not include: (i) securities which are direct obligations of the government of the United States, debt instruments issued or guaranteed by the U.S. federal government agencies or issued by government-sponsored enterprises, (ii) shares issued by U.S. registered open-end investment companies (i.e. mutual funds) for which the Firm is not an investment adviser, or (iii) bankers’ acceptances, bank certificates of deposit, commercial paper or high quality short-term debt instruments, including repurchase agreements, and money market funds . Note that the term “Covered Security” includes any closed-end fund or open-end fund for which the Firm is an investment adviser.

 

  (i)

“Federal Securities Laws” means the Securities Act of 1933, the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the Sarbanes Oxley Act of 2002, the Investment Company Act of 1940, the Investment Advisers Act of 1940, title V of the Gramm-Leach Bliley Act, the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act, and any rules adopted by the Securities and Exchange

 

4


  Commission (“SEC”) under any of the foregoing statutes, the Bank Secrecy Act (as it applies to pooled investment vehicles and investment advisers) and any rules adopted thereunder by the SEC or the Department of the Treasury.

 

  (j) “Gift” means the giving or receipt of anything of value. The term “Gift” does not include “Business Entertainment” as defined herein.

 

  (k) “Initial Public Offering” means an offering of securities registered under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, the issuer of which, before the registration, was not required to file under Sections 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, or an initial public offering under comparable foreign law.

 

  (l) “Investment Personnel” means any employee, officer or director of the Firm (or any company in a control relationship with the Firm) who, in connection his or her regular functions or duties, makes or participates in making recommendations regarding the purchase or sale of securities by the Firm or who executes such transactions. Investment Personnel also includes any person who controls the Firm or Adviser and who obtains recommendations made to the Firm regarding purchase or sale of securities by the Firm.

 

  (m) “Limited Offering” means an offering that is exempt from under Section 4(2) or Section 4(6) under the Securities of 1933, as amended, or pursuant to Rule 504, Rule 505, or Rule 506 under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, and similar offerings under comparable foreign law.

 

  (n)

“Security” means any note, stock, treasury stock, security future, bond, debenture, evidence of indebtedness, certificate of interest or participation in any profit-sharing agreement, collateral-trust certificate, preorganization certificate or subscription, transferable share, investment contract, voting-trust certificate, certificate of deposit for a security, fractional undivided interest in oil, gas, or other mineral rights, any put, call, straddle, option, or privilege on any security (including a certificate of deposit) or on any group or index of securities (including any interest therein or based on the value thereof), or any put, call, straddle, option, or privilege entered into on a national securities exchange relating to foreign currency, or, in general, any interest or instrument commonly known as a “security”, or any certificate of interest or

 

5


  participation in, temporary or interim certificate for, receipt for, guaranty of, or warrant or right to subscribe to or purchase any of the foregoing. Note that the term “Security” includes exchange traded funds (ETFs) and exchange traded notes (ETNs), but does not include bitcoins. The term “Security” may include virtual currency tokens, whether issued as part of an Initial Coin Offering or otherwise (collectively, “Cryptocurrencies”). An Access Person seeking to trade in a Cryptocurrency must first request a determination by a Compliance Officer of whether or not the instrument is a “Security.”

 

IV. PREFERENTIAL TREATMENT, GIFTS AND ENTERTAINMENT

As a general matter, no Access Person shall seek or accept favors, preferential treatment or any other personal benefit because of his or her association with the Firm.

The common practice of providing or receiving Gifts and Business Entertainment in connection with business discussions to develop and strengthen business relationships is generally deemed appropriate and acceptable. However, any Gift or other personal benefit that creates a conflict between the interests of such Person and the Firm or its Clients or any other entity that does business with or seeks to do business with the Firm should not be given or accepted. In this regard, Gifts and Business Entertainment must not give the appearance of influencing business judgment. The appearance of a conflict of interest can be as harmful, from a reputational standpoint, as an actual conflict. Access persons should never solicit Gifts or Business Entertainment, participate in illegal or inappropriate Business Entertainment or accept Business Entertainment that would not be reimbursable if provided by the Access Person.

Due to actual and potential conflicts of interest, Access Persons may not give or accept any Gifts or Business Entertainment from the following: (i) broker-dealers who distribute shares of registered investment companies managed by the Firm, or (ii) representatives of municipalities, state or local pension plans, ERISA plans or Taft-Hartley union plans (each, a “Prohibited Person”).

The following policies and procedures are designed to set forth limits on Gifts and Business Entertainment and to monitor them to ensure that no actual or potential conflict of interest arises:

 

  A. Gifts

 

6


  1. Access Persons are expected to use good judgment and to accept or give Gifts only if all of the following apply:

 

  a. The Gift cannot be viewed as overly generous, lavish, extravagant or improper;

 

  b. The Gift is not in the form of cash or a cash equivalent (checks, lottery tickets, gift certificates or gift cards redeemable for cash, etc.);

 

  c. The Gift is reasonable in terms of frequency and is of limited value (less than $300 per single donor or recipient annually) 1 ;

 

  d. The Gift does not involve a Prohibited Person and does not violate any laws or regulations; and

 

  e. Disclosure of the Gift to other Access Persons, Clients or other third parties would not embarrass the recipient or the Firm.

 

  2. Exclusions:

 

  a. Gifts of de minimis value (e.g. pens, notepads, modest desk ornaments) or promotional items of nominal value that display a firm’s logo (e.g. umbrellas, tote bags, golf shirts, conference bags) shall not count towards the annual $300 limit.

 

  b. If approved by a Compliance Officer, personal Gifts, such as wedding Gifts or congratulatory Gifts for the birth of a child (all of which must be of reasonable value) may be excluded from the Gift policy and not count towards the annual $300 limit. Requests for an exclusion of a personal gift from the Gift policy must be made in advance through Schwab CT ( https://client.schwabct.com ). Requests for an exclusion will be granted on a case-by-case basis by a Compliance Officer after a careful review of the individual facts and circumstances.

 

 

1   For purposes of this limit, all Gifts by an Access Person to employees of a company will be considered cumulatively for purpose of the annual $300 limit.

 

7


  3. Other Considerations:

 

  a. To determine a Gift’s value, use the higher of cost, face or market value (i.e. what it would cost to purchase on the open market);

 

  b. Any Gift received that is prohibited by Firm policy should be refused; however, if it is not possible in the interest of business, the Gift should be donated to a charitable organization after consultation with a Compliance Officer;

 

  c. This policy applies to Gifts given to or received by family and friends on behalf of an Access Person; and

 

  d. Access Persons who are registered representatives of a broker-dealer are also subject to the broker-dealer’s policies and procedures with respect to Gifts, which may be more restrictive than the Firm’s policy.

 

  4. Reporting of Gifts:

 

  a. Upon giving or receiving any Gift greater than $10 in value that is not otherwise excluded from the annual $300 limit, the Access Person shall report the Gift to a Compliance Officer through Schwab CT ( https://client.schwabct.com );

 

8


  b. The Compliance Department will maintain a log of Gifts, including a description of the item, its cost, and the name and association of the recipient and donor.

 

  B. Business Entertainment

 

  1. Access Persons are expected to use good judgment and to accept or provide Business Entertainment only if all of the following apply:

 

  a. Both the Access Person and donor are present. If an Access Person is invited, for example, to attend a sporting event by a business contact and neither the business contact nor any of his or her associates attends the event, the tickets would constitute a “Gift” and not “Business Entertainment” and would be subject to the dollar limit on Gifts;

 

  b. The Business Entertainment cannot be viewed as overly generous, lavish, extravagant or improper. Examples of Business Entertainment that may be considered unreasonable under any circumstances would be vacation trips or World Series, NBA Championship, or Super Bowl tickets;

 

  c. The Business Entertainment could not be viewed as aimed at influencing the recipient’s decision-making or making the recipient feel beholden to the person providing the Business Entertainment;

 

  d. The Business Entertainment does not involve a Prohibited Person and does not violate any laws or regulations;

 

9


  e. Disclosure of the Business Entertainment to other Access Persons, Clients or other third parties would not embarrass the recipient or the Firm;

 

  f. The Business Entertainment is accepted from or provided to the same person no more than four (4) times within a calendar year and in an annual amount of no more than $1,000; and

 

  g. Any exceptions to the foregoing limitations must be pre-approved by the Chief Compliance Officer.

 

  2. Reporting of Business Entertainment:

 

  a. Business Entertainment accepted or provided in an estimated amount of $250 or greater from the same person must be reported to a Compliance Officer through Schwab CT (https://client.schwabct.com); and

 

  b. The Compliance Department will maintain a log of Business Entertainment, including a description of the event, its cost, and the name and association of the recipient and donor.

 

  3. Other Considerations:

 

  a. Any Business Entertainment that would be prohibited by Firm policy should be refused;

 

  b. This policy applies to Business Entertainment given to or received by family and friends on behalf of an Access Person.

 

  c. Access Persons who are registered representatives of a broker-dealer are also subject to the broker-dealer’s policies and procedures with respect to Business Entertainment, which may be more restrictive than the Firm’s policy.

Any questions regarding the receipt of any Gift, Business Entertainment or other personal benefit should be directed to a Compliance Officer.

 

10


V. CONFLICTS OF INTEREST

If any Access Person is aware of a personal interest that is, or might be, in conflict with the interests of the Firm or its Clients, that person should disclose the situation or transaction and the nature of the conflict to a Compliance Officer through Schwab CT ( https://client.schwabct.com ) for appropriate consideration. Examples of such a conflict of interest may include: (i) immediate family members employed by a financial services business, broker-dealer, investment adviser, fund administrator or private investment vehicle (i.e. hedge fund, private equity fund, etc.), (ii) service by an Access Person or their immediate family member on the board of directors or similar capacity of a public company, or (iii) service by an Access Person or their immediate family member with an non-profit entity, foundation or pension plan in which the Access Person or immediate family member has input regarding investment decisions for the entity.

 

VI. SERVICE AS A DIRECTOR

Investment Personnel are prohibited from accepting any appointment or election to the board of directors of any for-profit corporation, business trust or partnership, whether or not its securities are publicly traded, absent prior authorization of Jerry V. Swank (the “Managing Partner”) who will notify a Compliance Officer of any request for authorization and whether authorization was granted. In determining whether to authorize such appointment, the Managing Partner shall consider whether the board service would be adverse to the interests of the Firm or would give rise to conflicts of interest or the appearance of conflicts of interest and whether adequate procedures exist to ensure isolation from those making investment decisions. All Access Persons shall report board positions to a Compliance Officer through Schwab Compliance Technologies ( http://client.schwabact.com ).

 

VII. INSIDE INFORMATION

U.S. securities laws and regulations, and certain foreign laws, prohibit the misuse of “inside” or “material non-public” information when trading or recommending securities. In addition, Regulation FD prohibits certain selective disclosure to analysts. Inside information may include, but is not limited to, knowledge of pending customer orders or research recommendations, corporate finance activity, mergers or acquisitions, advance earnings information and other material non-public information that could affect the price of a security.

 

11


Firm and shareholder account information is also confidential and must not be discussed with any individual whose responsibilities do not require knowledge of such information.

Inside information obtained by any Access Person from any source must be kept strictly confidential. All inside information should be kept secure, and access to files and computer files containing such information should be restricted.

Contact with public company representatives is an important part of the Firm’s research efforts. Difficult legal issues arise, however, when in the course of these contacts, an Access Person becomes aware of material, non-public information. Access Persons shall promptly report the receipt of any material, non-public information related to securities in which the Firm may invest to a Compliance Officer. Access Persons may not act upon or disclose material, non-public or insider information except as may be necessary for legitimate business purposes on behalf of the Firm and with prior approval of a Compliance Officer. Questions and requests for assistance regarding insider information should be promptly directed to a Compliance Officer.

Front running occurs when a person employed by a financial services firm executes an order for a security for his or her own personal account while using advance knowledge of pending orders or trade decisions from his or her employer. Any actual or apparent front running activity by Access Persons is strictly prohibited.

 

VIII. PERSONAL SECURITIES TRANSACTIONS RESTRICTIONS

 

  (a) Accounts Covered by the Code . The Code’s policies and procedures regarding personal securities transactions apply to all accounts holding any Securities over which an Access Person has any Beneficial Interest. For purposes of the Code, it is presumed that an Access Person has a Beneficial Interest in any account held personally or by immediate family members sharing the same household. Immediate family members include children, step-children, grandchildren, parents, step-parents, grandparents, spouses, domestic partners, siblings, parents-in-law, and children-in-law, as well as adoptive relationships that meet the above criteria. An Access Person seeking to exclude an account from the Code must be able to demonstrate to a Compliance Officer that he or she does not have any direct or indirect influence or control over the account.

 

  (b) Reportable Securities . The Code requires Access Persons to provide periodic reports regarding transactions and holdings in all Covered Securities (as defined herein).

 

12


  (c) Prohibited Purchases and Sales of a Covered Security . No Access Person of the Firm shall purchase or sell, directly or indirectly:

(i)    any Covered Security in which he or she has, or by reason of such transaction will acquire, any direct or indirect beneficial ownership and which, to his or her actual knowledge at the time of such purchase or sale, is being purchased or sold or considered for purchase or sale by the Firm on behalf of a Client Account;

(ii)    any related Covered Security to a security being actively considered for purchase or sale by the Firm, such as puts, calls, other options or rights in such security; or

(iii)    any Covered Security in a sector or industry within the Firm’s investment universe (defined in Appendix VIII: Restricted Sectors and Industries) 2

(iv)    any shares of a closed-end fund advised by the Firm (A) during any applicable blackout period established by the Firm or (B) if such transaction would give rise to “short-swing profits” under Section 16 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 as if the Access Person were a Section 16 reporting person.

 

  (d) Short-Term Trading by Investment Personnel . No Investment Personnel may engage in the purchase and sale, or sale and purchase, of the same (or equivalent) Covered Security within thirty (30) calendar days; provided, however, that individual exceptions may be permitted by a Compliance Officer when it is deemed that short-term trading by Investment Personnel would not create a conflict with any Client Account. Any trade made in violation of this prohibition should be reversed or, if not feasible, any profits resulting from the trading should be donated to a charitable organization

 

2  

Access Persons who directly or indirectly held a Covered Security in a sector or industry within the Firm’s investment universe prior to the prohibition being implemented (effective October 3, 2016) are not required to sell such Covered Securities. If an Access Person wishes to sell such a Covered Security at a later date, the transaction will be subject to the pre-clearance provisions of the Code.

 

13


  designated by the Firm’s Managing Partner; provided, however, that the Firm’s Managing Partner may waive disgorgement of profits if it is determined that trading in violation of this prohibition was inadvertent and did not otherwise result in a conflict with any Client Account.

 

  (e) Prohibited Conduct . No Access Person of the Firm shall, directly or indirectly:

(i)    discuss with or otherwise inform others of actual or contemplated security transactions by the Firm on behalf of a Client Account except in the performance of his or her employment duties or in an official capacity and then only for the benefit of the Client Account, and not for personal benefit or for the benefit of others;

(ii)    use knowledge of portfolio transactions made or contemplated for the Firm to profit by the market effect of such transactions or otherwise engage in fraudulent conduct in connection with the purchase or sale of a security sold or acquired by the Firm;

(iii)    knowingly take advantage of a corporate opportunity of the Firm for personal benefit (or the benefit of anyone other than Clients), or take action for personal benefit (or the benefit of anyone other than Clients) in connection with such Person’s obligations to the Firm. All securities transactions must be consistent with this Code. Access Persons must avoid any actual or potential conflict of interest or any abuse of any Person’s position of trust.

 

IX. PRE-CLEARANCE

 

  (a) No Access Person shall direct or allow any account over which he or she has any Beneficial Interest to buy or sell a Covered Security without the Access Person having first obtained specific permission from the Compliance Officer by completing a Personal Trade Pre-clearance Questionnaire, which may be found at Schwab Client Technologies ( http://client.schwabact.com ); provided, however, that pre-clearance shall not be required for personal trades in Covered Securities which are debt instruments issued or guaranteed by U.S. federal government agencies or issued by government-sponsored enterprises.

 

  (b)

A request for pre-clearance will be denied if: (i) a transaction in the same

 

14


  issuer of the Covered Security has been effected on behalf of a Client account within the seven (7) days prior to the personal trade request or is contemplated as of the time of the compliance review of such request to occur within the next seven (7) days from the date of the trade request; (ii) the issuer of the Covered Security is included on the Firm’s Restricted List; or (iii) a Compliance Officer determines that the proposed transaction appears to pose a conflict of interest or otherwise appears improper.

 

  (c) Any Access Person seeking pre-clearance must certify that he or she is not aware of any firm trades on behalf of Client accounts in the same issuer of a Covered Security during the prior seven (7) days or of any present intention by Investment Personnel to effect a transaction in the same issuer of a Covered Security on behalf of a Client account in the next seven (7) days. Access Persons should be mindful of their duty to place the interests of Clients first, and consider carefully the timing of requested personal trades. A Compliance Officer will seek to verify that no Firm trades have occurred within the prior seven (7) days or are anticipated within the next seven (7) days before approving the requested trade.

 

  (d) In determining whether an actual or potential conflict of interest exists in connection with a requested personal trade, a Compliance Officer may review the Firm’s current trade blotter and prior trading history on behalf of Client accounts, make inquiries with appropriate Investment Personnel regarding planned trades for Client accounts and take such other steps as are deemed appropriate by a Compliance Officer.

 

  (e) After a completed pre-clearance request has been approved, the transaction must be effected within the same trading day or a new Pre-clearance Questionnaire must be submitted for approval.

 

  (f) No Investment Personnel shall directly or indirectly acquire an interest in a Covered Security through a Limited Offering or in an Initial Public Offering without obtaining the prior consent of a Compliance Officer. Consideration will be given to whether the opportunity should be reserved for the Client Accounts.

 

  (g) The Firm’s Chief Operating Officer, John Alban, will review and approve any request for pre-clearance of any transaction in Covered Securities by the Chief Compliance Officer.

 

15


X. EXCLUDED TRANSACTIONS

The following types of transactions do not invoke the pre-clearance requirements of Section IX:

 

  (a) Transactions effected for any account over which the Access Person has no investment discretion, as established pursuant to the Firm’s policies.

 

  (b) Non-volitional purchases and sales, such as Dividend Reinvestment or “calls” or redemption of securities.

 

  (c) The acquisition of securities by gift or inheritance or disposition of securities by gift to charitable organizations.

 

XI. REPORTING PROCEDURES

Access Persons shall make the reports set forth below.

 

  (a) Brokerage Accounts . Before effecting personal transactions, each Access Person must (i) inform each brokerage firm where accounts holding any Securities over which the Access Person has any Beneficial Interest are held of his or her affiliation with the Firm and (ii) provide the Firm access to all accounts holding any Securities over which the Access Person has any Beneficial Interest by either completing a brokerage account approval form in Schwab Compliance Technologies ( http://client.schwabact.com ) or arranging for the brokerage firm to submit duplicate copies of all confirmations and account statements to a Compliance Officer.

 

  (b) Initial Holdings Report . Each Access Person must provide a report through Schwab Compliance Technologies ( http://client.schwabact.com ) which includes the following information within ten (10) days of becoming a Access Person:

 

    Title and type of security, ticker symbol, CUSIP number (if applicable), number of shares and principal amount of each Covered Security in which the Access Person had any Beneficial Interest when the Person became an Access Person;
 

 

16


    The name of any broker, dealer or bank with whom the Access Person maintains any account holding any Securities over which the Access Person has any Beneficial Interest as of date the person became an Access Person; and

 

    The date that the report is submitted by the Access Person.

The information contained in the initial holdings report must be current as of a date no more than forty-five (45) days prior to the date the person became an Access Person.

 

  (c) Quarterly Transaction Reports . Not later than thirty (30) days after the end of each calendar quarter, each Access Person must provide an affirmation through Schwab Compliance Technologies ( http://client.schwabact.com ) which includes following information with respect to any transaction in a Covered Security in an account for which the Access Person had any direct or indirect beneficial ownership:

 

    The date of the transaction, the title, ticker symbol or CUSIP number (if applicable), interest rate and maturity date (if applicable), the number of shares and principal amount of each Covered Security involved;

 

    The nature of the transaction (i.e., purchase, sale or other of acquisition or disposition);

 

    The price of the Covered Security at which the transaction was effected;

 

    The name of the broker, dealer or bank with or through which transaction was effected; and

 

    The date that the report is submitted by the Access Person.

 

  (d)

Annual Holdings Report . Each Access Person shall provide a written affirmation annually containing the information required in Section XI.(b) above as of December 31, within forty-five (45) days after December 31 st each year. An Access Person need not make a quarterly transaction report or

 

17


  Annual Holdings Report if it would duplicate information contained in affirmations, broker trade confirmations and account statements received through Schwab Compliance Technologies ( http://client.schwabact.com ) by the Compliance Officer.

 

  (e) Review of Reports . The Compliance Officers shall be responsible for notifying Access Persons of their reporting obligations under this Code and for reviewing reports submitted by Access Persons. The Compliance Officers will maintain records of all reports filed pursuant to these procedures. The Firm’s Chief Operating Officer, John Alban, shall review reports submitted by the Chief Compliance Officer.

 

XII. REVIEW OF PERSONAL SECURITIES TRANSACTIONS

The Code’s policies and procedures are designed to mitigate any potential material conflicts of interest associated with Access Persons’ personal trading activities. Accordingly, the Compliance Officers will closely monitor Access Persons’ investment patterns to detect the following potentially abusive behavior:

 

    Failure to comply with the Code’s personal trade reporting and pre-clearance requirements;

 

    Frequent and/or short-term trades in any Security, with particular attention paid to potential manipulative behavior;

 

    Trading opposite of Client trades;

 

    Trading ahead of Clients; and

 

    Trading that appears to be based on material non-public information.

The Compliance Officers will compare all personal trading information reported by Access Persons with Firm trading activity to determine compliance with the Code. The Compliance Officers will use additional methods, such as electronic communications surveillance, to monitor for correlations between personal trading and noted Access Person conflicts of interest (such as board of directors service or personal relationships) and to identify potentially abusive patterns between personal trading and Firm trading. The Compliance Officers will keep appropriate records relating to such reviews and will inform the Firm’s Managing Partner of any material issues or concerns.

 

18


XIII. ADMINISTRATION OF CODE

 

  (a) Exceptions . The Compliance Officers shall be responsible for all aspects of administering this Code and for all interpretative issues arising under the Code. The Compliance Officers are responsible for considering any requests for exceptions to, or exemptions from, the Code (e.g., due to level of risk or personal financial hardship). Any exceptions to, or exemptions from, the Code shall be subject to such additional procedures, reviews and reporting as may be deemed appropriate by a Compliance Officer.

 

  (b) Verification of Information Provided . If deemed warranted by the Compliance Officer, an Access Person may be requested to complete IRS Form 4506, which will allow the Firm or a third-party designated by the Firm to receive copies of the Access Person’s completed tax returns directly from the Internal Revenue Service. The purpose of such a request will be to verify that such Access Person has properly reported all personal brokerage accounts, as required by the Code. Any such request will be risk-based, taking into consideration the Access Person’s position with the Firm, access to material non-public information regarding the Firm’s trading activities and frequency of personal trades. Refusal of an Access Person to comply with such a request will be deemed a violation of the Code and will subject the Access Person to sanctions, as determined by the Chief Compliance Officer and the Managing Partner.

 

  (c) Determination of Violation . The Compliance Officers shall have the authority to determine whether a person violated this Code. A violation of the general principles of the Code may constitute a punishable violation of the Code.

 

  (d) Sanctions . The Compliance Officers will take whatever action is deemed necessary with respect to any Access Person who violates any provision of this Code including, but not limited to, a reprimand, letter of censure, full or partial disgorgement of profits, imposition of a fine, suspension, restriction on activities, demotion or termination of the employment of the violator. Factors to be considered by the Compliance Officers in determining the severity of sanctions shall include the number of prior violations, the severity of the harm (to either affected Client account(s) or the Firm), cooperation with the investigation of the violation and remedial actions taken to address the violation.

 

19


  (e) Availability of the Code . Each new Access Person will be provided with a copy of the Code through Schwab Compliance Technologies ( http://client.schwabact.com ) within ten (10) days of becoming an Access Person. A copy of the Code and any amendments thereto will be available to all Access Persons at all times through Schwab Compliance Technologies ( http://client.schwabact.com ).

 

XIV. RECORDKEEPING REQUIREMENTS

The Firm shall maintain records, at its principal place of business, of the following: a copy of each Code in effect during the past five years; a record of any violation of the Code and any action taken as a result of the violation for at least five years after the end of the fiscal year in which the violation occurs; a copy of each report made by Access Persons as required in this Code; a record of all persons required to make reports currently and during the past five years; a record of all who are or were responsible for reviewing these reports during the past five years; and, for at least five years after approval, a record of any decision and the reasons supporting that decision, to approve an Investment Personnel’s purchase of securities in an Initial Public Offering or a Limited Offering.

 

XV. REPORTING ILLEGAL OR UNETHICAL BEHAVIOR

Access Persons are encouraged to report exceptions or potential violations of the Code by themselves or others, issues arising under the Code or other illegal or unethical behavior to the Compliance Officer or any partner of the Firm. Access Persons are also encouraged to discuss situations that may present ethical issues with such persons. The Firm will endeavor to maintain the confidentiality of reported violations, subject to applicable law, regulation or legal proceedings and to investigate those reported obligations as the Chief Compliance Officer or other personnel deem appropriate.

Notwithstanding the above or any other confidentiality obligation in this Code or elsewhere (such as pursuant to a confidentiality agreement), Access Persons may choose to report a possible violation of the federal securities laws directly to the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission. The SEC is authorized by Congress to provide monetary awards to eligible individuals who come forward with information that leads to a successful SEC enforcement action.

 

20


The Firm will not permit retaliation of any kind by, or on behalf of, the Firm or any Access Person against any individual for making good faith reports of violations of this Code. Such behavior shall be considered, in and of itself, a violation of the Code.

 

XVI. CONDITION OF EMPLOYMENT OR SERVICE

All Access Persons shall conduct themselves at all times in the best interests of the Firm and its Clients. Compliance with the Code shall be a condition of employment or continued affiliation with the Firm and conduct not in accordance shall constitute grounds for actions which may include, but are not limited to, a reprimand, letter of censure, full or partial disgorgement of profits, imposition of a fine, suspension, restriction on activities, demotion or termination of employment. All Persons shall certify quarterly via Schwab Compliance Technologies ( http://client.schwabact.com ) that they have read and agree to comply in all respects with this Code and that they have disclosed or reported all personal securities transactions, holdings and accounts required to be disclosed or reported by this Code.

 

21


Effective as of: September 22, 2017

Appendix V-1

Fund :

The Cushing MLP Infrastructure Master Fund

The Cushing MLP Infrastructure Fund I

The Cushing MLP Infrastructure Fund II

The Cushing MLP Total Return Fund

The Cushing Renaissance Fund

The Cushing Energy Income Fund

The Cushing American Renaissance Fund*

Cushing Mutual Funds Trust*

 

* Fund has been formed, but has not yet commenced operations


Effective as of: September 22, 2017

APPENDIX VIII

RESTRICTED SECTORS AND INDUSTRIES

Sectors:

Commercial Services

Consumer Durables

Distribution Services

Energy Minerals

Non-Energy Minerals

Industrial Services

Process Industries

Producer Manufacturing

Transportation

Utilities

Industries:

 

Air Freight/Couriers

Airlines

Alternate Power Generation

Aluminum

Automobile Aftermarket

Building Products

Chemicals: Agricultural

Chemicals: Major Diversified

Chemicals: Specialty

Coal

Construction Materials

Containers/Packaging

Electric Utilities

Electrical Products

Engineering & Construction

Forest Products

Gas Distributors

Industrial Machinery

Industrial Specialties

Integrated Oil

  

Miscellaneous Manufacturing

Marine Shipping

Metal Fabrication

Oil & Gas Pipelines

Oil & Gas Production

Oil Refining/Marketing

Oilfield Services/Equipment

Other Metals/Minerals

Other Transportation

Pulp & Paper

Railroads

Real Estate Development

Specialty Stores

Steel

Textiles

Tools & Hardware

Trucking

Trucks/Construction/Farm Machinery

Water Utilities

Wholesale Distributors

As of: September 22, 2017

CUSHING ASSET MANAGEMENT, L.P.

CODE OF ETHICS AND PERSONAL TRADING POLICY

 

I. STATEMENT OF GENERAL POLICY

Rule 204A-1 under the Investment Advisers Act of 1940, as amended (the “Rule”) requires Cushing Asset Management, L.P. (“Cushing” or the “Firm”) adopt a code of ethics containing provisions reasonably necessary to prevent Supervised Persons (as defined below) from engaging in any act, practice or course of business prohibited by the Rule. Accordingly, this Code of Ethics (the “Code”) has been adopted to ensure that all Supervised Persons:

 

    are aware of the fiduciary duty that they and the Firm owe to Clients and the responsibility that comes with such duty;

 

    are aware of their obligation to abide by all applicable securities laws and regulations;

 

    limit their trading in securities in which the Firm’s clients trade

 

    report their personal securities transactions;

 

    are aware of the Firm’s policy and procedures regarding potential conflicts of interest, including the giving or receipt of gifts and board service; and

 

    report suspected violations of the Code.

The Code does not purport comprehensively to cover all types of conduct or transactions which may be prohibited or regulated by the laws and regulations applicable to the Firm and persons connected with it. It is the responsibility of each Supervised Person to conduct personal securities transactions in a manner that does not interfere with the transactions of the Firm or otherwise take unfair advantage of the Firm, and to understand the various laws applicable to such person.

 

II. RESPONSIBILITIES

The Firm expects all Supervised Persons to adhere to the highest standards with respect to any potential conflicts of interest with Clients. As a fiduciary, the Firm must act in its Clients’ best interests. Neither the Firm, nor any Supervised Person should ever benefit at the expense of any Client. Therefore, a Supervised Person should not place his or her own interests ahead of the interests of Clients or engage in any transaction which interferes with, derives undue benefit other than customary compensation for investment management services, deprives a Client of an investment opportunity or is inconsistent with the investments undertaken for a Client.

This Code is intended to assist Supervised Persons in meeting the high ethical standards the Firm follows in conducting its business. The following general fiduciary principles must govern the activities of all Supervised Persons:

 

    a duty to place the interests of Clients first

 

    seek to avoid any actual or potential conflicts of interest

 

    do not take inappropriate advantage of your position with the Firm

 

    comply with all applicable Federal Securities Laws


Supervised Persons are expected to adhere to the general principles of this Code as well as comply with the Code’s specific provisions. Technical compliance with the Code’s procedures will not necessarily insulate from scrutiny personal trades which show a pattern of abuse of fiduciary duties to Clients. Any questions regarding the application of the Code in a particular circumstance should be directed to a Compliance Officer promptly.

 

III. DEFINITIONS

 

  (a) “Automatic Investment Plan” means a program, including a dividend reinvestment plan, in which regular periodic purchases (or withdrawals) are made automatically in (or from) investment accounts in accordance with a predetermined schedule and allocation.

 

  (b) “Beneficial interest” shall be interpreted in the same manner as it would be in determining whether a person is subject to the provisions of Section 16 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 and Rule 16a-1(a)(2) thereunder, which includes any interest in which a person, directly or indirectly, has or shares a direct or indirect pecuniary interest. A pecuniary interest is the opportunity, directly or indirectly, to profit or share in any profit derived from any transaction. In general, “Beneficial interest” shall mean, ownership of securities or securities accounts by or for the benefit of a person, including any account in which the Supervised Person holds a direct or indirect beneficial interest, retains discretionary investment authority or other investment authority (e.g., a power of attorney), including immediate family members and trusts in which they have a pecuniary interest.

 

  (c) “Business Entertainment” refers to meals, attendance at cultural or sporting events, recreational activities (e.g. golf), or other reasonable entertainment provided or received in connection with discussing or conducting business related to the Firm. Incidental transportation offered in connection with attending an event (such as a taxi to the venue) may also be considered “Business Entertainment.” To be deemed “Business Entertainment,” a Supervised Person and the other party must be present. If a Supervised Person and the other party do not both plan to be present, the expense will be considered a Gift. “Business Entertainment” does not include (a) meals or entertainment provided during a research trip or business conference; or (b) a social event or trip where each participant pays his or her own expenses.

 

  (d) “Client” shall mean any investment account managed by the Firm, including pooled investment vehicles.

 

  (e) Code” shall mean this Code of Ethics.

 

  (f) “Compliance Officer” shall mean Barry Greenberg, Katy Whitt or his or her designee.

 

2


  (g) “Covered Security” shall mean any “Security”, and any security related to or connected with such security, except that it shall not include: (i) securities which are direct obligations of the government of the United States, debt instruments issued or guaranteed by the U.S. federal government agencies or issued by government-sponsored enterprises, (ii) shares issued by U.S. registered open-end investment companies (i.e. mutual funds) for which the Firm is not an investment adviser, or (iii) bankers’ acceptances, bank certificates of deposit, commercial paper or high quality short-term debt instruments, including repurchase agreements, and money market funds . Note that the term “Covered Security” includes any closed-end fund or open-end fund for which the Firm is an investment adviser.

 

  (h) “Federal Securities Laws” means the Securities Act of 1933, the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the Sarbanes Oxley Act of 2002, the Investment Company Act of 1940, the Investment Advisers Act of 1940, title V of the Gramm-Leach Bliley Act, the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act, any rules adopted by the Securities and Exchange Commission (“SEC”) under any of the foregoing statutes, the Bank Secrecy Act (as it applies to pooled investment vehicles and investment advisers) and any rules adopted thereunder by the SEC or the Department of the Treasury.

 

  (i) “Gift” means the giving or receipt of anything of value. The term “Gift” does not include “Business Entertainment” as defined herein.

 

  (j) “Initial Public Offering” means an offering of securities registered under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, the issuer of which, before the registration, was not required to file under Sections 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, or an initial public offering under comparable foreign law.

 

  (k) “Investment Personnel” means any employee, officer or director of the Firm (or any company in a control relationship with the Firm) who, in connection his or her regular functions or duties, makes or participates in making recommendations regarding the purchase or sale of securities by the Firm or who executes such transactions. Investment Personnel also includes any person who controls the Firm or Adviser and who obtains recommendations made to the Firm regarding purchase or sale of securities by the Firm.

 

  (l) “Limited Offering” means an offering that is exempt from under Section 4(2) or Section 4(6) under the Securities of 1933, as amended, or pursuant to Rule 504, Rule 505, or Rule 506 under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, and similar offerings under comparable foreign law.

 

  (m)

“Security” means any note, stock, treasury stock, security future, bond, debenture, evidence of indebtedness, certificate of interest or participation in any profit-sharing agreement, collateral-trust certificate, preorganization certificate or subscription, transferable share, investment contract, voting-trust certificate, certificate of deposit for a security, fractional undivided interest in oil, gas, or other mineral rights, any put,

 

3


  call, straddle, option, or privilege on any security (including a certificate of deposit) or on any group or index of securities (including any interest therein or based on the value thereof), or any put, call, straddle, option, or privilege entered into on a national securities exchange relating to foreign currency, or, in general, any interest or instrument commonly known as a “security”, or any certificate of interest or participation in, temporary or interim certificate for, receipt for, guaranty of, or warrant or right to subscribe to or purchase any of the foregoing. Note that the term “Security” includes exchange traded funds (ETFs) and exchange traded notes (ETNs), but does not include bitcoins. The term “Security” may include virtual currency tokens, whether issued as part of an Initial Coin Offering or otherwise (collectively, “Cryptocurrencies”). A Supervised Person seeking to trade in a Cryptocurrency must first request a determination by a Compliance Officer of whether or not the instrument is a “Security”.

 

  (n) “Supervised Person” means the Firm’s partners, officers, directors (or other persons occupying a similar status or performing similar functions) and employees, as well as any other persons who provide advice on behalf of the Firm and are subject to the Firm’s supervision and control. All Firm employees are currently considered Supervised Persons under the Code.

 

IV. PREFERENTIAL TREATMENT, GIFTS AND ENTERTAINMENT

As a general matter, no Supervised Person shall seek or accept favors, preferential treatment or any other personal benefit because of his or her association with the Firm.

The common practice of providing or receiving Gifts and Business Entertainment in connection with business discussions to develop and strengthen business relationships is generally deemed appropriate and acceptable. However, any Gift or other personal benefit that creates a conflict between the interests of such Person and the Firm or its Clients or any other entity that does business with or seeks to do business with the Firm should not be given or accepted. In this regard, Gifts and Business Entertainment must not give the appearance of influencing business judgment. The appearance of a conflict of interest can be as harmful, from a reputational standpoint, as an actual conflict. Supervised persons should never solicit Gifts or Business Entertainment, participate in illegal or inappropriate Business Entertainment or accept Business Entertainment that would not be reimbursable if provided by the Supervised Person.

Due to actual and potential conflicts of interest, Supervised Persons may not give or accept any Gifts or Business Entertainment from the following: (i) broker-dealers who distribute shares of registered investment companies managed by the Firm, or (ii) representatives of municipalities, state or local pension plans, ERISA plans or Taft-Hartley union plans (each, a “ Prohibited Person ”).

 

4


The following policies and procedures are designed to set forth limits on Gifts and Business Entertainment and to monitor them to ensure that no actual or potential conflict of interest arises:

 

  A. Gifts

 

  1. Supervised Persons are expected to use good judgment and to accept or give Gifts only if all of the following apply:

 

  a. The Gift cannot be viewed as overly generous, lavish, extravagant or improper;

 

  b. The Gift is not in the form of cash or a cash equivalent (checks, lottery tickets, gift certificates or gift cards redeemable for cash, etc.);

 

  c. The Gift is reasonable in terms of frequency and is of limited value (less than $300 per single donor or recipient annually) 1 ;

 

  d. The Gift does not involve a Prohibited Person and does not violate any laws or regulations; and

 

  e. Disclosure of the Gift to other Supervised Persons, Clients or other third parties would not embarrass the recipient or the Firm.

 

  2. Exclusions:

 

  a. Gifts of de minimis value (e.g. pens, notepads, modest desk ornaments) or promotional items of nominal value that display a firm’s logo (e.g. umbrellas, tote bags, golf shirts, conference bags) shall not count towards the annual $300 limit.

 

  b. If approved by a Compliance Officer, personal Gifts, such as wedding Gifts or congratulatory Gifts for the birth of a child (all of which must be of reasonable value) may be excluded from the Gift policy and not count towards the annual $300 limit. Requests for an exclusion of a personal gift from the Gift policy must be made in advance through Schwab CT ( https://client.schwabct.com ). Requests for an exclusion will be granted on a case-by-case basis by a Compliance Officer after a careful review of the individual facts and circumstances.

 

  3. Other Considerations:

 

  a. To determine a Gift’s value, use the higher of cost, face or market value (i.e. what it would cost to purchase on the open market);

 

 

1   For purposes of this limit, all Gifts by a Supervised Person to employees of a company will be considered cumulatively for purposes of the annual $300 limit.

 

5


  b. Any Gift received that is prohibited by Firm policy should be refused; however, if it is not possible in the interest of business, the Gift should be donated to a charitable organization after consultation with a Compliance Officer;

 

  c. This policy applies to Gifts given to or received by family and friends on behalf of a Supervised Person; and

 

  d. Supervised Persons who are registered representatives of a broker-dealer are also subject to the broker-dealer’s policies and procedures with respect to Gifts, which may be more restrictive than the Firm’s policy.

 

  4. Reporting of Gifts:

 

  a. Upon giving or receiving any Gift greater than $10 in value that is not otherwise excluded from the annual $300 limit, the Supervised Person shall report the Gift to a Compliance Officer through Schwab CT ( https://client.schwabct.com );

 

  b. The Compliance Department will maintain a log of Gifts, including a description of the item, its cost, and the name and association of the recipient and donor.

 

  B. Business Entertainment

 

  1. Supervised Persons are expected to use good judgment and to accept or provide Business Entertainment only if all of the following apply:

 

  a. Both the Supervised Person and donor are present. If a Supervised Person is invited, for example, to attend a sporting event by a business contact and neither the business contact nor any of his or her associates attends the event, the tickets would constitute a “Gift” and not “Business Entertainment” and would be subject to the dollar limit on Gifts;

 

  b. The Business Entertainment cannot be viewed as overly generous, lavish, extravagant or improper. Examples of Business Entertainment that may be considered unreasonable under any circumstances would be vacation trips or World Series, NBA Championship, or Super Bowl tickets;

 

  c. The Business Entertainment could not be viewed as aimed at influencing the recipient’s decision-making or making the recipient feel beholden to the person providing the Business Entertainment;

 

6


  d. The Business Entertainment does not involve a Prohibited Person and does not violate any laws or regulations;

 

  e. Disclosure of the Business Entertainment to other Supervised Persons, Clients or other third parties would not embarrass the recipient or the Firm;

 

  f. The Business Entertainment is accepted from or provided to the same person no more than four (4) times within a calendar year and in an annual amount of no more than $1,000; and

 

  g. Any exceptions to the foregoing limitations must be pre-approved by the Chief Compliance Officer.

 

  2. Reporting of Business Entertainment:

 

  a. Business Entertainment accepted or provided in an estimated amount of $250 or greater from the same person must be reported to a Compliance Officer through Schwab CT ( https://client.schwabct.com ); and

 

  b. The Compliance Department will maintain a log of Business Entertainment, including a description of the event, its cost, and the name and association of the recipient and donor.

 

  3. Other Considerations:

 

  a. Any Business Entertainment that would be prohibited by Firm policy should be refused;

 

  b. This policy applies to Business Entertainment given to or received by family and friends on behalf of a Supervised Person.

 

  c. Supervised Persons who are registered representatives of a broker-dealer are also subject to the broker-dealer’s policies and procedures with respect to Business Entertainment, which may be more restrictive than the Firm’s policy.

Any questions regarding the receipt of any Gift, Business Entertainment or other personal benefit should be directed to a Compliance Officer.

 

7


V. CONFLICTS OF INTEREST

If any Supervised Person is aware of a personal interest that is, or might be, in conflict with the interests of the Firm or its Clients, that person should disclose the situation or transaction and the nature of the conflict to a Compliance Officer through Schwab CT ( https://client.schwabct.com ) for appropriate consideration. Examples of such a conflict of interest may include: (i) immediate family members employed by a financial services business, broker-dealer, investment adviser, fund administrator or private investment vehicle (i.e. hedge fund, private equity fund, etc.), (ii) service by a Supervised Person or their immediate family member on the board of directors or similar capacity of a public company, or (iii) service by a Supervised Person or their immediate family member with an non-profit entity, foundation or pension plan in which the Supervised Person or immediate family member has input regarding investment decisions for the entity.

 

VI. SERVICE AS A DIRECTOR

Investment Personnel are prohibited from accepting any appointment or election to the board of directors of any for-profit corporation, business trust or partnership, whether or not its securities are publicly traded, absent prior authorization of Jerry V. Swank (the “Managing Partner”) who will notify a Compliance Officer of any request for authorization and whether authorization was granted. In determining whether to authorize such appointment, the Managing Partner shall consider whether the board service would be adverse to the interests of the Firm or would give rise to conflicts of interest or the appearance of conflicts of interest and whether adequate procedures exist to ensure isolation from those making investment decisions. All Supervised Persons shall report board positions to a Compliance Officer through Schwab CT ( https://client.schwabct.com ).

 

VII. INSIDE INFORMATION

U.S. securities laws and regulations, and certain foreign laws, prohibit the misuse of “inside” or “material non-public” information when trading or recommending securities. In addition, Regulation FD prohibits certain selective disclosure to analysts. Inside information may include, but is not limited to, knowledge of pending customer orders or research recommendations, corporate finance activity, mergers or acquisitions, advance earnings information and other material non-public information that could affect the price of a security.

Firm and shareholder account information is also confidential and must not be discussed with any individual whose responsibilities do not require knowledge of such information.

Inside information obtained by any Supervised Person from any source must be kept strictly confidential. All inside information should be kept secure, and access to files and computer files containing such information should be restricted.

Contact with public company representatives is an important part of the Firm’s research efforts. Difficult legal issues arise, however, when in the course of these contacts, a Supervised

 

8


Person becomes aware of material, non-public information. Supervised Persons shall promptly report the receipt of any material non-public information related to securities in which the Firm may invest to a Compliance Officer. Supervised Persons may not act upon or disclose material non-public or insider information except as may be necessary for legitimate business purposes on behalf of the Firm and with prior approval of a Compliance Officer. Questions and requests for assistance regarding insider information should be promptly directed to a Compliance Officer.

Front running occurs when a person employed by a financial services firm executes an order for a security for his or her own personal account while using advance knowledge of pending orders or trade decisions from his or her employer. Any actual or apparent front running activity by Supervised Persons is strictly prohibited.

 

VIII. PERSONAL SECURITIES TRANSACTIONS RESTRICTIONS

 

  (a) Accounts Covered by the Code . The Code’s policies and procedures regarding personal securities transactions apply to all accounts holding any Securities over which a Supervised Person has any Beneficial Interest. For purposes of the Code, it is presumed that a Supervised Person has a Beneficial Interest in any account held personally or by immediate family members sharing the same household. Immediate family members include children, step-children, grandchildren, parents, step-parents, grandparents, spouses, domestic partners, siblings, parents-in-law, and children-in-law, as well as adoptive relationships that meet the above criteria. A Supervised Person seeking to exclude an account from the Code must be able to demonstrate to a Compliance Officer that he or she does not have any direct or indirect influence or control over the account.

 

  (b) Reportable Securities . The Code requires Supervised Persons to provide periodic reports regarding transactions and holdings in all Covered Securities (as defined herein).

 

  (c) Prohibited Purchases and Sales of a Covered Security . No Supervised Person of the Firm shall purchase or sell, directly or indirectly:

(i)    any Covered Security in which he or she has, or by reason of such transaction will acquire, any direct or indirect beneficial ownership and which, to his or her actual knowledge at the time of such purchase or sale, is being purchased or sold or considered for purchase or sale by the Firm on behalf of a Client Account;

(ii)    any related Covered Security to a security being actively considered for purchase or sale by the Firm, such as puts, calls, other options or rights in such security;

 

9


(iii)    any Covered Security in a sector or industry within the Firm’s investment universe (defined in Appendix A: Restricted Sectors and Industries) 2 ; or

(iv)     any shares of a closed-end fund advised by the Firm (A) during any applicable blackout period established by the Firm or (B) if such transaction would give rise to “short-swing profits” under Section 16 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 as if the Supervised Person were a Section 16 reporting person; or

 

  (d) Short-Term Trading by Investment Personnel . No Investment Personnel may engage in the purchase and sale, or sale and purchase, of the same (or equivalent) Covered Security within thirty (30) calendar days; provided, however, that individual exceptions may be permitted by a Compliance Officer when it is deemed that short-term trading by Investment Personnel would not create a conflict with any Client Account. Any trade made in violation of this prohibition should be reversed or, if not feasible, any profits resulting from the trading should be donated to a charitable organization designated by the Firm’s Managing Partner; provided, however, that the Firm’s Managing Partner may waive disgorgement of profits if it is determined that trading in violation of this prohibition was inadvertent and did not otherwise result in a conflict with any Client Account.

 

  (e) Prohibited Conduct . No Supervised Person of the Firm shall, directly or indirectly:

(i)    discuss with or otherwise inform others of actual or contemplated security transactions by the Firm on behalf of a Client Account except in the performance of his or her employment duties or in an official capacity and then only for the benefit of the Client Account, and not for personal benefit or for the benefit of others;

(ii)    use knowledge of portfolio transactions made or contemplated for the Firm to profit by the market effect of such transactions or otherwise engage in fraudulent conduct in connection with the purchase or sale of a security sold or acquired by the Firm;

(iii)    knowingly take advantage of a corporate opportunity of the Firm for personal benefit (or the benefit of anyone other than Clients), or take action for personal benefit (or the benefit of anyone other than Clients) in connection with such Person’s obligations to the Firm. All securities transactions must be consistent with this Code. Supervised Persons must avoid any actual or potential conflict of interest or any abuse of any Person’s position of trust.

 

 

2   Supervised Persons who directly or indirectly held a Covered Security in a sector or industry within the Firm’s investment universe prior to the prohibition being implemented (effective October 3, 2016) are not required to sell such Covered Securities. If a Supervised Persons wishes to sell such a Covered Security at a later date, the transaction will be subject to the pre-clearance provisions of the Code.

 

10


IX. PRE-CLEARANCE

 

  (a) No Supervised Person shall direct or allow any account over which he or she has any Beneficial Interest to buy or sell a Covered Security without the Supervised Person having first obtained specific permission from a Compliance Officer by completing a Personal Trade Pre-clearance Questionnaire, which may be found at Schwab CT ( https://client.schwabct.com ); provided, however, that pre-clearance shall not be required for personal trades in Covered Securities which are debt instruments issued or guaranteed by U.S. federal government agencies or issued by government-sponsored enterprises.

 

  (b) A request for pre-clearance will be denied if: (i) a transaction in the same issuer of the Covered Security has been effected on behalf of a Client account within the seven (7) days prior to the personal trade request or is contemplated as of the time of the compliance review of such request to occur within the next seven (7) days from the date of the trade request; (ii) the issuer of the Covered Security is included on the Firm’s Restricted List; or (iii) a Compliance Officer determines that the proposed transaction appears to pose a conflict of interest or otherwise appears improper.

 

  (c) Any Supervised Person seeking pre-clearance must certify that he or she is not aware of any firm trades on behalf of Client accounts in the same issuer of a Covered Security during the prior seven (7) days or of any present intention by Investment Personnel to effect a transaction in the same issuer of a Covered Security on behalf of a Client account in the next seven (7) days. Supervised Persons should be mindful of their duty to place the interests of Clients first, and consider carefully the timing of requested personal trades. A Compliance Officer will seek to verify that no firm trades have occurred within the prior seven (7) days or are anticipated within the next seven (7) days before approving the requested trade. Purchases or sales of ETFs/ETNs which track a benchmark other than a Cushing-sponsored index are not subject to the 7 day blackout period, although pre-clearance is still required.

 

  (d) In determining whether an actual or potential conflict of interest exists in connection with a requested personal trade, a Compliance Officer may review the Firm’s current trade blotter and prior trading history on behalf of Client accounts, make inquiries with appropriate Investment Personnel regarding planned trades for Client accounts and take such other steps as are deemed appropriate by a Compliance Officer.

 

11


  (e) After a completed pre-clearance request has been approved, the transaction must be effected within the same trading day or a new Pre-clearance Questionnaire must be submitted for approval.

 

  (f) No Investment Personnel shall directly or indirectly acquire an interest in a Covered Security through a Limited Offering or in an Initial Public Offering without obtaining the prior consent of a Compliance Officer. Consideration will be given to whether the opportunity should be reserved for the Client Accounts.

 

  (g) The Firm’s Chief Operating Officer, John Alban, will review and approve any request for pre-clearance of any transaction in Covered Securities by the Chief Compliance Officer.

 

X. EXCLUDED TRANSACTIONS

The following types of transactions do not invoke the pre-clearance requirements of Section IX:

 

  (a) Transactions effected for any account over which the Supervised Person has no investment discretion as established pursuant to the Firm’s policies.

 

  (b) Non-volitional purchases and sales, such as Dividend Reinvestment or “calls” or redemption of securities.

 

  (c) The acquisition of securities by gift or inheritance or disposition of securities by gift to charitable organizations.

 

XI. REPORTING PROCEDURES

Supervised Persons shall make the reports set forth below.

 

  (a) Brokerage Accounts . Before effecting personal transactions, each Supervised Person must (i) inform each brokerage firm where accounts holding any Securities over which the Supervised Person has any Beneficial Interest are held of his or her affiliation with the Firm and (ii) provide the Firm access to all accounts holding any Securities over which the Supervised Person has any Beneficial Interest by either completing a brokerage account approval form in Schwab CT ( https://client.schwabct.com ) or arranging for the brokerage firm to submit duplicate copies of all confirmations and account statements to a Compliance Officer.

 

12


  (b) Initial Holdings Report . Each Supervised Person must provide a report through Schwab CT (https://client.schwabct.com) which includes the following information within ten (10) days of becoming a Supervised Person:

 

    Title and type of security, ticker symbol, CUSIP number (if applicable), number of shares and principal amount of each Covered Security in which the Supervised Person had any Beneficial Interest when the Person became a Supervised Person;

 

    The name of any broker, dealer or bank with whom the Supervised Person maintains any account holding any Securities over which the Supervised Person has any Beneficial Interest as of date the person became a Supervised Person; and

 

    The date that the report is submitted by the Supervised Person.

The information contained in the initial holdings report must be current as of a date no more than forty-five (45) days prior to the date the person became a Supervised Person.

 

  (c) Quarterly Transaction Reports . Not later than thirty (30) days after the end of each calendar quarter, each Supervised Person must provide an affirmation through Schwab CT ( https://client.schwabct.com ) which includes following information with respect to any transaction in a Covered Security in an account for which the Supervised Person had any direct or indirect beneficial ownership:

 

    The date of the transaction, the title, ticker symbol or CUSIP number (if applicable), interest rate and maturity date (if applicable), the number of shares and principal amount of each Covered Security involved;

 

    The nature of the transaction (i.e., purchase, sale or other of acquisition or disposition);

 

    The price of the Covered Security at which the transaction was effected;

 

    The name of the broker, dealer or bank with or through which transaction was effected; and

 

    The date that the report is submitted by the Supervised Person.

 

  (d) Annual Holdings Report . Each Supervised Person shall provide a written affirmation annually containing the information required in Section XI.(b) above as of December 31, within forty-five (45) days after December 31 st each year. A Supervised Person need not make a quarterly transaction report or Annual Holdings Report if it would duplicate information contained in affirmations, broker trade confirmations and account statements received through Schwab CT by the Compliance Officer.

 

13


  (e) Review of Reports . The Compliance Officers shall be responsible for notifying Supervised Persons of their reporting obligations under this Code and for reviewing reports submitted by Supervised Persons. The Compliance Officers will maintain records of all reports filed pursuant to these procedures. The Firm’s Chief Operating Officer, John Alban, shall review reports submitted by the Chief Compliance Officer.

 

XII. REVIEW OF PERSONAL SECURITIES TRANSACTIONS

The Code’s policies and procedures are designed to mitigate any potential material conflicts of interest associated with Supervised Persons’ personal trading activities. Accordingly, the Compliance Officers will closely monitor Supervised Persons’ investment patterns to detect the following potentially abusive behavior:

 

    Failure to comply with the Code’s personal trade reporting and pre-clearance requirements;

 

    Frequent and/or short-term trades in any Security, with particular attention paid to potential manipulative behavior;

 

    Trading opposite of Client trades;

 

    Trading ahead of Clients; and

 

    Trading that appears to be based on material non-public information.

The Compliance Officers will compare all personal trading information reported by Supervised Persons with Firm trading activity to determine compliance with the Code. The Compliance Officers will use additional methods, such as electronic communications surveillance, to monitor for correlations between personal trading and noted Supervised Person conflicts of interest (such as board of directors service or personal relationships) and to identify potentially abusive patterns between personal trading and Firm trading. The Compliance Officers will keep appropriate records relating to such reviews and will inform the Firm’s Managing Partner of any material issues or concerns.

 

XIII. ADMINISTRATION OF THE CODE

 

  (a) Exceptions . The Compliance Officers shall be responsible for all aspects of administering this Code and for all interpretative issues arising under the Code. The Compliance Officers are responsible for considering any requests for exceptions to, or exemptions from, the Code (e.g., due to level of risk or personal financial hardship). Any exceptions to, or exemptions from, the Code shall be subject to such additional procedures, reviews and reporting as may be deemed appropriate by a Compliance Officer.

 

14


  (b) Verification of Information Provided . If deemed warranted by a Compliance Officer, a Supervised Person may be requested to complete IRS Form 4506, which will allow the Firm or a third-party designated by the Firm to receive copies of the Supervised Person’s completed tax returns directly from the Internal Revenue Service. The purpose of such a request will be to verify that such Supervised Person has properly reported all personal brokerage accounts, as required by the Code. Any such request will be risk-based, taking into consideration the Supervised Person’s position with the Firm, access to material non-public information regarding the Firm’s trading activities and frequency of personal trades. Refusal of a Supervised Person to comply with such a request will be deemed a violation of the Code and will subject the Supervised Person to sanctions, as determined by the Chief Compliance Officer and the Managing Partner.

 

  (c) Determination of Violation . The Compliance Officers shall have the authority to determine whether a person violated this Code. A violation of the general principles of the Code may constitute a punishable violation of the Code.

 

  (d) Sanctions . The Compliance Officers will take whatever action is deemed necessary with respect to any Supervised Person who violates any provision of this Code including, but not limited to, a reprimand, letter of censure, full or partial disgorgement of profits, imposition of a fine, suspension, restriction on activities, demotion or termination of the employment of the violator. Factors to be considered by the Compliance Officers in determining the severity of sanctions shall include the number of prior violations, the severity of the harm (to either affected Client account(s) or the Firm), cooperation with the investigation of the violation and remedial actions taken to address the violation.

 

  (e) Availability of the Code . Each new Supervised Person will be provided with a copy of the Code through Schwab CT ( https://client.schwabct.co m ) within ten (10) days of becoming a Supervised Person. A copy of the Code and any amendments thereto will be available to all Supervised Persons at all times through Schwab CT ( https://client.schwabct.com ).

 

15


XIV. RECORDKEEPING REQUIREMENTS

The Firm shall maintain records, at its principal place of business, of the following: a copy of each Code in effect during the past five years; a record of any violation of the Code and any action taken as a result of the violation for at least five years after the end of the fiscal year in which the violation occurs; a copy of each report made by Supervised Persons as required in this Code; a record of all persons required to make reports currently and during the past five years; a record of all who are or were responsible for reviewing these reports during the past five years; and, for at least five years after approval, a record of any decision and the reasons supporting that decision, to approve an Investment Personnel’s purchase of securities in an Initial Public Offering or a Limited Offering.

 

XV. REPORTING ILLEGAL OR UNETHICAL BEHAVIOR

Supervised Persons are encouraged to report exceptions or potential violations of the Code by themselves or others, issues arising under the Code or other illegal or unethical behavior to a Compliance Officer or any partner of the Firm. Supervised Persons are also encouraged to discuss situations that may present ethical issues with such persons. The Firm will endeavor to maintain the confidentiality of reported violations, subject to applicable law, regulation or legal proceedings and to investigate those reported obligations as the Chief Compliance Officer or other personnel deem appropriate.

Notwithstanding the above or any other confidentiality obligation in this Code or elsewhere (such as pursuant to a confidentiality agreement), Supervised Persons may choose to report a possible violation of the federal securities laws directly to the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission. The SEC is authorized by Congress to provide monetary awards to eligible individuals who come forward with information that leads to a successful SEC enforcement action.

The Firm will not permit retaliation of any kind by, or on behalf of, the Firm or any Supervised Person against any individual for making good faith reports of violations of this Code. Such behavior shall be considered, in and of itself, a violation of the Code.

 

XVI. CONDITION OF EMPLOYMENT OR SERVICE

All Supervised Persons shall conduct themselves at all times in the best interests of the Firm and its Clients. Compliance with the Code shall be a condition of employment or continued affiliation with the Firm and conduct not in accordance shall constitute grounds for actions which may include, but are not limited to, a reprimand, letter of censure, full or partial disgorgement of profits, imposition of a fine, suspension, restriction on activities, demotion or termination of employment. All Persons shall certify quarterly via Schwab CT ( https://client.schwabct.com ) that they have read and agree to comply in all respects with this Code and that they have disclosed or reported all personal securities transactions, holdings and accounts required to be disclosed or reported by this Code.

* * * * *

 

16


As of: September 22, 2017

APPENDIX A

RESTRICTED SECTORS AND INDUSTRIES

Sectors:

Commercial Services

Consumer Durables

Distribution Services

Energy Minerals

Non-Energy Minerals

Industrial Services

Process Industries

Producer Manufacturing

Transportation

Utilities

Industries:

 

Air Freight/Couriers

Airlines

Alternate Power Generation

Aluminum

Automobile Aftermarket

Building Products

Chemicals: Agricultural

Chemicals: Major Diversified

Chemicals: Specialty

Coal

Construction Materials

Containers/Packaging

Electric Utilities

Electrical Products

Engineering & Construction

Forest Products

Gas Distributors

Industrial Machinery

Industrial Specialties

Integrated Oil

  

Miscellaneous Manufacturing

Marine Shipping

Metal Fabrication

Oil & Gas Pipelines

Oil & Gas Production

Oil Refining/Marketing

Oilfield Services/Equipment

Other Metals/Minerals

Other Transportation

Pulp & Paper

Railroads

Real Estate Development

Specialty Stores

Steel

Textiles

Tools & Hardware

Trucking

Trucks/Construction/Farm Machinery

Water Utilities

Wholesale Distributors

Exhibit (s)

THE CUSHING ® RENAISSANCE FUND

POWER OF ATTORNEY

That each of the undersigned officers and trustees of The Cushing ® Renaissance Fund, a statutory trust formed under the laws of the State of Delaware (the “Trust”), do constitute and appoint Jerry V. Swank, John H. Alban and Barry Y. Greenberg as true and lawful attorneys and agents, with full power and authority (acting alone and without the other) to execute in the name and on behalf of each of the undersigned as such officer or trustee, a Registration Statement on Form N-2, including any pre-effective amendments and/or any post-effective amendments thereto, and any other filings in connection therewith, and to file the same under the Securities Act of 1993, as amended, the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended, or otherwise, with respect to the registration and offering of the Trust’s shares of beneficial interest, par value $0.01 per share; granting to such attorney and agent full power of substitution and revocation in the premises; and ratifying and confirming all that such attorney and agent may do or cause to be done by virtue of these presents.

This Power of Attorney may be executed in multiple counterparts, each of which shall be deemed an original, but which taken together shall constitute one instrument.


IN WITNESS WHEREOF, each of the undersigned has executed this Power of Attorney as of this 15 th day of November, 2017.

 

/s/ Jerry V. Swank

Jerry V. Swank
Trustee and Chief Executive Officer

/s/ John H. Alban

John H. Alban
Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

/s/ Brian R. Bruce

Brian R. Bruce
Trustee

/s/ Brenda A. Cline

Brenda A. Cline
Trustee

/s/ Ronald P. Trout

Ronald P. Trout
Trustee

 

2

Exhibit (z)(i)

 

The information in this Prospectus Supplement is not complete and may be changed. A Registration Statement relating to these securities has been filed with and declared effective by the Securities and Exchange Commission. This Prospectus Supplement and the accompanying Prospectus is not an offer to sell these securities and is not soliciting an offer to buy these securities in any jurisdiction where the offer or sale is not permitted.

 

Subject to Completion, dated [ ], 2018

FORM OF PRELIMINARY PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT TO BE USED IN CONNECTION WITH OFFERINGS OF COMMON SHARES 1

(to Prospectus dated              , 2018)

 

LOGO

                 Shares

The Cushing ® Renaissance Fund

Common Shares

$                 per Share

 

 

Investment Objective . The Cushing ® Renaissance Fund (the “Fund”) is a non-diversified, closed-end management investment company. The Fund’s investment objective is to seek high total return with an emphasis on current income.

Investment Strategy. The Fund seeks to achieve its investment objective by investing, under normal conditions, at least 80% of its Managed Assets (as defined in this Prospectus) in a portfolio of (i) companies across the energy supply chain spectrum, including upstream, midstream and downstream energy companies (i.e. companies engaged in exploration and production, gathering, transporting and processing and marketing and distribution, respectively), as well as oil and gas services companies (collectively, “Energy Companies”), (ii) energy-intensive chemical, metal and industrial and manufacturing companies and engineering and construction companies that the Investment Adviser expects to benefit from growing energy production and lower feedstock costs relative to global costs (collectively, “Industrial Companies”) and, (iii) transportation and logistics companies providing solutions to the U.S. manufacturing industry (collectively, “Logistics Companies” and, together with Energy Companies and Industrial Companies, “Renaissance Companies”). The Fund will invest no more than 25% of its Managed Assets in securities of energy master limited partnerships (“MLPs”) that are “qualified publicly traded partnerships” under the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the “Code”), and no more than 30% of its Managed Assets in debt securities, preferred stock and convertible securities.

NYSE Listing. The Fund’s currently outstanding Common Shares are, and the Common Shares offered by this Prospectus, will be, subject to notice of issuance, listed on the New York Stock Exchange (the “NYSE”) under the symbol “SZC.” As of                 , the last reported sale price for the Fund’s Common Shares on the NYSE was $                 per Common Share, and the net asset value of the Fund’s Common Shares was $                 per Common Share, representing a [discount/premium] to net asset value of     %.

 

 

1   In addition to the sections outlined in this form of prospectus supplement, each prospectus supplement actually used in connection with an offering conducted pursuant to the registration statement to which this form of prospectus supplement is attached will be updated to include such other information as may then be required to be disclosed therein pursuant to applicable law or regulation as in effect as of the date of each such prospectus supplement, including, without limitation, information particular to the terms of each security offered thereby and any related risk factors or tax considerations pertaining thereto. This form of prospectus supplement is intended only to provide a rough approximation of the nature and type of disclosure that may appear in any actual prospectus supplement used for the purposes of offering securities pursuant to the registration statement to which this form of prospectus supplement is attached, and is not intended to and does not contain all of the information that would appear is any such actual prospectus supplement, and should not be used or relied upon in connection with any offer or sale of securities.

 

i


 

Investing in the Fund’s Common Shares involves certain risks. See “ Risks ” on page 36 of the accompanying Prospectus.

Neither the Securities and Exchange Commission nor any state securities commission has approved or disapproved of these securities or determined if this Prospectus Supplement or the accompanying Prospectus is truthful or complete. Any representation to the contrary is a criminal offense.

 

 

 

     Per
Share
     Total (1)  

Public offering price

   $                   $               

Underwriting discount

   $                   $               

Proceeds, before expenses, to the Fund (2)

   $                   $               

 

(1) [The Fund has granted the underwriters an option to purchase up to an additional                  Common Shares at the public offering price, less the sales load, within      days of the date of this prospectus solely to cover overallotments, if any. If such option is exercised in full, the public offering price, sales load, estimated offering expenses and proceeds, before expenses, to the Fund will be $        , $         and $        , respectively. See “Underwriting.”]
(2) [Offering expenses payable by the Fund will be deducted from the Proceeds, before expenses, to the Fund. Total offering expenses (other than sales load) are estimated to be $        , which will be paid by the Fund.]

This Prospectus Supplement, together with the accompanying Prospectus, dated             , 2018, sets forth concisely the information that you should know before investing in the Fund’s Common Shares. You should read this Prospectus, which contains important information about the Fund, together with any Prospectus Supplement, before deciding whether to invest, and retain it for future reference. A Statement of Additional Information, dated             , 2018, containing additional information about the Fund, has been filed with the SEC and is incorporated by reference in its entirety into the accompanying Prospectus. You may request a free copy of the Statement of Additional Information, the table of contents of which is on page      of the accompanying Prospectus, or request other information about the Fund (including the Fund’s annual and semi-annual reports) or make shareholder inquiries by calling (800) 345-7999 or by writing the Fund, or you may obtain a copy (and other information regarding the Fund) from the SEC’s website (www.sec.gov). Free copies of the Fund’s reports and the SAI will also be available from the Fund’s website.

The Fund’s Common Shares do not represent a deposit or obligation of, and are not guaranteed or endorsed by, any bank or other insured depository institution and are not federally insured by the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation, the Federal Reserve Board or any other government agency.

Capitalized terms used herein that are not otherwise defined shall have the meanings assigned to them in the accompanying Prospectus.

The underwriters expect to deliver the Common Shares to purchasers on or about                     .

 

 

This Prospectus Supplement is dated                      .

 

ii


TABLE OF CONTENTS

 

     Page  

Prospectus Supplement

  

PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT SUMMARY

     S-1  

SUMMARY OF FUND EXPENSES

     S-4  

CAPITALIZATION

     S-5  

USE OF PROCEEDS

     S-6  

RECENT DEVELOPMENTS

     S-6  

UNDERWRITERS

     S-7  

LEGAL MATTERS

     S-8  

INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

     S-    

ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

     S-8  

Prospectus

  

Prospectus Summary

     1  

Summary of Fund Expenses

     22  

Financial Highlights

     23  

Senior Securities

     25  

The Fund

     26  

Use of Proceeds

     26  

Market and Net Asset Value Information

     26  

Investment Objective and Policies

     27  

The Fund’s Investments

     29  

Use of Leverage

     33  

Risks

     36  

Management of the Fund

     53  

Net Asset Value

     56  

Distributions

     57  

Dividend Reinvestment Plan

     58  

Description of Shares

     59  

Anti-Takeover Provisions in the Agreement and Declaration of Trust

     62  

Certain Provisions of Delaware Law, the Agreement and Declaration of Trust and Bylaws

     64  

Closed-End Fund Structure

     65  

Repurchase of Common Shares

     65  

U.S. Federal Income Tax Considerations

     66  

Plan of Distribution

     69  

Other Service Providers

     71  

Legal Matters

     71  

Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

     71  

Additional Information

     71  

Privacy Policy

     73  

Table of Contents of the Statement of Additional Information

     74  

 

 

FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS

This prospectus contains or incorporates by reference forward-looking statements, within the meaning of the federal securities laws, that involve risks and uncertainties. These statements describe the Fund’s plans, strategies, and goals and our beliefs and assumptions concerning future economic and other conditions and the outlook for the Fund, based on currently available information. In this prospectus, words such as “anticipates,” “believes,” “expects,” “objectives,” “goals,” “future,” “intends,” “seeks,” “will,” “may,” “could,” “should,” and similar expressions are used in an effort to identify forward-looking statements, although some forward-looking statements may be expressed differently. The Fund is not entitled to the safe harbor for forward-looking statements pursuant to Section 27A of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended.

 

iii


PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT SUMMARY

This is only a summary of information contained elsewhere in this Prospectus Supplement and the accompanying Prospectus. This summary does not contain all of the information that you should consider before investing in the Fund’s Common Shares. You should carefully read the more detailed information contained in this Prospectus Supplement and the accompanying Prospectus and the Statement of Additional Information, dated             , 2018 (the “SAI”), especially the information set forth under the headings “Investment Objective and Policies” and “Risks.”

 

The Fund    The Cushing ® Renaissance Fund is a non-diversified, closed-end management investment company registered under the 1940 Act that commenced investment operations on September 25, 2012. The Fund’s Investment Adviser is Cushing ® Asset Management, LP.
Investment Adviser   

The Fund’s investments are managed by its Cushing ® Asset Management, LP (the “Investment Adviser”), whose principal business address is 8117 Preston Road, Suite 440, Dallas, Texas 75225. The Investment Adviser serves as investment adviser to registered and unregistered funds, which invest primarily in securities of MLPs and other Energy Companies. The Investment Adviser continues to seek to expand its platform of energy-related investment products, leveraging extensive industry contacts and significant research depth to drive both passive and actively managed investment opportunities for individual and institutional investors. The Investment Adviser seeks to identify and exploit investment niches that it believes are generally less understood and less followed by the broader investor community.

 

The Investment Adviser considers itself one of the principal professional institutional investors in the energy sector based on the following:

 

•       An investment team with extensive experience in analysis, portfolio management, risk management, and private securities transactions.

 

•       A focus on bottom-up, fundamental analysis performed by its experienced investment team is core to the Investment Adviser’s investment process.

 

•       The investment team’s wide range of professional backgrounds, market knowledge, industry relationships, and experience in the analysis, financing, and structuring of energy income investments give the Investment Adviser insight into, and the ability to identify and capitalize on, investment opportunities.

 

Its central location in Dallas, Texas and proximity to major players and assets in the energy sector.

Listing and Symbol    The Fund’s currently outstanding Common Shares are, and the Common Shares offered by this Prospectus, will be, subject to notice of issuance, listed on the New York Stock Exchange (the “NYSE”) under the symbol “SZC.” As of                     , the last reported sale price for the Fund’s Common Shares on the NYSE was $                 per Common Share, and the net asset value of the Fund’s Common Shares was $                 per Common Share, representing a [premium/discount] to net asset value of     %.
Distributions    The Fund has paid distributions to Common Shareholders monthly since inception. Payment of future distributions is subject to approval by the Fund’s Board of Trustees, as well as meeting the covenants of any outstanding borrowings and the asset coverage requirements of the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended (the “1940 Act”).

 



 

S-1


  

The Fund’s next regularly scheduled distribution will be for the month ending                      and, if approved by the Board of Trustees, is expected to be paid to Common Shareholders on or about                     .

 

The Fund expects that distributions paid on the Common Shares will consist primarily of (i) investment company taxable income, which includes, among other things, ordinary income, net short-term capital gain and income from certain hedging and interest rate transactions, and (ii) net capital gain (which is the excess of net long-term capital gain over net short-term capital loss). A portion of the Fund’s distributions may also be characterized as return of capital. The Fund may invest up to 25% of its Managed Assets in MLPs that are “qualified publicly traded partnerships” under the Code, and a portion of the cash distributions received by the Fund from the MLPs in which it invests may be characterized as return of capital. If, for any calendar year, the Fund’s total distributions exceed both current earnings and profits and accumulated earnings and profits, the excess will generally be treated as a return of capital for U.S. federal income tax purposes up to the amount of a shareholder’s tax basis in the Common Shares, reducing that basis accordingly. The Fund cannot assure you as to what percentage, if any, of the distributions paid on the Common Shares will consist of net capital gain, which is taxed at reduced rates for non-corporate shareholders, or return of capital.

The Offering    Common Shares Offered by the Fund
   Common Shares Outstanding after the Offering
   The number of Common Shares offered and outstanding after the offering assumes the underwriters’ over-allotment option is not exercised. If the over-allotment option is exercised in full, the Fund will issue an additional Common Shares and will have                  Common Shares outstanding after the Offering.
   The Fund’s Common Shares have recently traded at a premium to net asset value (“NAV”) per share and the price of the Common Shares is expected to be above net asset value per share. Therefore, investors in this offering are likely to experience immediate dilution of their investment. Furthermore, shares of closed-end investment companies, such as the Fund, frequently trade at a price below their NAV. The Fund cannot predict whether its Common Shares will trade at a premium or a discount to NAV.
Risks    See “Risks” beginning on page      of the accompanying Prospectus for a discussion of factors you should consider carefully before deciding to invest in the Fund’s Common Shares.

 



 

S-2


Use of Proceeds    The Fund intends to invest the net proceeds of the offering in accordance with its investment objective and policies as stated in the accompanying Prospectus. It is currently anticipated that the Fund will be able to invest substantially all of the net proceeds of the offering in accordance with its investment objective and policies within                      months after the completion of the offering. Pending such investment, it is anticipated that the proceeds will be invested in cash, cash equivalents or other securities, including U.S. government securities or high quality, short-term debt securities. The Fund may also use the proceeds for working capital purposes, including the payment of distributions, interest and operating expenses, although the Fund currently has no intent to issue Securities primarily for these purposes.

 



 

S-3


SUMMARY OF FUND EXPENSES

The following table contains information about the costs and expenses that Common Shareholders will bear directly or indirectly. The table is based on the capital structure of the Fund as of                      (except as noted below) after giving effect to the anticipated net proceeds of the Common Shares offered by this Prospectus Supplement and assuming the Fund incurs the estimated offering expenses. The purpose of the table and the example below is to help you understand the fees and expenses that you, as a holder of Common Shares, would bear directly or indirectly.

Shareholder Transaction Expenses

 

Sales load (as a percentage of offering price)

         

Offering expenses borne by the Fund (as a percentage of offering price)

         

Automatic Dividend Reinvestment Plan fees

     None  

Annual Expenses

 

     Percentage of Net
Assets Attributable to Common
Shares
 

Management fees (1)

         

Interest payments on borrowed funds (2)

         

Other expenses (3)

         

Total annual expenses (4)

         

 

(1) The Fund pays the Investment Adviser an annual fee, payable monthly, in an amount equal to 1.00% of the Fund’s average daily Managed Assets (net assets plus any assets attributable to Financial Leverage). The fee shown above is based upon outstanding Financial Leverage of     % of the Fund’s Managed Assets. If Financial Leverage of more than     % of the Fund’s Managed Assets is used, the management fees shown would be higher.
(2) Based upon the Fund’s outstanding borrowings as of                      of approximately $         million and the borrowing rate on the facility as of                     , of     %.
(3) Other expenses are estimated based upon those incurred during the fiscal year ended                     . Other expenses do not include expense related to realized or unrealized investment gains or losses.
(4) The Investment Adviser has agreed to waive a portion of the management fee in an amount equal to     % of the Fund’s Managed Assets through                     . After giving effect to this waiver, the Fund’s net total annual expenses are     %.

Example

The following example illustrates the expenses that you would pay on a $1,000 investment in Common Shares, assuming (1) “Total annual expenses” of % of net assets attributable to Common Shares, (2) the sales load of $         and estimated offering expenses of $        , and (3) a 5% annual return*:

 

     1 Year      3 Years      5 Years      10 Years  

Total Expenses Incurred

   $                   $                   $                   $               

 

* The example should not be considered a representation of future expenses or returns. Actual expenses may be higher or lower than those assumed. Moreover, the Fund’s actual rate of return may be higher or lower than the hypothetical 5% return shown in the example. The example assumes that the estimated “Other expenses” set forth in the Annual Expenses table are accurate and that all dividends and distributions are reinvested at net asset value.

 

S-4


CAPITALIZATION

The following table sets forth the Fund’s capitalization at                     :

 

  (i) on a historical basis;

 

  (ii) on an as adjusted basis to reflect the issuance of an aggregate of                  Common Shares pursuant to the Fund’s Automatic Dividend Reinvestment Plan, and the application of the net proceeds from such issuances of Common Shares; and

 

  (iii) on an as further adjusted basis to reflect the assumed sale of                  of Common Shares at a price of $                 per share in an offering under this Prospectus Supplement and the accompanying Prospectus less the aggregate underwriting discount of $         and estimated offering expenses payable by the Fund of $         (assuming no exercise of the underwriters’ over-allotment option).

 

     Actual      As
Adjusted (unaudited)
     As Further
Adjusted (unaudited)
 

Short-Term Debt:

        

Borrowings

   $                   $                   $               

Common Shareholder’s Equity:

        

Common Shares of beneficial interest, par value $0.01 per share; unlimited shares authorized,                  shares issued and outstanding (actual),                  shares issued and outstanding (as adjusted), and                  shares issued and outstanding (as further adjusted)

        

Additional paid-in capital

        

Net unrealized appreciation on investments, net of tax

        

Accumulated net realized gain on investments, net of tax

        

Accumulated net investment loss, net of tax

        

Net assets

        

 

S-5


USE OF PROCEEDS

The Fund estimates that the net proceeds to the Fund from this offering will be approximately $         million (or $        million if the underwriters exercise their over-allotment option to purchase additional Common Shares in full), after deducting underwriting discounts and commissions and estimated offering expenses borne by the Fund.

The Fund intends to invest the net proceeds of the offering in accordance with its investment objective and policies as stated in the accompanying Prospectus. It is currently anticipated that the Fund will be able to invest substantially all of the net proceeds of the offering in accordance with its investment objective and policies within      months after the completion of the offering. Pending such investment, it is anticipated that the proceeds will be invested in cash, cash equivalents or other securities, including U.S. government securities or high quality, short-term debt securities. The Fund may also use the proceeds for working capital purposes, including the payment of distributions, interest and operating expenses, although the Fund currently has no intent to issue Securities primarily for these purposes.

RECENT DEVELOPMENTS

[TO COME, IF ANY]

 

S-6


UNDERWRITERS

[TO COME]

 

S-7


LEGAL MATTERS

Certain legal matters will be passed on by Skadden, Arps, Slate, Meagher & Flom LLP, Chicago, Illinois, as special counsel to the Fund in connection with the offering of Common Shares. Certain legal matters will be passed on by     ,         ,         , as special counsel to the underwriters in connection with the offering of Common Shares.

ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

This Prospectus Supplement and the accompanying Prospectus constitute part of a Registration Statement filed by the Fund with the SEC under the Securities Act and the 1940 Act. This Prospectus Supplement and the accompanying Prospectus omit certain of the information contained in the Registration Statement, and reference is hereby made to the Registration Statement and related exhibits for further information with respect to the Fund and the Common Shares offered hereby. Any statements contained herein concerning the provisions of any document are not necessarily complete, and, in each instance, reference is made to the copy of such document filed as an exhibit to the Registration Statement or otherwise filed with the SEC. Each such statement is qualified in its entirety by such reference. The complete Registration Statement may be obtained from the SEC upon payment of the fee prescribed by its rules and regulations or free of charge through the SEC’s web site (http://www.sec.gov).

 

S-8


 

 

 

LOGO

                 Shares

The Cushing ® Renaissance Fund

Common Shares

 

 

FORM OF

PROSPECTUS

SUPPLEMENT

 

 

 

 

 

 

S-9

Exhibit (z)(il)

 

The information in this Prospectus Supplement is not complete and may be changed. A Registration Statement relating to these securities has been filed with and declared effective by the Securities and Exchange Commission. This Prospectus Supplement and the accompanying Prospectus is not an offer to sell these securities and is not soliciting an offer to buy these securities in any jurisdiction where the offer or sale is not permitted.

 

Subject to Completion, dated [ ], 2018

FORM OF PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT TO BE USED IN CONNECTION WITH RIGHTS OFFERINGS 1

(to Prospectus dated              , 2018)

 

LOGO

                 Common Shares

The Cushing ® Renaissance Fund

Subscription Rights for Common Shares

 

 

The Cushing ® Renaissance Fund (the “Fund”) is a non-diversified, closed-end management investment company.

The Fund is issuing [transferable/non-transferable] rights (“Rights”) to its common shareholders of record (“Record Date Shareholders”) as of 5:00 p.m., Eastern time, on                      (the “Record Date”), entitling the holders of those Rights to subscribe for up to an aggregate of                      of the Fund’s common shares of beneficial interest (the “Offer”). Record Date Shareholders will receive one Right for each outstanding whole common share held on the Record Date. The Rights entitle their holders to purchase one new common share for every    Rights held (1-for-         ). Any Record Date Shareholder who is issued fewer than                      Rights may subscribe for one full common share in the Offer. [In addition, Record Date Shareholders who fully exercise their Rights (other than those Rights that cannot be exercised because they represent the right to acquire less than one common share) will be entitled to subscribe for additional common shares of the Fund that remain unsubscribed as a result of any unexercised Rights. This over-subscription privilege is subject to a number of limitations and subject to allotment.]

The subscription price (the “Subscription Price”) will be determined based upon a formula equal to                                          (the “Formula Price”). The Offer will expire at                     , on                     , unless extended as described in this prospectus (the “Expiration Date”).

Rights holders may not know the Subscription Price at the time of exercise and will be required initially to pay for both the common shares subscribed for pursuant to the primary subscription [and, if eligible, any additional common shares subscribed for pursuant to the over-subscription privilege] at the estimated Subscription Price of $                 per common share and, except in limited circumstances, will not be able to rescind their subscription.

 

 

Exercising your Rights and investing in the Fund’s common shares involves a high degree of risk . See “ Risks ” on page 36 of the accompanying Prospectus.

This offering will dilute the ownership interest and voting power of the Common Shares owned by shareholders who do not fully exercise their Rights. Shareholders who do not fully exercise their Rights should expect, upon completion of the offering, to own a smaller proportional interest in the Fund than before the offering. Further, if the net proceeds per share from the offering are at a discount to the Fund’s net asset value per share, this offering will reduce the Fund’s net asset value per share.

 

 

1   This document is a form of prospectus supplement for an of common shares pursuant to subscription rights. In addition to the sections outlined in this form of prospectus supplement, each prospectus supplement actually used in connection with an offering conducted pursuant to the registration statement to which this form of prospectus supplement is attached will be updated to include such other information as may then be required to be disclosed therein pursuant to applicable law or regulation as in effect as of the date of each such prospectus supplement, including, without limitation, information particular to the terms of each security offered thereby and any related risk factors or tax considerations pertaining thereto. This form of prospectus supplement is intended only to provide a rough approximation of the nature and type of disclosure that may appear in any actual prospectus supplement used for the purposes of offering securities pursuant to the registration statement to which this form of prospectus supplement is attached, and is not intended to and does not contain all of the information that would appear is any such actual prospectus supplement, and should not be used or relied upon in connection with any offer or sale of securities.

 

i


Neither the Securities and Exchange Commission nor any state securities commission has approved or disapproved of these securities or determined if this Prospectus Supplement or the accompanying Prospectus is truthful or complete. Any representation to the contrary is a criminal offense.

(continued on following page)

 

     Per
Share
     Total (1)  

Estimated Subscription Price (2)

   $                   $               

Estimated Sales Load (2)(3)

   $                   $               

Proceeds, before expenses, to the Fund (2)

   $                   $               

(notes on following page)

 

 

This Prospectus Supplement is dated                     .

 

ii


(notes from previous page)

 

(1) Assumes that all Rights are exercised at the estimated Subscription Price. All of the Rights may not be exercised.
(2) Estimated on the basis of [                    ].
(3) [                     will act as dealer manager for the Offer (the “Dealer Manager”). The Fund has agreed to pay the Dealer Manager a fee for its financial structuring and soliciting services equal to     % of the Subscription Price per common share for each common share issued pursuant to the exercise of Rights, including the over-subscription privilege. The Dealer Manager will reallow to broker-dealers in the selling group to be formed and managed by the Dealer Manager selling fees equal to     % of the Subscription Price per common share for each common share issued pursuant to the exercise of Rights as a result of their selling efforts. In addition, the Dealer Manager will reallow to other broker-dealers that have executed and delivered a soliciting dealer agreement and have solicited the exercise of Rights solicitation fees equal to     % of the Subscription Price per common share for each common share issued pursuant to the exercise of Rights as a result of their soliciting efforts, subject to a maximum fee based on the number of common shares held by each broker-dealer through The Depository Trust Company (“DTC”) on the Record Date. The fees and expenses of the Offer, including the Dealer Manager fee, will be borne by the Fund and indirectly by all of its common shareholders, including those who do not exercise their Rights.]
(4) Offering expenses borne by the Fund are estimated to be $        .

(continued from previous page)

NAV dilution resulting from the Offer is not currently determinable because it is not known how many common shares will be subscribed for, what the net asset value or market price of the common shares will be on the Expiration Date or what the Subscription Price will be. Any such dilution will disproportionately affect non-exercising common shareholders. If the Subscription Price is substantially less than the then current net asset value, this dilution could be substantial. However, assuming all of the common shares are sold at the estimated Subscription Price, the Fund’s current net asset value per common share would be reduced by approximately $        , or     %. [The distribution to common shareholders of transferable Rights, which themselves have intrinsic value, will afford non-participating Record Date Shareholders the potential of receiving cash payment upon the sale of the Rights, receipt of which may be viewed as partial compensation for any dilution of their interests that may occur as a result of the Offer. There can be no assurance that a market for the Rights will develop or, if such a market develops, what the price of the Rights will be.] See “Risks Related to the Offer” in this prospectus supplement.

Investment Objective . The Cushing ® Renaissance Fund (the “Fund”) is a non-diversified, closed-end management investment company. The Fund’s investment objective is to seek high total return with an emphasis on current income. There can be no assurance that the Fund will achieve its investment objective.

Investment Strategy. The Fund seeks to achieve its investment objective by investing, under normal conditions, at least 80% of its Managed Assets (as defined in this Prospectus) in a portfolio of (i) companies across the energy supply chain spectrum, including upstream, midstream and downstream energy companies (i.e. companies engaged in exploration and production, gathering, transporting and processing and marketing and distribution, respectively), as well as oil and gas services companies (collectively, “Energy Companies”), (ii) energy-intensive chemical, metal and industrial and manufacturing companies and engineering and construction companies that the Investment Adviser expects to benefit from growing energy production and lower feedstock costs relative to global costs (collectively, “Industrial Companies”) and, (iii) transportation and logistics companies providing solutions to the U.S. manufacturing industry (collectively, “Logistics Companies” and, together with Energy Companies and Industrial Companies, “Renaissance Companies”). The Fund will invest no more than 25% of its Managed Assets in securities of energy master limited partnerships (“MLPs”) that are “qualified publicly traded partnerships” under the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the “Code”), and no more than 30% of its Managed Assets in debt securities, preferred stock and convertible securities.

Listing and Symbol . The Fund’s currently outstanding Common Shares are, and the Common Shares offered by this Prospectus, will be, subject to notice of issuance, listed on the New York Stock Exchange (the “NYSE”) under the symbol “SZC.” As of                     , the last reported sale price for the Fund’s Common Shares on the NYSE was $                 per Common Share, and the net asset value of the Fund’s Common Shares was $                 per Common Share, representing a [discount/premium] to net asset value of     %. [The Rights will be, subject to notice of issuance, admitted for trading on the                      under the symbol “                    ” during the course of the offer. Trading in the Rights on the                     may be conducted until the close of trading on the                      on the last business day prior to the expiration date.]

 

iii


This Prospectus Supplement, together with the accompanying Prospectus, dated             , 2018, sets forth concisely the information that you should know before investing in the Fund’s Securities. You should read this Prospectus, which contains important information about the Fund, together with any Prospectus Supplement, before deciding whether to invest, and retain it for future reference. A Statement of Additional Information, dated             , 2018, containing additional information about the Fund, has been filed with the SEC and is incorporated by reference in its entirety into the accompanying Prospectus. You may request a free copy of the Statement of Additional Information, the table of contents of which is on page      of the accompanying Prospectus, or request other information about the Fund (including the Fund’s annual and semi-annual reports) or make shareholder inquiries by calling (800) 345-7999 or by writing the Fund, or you may obtain a copy (and other information regarding the Fund) from the SEC’s website (www.sec.gov). Free copies of the Fund’s reports and the SAI will also be available from the Fund’s website.

The Fund’s Securities do not represent a deposit or obligation of, and are not guaranteed or endorsed by, any bank or other insured depository institution and are not federally insured by the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation, the Federal Reserve Board or any other government agency.

Capitalized terms used herein that are not otherwise defined shall have the meanings assigned to them in the accompanying Prospectus.

 

iv


TABLE OF CONTENTS

 

     Page  

Prospectus Supplement

  

Prospectus Supplement Summary

     S-1  

Summary of Fund Expenses

     S-6  

Capitalization

     S-8  

Use of Proceeds

     S-9  

Recent Developments

     S-9  

Terms of the Offer

     S-9  

Risks Related to the Offer

     S-18  

Legal Matters

     S-20  

Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

     S-20  

Additional Information

     S-21  

Prospectus

  

Prospectus Summary

     1  

Summary of Fund Expenses

     22  

Financial Highlights

     23  

Senior Securities

     25  

The Fund

     26  

Use of Proceeds

     26  

Market and Net Asset Value Information

     26  

Investment Objective and Policies

     27  

The Fund’s Investments

     29  

Use of Leverage

     33  

Risks

     36  

Management of the Fund

     53  

Net Asset Value

     56  

Distributions

     57  

Dividend Reinvestment Plan

     58  

Description of Shares

     59  

Anti-Takeover Provisions in the Agreement and Declaration of Trust

     62  

Certain Provisions of Delaware Law, the Agreement and Declaration of Trust and Bylaws

     64  

Closed-End Fund Structure

     65  

Repurchase of Common Shares

     65  

U.S. Federal Income Tax Considerations

     66  

Plan of Distribution

     69  

Other Service Providers

     71  

Legal Matters

     71  

Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

     71  

Additional Information

     71  
Privacy Policy    73  
Table of Contents of the Statement of Additional Information    74  

 

 

FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS

This prospectus contains or incorporates by reference forward-looking statements, within the meaning of the federal securities laws, that involve risks and uncertainties. These statements describe the Fund’s plans, strategies, and goals and our beliefs and assumptions concerning future economic and other conditions and the outlook for the Fund, based on currently available information. In this prospectus, words such as “anticipates,” “believes,” “expects,” “objectives,” “goals,” “future,” “intends,” “seeks,” “will,” “may,” “could,” “should,” and similar expressions are used in an effort to identify forward-looking statements, although some forward-looking statements may be expressed differently. The Fund is not entitled to the safe harbor for forward-looking statements pursuant to Section 27A of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended.

 

v


PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT SUMMARY

This is only a summary of information contained elsewhere in this Prospectus Supplement and the accompanying Prospectus. This summary does not contain all of the information that you should consider before investing in the Fund’s Common Shares. You should carefully read the more detailed information contained in this Prospectus Supplement and the accompanying Prospectus and the Statement of Additional Information, dated             , 2018 (the “SAI”), especially the information set forth under the headings “Investment Objective and Policies” and “Risks.”

 

The Fund    The Cushing ® Renaissance Fund is a non-diversified, closed-end management investment company registered under the 1940 Act that commenced investment operations on September 25, 2012.
Purpose of the Offer    [                    ]
Important Terms of the Offer   

The Fund is issuing [transferable/non-transferable] rights (“Rights”) to its Common Shareholders of record (“Record Date Shareholders”) as of                     , on                      (the “Record Date”), entitling the holders of those Rights to subscribe for up to an aggregate of                      of the Fund’s common shares (the “Shares”) (the “Offer”). Record Date Shareholders will receive one Right for each outstanding whole common share held on the Record Date. The Rights entitle their holders to purchase one Share for every              Rights held (1-for-         ). Fractional Shares will not be issued upon the exercise of Rights; accordingly, Rights may be exercised only in integer multiples of                     , except that any Record Date Shareholder who is issued fewer than                      Rights may subscribe, at the Subscription Price (defined below), for one full Share. Assuming the exercise of all Rights, the Offer will result in an approximately     % increase in the Fund’s common shares outstanding. The Offer is not contingent upon any number of Rights being exercised. The subscription period commences on                      and ends at                     , on                     , unless otherwise extended (the “Expiration Date”). See “The Offer—Important Terms of the Offer.”

 

[The Fund expects to declare a monthly common share distribution in                     . Such distribution will not be payable with respect to Shares that are issued pursuant to the Offer after the record date for such distribution.]

 

The Fund will bear the expenses of the Offer and all such expenses will be borne indirectly by the Fund’s Common Shareholders, including those who do not exercise their Rights. These expenses include, but are not limited to, [the dealer manager fee and reimbursement of dealer manager expenses], the expenses of preparing, printing and mailing the prospectus and Rights subscription materials for the Offer and the expenses of Fund counsel and the Fund’s independent registered public accounting firm in connection with the Offer.

Important Dates to Remember   

Record Date:

 

Subscription Period:         *

 

Final Date Rights Will Trade:        *

 

Expiration Date and Pricing Date:        *

 

Payment for Shares or Notice of Guarantees of Delivery Due:

 

Payment for Guarantees of Delivery Due:

 

Confirmation Mailed to Participants:

 

Final Payment for Shares Due:        †

 

*  Unless the Offer is extended.

†  See “The Offer––Payment for Shares.”

 



 

S-1


Subscription Price    The subscription price for the Shares (the “Subscription Price”) will be determined based on a formula equal to                      (the “Formula Price”). Because the Expiration Date of the subscription period will be (unless the subscription period is extended), Rights holders may not know the Subscription Price at the time of exercise and will be required initially to pay for both the Shares subscribed for pursuant to the primary subscription [and, if eligible, any additional Shares subscribed for pursuant to the over-subscription privilege] at the estimated Subscription Price of $                 per Share and, except in limited circumstances, will not be able to rescind their subscription. See “The Offer—Subscription Price.”
[Oversubscription Privilege    Record Date Shareholders who exercise all the Rights issued to them (other than those Rights that cannot be exercised because they represent the right to acquire less than one Share) are entitled to subscribe for additional Shares at the same Subscription Price pursuant to the over-subscription privilege, subject to certain limitations and subject to allotment. If sufficient remaining Shares are available following the primary subscription, all Record Date Shareholders’ over-subscription requests will be honored in full. Investors who are not Record Date Shareholders, but who otherwise acquire Rights pursuant to the Offer, are not entitled to subscribe for any Shares pursuant to the over-subscription privilege. If sufficient Shares are not available to honor all over-subscription requests, unsubscribed Shares will be allocated pro rata among those Record Date Shareholders who over-subscribe based on the number of common shares of the Fund they owned on the Record Date. See “The Offer—Over-Subscription Privilege.”]
[Sale and Transferability of Rights   

The Rights will be, subject to notice of issuance, admitted for trading on                      under the symbol      during the course of the Offer. Trading in the Rights on the                      may be conducted until the close of trading on the      on the last business day prior to the Expiration Date. The Fund will use its best efforts to ensure that an adequate trading market for the Rights will exist, although there can be no assurance that a market for the Rights will develop. Assuming a market exists for the Rights, the Rights may be purchased and sold through usual brokerage channels or sold through the Subscription Agent.

 

Record Date Shareholders who do not wish to exercise any of the Rights issued to them pursuant to the Offer may instruct the Subscription Agent to try to sell any unexercised Rights. Although the Rights are expected to trade on the      through the last business day prior to the Expiration Date, Subscription certificates representing the Rights to be sold through the Subscription Agent must be received by the Subscription Agent by 5:00 p.m., Eastern time, on                      (or, if the subscription period is extended, by 5:00 p.m., Eastern time, on the      business day prior to the extended Expiration Date). Upon the timely receipt by the Subscription Agent of appropriate instructions to sell Rights, the Subscription Agent will ask the Dealer Manager it if will purchase the Rights. If the Dealer Manager purchases the Rights, the sales price paid by the Dealer Manager will be based upon the then-current market price for the Rights. If the Dealer Manager declines to purchase the Rights of a Record Date Shareholder that have been duly submitted to the Subscription Agent for sale, the Subscription Agent will attempt to sell such Rights in the open market.

 

Alternatively, the Rights evidenced by a subscription certificate may be transferred until the Expiration Date in whole or in part by endorsing the subscription certificate for transfer in accordance with the accompanying instructions. See “The Offer—Sale and Transferability of Rights.”]

 



 

S-2


Method for Exercising Rights

  

Rights are evidenced by subscription certificates that will be mailed to Record Date Shareholders (except as described below under “The Offer—Requirements for Foreign Shareholders”) or, if their common shares are held by Cede & Co. or any other depository or nominee, to Cede & Co. or such other depository or nominee. Rights may be exercised by completing and signing the subscription certificate and mailing it in the envelope provided, or otherwise delivering the completed and signed subscription certificate to the Subscription Agent, together with payment in full of the estimated Subscription Price for the Shares subscribed for. Completed subscription certificates and payments must be received by the Subscription Agent by                     , on the Expiration Date at the offices of the Subscription Agent. Rights also may be exercised by contacting your broker, banker, trust company or other intermediary, which can arrange, on your behalf, to guarantee delivery of payment and of a properly completed and executed subscription certificate. A fee may be charged for this service by your broker, bank, trust company or other intermediary. In addition, your broker, bank, trust company or other intermediary may impose a deadline for exercising Rights earlier than 5:00 p.m., Eastern time, on the Expiration Date. See “The Offer—Method for Exercising Rights” and “The Offer—Payment for Shares.”

 

Rights holders who have exercised their Rights will have no right to rescind their subscription after receipt by the Subscription Agent of the completed subscription certificate together with payment for Shares subscribed for, except as described under “The Offer.”

Requirements for Foreign Shareholders

   Subscription certificates will not be mailed to Record Date Shareholders whose addresses are outside the United States (for these purposes, the United States includes the District of Columbia and the territories and possessions of the United States) (“Foreign Shareholders”). The Subscription Agent will send a letter via regular mail to Foreign Shareholders to notify them of the Offer. The Rights of Foreign Shareholders will be held by the Subscription Agent for their accounts until instructions are received to exercise the Rights. If instructions have not been received by                     , on             ,          business days prior to the Expiration Date (or, if the subscription period is extended, on or before the      business day prior to the extended Expiration Date), the Subscription Agent will ask the Dealer Manager if it will purchase the Rights of Foreign Shareholders. If the Dealer Manager declines to purchase the Rights, the Subscription Agent will attempt to sell such Rights in the open market. The net proceeds, if any, from the sale of those Rights will be remitted to these Foreign Shareholders.

U.S. Federal Income Tax Considerations

   We urge you to consult your own tax adviser with respect to the particular tax consequences of the Offer. See “Terms of the Offer—U.S. Federal Income Tax Considerations” for more information on the tax consequences of the Offer.

[Distribution Arrangements

                        (the “Dealer Manager”) will act as Dealer Manager for this Offer. Under the terms and subject to the conditions contained in the Dealer Manager Agreement among the Dealer Manager, the Fund and the Investment Adviser, the Dealer Manager will provide financial structuring services in connection with the Offer and will solicit the exercise of Rights and participation in the over-subscription privilege. The Fund has agreed to

 



 

S-3


  

pay the Dealer Manager a fee for its financial structuring and soliciting services equal to     % of the aggregate Subscription Price for the Shares issued pursuant to the exercise of Rights and the over-subscription privilege. The fees paid to the Dealer Manager and other expenses of the Offer will be borne by the Fund and indirectly by all of its Common Shareholders, including those who do not exercise their Rights. The Dealer Manager will reallow a portion of its fees to other broker-dealers who have assisted in soliciting the exercise of Rights. The Fund and the Investment Adviser have each agreed to indemnify the Dealer Manager for losses arising out of certain liabilities, including liabilities under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the “Securities Act”).

 

Prior to the expiration of the Offer, the Dealer Manager may independently offer for sale Shares it has acquired through purchasing and exercising the Rights, at prices it sets. Although the Dealer Manager may realize gains and losses in connection with purchases and sales of Shares, such offering of Shares is intended by the Dealer Manager to facilitate the Offer, and any such gains or losses are not expected to be material to the Dealer Manager. The Dealer Manager’s fee for its financial structuring and soliciting services is independent of any gains or losses that may be realized by the Dealer Manager through the purchase and exercise of the Rights and the sale of Shares. See “The Offer—Distribution Arrangements.”]

Investment Adviser

  

The Fund’s investments are managed by its Cushing ® Asset Management, LP (the “Investment Adviser”), whose principal business address is 8117 Preston Road, Suite 440, Dallas, Texas 75225. The Investment Adviser serves as investment adviser to registered and unregistered funds, which invest primarily in securities of MLPs and other Energy Companies. The Investment Adviser continues to seek to expand its platform of energy-related investment products, leveraging extensive industry contacts and significant research depth to drive both passive and actively managed investment opportunities for individual and institutional investors. The Investment Adviser seeks to identify and exploit investment niches that it believes are generally less understood and less followed by the broader investor community.

 

The Investment Adviser considers itself one of the principal professional institutional investors in the energy sector based on the following:

 

•       An investment team with extensive experience in analysis, portfolio management, risk management, and private securities transactions.

 

•       A focus on bottom-up, fundamental analysis performed by its experienced investment team is core to the Investment Adviser’s investment process.

 

•       The investment team’s wide range of professional backgrounds, market knowledge, industry relationships, and experience in the analysis, financing, and structuring of energy income investments give the Investment Adviser insight into, and the ability to identify and capitalize on, investment opportunities.

 

Its central location in Dallas, Texas and proximity to major players and assets in the energy sector.

Benefits to the Investment Adviser

   The Investment Adviser will benefit from the Offer, in part, because the investment management fee paid by the Fund to the Investment Adviser is based on “Managed Assets” of the Fund. It is not possible to state precisely

 



 

S-4


   the amount of additional compensation the Investment Adviser will receive as a result of the Offer because it is not known how many Shares of the Fund will be subscribed for and because the proceeds of the Offer will be invested in additional portfolio securities which will fluctuate in value. However, assuming (i) all Rights are exercised, (ii) the Fund’s average net asset value during the twelve-month period beginning                      is $                 per common share (the net asset value per common share on                 ) (iii) the Subscription Price is $                 per Share , and (iv) for purposes of this example, the Fund increases the amount of leverage it has outstanding (through the use of reverse repurchase agreements) while maintaining approximately the same percentage of total assets attributable to leverage, and after giving effect to the Dealer Manager fee and other estimated offering expenses, the Investment Adviser would receive additional investment management fees of approximately $        , for the twelve-month period beginning                     , and would continue to receive additional investment management fees, as a result of the Offer, based on the Fund’s Managed Assets attributable to the Shares issued in the Offer and related additional leverage, thereafter.

Listing and Symbol

   The Fund’s currently outstanding Common Shares are, and the Common Shares offered by this Prospectus, will be, subject to notice of issuance, listed on the New York Stock Exchange (the “NYSE”) under the symbol “SZC.” As of                     , the last reported sale price for the Fund’s Common Shares on the NYSE was $                 per Common Share, and the net asset value of the Fund’s Common Shares was $                 per Common Share, representing a [premium/discount] to net asset value of     %. [The Subscription Rights for Common Shares offered by this Prospectus Supplement and the accompanying Prospectus, will be, subject to notice of issuance, admitted for trading on the                      under the symbol “                    ” during the course of the offer. Trading in the Rights on the                      may be conducted until the close of business on the                      on the last business day prior to the expiration date.]

Risks

   See “Risks” beginning on page      of this Prospectus Supplement and page      of the accompanying Prospectus for a discussion of factors you should consider carefully before deciding to invest in the Fund’s Common Shares.

Use of Proceeds

  

The Fund estimates the net proceeds of the Offering to be approximately $        . This figure is based on the Subscription Price per Common Share of $                 and assumes all new Common Shares offered are sold and that the expenses related to the Offering, estimated at approximately $        , are paid.

 

The Fund intends to invest the net proceeds of the offering in accordance with its investment objective and policies as stated in the accompanying Prospectus. It is currently anticipated that the Fund will be able to invest substantially all of the net proceeds of the offering in accordance with its investment objective and policies within      months after the completion of the offering. Pending such investment, it is anticipated that the proceeds will be invested in cash, cash equivalents or other securities, including U.S. government securities or high quality, short-term debt securities. The Fund may also use the proceeds for working capital purposes, including the payment of distributions, interest and operating expenses, although the Fund currently has no intent to issue Securities primarily for these purposes.

 



 

S-5


SUMMARY OF FUND EXPENSES

The following table contains information about the costs and expenses that Common Shareholders will bear directly or indirectly. The table is based on the capital structure of the Fund as of                      (except as noted below) after giving effect to the Offering, assuming that the Offer is fully subscribed resulting in the receipt of net proceeds from the Offer of approximately $         million. If the Fund issues fewer Shares in the Offer and the net proceeds to the Fund are less, all other things being equal, the total annual expenses shown would increase. The purpose of the table and the example below is to help you understand the fees and expenses that you, as a holder of Common Shares, would bear directly or indirectly.

Shareholder Transaction Expenses

 

Sales load (as a percentage of offering price)

          % (1)  

Offering expenses borne by the Fund (as a percentage of offering price)

          % (2)  

Automatic Dividend Reinvestment Plan fees

     None  

Annual Expenses

 

     Percentage of Net
Assets Attributable to  Common
Shares (3)
 

Management fees (4)

                     

Interest expense (5)

                     

Other expenses (6)

                     

Total annual expenses (7)

                     

 

(1)   The Dealer Manager will receive a fee for its financial structuring and soliciting services equal to     % of the aggregate Subscription Price for Shares issued pursuant to the Offer. The Dealer Manager will reallow to broker-dealers in the selling group to be formed and managed by the Dealer Manager selling fees equal to     % of the Subscription Price per Share for each Share issued pursuant to the Offer as a result of their selling efforts. In addition, the Dealer Manager will reallow to other broker-dealers that have executed and delivered a soliciting dealer agreement and have solicited the exercise of Rights solicitation fees equal to     % of the Subscription Price per Share for each Share issued pursuant to the exercise of Rights as a result of their soliciting efforts, subject to a maximum fee based on the number of Shares held by each broker-dealer through The Depository Trust Company (“DTC”) on the Record Date.
(2) The fees and expenses of the Offer will be borne by the Fund and indirectly by all of its Common Shareholders, including those who do not exercise their Rights.
(3)   Based on net assets attributable to Common Shares during the period ended                     .
(4) The Fund pays the Adviser an annual fee, payable monthly, in an amount equal to 1.25% of the Fund’s average daily Managed Assets (net assets plus any assets attributable to Financial Leverage). The fee shown above is based upon outstanding Financial Leverage of     % of the Fund’s Managed Assets. If Financial Leverage of more than     % of the Fund’s Managed Assets is used, the management fees shown would be higher. Management fees calculated based on management fees earned for the year ended                      divided by average net assets attributable to Common Shareholders for the period ended                     .
(5)   Based upon the Fund’s outstanding borrowings as of                      of approximately $         million and the borrowing rate on the facility as of                     , of     %.
(6)   Other expenses are estimated based upon those incurred during the fiscal year ended                     .
(7) The Investment Adviser has agreed to waive a portion of the management fee in an amount equal to     % of the Fund’s Managed Assets through                     . After giving effect to this waiver, the Fund’s net total annual expenses are     %.

Example

As required by relevant SEC regulations, the following Example illustrates the expenses that you would pay on a $1,000 investment in Common Shares, assuming (1) “Total annual expenses” of     % of net assets

 

S-6


attributable to Common Shares, (2) the sales load of $         and estimated offering expenses of $        , and (3) a 5% annual return*:

 

     1 Year      3 Years      5 Years      10 Years  

Total Expenses Incurred

   $                   $                   $                   $               

 

* The Example should not be considered a representation of future expenses or returns. Actual expenses may be higher or lower than those assumed . Moreover, the Fund’s actual rate of return may be higher or lower than the hypothetical 5% return shown in the Example. The Example assumes that all dividends and distributions are reinvested at net asset value.

 

S-7


CAPITALIZATION

The following table sets forth the Fund’s capitalization at                     :

 

  (i) on a historical basis;

 

  (ii) on an as adjusted basis to reflect the issuance of an aggregate of                  Common Shares pursuant to the Fund’s Automatic Dividend Reinvestment Plan, and the application of the net proceeds from such issuances of Common Shares; and

 

  (iii) on an as further adjusted basis to reflect the assumed sale of                      of Rights to purchase Common Shares at a price of $                 per share in an offering under this Prospectus Supplement and the accompanying Prospectus less the [aggregate underwriting discount of $         and] estimated offering expenses payable by the Fund of $        .

 

    Actual     As
Adjusted (unaudited)
    As Further
Adjusted (unaudited)
 

Short-Term Debt:

     

Borrowings

  $                  $                  $               

Common Shareholder’s Equity:

     

Common Shares of beneficial interest, par value $0.01 per share; unlimited shares authorized,                  shares issued and outstanding (actual),                  shares issued and outstanding (as adjusted), and                  shares issued and outstanding (as further adjusted)

     

Additional paid-in capital

     

Net unrealized appreciation on investments, net of tax

     

Accumulated net realized gain on investments, net of tax

     

Accumulated net investment loss, net of tax

     

Net assets

     

 

S-8


USE OF PROCEEDS

The Fund estimates the net proceeds of the Offering to be approximately $        . This figure is based on the Subscription Price per Common Share of $                 and assumes all new Common Shares offered are sold and that the expenses related to the Offering, estimated at approximately $        , are paid.

The Fund intends to invest the net proceeds of the offering in accordance with its investment objective and policies as stated in the accompanying Prospectus. It is currently anticipated that the Fund will be able to invest substantially all of the net proceeds of the offering in accordance with its investment objective and policies within      months after the completion of the offering. Pending such investment, it is anticipated that the proceeds will be invested in cash, cash equivalents or other securities, including U.S. government securities or high quality, short-term debt securities. The Fund may also use the proceeds for working capital purposes, including the payment of distributions, interest and operating expenses, although the Fund currently has no intent to issue Securities primarily for these purposes.

RECENT DEVELOPMENTS

[TO COME, IF ANY]

TERMS OF THE OFFER

Purpose of the Offer

[TO COME]

The Offer may not be successful. The completion of the Offer may result in an immediate dilution of the net asset value per common share for all existing Common Shareholders, including those who fully exercise their Rights (as defined below).

Important Terms of The Offer

The Fund is issuing [transferable/non-transferable] rights (“Rights”) to its Common Shareholders of record (“Record Date Shareholders”) as of                     , Eastern time, on          (the “Record Date”), entitling the holders of those Rights to subscribe for up to an aggregate of                      of the Fund’s common shares (the “Shares”) (the “Offer”). Record Date Shareholders will receive one Right for each outstanding whole common share of the Fund held on the Record Date. The Rights entitle their holders to purchase one Share for every                      Rights held (1-for-        ). Fractional Shares will not be issued upon the exercise of Rights; accordingly, Rights may be exercised only in integer multiples of                     , except that any Record Date Shareholder who is issued fewer than                      Rights may subscribe, at the Subscription Price (as defined on the next page), for one full Share. Assuming the exercise of all Rights, the Offer will result in an approximately     % increase in the Fund’s common shares outstanding.

[Record Date Shareholders who exercise all the Rights issued to them (other than those Rights that cannot be exercised because they represent the right to acquire less than one Share) are entitled to subscribe for additional Shares at the same Subscription Price pursuant to the over-subscription privilege, subject to certain limitations and subject to allotment. Investors who are not Record Date Shareholders, but who otherwise acquire Rights to purchase Shares pursuant to the Offer, are not entitled to subscribe for any Shares pursuant to the over-subscription privilege. See “—Over-Subscription Privilege” below. The distribution to Record Date Shareholders of transferable Rights may afford non-participating Record Date Shareholders the opportunity to sell their Rights for some cash value, receipt of which may be viewed as partial compensation for any economic dilution of their interests resulting from the Offer.]

The subscription period commences on                      and ends at                     , Eastern time, on                     , unless otherwise extended (the “Expiration Date”).

 

S-9


The Fund expects to declare a monthly distribution in                     . Such distribution will not be payable with respect to Shares that are issued pursuant to the Offer after the record date for such distribution.

For purposes of determining the maximum number of Shares a Rights holder may acquire pursuant to the Offer, broker-dealers, trust companies, banks or others whose shares are held of record by Cede & Co., the nominee for the Depository Trust Company (“DTC”), or by any other depository or nominee, will be deemed to be the holders of the Rights that are held by Cede & Co. or such other depository or nominee on their behalf.

[The Rights are transferable and, subject to notice of issuance, will be admitted for trading on                      under the symbol “    ” during the course of the Offer. Trading in the Rights on the                      may be conducted until the close of trading on                      on the last business day prior to the Expiration Date. See “—Sale and Transferability of Rights.” The Shares, once issued, will be listed on the                      under the symbol “    ” The Rights will be evidenced by subscription certificates which will be mailed to Record Date Shareholders, except as discussed under “—Requirements for Foreign Shareholders.”]

Rights may be exercised by filling in and signing the subscription certificate and mailing it in the envelope provided, or otherwise delivering the completed and signed subscription certificate to                                         , the subscription agent for the Offer (the “Subscription Agent”), together with payment at the estimated Subscription Price for the Shares subscribed for. For a discussion of the method by which Rights may be exercised and Shares may be paid for, see “—Method for Exercising Rights” and “—Payment for Shares.”

[The Fund has retained                      (                     “Dealer Manager”) to provide the Fund with financial structuring and soliciting services relating to the Offer, including advice with respect to the structure, timing and terms of the Offer. In determining the structure of the Offer, the Board considered, among other things, using a fixed-pricing versus a variable-pricing mechanism, the benefits and drawbacks of conducting a non-transferable versus a transferable rights offering, the anticipated effect on the Fund and its existing Common Shareholders if the Offer is not fully subscribed, the anticipated dilutive effects on the Fund and its existing Common Shareholders of the Offer and the experience of the Dealer Manager in conducting rights offerings. The Board also considered that the Investment Adviser would benefit from the Offer because the advisory fee paid to the Investment Adviser is based on the Fund’s Managed Assets, which would increase as a result of the Offer. See “—Benefits to the Investment Adviser.”]

Important Dates to Remember

 

Record Date:

       

Subscription Period:                      through

     *       

Final Date Rights Will Trade on the Exchange:

     *       

Expiration Date and Pricing Date:

     *       

Payment for Shares Due or Notices of Guarantees of Delivery Due:

        *    

Payment for Guarantees of Delivery Due:

        *    

Confirmation Mailed to Participants:

     *       

Final Payment for Shares Due:

     * †      

 

* Unless the Offer is extended.
See “—Payment for Shares.”

 

S-10


Subscription Price

The subscription price for the Shares (the “Subscription Price”) will be determined based on a formula equal to                                          (the “Formula Price”). In each case, net asset value will be calculated as of the close of trading on the NYSE on the applicable day.

Because the Expiration Date of the subscription period will be                                          (unless the subscription period is extended), Rights holders may not know the Subscription Price at the time of exercise and will be required initially to pay for both the Shares subscribed for pursuant to the primary subscription [and, if eligible, any additional Shares subscribed for pursuant to the over-subscription privilege] at the estimated Subscription Price of $                 per Share. See “—Payment for Shares.” A Rights holder will have no right to rescind his subscription after the Subscription Agent has received a completed subscription certificate together with payment for the Shares subscribed for, except as provided under “—Notice of Net Asset Value Decline.” The Fund does not have the right to withdraw the Rights or to cancel the Offer after the Rights have been distributed.

The net asset value per share of the Fund’s common shares at the close of business on                      (the last trading date prior to the date of this prospectus on which the Fund determined its net asset value) was $        , and the last reported sale price of a common share on the NYSE on that day was $        .

[Over-Subscription Privilege

Record Date Shareholders who exercise all the Rights issued to them (other than those Rights that cannot be exercised because they represent the right to acquire less than one Share) are entitled to subscribe for additional Shares that were not subscribed for by other holders of Rights at the same Subscription Price pursuant to the over-subscription privilege, subject to certain limitations and subject to allotment. If sufficient remaining Shares are available following the primary subscription, all Record Date Shareholders’ over-subscription requests will be honored in full. Investors who are not Record Date Shareholders, but who otherwise acquire Rights pursuant to the Offer, are not entitled to subscribe for any Shares pursuant to the over-subscription privilege. If sufficient Shares are not available to honor all over-subscription requests, unsubscribed Shares will be allocated pro rata among those Record Date Shareholders who over-subscribe based on the number of common shares of the Fund they owned on the Record Date. The allocation process may involve a series of allocations in order to ensure that the total number of Shares available for over-subscriptions is distributed on a pro rata basis.

Record Date Shareholders who are fully exercising their Rights during the subscription period should indicate, on the subscription certificate that they submit with respect to the exercise of the Rights issued to them, how many Shares they desire to acquire pursuant to the over-subscription privilege.

Banks, broker-dealers, trustees and other nominee holders of Rights will be required to certify to the Subscription Agent, before any over-subscription privilege may be exercised with respect to any particular beneficial owner, as to the aggregate number of Rights exercised during the subscription period and the number of Shares subscribed for pursuant to the over-subscription privilege by such beneficial owner, and that such beneficial owner’s primary subscription was exercised in full. Nominee holder over-subscription forms will be distributed to banks, brokers, trustees and other nominee holders of Rights with the subscription certificates.

The Fund will not offer or sell any Shares that are not subscribed for during the subscription period or pursuant to the over-subscription privilege.

The Fund has been advised that one or more of the officers or employees of the Adviser may exercise all of the Rights initially issued to them and may request additional Shares pursuant to the over-subscription privilege. An exercise of the over-subscription privilege by such persons will increase their proportionate voting power and share of the Fund’s assets.]

 

S-11


[Sale and Transferability of Rights

The Rights will be, subject to notice of issuance, admitted for trading on                      under the symbol “                    ” during the course of the Offer. Trading in the Rights on                      may be conducted until the close of trading on                      on the last business day prior to the Expiration Date. The Fund will use its best efforts to ensure that an adequate trading market for the Rights will exist, although there can be no assurance that a market for the Rights will develop. Assuming a market exists for the Rights, the Rights may be purchased and sold through usual brokerage channels or sold through the Subscription Agent.

Sales through the Subscription Agent. Record Date Shareholders who do not wish to exercise any or all of the Rights issued to them pursuant to the Offer may instruct the Subscription Agent to try to sell any unexercised Rights. Although the Rights are expected to trade on through the last business day prior to the Expiration Date, subscription certificates representing the Rights to be sold by the Subscription Agent must be received by the Subscription Agent on or before 5:00 p.m., Eastern time, on                      (or, if the subscription period is extended, by 5:00 p.m., Eastern time, on the                      business day prior to the extended Expiration Date).

Upon the timely receipt by the Subscription Agent of appropriate instructions to sell Rights, the Subscription Agent will ask the Dealer Manager if it will purchase the Rights. The sale price of any Rights sold to the Dealer Manager will be based upon the then-current market price for the Rights. The proceeds from each of such sales to the Dealer Manager will be remitted to the Subscription Agent, which will hold such proceeds in an account segregated from the Subscription Agent’s own funds pending distribution to each selling Record Date Shareholder. It is expected that following each such sale of Rights to the Dealer Manager, the proceeds from each such sale will be received by the Subscription Agent within      business days of the sale and that the proceeds will then be remitted to the selling Record Date Shareholder within      business days following the Expiration Date by the Subscription Agent.

If the Dealer Manager declines to purchase the Rights of a Record Date Shareholder that have been duly submitted to the Subscription Agent for sale, the Subscription Agent will attempt to sell such Rights in the open market. If the Rights can be sold in such manner, all of such sales will be deemed to have been effected at the weighted-average price of all Rights sold by the Subscription Agent in such open market transactions throughout the subscription period. The proceeds from such sales will be held by the Subscription Agent in an account segregated from the Subscription Agent’s own funds pending distribution to the selling Record Date Shareholders. It is expected that the proceeds of such open market sales will be remitted by the Subscription Agent to the selling Record Date Shareholders within      business days following the Expiration Date.

The Subscription Agent will also attempt to sell (either to the Dealer Manager or in open market transactions) all Rights that remain unclaimed as a result of subscription certificates being returned by the postal authorities to the Subscription Agent as undeliverable as of the      business day prior to the Expiration Date. The Subscription Agent will hold the proceeds from those sales for the benefit of those non-claiming Common Shareholders until the proceeds are either claimed or revert to their state of residence.

There can be no assurance that the Subscription Agent will be able to complete the sale of any Rights, and neither the Fund nor the Subscription Agent have guaranteed any minimum sale price for the Rights. If a Record Date Shareholder does not utilize the services of the Subscription Agent and chooses to use another broker-dealer or other financial institution to sell Rights issued to that shareholder pursuant to the Offer, then the other broker-dealer or financial institution may charge a fee to sell the Rights.

Other Transfers . The Rights evidenced by a subscription certificate may be transferred in whole by endorsing the subscription certificate for transfer in accordance with the instructions accompanying the subscription certificate. A portion of the Rights evidenced by a single subscription certificate (but not fractional Rights) may be transferred by delivering to the Subscription Agent a subscription certificate properly endorsed for transfer, with instructions to register such portion of the Rights evidenced thereby in the name of the transferee and to issue a new subscription certificate to the transferee evidencing the transferred Rights. If this occurs, a new subscription certificate evidencing the balance of the Rights, if any, will be issued to the Record Date Shareholder or, if the Record Date Shareholder so instructs, to an additional transferee. The signature on the subscription certificate must correspond with the name as written upon the face of the subscription certificate in every particular, without alteration or enlargement or any other change. A signature guarantee must be provided by an “eligible guarantor institution” (as defined in Rule 17Ad-15 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934).

 

S-12


Record Date Shareholders wishing to transfer all or a portion of their Rights should allow at least      business days prior to the Expiration Date for: (i) the transfer instructions to be received and processed by the Subscription Agent; (ii) a new subscription certificate to be issued and transmitted to the transferee or transferees with respect to transferred Rights and to the transferor with respect to retained Rights, if any; and (iii) the Rights evidenced by the new subscription certificate to be exercised or sold by the recipients of the subscription certificate. Neither the Fund nor the Subscription Agent nor the Dealer Manager shall have any liability to a transferee or transferor of Rights if subscription certificates are not received in time for exercise or sale prior to the Expiration Date.

Except for the fees charged by                                         , the information agent for the Offer (the “Information Agent”), the Subscription Agent and the Dealer Manager (which are expected to be paid from the proceeds of the Offer by the Fund), all commissions, fees and other expenses (including brokerage commissions and transfer taxes) incurred or charged in connection with the purchase, sale or transfer of Rights will be for the account of the transferor of the Rights, and none of these commissions, fees or other expenses will be paid by the Fund, the Investment Adviser, the Information Agent, the Subscription Agent or the Dealer Manager. Rights holders who wish to purchase, sell, exercise or transfer Rights through a broker, bank or other party should first inquire about any fees and expenses that the holder will incur in connection with the transactions.

The Fund anticipates that the Rights will be eligible for transfer through, and that the exercise of the primary subscription and the over-subscription may be effected through, the facilities of DTC or the Subscription Agent until 5:00 p.m., Eastern time, on the Expiration Date. Your broker, bank, trust company or other intermediary may impose a deadline for transferring Rights earlier than 5:00 p.m. Eastern time, on the Expiration Date.]

Method for Exercising Rights

Rights are evidenced by subscription certificates that will be mailed to Record Date Shareholders (except as described under “—Requirements for Foreign Shareholders” below) or, if their common shares are held by Cede & Co. or any other depository or nominee on their behalf, to Cede & Co. or such other depository or nominee. Rights may be exercised by completing and signing the subscription certificate and mailing it in the envelope provided, or otherwise delivering the completed and signed subscription certificate to the Subscription Agent, together with payment in full at the estimated Subscription Price for the Shares subscribed for by the Expiration Date as described under “—Payment For Shares.” Rights may also be exercised by contacting your broker, banker, trust company or other intermediary, which can arrange, on your behalf, to guarantee delivery of payment and of a properly completed and executed subscription certificate pursuant to a notice of guaranteed delivery by the close of business on the      business day after the Expiration Date. A fee may be charged for this service. Completed subscription certificates and payments must be received by the Subscription Agent by                     , Eastern time, on the Expiration Date (unless delivery of subscription certificate and payment is effected by means of a notice of guaranteed delivery as described below under “—Payment for Shares”) at the offices of the Subscription Agent at one of the addresses set forth below under “—Subscription Agent.” Your broker, bank, trust company or other intermediary may impose a deadline for transferring Rights earlier than 5:00 p.m. Eastern time, on the Expiration Date. Fractional Shares will not be issued upon exercise of Rights.

Shareholders who are Record Owners . Shareholders who are record owners of common shares can choose between either option set forth under “—Payment For Shares.” If time is of the essence, option (2) will permit delivery of the subscription certificate and payment after the Expiration Date.

Investors whose Common Shares are Held by a Nominee . Investors whose common shares are held by a nominee, such as a bank, broker, trustee or other intermediary, must contact that nominee to exercise their Rights. In that case, the nominee will complete the subscription certificate on behalf of the investor and arrange for proper payment by one of the methods set forth below under “—Payment For Shares.”

Nominees . Nominees, such as banks, brokers, trustees or depositories for securities, who hold common shares of the Fund for the account of others should notify the respective beneficial owners of such common shares as

 

S-13


soon as possible to ascertain those beneficial owners’ intentions and to obtain instructions with respect to the Rights. If the beneficial owner so instructs, the nominee should complete the subscription certificate and submit it to the Subscription Agent with the proper payment as described under “—Payment For Shares.”

[Banks, brokers, trustees and other nominee holders of Rights will be required to certify to the Subscription Agent, before any over-subscription privilege may be exercised with respect to any particular beneficial owner who is a Record Date Shareholder, as to the aggregate number of Rights exercised during the subscription period and the number of Shares subscribed for pursuant to the over-subscription privilege by the beneficial owner, and that the beneficial owner exercised all the Rights issued to it pursuant to the Offer.]

Requirements for Foreign Shareholders. Subscription certificates will not be mailed to Record Date Shareholders whose addresses are outside the United States (for these purposes, the United States includes the District of Columbia and the territories and possessions of the United States) (“Foreign Shareholders”). The Subscription Agent will send a letter via regular mail to Foreign Shareholders to notify them of the Offer. The Rights of Foreign Shareholders will be held by the Subscription Agent for their accounts until instructions are received to exercise the Rights. If instructions have not been received by                     , Eastern time, on             ,         business days prior to the Expiration Date (or, if the subscription period is extended, on or before the      business day prior to the extended Expiration Date), the Subscription Agent will ask the Dealer Manager if it will purchase the Rights. If the Dealer Manager declines to purchase the Rights, the Subscription Agent will attempt to sell such Rights in the open market. The net proceeds, if any, from the sale of those Rights will be remitted to those Foreign Shareholders.

Subscription Agent

                     is the Subscription Agent for the Offer. The Subscription Agent will receive for its administrative, processing, invoicing and other services a fee estimated to be approximately $        , plus reimbursement for all out-of-pocket expenses related to the Offer. The fees and expenses of the Subscription Agent are included in the fees and expenses of the Offer and therefore will be borne by the Fund and indirectly by all Common Shareholders, including those who do not exercise their Rights. Questions regarding the subscription certificates should be directed by mail to                                                              . Shareholders may also subscribe for the Offer by contacting their broker dealer, trust company, bank or other nominee.

Completed subscription certificates must be sent together with proper payment of the estimated Subscription Price for all Shares subscribed for in the primary subscription and the over-subscription privilege (for Record Date Shareholders) to the Subscription Agent by one of the methods described below. Alternatively, Rights holders may arrange for their financial intermediaries to send notices of guaranteed delivery by facsimile to DTC to be received by the Subscription Agent prior to                                         , Eastern time, on the Expiration Date. Facsimiles should be confirmed by telephone at DTC. The Fund will accept only properly completed and executed subscription certificates actually received at any of the addresses listed below, prior to                     , Eastern time, on the Expiration Date, or by the close of business on the      business day after the Expiration Date following timely receipt of a notice of guaranteed delivery. See “—Payment for Shares.”

 

Subscription Certificate Delivery Method

  

Address/Number

Notice of Guaranteed Delivery:    Contact your broker-dealer, trust company, bank or other nominee to notify the Fund of your intent to exercise the Rights.
First Class Mail Only   
(No Express Mail or Overnight Courier):   
Hand:   
Express Mail or Overnight Courier:   

 

S-14


The Fund will honor only subscription certificates received by the Subscription Agent prior to                     , Eastern Time, on the Expiration Date at one of the addresses listed above. Delivery to an address other than those listed above will not constitute good delivery.

Information Agent

The Information Agent for the Offer is                     . If you have questions or need further information about the Offer, please write the Information Agent at                                                               or call                     . Any questions or requests for assistance concerning the method of subscribing for Shares or additional copies of this prospectus or subscription certificates should be directed to the Information Agent. Shareholders may also contact their brokers or nominees for information with respect to the Offer.

The Information Agent will receive a fee estimated to be approximately $         for its services, plus reimbursement for all out-of-pocket expenses related to the Offer. The fees and expenses of the Information Agent are included in the fees and expenses of the Offer and therefore will be borne by the Fund and indirectly by all of its Common Shareholders, including those who do not exercise their Rights.

Expiration of the Offer

The Offer will expire at                     , Eastern time, on                     , unless the Fund extends the subscription period. Rights will expire on the Expiration Date and may not be exercised after that date. If the Fund extends the subscription period, the Fund will make an announcement as promptly as practicable. This announcement will be issued no later than 9:00 a.m., Eastern time, on the next business day following the previously scheduled Expiration Date. Without limiting the manner in which the Fund may choose to make this announcement, the Fund will not, unless otherwise required by law, have any obligation to publish, advertise or otherwise communicate this announcement other than by making a release to the Dow Jones News Service or any other means of public announcement as the Fund may deem proper.

Payment for Shares

Rights holders who wish to acquire Shares pursuant to the Offer may choose between the following methods of payment:

(1)    A Rights holder can send the properly completed and executed subscription certificate together with payment for the Shares subscribed for during the subscription period [and, if eligible, for any additional Shares subscribed for pursuant to the over-subscription privilege] to the Subscription Agent based upon an estimated Subscription Price of $                 per Share. A subscription will be accepted when payment, together with the executed subscription certificate, is received by the Subscription Agent at one of the addresses set forth under “—Subscription Agent”, the payment and the properly completed and executed subscription certificate must be received by the Subscription Agent by                     , Eastern time, on the Expiration Date. The Subscription Agent will deposit all checks received by it for the purchase of Shares into a segregated interest-bearing account of the Fund (the interest from which will belong to the Fund) pending proration and distribution of Shares. A payment pursuant to this method must be in U.S. dollars by money order or check drawn on a bank located in the United States, must be payable to                                          and must accompany a properly completed and executed subscription certificate for such subscription to be accepted.

(2)    Alternatively, a subscription will be accepted by the Subscription Agent if, by                     , Eastern time, on the Expiration Date, the Subscription Agent has received a notice of guaranteed delivery by facsimile (telecopy) or otherwise from a bank, a trust company or an NYSE member guaranteeing delivery of (i) payment of the full Subscription Price at the estimated Subscription Price for the Shares subscribed for during the subscription period and, if eligible, any additional Shares subscribed for pursuant to the over-subscription privilege and (ii) a properly completed and executed subscription certificate. The Subscription Agent will not honor a notice of guaranteed delivery unless a properly completed and executed subscription certificate and full payment for the Shares at the estimated Subscription Price are received by the Subscription Agent by the close of business on the      business day after the Expiration Date.

 

S-15


On the confirmation date, which will be      business days following the Expiration Date, a confirmation will be sent by the Subscription Agent to each Rights holder exercising its Rights (or, if a Rights holder’s common shares are held by DTC or any other depository or nominee, to DTC and/or that other depository or nominee) showing (i) the number of Shares acquired during the subscription period, (ii) the number of Shares, if any, acquired pursuant to the over-subscription privilege, (iii) the per Share and total purchase price for the Shares and (iv) any additional amount payable to the Fund by the Rights holder or any excess to be refunded by the Fund to the Rights holder, in each case based on the Subscription Price as determined on the Expiration Date. Any additional payment required from a Rights holder must be received by the Subscription Agent within      business days after the confirmation date (                                         , unless the subscription period is extended). Any excess payment to be refunded by the Fund to a Rights holder will be mailed by the Subscription Agent to such Rights holder as promptly as practicable. All payments by a Rights holder must be in U.S. dollars by money order or check drawn on a bank located in the United States and payable to “                                         ”

Whichever of the two methods described above is used, issuance and delivery of the Shares subscribed for are contingent upon actual payment for such Shares. No certificates will be issued or delivered with respect to Shares issued and sold in the Offer.

Rights holders who have exercised their Rights will have no right to rescind their subscription after receipt of the completed subscription certificate together with payment for Shares by the Subscription Agent, except as described under “—Notice of Net Asset Value Decline” below.

If a Rights holder who acquires Shares during the subscription period [or pursuant to the over-subscription privilege (for Record Date Shareholders)] does not make payment of any amounts due by the Expiration Date or the date payment is due under a notice of guaranteed delivery, the Fund reserves the right to take any or all of the following actions through all appropriate means: (i) find other Record Date Shareholders for the subscribed and unpaid-for Shares; [(ii) apply any payment actually received by the Fund toward the purchase of the greatest whole number of Shares that could be acquired by the Rights holder upon exercise of such Rights acquired during the subscription period or pursuant to the over-subscription privilege;] and/or (iii) exercise any and all other rights or remedies to which the Fund may be entitled, including, without limitation, the right to set off against payments actually received by it with respect to such subscribed Shares.

The method of delivery of completed subscription certificates and payment of the Subscription Price to the Subscription Agent will be at the election and risk of exercising Rights holders, but if sent by mail it is recommended that such forms and payments be sent by registered mail, properly insured, with return receipt requested, and that a sufficient number of days be allowed to ensure delivery to the Subscription Agent and clearance of payment by                     , Eastern time, on the Expiration Date. Because uncertified personal checks may take at least      business days to clear, exercising Rights holders are strongly urged to pay, or arrange for payment, by means of certified or cashier’s check with the Right holder’s name and Subscription Agent account number identified on the check.

All questions concerning the timeliness, validity, form and eligibility of any exercise of Rights will be determined by the Fund, which determinations will be final and binding. The Fund, in its sole discretion, may waive any defect or irregularity, or permit a defect or irregularity to be corrected within such time as it may determine, or reject the purported exercise of any Right. Subscriptions will not be deemed to have been received or accepted until substantially all irregularities have been waived or cured within such time as the Fund determines in its sole discretion. The Fund will not be under any duty to give notification of any defect or irregularity in connection with the submission of subscription certificates or incur any liability for failure to give such notification.

Notice of Net Asset Value Decline

The Fund has, pursuant to the SEC’s regulatory requirements, undertaken to suspend the Offer until the Fund amends this prospectus if, after                                          , the effective date of the Fund’s registration statement relating to the offer, the Fund’s net asset value declines more than     % from the Fund’s net asset value as of that date. In that event, the Expiration Date will be extended and the Fund will notify Record Date Shareholders of any such decline and permit Rights holders to cancel their exercise of Rights.

 

S-16


Delivery of Shares

Participants in the Fund’s dividend reinvestment plan (the “Plan”) will have any Shares acquired pursuant to the Offer credited to their shareholder dividend reinvestment accounts in the Plan. Common Shareholders whose shares are held of record by DTC or by any other depository or nominee on their behalf or their broker-dealers’ behalf will have any Shares acquired during the subscription period credited to the account of DTC or other depository or nominee. No certificates will be issued or delivered with respect to Shares issued and sold in the Offer.

U.S. Federal Income Tax Consequences

[TO COME]

Employee Plan Considerations

[TO COME]

Benefits to the Investment Adviser

The Investment Adviser will benefit from the Offer, in part, because the investment advisory fee paid by the Fund to the Investment Adviser is based on the Fund’s Managed Assets. It is not possible to state precisely the amount of additional compensation the Investment Adviser will receive as a result of the Offer because it is not known how many Shares of the Fund will be subscribed for and because the proceeds of the Offer will be invested in additional portfolio securities which will fluctuate in value. However, assuming (i) all Rights are exercised, (ii) the Fund’s average daily net asset value during the twelve-month period beginning                      is $                 per common share (the net asset value per common share on                 ) (iii) the Subscription Price is $                 per Share, and (iv) for purposes of this example, the Fund increases the amount of leverage outstanding while maintaining approximately the same percentage of total assets attributable to leverage, and after giving effect to Dealer Manager fee and other estimated offering expenses, the Investment Adviser would receive additional investment advisory fees of approximately $                 for the twelve-month period beginning                     , and would continue to receive additional investment advisory fees as a result of the Offer, based on the Fund’s Managed Assets attributable to the Shares issued in the Offer and related additional leverage, thereafter.

Investment Considerations and Dilution

Upon completion of the Offer, Common Shareholders who do not exercise their Rights fully will own a smaller proportional interest in the Fund than would be the case if the Offer had not been made. In addition, because the Subscription Price per Share is likely to be less than the Fund’s net asset value per common share, the Offer will likely result in a dilution of the Fund’s net asset value per common share for all Common Shareholders, irrespective of whether they exercise all or any portion of their Rights. Although it is not possible to state precisely the amount of such a decrease in value, because it is not known at this time what the Subscription Price will be, what the net asset value per common share will be on the Expiration Date or what proportion of Shares will be subscribed for, the dilution could be substantial. For example, assuming that all Rights are exercised, that the Fund’s net asset value on the Expiration Date is $                 per common share (the net asset value per common share on                     ), and that the Subscription Price is $                 per Share, the Fund’s net asset value per common share on this date would be reduced by approximately $                 per common share, after giving effect to the estimated Dealer Manager fee of $         and to other estimated offering expenses of $        , each payable by the Fund. Record Date Shareholders will experience a decrease in the net asset value per common share held by them, irrespective of whether they exercise all or any portion of their Rights. [The distribution of transferable Rights, which may themselves have value, will afford non-participating Common Shareholders the potential of receiving a cash payment upon the sale of the Rights, receipt of which may be viewed as partial compensation for the economic dilution of their interests, although there can be no assurance that a market for the Rights will develop.]

 

S-17


RISKS RELATING TO THE OFFER

Dilution Risk

As a result of this Offer, it is anticipated that even if you fully exercise your Rights, you should expect to incur immediate economic dilution and, if you do not exercise all of your Rights, you will incur voting dilution. Further, both the sales load and the expenses associated with the Offer paid by the Fund will immediately reduce the NAV of each Common Shareholder’s common shares. To the extent that the number of Common Shares outstanding after the Offer will have increased proportionately more than the increase in the size of the Fund’s net assets, you will, at the completion of the Offer, experience immediate dilution of net asset value. The percentage increase in common shares outstanding that will occur if all the Rights are exercised is     %. In addition, if the Subscription Price for the Offer is less than the Fund’s net asset value per share as of the Expiration Date, you would experience additional immediate dilution of net asset value as a result of the Offer. If the Subscription Price is substantially less than the current net asset value per share at the expiration of the Offer, such dilution could be substantial. It is anticipated that the existing Common Shareholders will experience immediate dilution even if they fully exercise their Rights. In addition, whether or not you exercise your Rights, you will experience a dilution of net asset value of the common shares because you will indirectly bear the expenses of this Offer, which include, among other items, SEC registration fees, printing expenses and the fees assessed by service providers (including the cost of the Fund’s counsel and independent registered public accounting firm). This dilution of net asset value will disproportionately affect Common Shareholders who do not exercise their Rights. The Fund cannot state precisely the amount of any decrease because it is not know at this time how many common shares will be subscribed for or what the net asset value or market price of the Fund’s common shares will be on the Expiration Date or what the Subscription Price will be. For example, based on the Fund’s net asset value and market price on                     , the Subscription Price would be less than net asset value and there would be dilution. Assuming full exercise of the Rights being offered at the Subscription Price and assuming that the Expiration Date were                 , it is estimated that the per share dilution resulting from the Offer, as of                                          , would be $        .

In addition to the economic dilution described above, if you do not exercise all of your Rights, you will incur voting dilution as a result of this Offer. This voting dilution will occur because you will own a smaller proportionate interest in the Fund after the Offer than you owned prior to the Offer.

[The fact that the Rights are transferable may reduce the effects of dilution as a result of the Offer. Rights holders can transfer or sell their Rights. The cash received from the sale of Rights may be viewed as partial compensation for any possible dilution. There can be no assurances, however, that a market for the Rights will develop or that the Rights will have any value in that market.]

Increase in Share Price Volatility; Decrease in Share Price

The Offer may result in an increase in trading of the Common Shares, which may increase volatility in the market price of the Common Shares. The Offer may result in an increase in the number of shareholders wishing to sell their Common Shares, which would exert downward price pressure on the price of Common Shares.

Under-Subscription

It is possible that the Offer will not be fully subscribed. Under-subscription of the Offer could have an impact on the net proceeds of the Offer and whether the Fund achieves any benefits.

Risks of Acquiring Rights to Purchase Common Shares

Shares of closed-end funds such as the Fund frequently trade at a discount to net asset value. Since inception, the Fund’s Common Shares have frequently traded at a discount in relation to NAV. See “Description of Common Shares.” If the Formula Price is less than     % of net asset value on the Expiration Date, then the Subscription Price will likely be greater than the market price of a Common Share on that date. In addition, the Formula Price, even if above     % of net asset value, may still be above the market price of a Common Share on the Expiration Date. If either event occurs, the Rights will have no value, and a person who exercises Rights will experience an immediate loss of value.

 

S-18


There can be no assurance that a market for the Rights will develop or, if such a market develops, what the price of the Rights will be. Changes in market conditions may result in the Common Shares purchasable upon exercise of the Rights being less attractive to investors at the Expiration Date. This may reduce or eliminate the value of the Rights. Investors who receive or acquire Rights may find that there is no market to sell Rights that they do not wish to excise.

PLAN OF DISTRIBUTION

Distribution Arrangements

[                     will act as Dealer Manager for this Offer. Under the terms and subject to the conditions contained in the Dealer Manager Agreement among the Dealer Manager, the Fund and the Adviser, the Dealer Manager will provide financial structuring and solicitation services in connection with the Offer and will solicit the exercise of Rights and participation in the Over-Subscription Privilege. The Offer is not contingent upon any number of Rights being exercised. The Dealer Manager will also be responsible for forming and managing a group of selling broker-dealers (each a “Selling Group Member” and collectively the “Selling Group Members”), whereby each Selling Group Member will enter into a Selling Group Agreement with the Dealer Manager to solicit the exercise of Rights and to sell Common Shares purchased by the Selling Group Member from the Dealer Manager. In addition, the Dealer Manager will enter into a Soliciting Dealer Agreement with other soliciting broker-dealers (each a “Soliciting Dealer” and collectively the “Soliciting Dealers”) to solicit the exercise of Rights. See “—Compensation to Dealer Manager” for a discussion of fees and other compensation to be paid to the Dealer Manager, Selling Group Members and Soliciting Dealers in connection with the Offer.

The Fund and the Adviser have each agreed to indemnify the Dealer Manager for losses arising out of certain liabilities, including liabilities under the Securities Act. The Dealer Manager Agreement also provides that the Dealer Manager will not be subject to any liability to the Fund in rendering the services contemplated by the Dealer Manager Agreement except for any act of willful misfeasance, bad faith or gross negligence of the Dealer Manager or reckless disregard by the Dealer Manager of its obligations and duties under the Dealer Manager Agreement.

Prior to the expiration of the Offer, the Dealer Manager may purchase Rights in the open-market and may purchase Rights offered to it by the Subscription Agent from electing Record Date Shareholders, that remain unclaimed as a result of subscription certificates being returned by the postal authorities and/or unexercised Rights of Record Date Shareholders whose record addresses are outside the United States that are held by the Subscription Agent and for which no instructions are received. The Dealer Manager may purchase such Rights as principal or act as agent on behalf of its clients for the purchase (and resale) of such Rights. The Dealer Manager is authorized to exercise Rights it acquires prior to the expiration of the Offer for delivery of Common Shares prior to the expiration of the Offer at a subscription price equal to [                    ]. Prior to the expiration of the Offer, the Dealer Manager may independently offer for sale Common Shares it has acquired through purchasing and exercising the Rights to the public or to Selling Group Members at the offering price set by the Dealer Manager from time to time.

Although the Dealer Manager may realize gains and losses in connection with purchases and sales of Common Shares, such offering of Common Shares is intended by the Dealer Manager to facilitate the Offer, and any such gains or losses are not expected to be material to the Dealer Manager. The Dealer Manager’s fee for its financial structuring and soliciting services is independent of any gains or losses that may be realized by the Dealer Manager through the purchase and exercise of the Rights and the sale of Common Shares.

Record Date Shareholders who do not wish to exercise any or all of their Rights may instruct the Subscription Agent to try to sell any Rights they do not intend to exercise themselves. Although Rights are expected to trade on the NYSE through the last business day prior to the Expiration Date, Subscription certificates evidencing the Rights to be sold by the Subscription Agent must be received by the Subscription Agent on or before 5:00 p.m., Eastern time, on                      (or, if the subscription period is extended, on or before 5:00 p.m., Eastern time,      business days prior to the extended Expiration Date). Upon the timely receipt by the Subscription Agent of

 

S-19


appropriate instructions to sell Rights, the Subscription Agent will ask the Dealer Manager if it will purchase the Rights. If the Dealer Manager purchases the Rights, the sales price paid by the Dealer Manager will be based upon the then-current market price for the Rights. The proceeds from each of such sales to the Dealer Manager will be remitted to the Subscription Agent, which will hold such proceeds in an account segregated from the Subscription Agent’s own funds pending distribution to each selling Record Date Shareholder. It is expected that following each such sale of Rights to the Dealer Manager, the proceeds from each such sale will be received by the Subscription

In the ordinary course of their businesses, the Dealer Manager and/or its affiliates may engage in investment banking or financial transactions with the Fund, the Adviser and their affiliates. In addition, in the ordinary course of their businesses, the Dealer Manager and/or its affiliates may, from time to time, own securities of the Fund or its affiliates.

The principal business address of the Dealer Manager is                                          .]

Compensation to Dealer Manager

[Pursuant to the Dealer Manager Agreement, the Fund, has agreed to pay the Dealer Manager a fee for its financial structuring and solicitation services equal to     % of the aggregate Subscription Price for Shares issued pursuant to the Offer and the Over-Subscription Privilege.

The Dealer Manager will reallow to Selling Group Members in the Selling Group to be formed and managed by the Dealer Manager selling fees equal to     % of the Subscription Price for each Common Share issued pursuant to the Offer or the Over-Subscription Privilege as a result of their selling efforts. In addition, the Dealer Manager will reallow to Soliciting Dealers that have executed and delivered a Soliciting Dealer Agreement and have solicited the exercise of Rights, solicitation fees equal to     % of the Subscription Price for each Common Share issued pursuant to the exercise of Rights as a result of their soliciting efforts, subject to a maximum fee based on the number of Common Shares held by such Soliciting Dealer through DTC on the Record Date. Fees will be paid to the broker-dealer designated on the applicable portion of the subscription certificates or, in the absence of such designation, to the Dealer Manager.

In addition, the Fund, has agreed to pay the Dealer Manager an amount up to $         as a partial reimbursement of its expenses incurred in connection with the Offer. The fees described above are one-time fees payable on each date on which the Fund issues Common Shares after the Expiration Date with respect to the Dealer Manager, and on or before the      business day following the day the Fund issues Common Shares after the Expiration Date with respect to a Selling Group Member or Soliciting Dealer. The Fund will also pay expenses relating to the printing or other production, mailing and delivery expenses incurred in connection with materials related to the Offer, including all reasonable out-of-pocket fees and expenses, if any and not to exceed $        , incurred by the Dealer Manager, Selling Group Members, Soliciting Dealers and other brokers, dealers and financial institutions in connection with their customary mailing and handling of materials related to the Offer to their customers. No other fees will be payable by the Fund or the Adviser to the Dealer Manager in connection with the Offer.]

LEGAL MATTERS

Certain legal matters will be passed on by Skadden, Arps, Slate, Meagher & Flom LLP, Chicago, Illinois, as special counsel to the Fund in connection with the Offer. Certain legal matters will be passed on by                     ,             ,         , as special counsel to the Dealer Manager in connection with the Offer.

INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

Ernst & Young LLP, Dallas, Texas, serves as the independent registered public accounting firm of the Fund and will annually render an opinion on the financial statements of the Fund.

 

S-20


ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

This Prospectus Supplement and the accompanying Prospectus constitute part of a Registration Statement filed by the Fund with the SEC under the Securities Act and the 1940 Act. This Prospectus Supplement and the accompanying Prospectus omit certain of the information contained in the Registration Statement, and reference is hereby made to the Registration Statement and related exhibits for further information with respect to the Fund and the Common Shares offered hereby. Any statements contained herein concerning the provisions of any document are not necessarily complete, and, in each instance, reference is made to the copy of such document filed as an exhibit to the Registration Statement or otherwise filed with the SEC. Each such statement is qualified in its entirety by such reference. The complete Registration Statement may be obtained from the SEC upon payment of the fee prescribed by its rules and regulations or free of charge through the SEC’s web site (http://www.sec.gov).

 

S-21


 

 

 

LOGO

                 Rights

The Cushing ® Renaissance Fund

Subscription Rights to Purchase Common Shares

 

 

FORM OF

PROSPECTUS

SUPPLEMENT

 

 

 

 

 

 

S-22